1 //===--- SemaExpr.cpp - Semantic Analysis for Expressions -----------------===// 2 // 3 // Part of the LLVM Project, under the Apache License v2.0 with LLVM Exceptions. 4 // See https://llvm.org/LICENSE.txt for license information. 5 // SPDX-License-Identifier: Apache-2.0 WITH LLVM-exception 6 // 7 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 8 // 9 // This file implements semantic analysis for expressions. 10 // 11 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 12 13 #include "TreeTransform.h" 14 #include "clang/AST/ASTConsumer.h" 15 #include "clang/AST/ASTContext.h" 16 #include "clang/AST/ASTLambda.h" 17 #include "clang/AST/ASTMutationListener.h" 18 #include "clang/AST/CXXInheritance.h" 19 #include "clang/AST/DeclObjC.h" 20 #include "clang/AST/DeclTemplate.h" 21 #include "clang/AST/EvaluatedExprVisitor.h" 22 #include "clang/AST/Expr.h" 23 #include "clang/AST/ExprCXX.h" 24 #include "clang/AST/ExprObjC.h" 25 #include "clang/AST/ExprOpenMP.h" 26 #include "clang/AST/RecursiveASTVisitor.h" 27 #include "clang/AST/TypeLoc.h" 28 #include "clang/Basic/FixedPoint.h" 29 #include "clang/Basic/PartialDiagnostic.h" 30 #include "clang/Basic/SourceManager.h" 31 #include "clang/Basic/TargetInfo.h" 32 #include "clang/Lex/LiteralSupport.h" 33 #include "clang/Lex/Preprocessor.h" 34 #include "clang/Sema/AnalysisBasedWarnings.h" 35 #include "clang/Sema/DeclSpec.h" 36 #include "clang/Sema/DelayedDiagnostic.h" 37 #include "clang/Sema/Designator.h" 38 #include "clang/Sema/Initialization.h" 39 #include "clang/Sema/Lookup.h" 40 #include "clang/Sema/Overload.h" 41 #include "clang/Sema/ParsedTemplate.h" 42 #include "clang/Sema/Scope.h" 43 #include "clang/Sema/ScopeInfo.h" 44 #include "clang/Sema/SemaFixItUtils.h" 45 #include "clang/Sema/SemaInternal.h" 46 #include "clang/Sema/Template.h" 47 #include "llvm/Support/ConvertUTF.h" 48 using namespace clang; 49 using namespace sema; 50 51 /// Determine whether the use of this declaration is valid, without 52 /// emitting diagnostics. 53 bool Sema::CanUseDecl(NamedDecl *D, bool TreatUnavailableAsInvalid) { 54 // See if this is an auto-typed variable whose initializer we are parsing. 55 if (ParsingInitForAutoVars.count(D)) 56 return false; 57 58 // See if this is a deleted function. 59 if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) { 60 if (FD->isDeleted()) 61 return false; 62 63 // If the function has a deduced return type, and we can't deduce it, 64 // then we can't use it either. 65 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus14 && FD->getReturnType()->isUndeducedType() && 66 DeduceReturnType(FD, SourceLocation(), /*Diagnose*/ false)) 67 return false; 68 69 // See if this is an aligned allocation/deallocation function that is 70 // unavailable. 71 if (TreatUnavailableAsInvalid && 72 isUnavailableAlignedAllocationFunction(*FD)) 73 return false; 74 } 75 76 // See if this function is unavailable. 77 if (TreatUnavailableAsInvalid && D->getAvailability() == AR_Unavailable && 78 cast<Decl>(CurContext)->getAvailability() != AR_Unavailable) 79 return false; 80 81 return true; 82 } 83 84 static void DiagnoseUnusedOfDecl(Sema &S, NamedDecl *D, SourceLocation Loc) { 85 // Warn if this is used but marked unused. 86 if (const auto *A = D->getAttr<UnusedAttr>()) { 87 // [[maybe_unused]] should not diagnose uses, but __attribute__((unused)) 88 // should diagnose them. 89 if (A->getSemanticSpelling() != UnusedAttr::CXX11_maybe_unused && 90 A->getSemanticSpelling() != UnusedAttr::C2x_maybe_unused) { 91 const Decl *DC = cast_or_null<Decl>(S.getCurObjCLexicalContext()); 92 if (DC && !DC->hasAttr<UnusedAttr>()) 93 S.Diag(Loc, diag::warn_used_but_marked_unused) << D->getDeclName(); 94 } 95 } 96 } 97 98 /// Emit a note explaining that this function is deleted. 99 void Sema::NoteDeletedFunction(FunctionDecl *Decl) { 100 assert(Decl->isDeleted()); 101 102 CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Decl); 103 104 if (Method && Method->isDeleted() && Method->isDefaulted()) { 105 // If the method was explicitly defaulted, point at that declaration. 106 if (!Method->isImplicit()) 107 Diag(Decl->getLocation(), diag::note_implicitly_deleted); 108 109 // Try to diagnose why this special member function was implicitly 110 // deleted. This might fail, if that reason no longer applies. 111 CXXSpecialMember CSM = getSpecialMember(Method); 112 if (CSM != CXXInvalid) 113 ShouldDeleteSpecialMember(Method, CSM, nullptr, /*Diagnose=*/true); 114 115 return; 116 } 117 118 auto *Ctor = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Decl); 119 if (Ctor && Ctor->isInheritingConstructor()) 120 return NoteDeletedInheritingConstructor(Ctor); 121 122 Diag(Decl->getLocation(), diag::note_availability_specified_here) 123 << Decl << 1; 124 } 125 126 /// Determine whether a FunctionDecl was ever declared with an 127 /// explicit storage class. 128 static bool hasAnyExplicitStorageClass(const FunctionDecl *D) { 129 for (auto I : D->redecls()) { 130 if (I->getStorageClass() != SC_None) 131 return true; 132 } 133 return false; 134 } 135 136 /// Check whether we're in an extern inline function and referring to a 137 /// variable or function with internal linkage (C11 6.7.4p3). 138 /// 139 /// This is only a warning because we used to silently accept this code, but 140 /// in many cases it will not behave correctly. This is not enabled in C++ mode 141 /// because the restriction language is a bit weaker (C++11 [basic.def.odr]p6) 142 /// and so while there may still be user mistakes, most of the time we can't 143 /// prove that there are errors. 144 static void diagnoseUseOfInternalDeclInInlineFunction(Sema &S, 145 const NamedDecl *D, 146 SourceLocation Loc) { 147 // This is disabled under C++; there are too many ways for this to fire in 148 // contexts where the warning is a false positive, or where it is technically 149 // correct but benign. 150 if (S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) 151 return; 152 153 // Check if this is an inlined function or method. 154 FunctionDecl *Current = S.getCurFunctionDecl(); 155 if (!Current) 156 return; 157 if (!Current->isInlined()) 158 return; 159 if (!Current->isExternallyVisible()) 160 return; 161 162 // Check if the decl has internal linkage. 163 if (D->getFormalLinkage() != InternalLinkage) 164 return; 165 166 // Downgrade from ExtWarn to Extension if 167 // (1) the supposedly external inline function is in the main file, 168 // and probably won't be included anywhere else. 169 // (2) the thing we're referencing is a pure function. 170 // (3) the thing we're referencing is another inline function. 171 // This last can give us false negatives, but it's better than warning on 172 // wrappers for simple C library functions. 173 const FunctionDecl *UsedFn = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D); 174 bool DowngradeWarning = S.getSourceManager().isInMainFile(Loc); 175 if (!DowngradeWarning && UsedFn) 176 DowngradeWarning = UsedFn->isInlined() || UsedFn->hasAttr<ConstAttr>(); 177 178 S.Diag(Loc, DowngradeWarning ? diag::ext_internal_in_extern_inline_quiet 179 : diag::ext_internal_in_extern_inline) 180 << /*IsVar=*/!UsedFn << D; 181 182 S.MaybeSuggestAddingStaticToDecl(Current); 183 184 S.Diag(D->getCanonicalDecl()->getLocation(), diag::note_entity_declared_at) 185 << D; 186 } 187 188 void Sema::MaybeSuggestAddingStaticToDecl(const FunctionDecl *Cur) { 189 const FunctionDecl *First = Cur->getFirstDecl(); 190 191 // Suggest "static" on the function, if possible. 192 if (!hasAnyExplicitStorageClass(First)) { 193 SourceLocation DeclBegin = First->getSourceRange().getBegin(); 194 Diag(DeclBegin, diag::note_convert_inline_to_static) 195 << Cur << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(DeclBegin, "static "); 196 } 197 } 198 199 /// Determine whether the use of this declaration is valid, and 200 /// emit any corresponding diagnostics. 201 /// 202 /// This routine diagnoses various problems with referencing 203 /// declarations that can occur when using a declaration. For example, 204 /// it might warn if a deprecated or unavailable declaration is being 205 /// used, or produce an error (and return true) if a C++0x deleted 206 /// function is being used. 207 /// 208 /// \returns true if there was an error (this declaration cannot be 209 /// referenced), false otherwise. 210 /// 211 bool Sema::DiagnoseUseOfDecl(NamedDecl *D, ArrayRef<SourceLocation> Locs, 212 const ObjCInterfaceDecl *UnknownObjCClass, 213 bool ObjCPropertyAccess, 214 bool AvoidPartialAvailabilityChecks, 215 ObjCInterfaceDecl *ClassReceiver) { 216 SourceLocation Loc = Locs.front(); 217 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && isa<FunctionDecl>(D)) { 218 // If there were any diagnostics suppressed by template argument deduction, 219 // emit them now. 220 auto Pos = SuppressedDiagnostics.find(D->getCanonicalDecl()); 221 if (Pos != SuppressedDiagnostics.end()) { 222 for (const PartialDiagnosticAt &Suppressed : Pos->second) 223 Diag(Suppressed.first, Suppressed.second); 224 225 // Clear out the list of suppressed diagnostics, so that we don't emit 226 // them again for this specialization. However, we don't obsolete this 227 // entry from the table, because we want to avoid ever emitting these 228 // diagnostics again. 229 Pos->second.clear(); 230 } 231 232 // C++ [basic.start.main]p3: 233 // The function 'main' shall not be used within a program. 234 if (cast<FunctionDecl>(D)->isMain()) 235 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_main_used); 236 237 diagnoseUnavailableAlignedAllocation(*cast<FunctionDecl>(D), Loc); 238 } 239 240 // See if this is an auto-typed variable whose initializer we are parsing. 241 if (ParsingInitForAutoVars.count(D)) { 242 if (isa<BindingDecl>(D)) { 243 Diag(Loc, diag::err_binding_cannot_appear_in_own_initializer) 244 << D->getDeclName(); 245 } else { 246 Diag(Loc, diag::err_auto_variable_cannot_appear_in_own_initializer) 247 << D->getDeclName() << cast<VarDecl>(D)->getType(); 248 } 249 return true; 250 } 251 252 // See if this is a deleted function. 253 if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) { 254 if (FD->isDeleted()) { 255 auto *Ctor = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(FD); 256 if (Ctor && Ctor->isInheritingConstructor()) 257 Diag(Loc, diag::err_deleted_inherited_ctor_use) 258 << Ctor->getParent() 259 << Ctor->getInheritedConstructor().getConstructor()->getParent(); 260 else 261 Diag(Loc, diag::err_deleted_function_use); 262 NoteDeletedFunction(FD); 263 return true; 264 } 265 266 // If the function has a deduced return type, and we can't deduce it, 267 // then we can't use it either. 268 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus14 && FD->getReturnType()->isUndeducedType() && 269 DeduceReturnType(FD, Loc)) 270 return true; 271 272 if (getLangOpts().CUDA && !CheckCUDACall(Loc, FD)) 273 return true; 274 } 275 276 if (auto *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(D)) { 277 // Lambdas are only default-constructible or assignable in C++2a onwards. 278 if (MD->getParent()->isLambda() && 279 ((isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(MD) && 280 cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(MD)->isDefaultConstructor()) || 281 MD->isCopyAssignmentOperator() || MD->isMoveAssignmentOperator())) { 282 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_cxx17_compat_lambda_def_ctor_assign) 283 << !isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(MD); 284 } 285 } 286 287 auto getReferencedObjCProp = [](const NamedDecl *D) -> 288 const ObjCPropertyDecl * { 289 if (const auto *MD = dyn_cast<ObjCMethodDecl>(D)) 290 return MD->findPropertyDecl(); 291 return nullptr; 292 }; 293 if (const ObjCPropertyDecl *ObjCPDecl = getReferencedObjCProp(D)) { 294 if (diagnoseArgIndependentDiagnoseIfAttrs(ObjCPDecl, Loc)) 295 return true; 296 } else if (diagnoseArgIndependentDiagnoseIfAttrs(D, Loc)) { 297 return true; 298 } 299 300 // [OpenMP 4.0], 2.15 declare reduction Directive, Restrictions 301 // Only the variables omp_in and omp_out are allowed in the combiner. 302 // Only the variables omp_priv and omp_orig are allowed in the 303 // initializer-clause. 304 auto *DRD = dyn_cast<OMPDeclareReductionDecl>(CurContext); 305 if (LangOpts.OpenMP && DRD && !CurContext->containsDecl(D) && 306 isa<VarDecl>(D)) { 307 Diag(Loc, diag::err_omp_wrong_var_in_declare_reduction) 308 << getCurFunction()->HasOMPDeclareReductionCombiner; 309 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_entity_declared_at) << D; 310 return true; 311 } 312 313 // [OpenMP 5.0], 2.19.7.3. declare mapper Directive, Restrictions 314 // List-items in map clauses on this construct may only refer to the declared 315 // variable var and entities that could be referenced by a procedure defined 316 // at the same location 317 auto *DMD = dyn_cast<OMPDeclareMapperDecl>(CurContext); 318 if (LangOpts.OpenMP && DMD && !CurContext->containsDecl(D) && 319 isa<VarDecl>(D)) { 320 Diag(Loc, diag::err_omp_declare_mapper_wrong_var) 321 << DMD->getVarName().getAsString(); 322 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_entity_declared_at) << D; 323 return true; 324 } 325 326 DiagnoseAvailabilityOfDecl(D, Locs, UnknownObjCClass, ObjCPropertyAccess, 327 AvoidPartialAvailabilityChecks, ClassReceiver); 328 329 DiagnoseUnusedOfDecl(*this, D, Loc); 330 331 diagnoseUseOfInternalDeclInInlineFunction(*this, D, Loc); 332 333 return false; 334 } 335 336 /// DiagnoseSentinelCalls - This routine checks whether a call or 337 /// message-send is to a declaration with the sentinel attribute, and 338 /// if so, it checks that the requirements of the sentinel are 339 /// satisfied. 340 void Sema::DiagnoseSentinelCalls(NamedDecl *D, SourceLocation Loc, 341 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args) { 342 const SentinelAttr *attr = D->getAttr<SentinelAttr>(); 343 if (!attr) 344 return; 345 346 // The number of formal parameters of the declaration. 347 unsigned numFormalParams; 348 349 // The kind of declaration. This is also an index into a %select in 350 // the diagnostic. 351 enum CalleeType { CT_Function, CT_Method, CT_Block } calleeType; 352 353 if (ObjCMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<ObjCMethodDecl>(D)) { 354 numFormalParams = MD->param_size(); 355 calleeType = CT_Method; 356 } else if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) { 357 numFormalParams = FD->param_size(); 358 calleeType = CT_Function; 359 } else if (isa<VarDecl>(D)) { 360 QualType type = cast<ValueDecl>(D)->getType(); 361 const FunctionType *fn = nullptr; 362 if (const PointerType *ptr = type->getAs<PointerType>()) { 363 fn = ptr->getPointeeType()->getAs<FunctionType>(); 364 if (!fn) return; 365 calleeType = CT_Function; 366 } else if (const BlockPointerType *ptr = type->getAs<BlockPointerType>()) { 367 fn = ptr->getPointeeType()->castAs<FunctionType>(); 368 calleeType = CT_Block; 369 } else { 370 return; 371 } 372 373 if (const FunctionProtoType *proto = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(fn)) { 374 numFormalParams = proto->getNumParams(); 375 } else { 376 numFormalParams = 0; 377 } 378 } else { 379 return; 380 } 381 382 // "nullPos" is the number of formal parameters at the end which 383 // effectively count as part of the variadic arguments. This is 384 // useful if you would prefer to not have *any* formal parameters, 385 // but the language forces you to have at least one. 386 unsigned nullPos = attr->getNullPos(); 387 assert((nullPos == 0 || nullPos == 1) && "invalid null position on sentinel"); 388 numFormalParams = (nullPos > numFormalParams ? 0 : numFormalParams - nullPos); 389 390 // The number of arguments which should follow the sentinel. 391 unsigned numArgsAfterSentinel = attr->getSentinel(); 392 393 // If there aren't enough arguments for all the formal parameters, 394 // the sentinel, and the args after the sentinel, complain. 395 if (Args.size() < numFormalParams + numArgsAfterSentinel + 1) { 396 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_not_enough_argument) << D->getDeclName(); 397 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_sentinel_here) << int(calleeType); 398 return; 399 } 400 401 // Otherwise, find the sentinel expression. 402 Expr *sentinelExpr = Args[Args.size() - numArgsAfterSentinel - 1]; 403 if (!sentinelExpr) return; 404 if (sentinelExpr->isValueDependent()) return; 405 if (Context.isSentinelNullExpr(sentinelExpr)) return; 406 407 // Pick a reasonable string to insert. Optimistically use 'nil', 'nullptr', 408 // or 'NULL' if those are actually defined in the context. Only use 409 // 'nil' for ObjC methods, where it's much more likely that the 410 // variadic arguments form a list of object pointers. 411 SourceLocation MissingNilLoc = getLocForEndOfToken(sentinelExpr->getEndLoc()); 412 std::string NullValue; 413 if (calleeType == CT_Method && PP.isMacroDefined("nil")) 414 NullValue = "nil"; 415 else if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11) 416 NullValue = "nullptr"; 417 else if (PP.isMacroDefined("NULL")) 418 NullValue = "NULL"; 419 else 420 NullValue = "(void*) 0"; 421 422 if (MissingNilLoc.isInvalid()) 423 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_missing_sentinel) << int(calleeType); 424 else 425 Diag(MissingNilLoc, diag::warn_missing_sentinel) 426 << int(calleeType) 427 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(MissingNilLoc, ", " + NullValue); 428 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_sentinel_here) << int(calleeType); 429 } 430 431 SourceRange Sema::getExprRange(Expr *E) const { 432 return E ? E->getSourceRange() : SourceRange(); 433 } 434 435 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 436 // Standard Promotions and Conversions 437 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 438 439 /// DefaultFunctionArrayConversion (C99 6.3.2.1p3, C99 6.3.2.1p4). 440 ExprResult Sema::DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(Expr *E, bool Diagnose) { 441 // Handle any placeholder expressions which made it here. 442 if (E->getType()->isPlaceholderType()) { 443 ExprResult result = CheckPlaceholderExpr(E); 444 if (result.isInvalid()) return ExprError(); 445 E = result.get(); 446 } 447 448 QualType Ty = E->getType(); 449 assert(!Ty.isNull() && "DefaultFunctionArrayConversion - missing type"); 450 451 if (Ty->isFunctionType()) { 452 if (auto *DRE = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(E->IgnoreParenCasts())) 453 if (auto *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(DRE->getDecl())) 454 if (!checkAddressOfFunctionIsAvailable(FD, Diagnose, E->getExprLoc())) 455 return ExprError(); 456 457 E = ImpCastExprToType(E, Context.getPointerType(Ty), 458 CK_FunctionToPointerDecay).get(); 459 } else if (Ty->isArrayType()) { 460 // In C90 mode, arrays only promote to pointers if the array expression is 461 // an lvalue. The relevant legalese is C90 6.2.2.1p3: "an lvalue that has 462 // type 'array of type' is converted to an expression that has type 'pointer 463 // to type'...". In C99 this was changed to: C99 6.3.2.1p3: "an expression 464 // that has type 'array of type' ...". The relevant change is "an lvalue" 465 // (C90) to "an expression" (C99). 466 // 467 // C++ 4.2p1: 468 // An lvalue or rvalue of type "array of N T" or "array of unknown bound of 469 // T" can be converted to an rvalue of type "pointer to T". 470 // 471 if (getLangOpts().C99 || getLangOpts().CPlusPlus || E->isLValue()) 472 E = ImpCastExprToType(E, Context.getArrayDecayedType(Ty), 473 CK_ArrayToPointerDecay).get(); 474 } 475 return E; 476 } 477 478 static void CheckForNullPointerDereference(Sema &S, Expr *E) { 479 // Check to see if we are dereferencing a null pointer. If so, 480 // and if not volatile-qualified, this is undefined behavior that the 481 // optimizer will delete, so warn about it. People sometimes try to use this 482 // to get a deterministic trap and are surprised by clang's behavior. This 483 // only handles the pattern "*null", which is a very syntactic check. 484 if (UnaryOperator *UO = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(E->IgnoreParenCasts())) 485 if (UO->getOpcode() == UO_Deref && 486 UO->getSubExpr()->IgnoreParenCasts()-> 487 isNullPointerConstant(S.Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull) && 488 !UO->getType().isVolatileQualified()) { 489 S.DiagRuntimeBehavior(UO->getOperatorLoc(), UO, 490 S.PDiag(diag::warn_indirection_through_null) 491 << UO->getSubExpr()->getSourceRange()); 492 S.DiagRuntimeBehavior(UO->getOperatorLoc(), UO, 493 S.PDiag(diag::note_indirection_through_null)); 494 } 495 } 496 497 static void DiagnoseDirectIsaAccess(Sema &S, const ObjCIvarRefExpr *OIRE, 498 SourceLocation AssignLoc, 499 const Expr* RHS) { 500 const ObjCIvarDecl *IV = OIRE->getDecl(); 501 if (!IV) 502 return; 503 504 DeclarationName MemberName = IV->getDeclName(); 505 IdentifierInfo *Member = MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo(); 506 if (!Member || !Member->isStr("isa")) 507 return; 508 509 const Expr *Base = OIRE->getBase(); 510 QualType BaseType = Base->getType(); 511 if (OIRE->isArrow()) 512 BaseType = BaseType->getPointeeType(); 513 if (const ObjCObjectType *OTy = BaseType->getAs<ObjCObjectType>()) 514 if (ObjCInterfaceDecl *IDecl = OTy->getInterface()) { 515 ObjCInterfaceDecl *ClassDeclared = nullptr; 516 ObjCIvarDecl *IV = IDecl->lookupInstanceVariable(Member, ClassDeclared); 517 if (!ClassDeclared->getSuperClass() 518 && (*ClassDeclared->ivar_begin()) == IV) { 519 if (RHS) { 520 NamedDecl *ObjectSetClass = 521 S.LookupSingleName(S.TUScope, 522 &S.Context.Idents.get("object_setClass"), 523 SourceLocation(), S.LookupOrdinaryName); 524 if (ObjectSetClass) { 525 SourceLocation RHSLocEnd = S.getLocForEndOfToken(RHS->getEndLoc()); 526 S.Diag(OIRE->getExprLoc(), diag::warn_objc_isa_assign) 527 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(OIRE->getBeginLoc(), 528 "object_setClass(") 529 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement( 530 SourceRange(OIRE->getOpLoc(), AssignLoc), ",") 531 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(RHSLocEnd, ")"); 532 } 533 else 534 S.Diag(OIRE->getLocation(), diag::warn_objc_isa_assign); 535 } else { 536 NamedDecl *ObjectGetClass = 537 S.LookupSingleName(S.TUScope, 538 &S.Context.Idents.get("object_getClass"), 539 SourceLocation(), S.LookupOrdinaryName); 540 if (ObjectGetClass) 541 S.Diag(OIRE->getExprLoc(), diag::warn_objc_isa_use) 542 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(OIRE->getBeginLoc(), 543 "object_getClass(") 544 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement( 545 SourceRange(OIRE->getOpLoc(), OIRE->getEndLoc()), ")"); 546 else 547 S.Diag(OIRE->getLocation(), diag::warn_objc_isa_use); 548 } 549 S.Diag(IV->getLocation(), diag::note_ivar_decl); 550 } 551 } 552 } 553 554 ExprResult Sema::DefaultLvalueConversion(Expr *E) { 555 // Handle any placeholder expressions which made it here. 556 if (E->getType()->isPlaceholderType()) { 557 ExprResult result = CheckPlaceholderExpr(E); 558 if (result.isInvalid()) return ExprError(); 559 E = result.get(); 560 } 561 562 // C++ [conv.lval]p1: 563 // A glvalue of a non-function, non-array type T can be 564 // converted to a prvalue. 565 if (!E->isGLValue()) return E; 566 567 QualType T = E->getType(); 568 assert(!T.isNull() && "r-value conversion on typeless expression?"); 569 570 // We don't want to throw lvalue-to-rvalue casts on top of 571 // expressions of certain types in C++. 572 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && 573 (E->getType() == Context.OverloadTy || 574 T->isDependentType() || 575 T->isRecordType())) 576 return E; 577 578 // The C standard is actually really unclear on this point, and 579 // DR106 tells us what the result should be but not why. It's 580 // generally best to say that void types just doesn't undergo 581 // lvalue-to-rvalue at all. Note that expressions of unqualified 582 // 'void' type are never l-values, but qualified void can be. 583 if (T->isVoidType()) 584 return E; 585 586 // OpenCL usually rejects direct accesses to values of 'half' type. 587 if (getLangOpts().OpenCL && !getOpenCLOptions().isEnabled("cl_khr_fp16") && 588 T->isHalfType()) { 589 Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_opencl_half_load_store) 590 << 0 << T; 591 return ExprError(); 592 } 593 594 CheckForNullPointerDereference(*this, E); 595 if (const ObjCIsaExpr *OISA = dyn_cast<ObjCIsaExpr>(E->IgnoreParenCasts())) { 596 NamedDecl *ObjectGetClass = LookupSingleName(TUScope, 597 &Context.Idents.get("object_getClass"), 598 SourceLocation(), LookupOrdinaryName); 599 if (ObjectGetClass) 600 Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::warn_objc_isa_use) 601 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(OISA->getBeginLoc(), "object_getClass(") 602 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement( 603 SourceRange(OISA->getOpLoc(), OISA->getIsaMemberLoc()), ")"); 604 else 605 Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::warn_objc_isa_use); 606 } 607 else if (const ObjCIvarRefExpr *OIRE = 608 dyn_cast<ObjCIvarRefExpr>(E->IgnoreParenCasts())) 609 DiagnoseDirectIsaAccess(*this, OIRE, SourceLocation(), /* Expr*/nullptr); 610 611 // C++ [conv.lval]p1: 612 // [...] If T is a non-class type, the type of the prvalue is the 613 // cv-unqualified version of T. Otherwise, the type of the 614 // rvalue is T. 615 // 616 // C99 6.3.2.1p2: 617 // If the lvalue has qualified type, the value has the unqualified 618 // version of the type of the lvalue; otherwise, the value has the 619 // type of the lvalue. 620 if (T.hasQualifiers()) 621 T = T.getUnqualifiedType(); 622 623 // Under the MS ABI, lock down the inheritance model now. 624 if (T->isMemberPointerType() && 625 Context.getTargetInfo().getCXXABI().isMicrosoft()) 626 (void)isCompleteType(E->getExprLoc(), T); 627 628 ExprResult Res = CheckLValueToRValueConversionOperand(E); 629 if (Res.isInvalid()) 630 return Res; 631 E = Res.get(); 632 633 // Loading a __weak object implicitly retains the value, so we need a cleanup to 634 // balance that. 635 if (E->getType().getObjCLifetime() == Qualifiers::OCL_Weak) 636 Cleanup.setExprNeedsCleanups(true); 637 638 // C++ [conv.lval]p3: 639 // If T is cv std::nullptr_t, the result is a null pointer constant. 640 CastKind CK = T->isNullPtrType() ? CK_NullToPointer : CK_LValueToRValue; 641 Res = ImplicitCastExpr::Create(Context, T, CK, E, nullptr, VK_RValue); 642 643 // C11 6.3.2.1p2: 644 // ... if the lvalue has atomic type, the value has the non-atomic version 645 // of the type of the lvalue ... 646 if (const AtomicType *Atomic = T->getAs<AtomicType>()) { 647 T = Atomic->getValueType().getUnqualifiedType(); 648 Res = ImplicitCastExpr::Create(Context, T, CK_AtomicToNonAtomic, Res.get(), 649 nullptr, VK_RValue); 650 } 651 652 return Res; 653 } 654 655 ExprResult Sema::DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Expr *E, bool Diagnose) { 656 ExprResult Res = DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(E, Diagnose); 657 if (Res.isInvalid()) 658 return ExprError(); 659 Res = DefaultLvalueConversion(Res.get()); 660 if (Res.isInvalid()) 661 return ExprError(); 662 return Res; 663 } 664 665 /// CallExprUnaryConversions - a special case of an unary conversion 666 /// performed on a function designator of a call expression. 667 ExprResult Sema::CallExprUnaryConversions(Expr *E) { 668 QualType Ty = E->getType(); 669 ExprResult Res = E; 670 // Only do implicit cast for a function type, but not for a pointer 671 // to function type. 672 if (Ty->isFunctionType()) { 673 Res = ImpCastExprToType(E, Context.getPointerType(Ty), 674 CK_FunctionToPointerDecay).get(); 675 if (Res.isInvalid()) 676 return ExprError(); 677 } 678 Res = DefaultLvalueConversion(Res.get()); 679 if (Res.isInvalid()) 680 return ExprError(); 681 return Res.get(); 682 } 683 684 /// UsualUnaryConversions - Performs various conversions that are common to most 685 /// operators (C99 6.3). The conversions of array and function types are 686 /// sometimes suppressed. For example, the array->pointer conversion doesn't 687 /// apply if the array is an argument to the sizeof or address (&) operators. 688 /// In these instances, this routine should *not* be called. 689 ExprResult Sema::UsualUnaryConversions(Expr *E) { 690 // First, convert to an r-value. 691 ExprResult Res = DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(E); 692 if (Res.isInvalid()) 693 return ExprError(); 694 E = Res.get(); 695 696 QualType Ty = E->getType(); 697 assert(!Ty.isNull() && "UsualUnaryConversions - missing type"); 698 699 // Half FP have to be promoted to float unless it is natively supported 700 if (Ty->isHalfType() && !getLangOpts().NativeHalfType) 701 return ImpCastExprToType(Res.get(), Context.FloatTy, CK_FloatingCast); 702 703 // Try to perform integral promotions if the object has a theoretically 704 // promotable type. 705 if (Ty->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType()) { 706 // C99 6.3.1.1p2: 707 // 708 // The following may be used in an expression wherever an int or 709 // unsigned int may be used: 710 // - an object or expression with an integer type whose integer 711 // conversion rank is less than or equal to the rank of int 712 // and unsigned int. 713 // - A bit-field of type _Bool, int, signed int, or unsigned int. 714 // 715 // If an int can represent all values of the original type, the 716 // value is converted to an int; otherwise, it is converted to an 717 // unsigned int. These are called the integer promotions. All 718 // other types are unchanged by the integer promotions. 719 720 QualType PTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(E); 721 if (!PTy.isNull()) { 722 E = ImpCastExprToType(E, PTy, CK_IntegralCast).get(); 723 return E; 724 } 725 if (Ty->isPromotableIntegerType()) { 726 QualType PT = Context.getPromotedIntegerType(Ty); 727 E = ImpCastExprToType(E, PT, CK_IntegralCast).get(); 728 return E; 729 } 730 } 731 return E; 732 } 733 734 /// DefaultArgumentPromotion (C99 6.5.2.2p6). Used for function calls that 735 /// do not have a prototype. Arguments that have type float or __fp16 736 /// are promoted to double. All other argument types are converted by 737 /// UsualUnaryConversions(). 738 ExprResult Sema::DefaultArgumentPromotion(Expr *E) { 739 QualType Ty = E->getType(); 740 assert(!Ty.isNull() && "DefaultArgumentPromotion - missing type"); 741 742 ExprResult Res = UsualUnaryConversions(E); 743 if (Res.isInvalid()) 744 return ExprError(); 745 E = Res.get(); 746 747 // If this is a 'float' or '__fp16' (CVR qualified or typedef) 748 // promote to double. 749 // Note that default argument promotion applies only to float (and 750 // half/fp16); it does not apply to _Float16. 751 const BuiltinType *BTy = Ty->getAs<BuiltinType>(); 752 if (BTy && (BTy->getKind() == BuiltinType::Half || 753 BTy->getKind() == BuiltinType::Float)) { 754 if (getLangOpts().OpenCL && 755 !getOpenCLOptions().isEnabled("cl_khr_fp64")) { 756 if (BTy->getKind() == BuiltinType::Half) { 757 E = ImpCastExprToType(E, Context.FloatTy, CK_FloatingCast).get(); 758 } 759 } else { 760 E = ImpCastExprToType(E, Context.DoubleTy, CK_FloatingCast).get(); 761 } 762 } 763 764 // C++ performs lvalue-to-rvalue conversion as a default argument 765 // promotion, even on class types, but note: 766 // C++11 [conv.lval]p2: 767 // When an lvalue-to-rvalue conversion occurs in an unevaluated 768 // operand or a subexpression thereof the value contained in the 769 // referenced object is not accessed. Otherwise, if the glvalue 770 // has a class type, the conversion copy-initializes a temporary 771 // of type T from the glvalue and the result of the conversion 772 // is a prvalue for the temporary. 773 // FIXME: add some way to gate this entire thing for correctness in 774 // potentially potentially evaluated contexts. 775 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && E->isGLValue() && !isUnevaluatedContext()) { 776 ExprResult Temp = PerformCopyInitialization( 777 InitializedEntity::InitializeTemporary(E->getType()), 778 E->getExprLoc(), E); 779 if (Temp.isInvalid()) 780 return ExprError(); 781 E = Temp.get(); 782 } 783 784 return E; 785 } 786 787 /// Determine the degree of POD-ness for an expression. 788 /// Incomplete types are considered POD, since this check can be performed 789 /// when we're in an unevaluated context. 790 Sema::VarArgKind Sema::isValidVarArgType(const QualType &Ty) { 791 if (Ty->isIncompleteType()) { 792 // C++11 [expr.call]p7: 793 // After these conversions, if the argument does not have arithmetic, 794 // enumeration, pointer, pointer to member, or class type, the program 795 // is ill-formed. 796 // 797 // Since we've already performed array-to-pointer and function-to-pointer 798 // decay, the only such type in C++ is cv void. This also handles 799 // initializer lists as variadic arguments. 800 if (Ty->isVoidType()) 801 return VAK_Invalid; 802 803 if (Ty->isObjCObjectType()) 804 return VAK_Invalid; 805 return VAK_Valid; 806 } 807 808 if (Ty.isDestructedType() == QualType::DK_nontrivial_c_struct) 809 return VAK_Invalid; 810 811 if (Ty.isCXX98PODType(Context)) 812 return VAK_Valid; 813 814 // C++11 [expr.call]p7: 815 // Passing a potentially-evaluated argument of class type (Clause 9) 816 // having a non-trivial copy constructor, a non-trivial move constructor, 817 // or a non-trivial destructor, with no corresponding parameter, 818 // is conditionally-supported with implementation-defined semantics. 819 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11 && !Ty->isDependentType()) 820 if (CXXRecordDecl *Record = Ty->getAsCXXRecordDecl()) 821 if (!Record->hasNonTrivialCopyConstructor() && 822 !Record->hasNonTrivialMoveConstructor() && 823 !Record->hasNonTrivialDestructor()) 824 return VAK_ValidInCXX11; 825 826 if (getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount && Ty->isObjCLifetimeType()) 827 return VAK_Valid; 828 829 if (Ty->isObjCObjectType()) 830 return VAK_Invalid; 831 832 if (getLangOpts().MSVCCompat) 833 return VAK_MSVCUndefined; 834 835 // FIXME: In C++11, these cases are conditionally-supported, meaning we're 836 // permitted to reject them. We should consider doing so. 837 return VAK_Undefined; 838 } 839 840 void Sema::checkVariadicArgument(const Expr *E, VariadicCallType CT) { 841 // Don't allow one to pass an Objective-C interface to a vararg. 842 const QualType &Ty = E->getType(); 843 VarArgKind VAK = isValidVarArgType(Ty); 844 845 // Complain about passing non-POD types through varargs. 846 switch (VAK) { 847 case VAK_ValidInCXX11: 848 DiagRuntimeBehavior( 849 E->getBeginLoc(), nullptr, 850 PDiag(diag::warn_cxx98_compat_pass_non_pod_arg_to_vararg) << Ty << CT); 851 LLVM_FALLTHROUGH; 852 case VAK_Valid: 853 if (Ty->isRecordType()) { 854 // This is unlikely to be what the user intended. If the class has a 855 // 'c_str' member function, the user probably meant to call that. 856 DiagRuntimeBehavior(E->getBeginLoc(), nullptr, 857 PDiag(diag::warn_pass_class_arg_to_vararg) 858 << Ty << CT << hasCStrMethod(E) << ".c_str()"); 859 } 860 break; 861 862 case VAK_Undefined: 863 case VAK_MSVCUndefined: 864 DiagRuntimeBehavior(E->getBeginLoc(), nullptr, 865 PDiag(diag::warn_cannot_pass_non_pod_arg_to_vararg) 866 << getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11 << Ty << CT); 867 break; 868 869 case VAK_Invalid: 870 if (Ty.isDestructedType() == QualType::DK_nontrivial_c_struct) 871 Diag(E->getBeginLoc(), 872 diag::err_cannot_pass_non_trivial_c_struct_to_vararg) 873 << Ty << CT; 874 else if (Ty->isObjCObjectType()) 875 DiagRuntimeBehavior(E->getBeginLoc(), nullptr, 876 PDiag(diag::err_cannot_pass_objc_interface_to_vararg) 877 << Ty << CT); 878 else 879 Diag(E->getBeginLoc(), diag::err_cannot_pass_to_vararg) 880 << isa<InitListExpr>(E) << Ty << CT; 881 break; 882 } 883 } 884 885 /// DefaultVariadicArgumentPromotion - Like DefaultArgumentPromotion, but 886 /// will create a trap if the resulting type is not a POD type. 887 ExprResult Sema::DefaultVariadicArgumentPromotion(Expr *E, VariadicCallType CT, 888 FunctionDecl *FDecl) { 889 if (const BuiltinType *PlaceholderTy = E->getType()->getAsPlaceholderType()) { 890 // Strip the unbridged-cast placeholder expression off, if applicable. 891 if (PlaceholderTy->getKind() == BuiltinType::ARCUnbridgedCast && 892 (CT == VariadicMethod || 893 (FDecl && FDecl->hasAttr<CFAuditedTransferAttr>()))) { 894 E = stripARCUnbridgedCast(E); 895 896 // Otherwise, do normal placeholder checking. 897 } else { 898 ExprResult ExprRes = CheckPlaceholderExpr(E); 899 if (ExprRes.isInvalid()) 900 return ExprError(); 901 E = ExprRes.get(); 902 } 903 } 904 905 ExprResult ExprRes = DefaultArgumentPromotion(E); 906 if (ExprRes.isInvalid()) 907 return ExprError(); 908 E = ExprRes.get(); 909 910 // Diagnostics regarding non-POD argument types are 911 // emitted along with format string checking in Sema::CheckFunctionCall(). 912 if (isValidVarArgType(E->getType()) == VAK_Undefined) { 913 // Turn this into a trap. 914 CXXScopeSpec SS; 915 SourceLocation TemplateKWLoc; 916 UnqualifiedId Name; 917 Name.setIdentifier(PP.getIdentifierInfo("__builtin_trap"), 918 E->getBeginLoc()); 919 ExprResult TrapFn = ActOnIdExpression(TUScope, SS, TemplateKWLoc, Name, 920 /*HasTrailingLParen=*/true, 921 /*IsAddressOfOperand=*/false); 922 if (TrapFn.isInvalid()) 923 return ExprError(); 924 925 ExprResult Call = BuildCallExpr(TUScope, TrapFn.get(), E->getBeginLoc(), 926 None, E->getEndLoc()); 927 if (Call.isInvalid()) 928 return ExprError(); 929 930 ExprResult Comma = 931 ActOnBinOp(TUScope, E->getBeginLoc(), tok::comma, Call.get(), E); 932 if (Comma.isInvalid()) 933 return ExprError(); 934 return Comma.get(); 935 } 936 937 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && 938 RequireCompleteType(E->getExprLoc(), E->getType(), 939 diag::err_call_incomplete_argument)) 940 return ExprError(); 941 942 return E; 943 } 944 945 /// Converts an integer to complex float type. Helper function of 946 /// UsualArithmeticConversions() 947 /// 948 /// \return false if the integer expression is an integer type and is 949 /// successfully converted to the complex type. 950 static bool handleIntegerToComplexFloatConversion(Sema &S, ExprResult &IntExpr, 951 ExprResult &ComplexExpr, 952 QualType IntTy, 953 QualType ComplexTy, 954 bool SkipCast) { 955 if (IntTy->isComplexType() || IntTy->isRealFloatingType()) return true; 956 if (SkipCast) return false; 957 if (IntTy->isIntegerType()) { 958 QualType fpTy = cast<ComplexType>(ComplexTy)->getElementType(); 959 IntExpr = S.ImpCastExprToType(IntExpr.get(), fpTy, CK_IntegralToFloating); 960 IntExpr = S.ImpCastExprToType(IntExpr.get(), ComplexTy, 961 CK_FloatingRealToComplex); 962 } else { 963 assert(IntTy->isComplexIntegerType()); 964 IntExpr = S.ImpCastExprToType(IntExpr.get(), ComplexTy, 965 CK_IntegralComplexToFloatingComplex); 966 } 967 return false; 968 } 969 970 /// Handle arithmetic conversion with complex types. Helper function of 971 /// UsualArithmeticConversions() 972 static QualType handleComplexFloatConversion(Sema &S, ExprResult &LHS, 973 ExprResult &RHS, QualType LHSType, 974 QualType RHSType, 975 bool IsCompAssign) { 976 // if we have an integer operand, the result is the complex type. 977 if (!handleIntegerToComplexFloatConversion(S, RHS, LHS, RHSType, LHSType, 978 /*skipCast*/false)) 979 return LHSType; 980 if (!handleIntegerToComplexFloatConversion(S, LHS, RHS, LHSType, RHSType, 981 /*skipCast*/IsCompAssign)) 982 return RHSType; 983 984 // This handles complex/complex, complex/float, or float/complex. 985 // When both operands are complex, the shorter operand is converted to the 986 // type of the longer, and that is the type of the result. This corresponds 987 // to what is done when combining two real floating-point operands. 988 // The fun begins when size promotion occur across type domains. 989 // From H&S 6.3.4: When one operand is complex and the other is a real 990 // floating-point type, the less precise type is converted, within it's 991 // real or complex domain, to the precision of the other type. For example, 992 // when combining a "long double" with a "double _Complex", the 993 // "double _Complex" is promoted to "long double _Complex". 994 995 // Compute the rank of the two types, regardless of whether they are complex. 996 int Order = S.Context.getFloatingTypeOrder(LHSType, RHSType); 997 998 auto *LHSComplexType = dyn_cast<ComplexType>(LHSType); 999 auto *RHSComplexType = dyn_cast<ComplexType>(RHSType); 1000 QualType LHSElementType = 1001 LHSComplexType ? LHSComplexType->getElementType() : LHSType; 1002 QualType RHSElementType = 1003 RHSComplexType ? RHSComplexType->getElementType() : RHSType; 1004 1005 QualType ResultType = S.Context.getComplexType(LHSElementType); 1006 if (Order < 0) { 1007 // Promote the precision of the LHS if not an assignment. 1008 ResultType = S.Context.getComplexType(RHSElementType); 1009 if (!IsCompAssign) { 1010 if (LHSComplexType) 1011 LHS = 1012 S.ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), ResultType, CK_FloatingComplexCast); 1013 else 1014 LHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), RHSElementType, CK_FloatingCast); 1015 } 1016 } else if (Order > 0) { 1017 // Promote the precision of the RHS. 1018 if (RHSComplexType) 1019 RHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), ResultType, CK_FloatingComplexCast); 1020 else 1021 RHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), LHSElementType, CK_FloatingCast); 1022 } 1023 return ResultType; 1024 } 1025 1026 /// Handle arithmetic conversion from integer to float. Helper function 1027 /// of UsualArithmeticConversions() 1028 static QualType handleIntToFloatConversion(Sema &S, ExprResult &FloatExpr, 1029 ExprResult &IntExpr, 1030 QualType FloatTy, QualType IntTy, 1031 bool ConvertFloat, bool ConvertInt) { 1032 if (IntTy->isIntegerType()) { 1033 if (ConvertInt) 1034 // Convert intExpr to the lhs floating point type. 1035 IntExpr = S.ImpCastExprToType(IntExpr.get(), FloatTy, 1036 CK_IntegralToFloating); 1037 return FloatTy; 1038 } 1039 1040 // Convert both sides to the appropriate complex float. 1041 assert(IntTy->isComplexIntegerType()); 1042 QualType result = S.Context.getComplexType(FloatTy); 1043 1044 // _Complex int -> _Complex float 1045 if (ConvertInt) 1046 IntExpr = S.ImpCastExprToType(IntExpr.get(), result, 1047 CK_IntegralComplexToFloatingComplex); 1048 1049 // float -> _Complex float 1050 if (ConvertFloat) 1051 FloatExpr = S.ImpCastExprToType(FloatExpr.get(), result, 1052 CK_FloatingRealToComplex); 1053 1054 return result; 1055 } 1056 1057 /// Handle arithmethic conversion with floating point types. Helper 1058 /// function of UsualArithmeticConversions() 1059 static QualType handleFloatConversion(Sema &S, ExprResult &LHS, 1060 ExprResult &RHS, QualType LHSType, 1061 QualType RHSType, bool IsCompAssign) { 1062 bool LHSFloat = LHSType->isRealFloatingType(); 1063 bool RHSFloat = RHSType->isRealFloatingType(); 1064 1065 // If we have two real floating types, convert the smaller operand 1066 // to the bigger result. 1067 if (LHSFloat && RHSFloat) { 1068 int order = S.Context.getFloatingTypeOrder(LHSType, RHSType); 1069 if (order > 0) { 1070 RHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), LHSType, CK_FloatingCast); 1071 return LHSType; 1072 } 1073 1074 assert(order < 0 && "illegal float comparison"); 1075 if (!IsCompAssign) 1076 LHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), RHSType, CK_FloatingCast); 1077 return RHSType; 1078 } 1079 1080 if (LHSFloat) { 1081 // Half FP has to be promoted to float unless it is natively supported 1082 if (LHSType->isHalfType() && !S.getLangOpts().NativeHalfType) 1083 LHSType = S.Context.FloatTy; 1084 1085 return handleIntToFloatConversion(S, LHS, RHS, LHSType, RHSType, 1086 /*ConvertFloat=*/!IsCompAssign, 1087 /*ConvertInt=*/ true); 1088 } 1089 assert(RHSFloat); 1090 return handleIntToFloatConversion(S, RHS, LHS, RHSType, LHSType, 1091 /*convertInt=*/ true, 1092 /*convertFloat=*/!IsCompAssign); 1093 } 1094 1095 /// Diagnose attempts to convert between __float128 and long double if 1096 /// there is no support for such conversion. Helper function of 1097 /// UsualArithmeticConversions(). 1098 static bool unsupportedTypeConversion(const Sema &S, QualType LHSType, 1099 QualType RHSType) { 1100 /* No issue converting if at least one of the types is not a floating point 1101 type or the two types have the same rank. 1102 */ 1103 if (!LHSType->isFloatingType() || !RHSType->isFloatingType() || 1104 S.Context.getFloatingTypeOrder(LHSType, RHSType) == 0) 1105 return false; 1106 1107 assert(LHSType->isFloatingType() && RHSType->isFloatingType() && 1108 "The remaining types must be floating point types."); 1109 1110 auto *LHSComplex = LHSType->getAs<ComplexType>(); 1111 auto *RHSComplex = RHSType->getAs<ComplexType>(); 1112 1113 QualType LHSElemType = LHSComplex ? 1114 LHSComplex->getElementType() : LHSType; 1115 QualType RHSElemType = RHSComplex ? 1116 RHSComplex->getElementType() : RHSType; 1117 1118 // No issue if the two types have the same representation 1119 if (&S.Context.getFloatTypeSemantics(LHSElemType) == 1120 &S.Context.getFloatTypeSemantics(RHSElemType)) 1121 return false; 1122 1123 bool Float128AndLongDouble = (LHSElemType == S.Context.Float128Ty && 1124 RHSElemType == S.Context.LongDoubleTy); 1125 Float128AndLongDouble |= (LHSElemType == S.Context.LongDoubleTy && 1126 RHSElemType == S.Context.Float128Ty); 1127 1128 // We've handled the situation where __float128 and long double have the same 1129 // representation. We allow all conversions for all possible long double types 1130 // except PPC's double double. 1131 return Float128AndLongDouble && 1132 (&S.Context.getFloatTypeSemantics(S.Context.LongDoubleTy) == 1133 &llvm::APFloat::PPCDoubleDouble()); 1134 } 1135 1136 typedef ExprResult PerformCastFn(Sema &S, Expr *operand, QualType toType); 1137 1138 namespace { 1139 /// These helper callbacks are placed in an anonymous namespace to 1140 /// permit their use as function template parameters. 1141 ExprResult doIntegralCast(Sema &S, Expr *op, QualType toType) { 1142 return S.ImpCastExprToType(op, toType, CK_IntegralCast); 1143 } 1144 1145 ExprResult doComplexIntegralCast(Sema &S, Expr *op, QualType toType) { 1146 return S.ImpCastExprToType(op, S.Context.getComplexType(toType), 1147 CK_IntegralComplexCast); 1148 } 1149 } 1150 1151 /// Handle integer arithmetic conversions. Helper function of 1152 /// UsualArithmeticConversions() 1153 template <PerformCastFn doLHSCast, PerformCastFn doRHSCast> 1154 static QualType handleIntegerConversion(Sema &S, ExprResult &LHS, 1155 ExprResult &RHS, QualType LHSType, 1156 QualType RHSType, bool IsCompAssign) { 1157 // The rules for this case are in C99 6.3.1.8 1158 int order = S.Context.getIntegerTypeOrder(LHSType, RHSType); 1159 bool LHSSigned = LHSType->hasSignedIntegerRepresentation(); 1160 bool RHSSigned = RHSType->hasSignedIntegerRepresentation(); 1161 if (LHSSigned == RHSSigned) { 1162 // Same signedness; use the higher-ranked type 1163 if (order >= 0) { 1164 RHS = (*doRHSCast)(S, RHS.get(), LHSType); 1165 return LHSType; 1166 } else if (!IsCompAssign) 1167 LHS = (*doLHSCast)(S, LHS.get(), RHSType); 1168 return RHSType; 1169 } else if (order != (LHSSigned ? 1 : -1)) { 1170 // The unsigned type has greater than or equal rank to the 1171 // signed type, so use the unsigned type 1172 if (RHSSigned) { 1173 RHS = (*doRHSCast)(S, RHS.get(), LHSType); 1174 return LHSType; 1175 } else if (!IsCompAssign) 1176 LHS = (*doLHSCast)(S, LHS.get(), RHSType); 1177 return RHSType; 1178 } else if (S.Context.getIntWidth(LHSType) != S.Context.getIntWidth(RHSType)) { 1179 // The two types are different widths; if we are here, that 1180 // means the signed type is larger than the unsigned type, so 1181 // use the signed type. 1182 if (LHSSigned) { 1183 RHS = (*doRHSCast)(S, RHS.get(), LHSType); 1184 return LHSType; 1185 } else if (!IsCompAssign) 1186 LHS = (*doLHSCast)(S, LHS.get(), RHSType); 1187 return RHSType; 1188 } else { 1189 // The signed type is higher-ranked than the unsigned type, 1190 // but isn't actually any bigger (like unsigned int and long 1191 // on most 32-bit systems). Use the unsigned type corresponding 1192 // to the signed type. 1193 QualType result = 1194 S.Context.getCorrespondingUnsignedType(LHSSigned ? LHSType : RHSType); 1195 RHS = (*doRHSCast)(S, RHS.get(), result); 1196 if (!IsCompAssign) 1197 LHS = (*doLHSCast)(S, LHS.get(), result); 1198 return result; 1199 } 1200 } 1201 1202 /// Handle conversions with GCC complex int extension. Helper function 1203 /// of UsualArithmeticConversions() 1204 static QualType handleComplexIntConversion(Sema &S, ExprResult &LHS, 1205 ExprResult &RHS, QualType LHSType, 1206 QualType RHSType, 1207 bool IsCompAssign) { 1208 const ComplexType *LHSComplexInt = LHSType->getAsComplexIntegerType(); 1209 const ComplexType *RHSComplexInt = RHSType->getAsComplexIntegerType(); 1210 1211 if (LHSComplexInt && RHSComplexInt) { 1212 QualType LHSEltType = LHSComplexInt->getElementType(); 1213 QualType RHSEltType = RHSComplexInt->getElementType(); 1214 QualType ScalarType = 1215 handleIntegerConversion<doComplexIntegralCast, doComplexIntegralCast> 1216 (S, LHS, RHS, LHSEltType, RHSEltType, IsCompAssign); 1217 1218 return S.Context.getComplexType(ScalarType); 1219 } 1220 1221 if (LHSComplexInt) { 1222 QualType LHSEltType = LHSComplexInt->getElementType(); 1223 QualType ScalarType = 1224 handleIntegerConversion<doComplexIntegralCast, doIntegralCast> 1225 (S, LHS, RHS, LHSEltType, RHSType, IsCompAssign); 1226 QualType ComplexType = S.Context.getComplexType(ScalarType); 1227 RHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), ComplexType, 1228 CK_IntegralRealToComplex); 1229 1230 return ComplexType; 1231 } 1232 1233 assert(RHSComplexInt); 1234 1235 QualType RHSEltType = RHSComplexInt->getElementType(); 1236 QualType ScalarType = 1237 handleIntegerConversion<doIntegralCast, doComplexIntegralCast> 1238 (S, LHS, RHS, LHSType, RHSEltType, IsCompAssign); 1239 QualType ComplexType = S.Context.getComplexType(ScalarType); 1240 1241 if (!IsCompAssign) 1242 LHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), ComplexType, 1243 CK_IntegralRealToComplex); 1244 return ComplexType; 1245 } 1246 1247 /// Return the rank of a given fixed point or integer type. The value itself 1248 /// doesn't matter, but the values must be increasing with proper increasing 1249 /// rank as described in N1169 4.1.1. 1250 static unsigned GetFixedPointRank(QualType Ty) { 1251 const auto *BTy = Ty->getAs<BuiltinType>(); 1252 assert(BTy && "Expected a builtin type."); 1253 1254 switch (BTy->getKind()) { 1255 case BuiltinType::ShortFract: 1256 case BuiltinType::UShortFract: 1257 case BuiltinType::SatShortFract: 1258 case BuiltinType::SatUShortFract: 1259 return 1; 1260 case BuiltinType::Fract: 1261 case BuiltinType::UFract: 1262 case BuiltinType::SatFract: 1263 case BuiltinType::SatUFract: 1264 return 2; 1265 case BuiltinType::LongFract: 1266 case BuiltinType::ULongFract: 1267 case BuiltinType::SatLongFract: 1268 case BuiltinType::SatULongFract: 1269 return 3; 1270 case BuiltinType::ShortAccum: 1271 case BuiltinType::UShortAccum: 1272 case BuiltinType::SatShortAccum: 1273 case BuiltinType::SatUShortAccum: 1274 return 4; 1275 case BuiltinType::Accum: 1276 case BuiltinType::UAccum: 1277 case BuiltinType::SatAccum: 1278 case BuiltinType::SatUAccum: 1279 return 5; 1280 case BuiltinType::LongAccum: 1281 case BuiltinType::ULongAccum: 1282 case BuiltinType::SatLongAccum: 1283 case BuiltinType::SatULongAccum: 1284 return 6; 1285 default: 1286 if (BTy->isInteger()) 1287 return 0; 1288 llvm_unreachable("Unexpected fixed point or integer type"); 1289 } 1290 } 1291 1292 /// handleFixedPointConversion - Fixed point operations between fixed 1293 /// point types and integers or other fixed point types do not fall under 1294 /// usual arithmetic conversion since these conversions could result in loss 1295 /// of precsision (N1169 4.1.4). These operations should be calculated with 1296 /// the full precision of their result type (N1169 4.1.6.2.1). 1297 static QualType handleFixedPointConversion(Sema &S, QualType LHSTy, 1298 QualType RHSTy) { 1299 assert((LHSTy->isFixedPointType() || RHSTy->isFixedPointType()) && 1300 "Expected at least one of the operands to be a fixed point type"); 1301 assert((LHSTy->isFixedPointOrIntegerType() || 1302 RHSTy->isFixedPointOrIntegerType()) && 1303 "Special fixed point arithmetic operation conversions are only " 1304 "applied to ints or other fixed point types"); 1305 1306 // If one operand has signed fixed-point type and the other operand has 1307 // unsigned fixed-point type, then the unsigned fixed-point operand is 1308 // converted to its corresponding signed fixed-point type and the resulting 1309 // type is the type of the converted operand. 1310 if (RHSTy->isSignedFixedPointType() && LHSTy->isUnsignedFixedPointType()) 1311 LHSTy = S.Context.getCorrespondingSignedFixedPointType(LHSTy); 1312 else if (RHSTy->isUnsignedFixedPointType() && LHSTy->isSignedFixedPointType()) 1313 RHSTy = S.Context.getCorrespondingSignedFixedPointType(RHSTy); 1314 1315 // The result type is the type with the highest rank, whereby a fixed-point 1316 // conversion rank is always greater than an integer conversion rank; if the 1317 // type of either of the operands is a saturating fixedpoint type, the result 1318 // type shall be the saturating fixed-point type corresponding to the type 1319 // with the highest rank; the resulting value is converted (taking into 1320 // account rounding and overflow) to the precision of the resulting type. 1321 // Same ranks between signed and unsigned types are resolved earlier, so both 1322 // types are either signed or both unsigned at this point. 1323 unsigned LHSTyRank = GetFixedPointRank(LHSTy); 1324 unsigned RHSTyRank = GetFixedPointRank(RHSTy); 1325 1326 QualType ResultTy = LHSTyRank > RHSTyRank ? LHSTy : RHSTy; 1327 1328 if (LHSTy->isSaturatedFixedPointType() || RHSTy->isSaturatedFixedPointType()) 1329 ResultTy = S.Context.getCorrespondingSaturatedType(ResultTy); 1330 1331 return ResultTy; 1332 } 1333 1334 /// UsualArithmeticConversions - Performs various conversions that are common to 1335 /// binary operators (C99 6.3.1.8). If both operands aren't arithmetic, this 1336 /// routine returns the first non-arithmetic type found. The client is 1337 /// responsible for emitting appropriate error diagnostics. 1338 QualType Sema::UsualArithmeticConversions(ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS, 1339 bool IsCompAssign) { 1340 if (!IsCompAssign) { 1341 LHS = UsualUnaryConversions(LHS.get()); 1342 if (LHS.isInvalid()) 1343 return QualType(); 1344 } 1345 1346 RHS = UsualUnaryConversions(RHS.get()); 1347 if (RHS.isInvalid()) 1348 return QualType(); 1349 1350 // For conversion purposes, we ignore any qualifiers. 1351 // For example, "const float" and "float" are equivalent. 1352 QualType LHSType = 1353 Context.getCanonicalType(LHS.get()->getType()).getUnqualifiedType(); 1354 QualType RHSType = 1355 Context.getCanonicalType(RHS.get()->getType()).getUnqualifiedType(); 1356 1357 // For conversion purposes, we ignore any atomic qualifier on the LHS. 1358 if (const AtomicType *AtomicLHS = LHSType->getAs<AtomicType>()) 1359 LHSType = AtomicLHS->getValueType(); 1360 1361 // If both types are identical, no conversion is needed. 1362 if (LHSType == RHSType) 1363 return LHSType; 1364 1365 // If either side is a non-arithmetic type (e.g. a pointer), we are done. 1366 // The caller can deal with this (e.g. pointer + int). 1367 if (!LHSType->isArithmeticType() || !RHSType->isArithmeticType()) 1368 return QualType(); 1369 1370 // Apply unary and bitfield promotions to the LHS's type. 1371 QualType LHSUnpromotedType = LHSType; 1372 if (LHSType->isPromotableIntegerType()) 1373 LHSType = Context.getPromotedIntegerType(LHSType); 1374 QualType LHSBitfieldPromoteTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(LHS.get()); 1375 if (!LHSBitfieldPromoteTy.isNull()) 1376 LHSType = LHSBitfieldPromoteTy; 1377 if (LHSType != LHSUnpromotedType && !IsCompAssign) 1378 LHS = ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), LHSType, CK_IntegralCast); 1379 1380 // If both types are identical, no conversion is needed. 1381 if (LHSType == RHSType) 1382 return LHSType; 1383 1384 // At this point, we have two different arithmetic types. 1385 1386 // Diagnose attempts to convert between __float128 and long double where 1387 // such conversions currently can't be handled. 1388 if (unsupportedTypeConversion(*this, LHSType, RHSType)) 1389 return QualType(); 1390 1391 // Handle complex types first (C99 6.3.1.8p1). 1392 if (LHSType->isComplexType() || RHSType->isComplexType()) 1393 return handleComplexFloatConversion(*this, LHS, RHS, LHSType, RHSType, 1394 IsCompAssign); 1395 1396 // Now handle "real" floating types (i.e. float, double, long double). 1397 if (LHSType->isRealFloatingType() || RHSType->isRealFloatingType()) 1398 return handleFloatConversion(*this, LHS, RHS, LHSType, RHSType, 1399 IsCompAssign); 1400 1401 // Handle GCC complex int extension. 1402 if (LHSType->isComplexIntegerType() || RHSType->isComplexIntegerType()) 1403 return handleComplexIntConversion(*this, LHS, RHS, LHSType, RHSType, 1404 IsCompAssign); 1405 1406 if (LHSType->isFixedPointType() || RHSType->isFixedPointType()) 1407 return handleFixedPointConversion(*this, LHSType, RHSType); 1408 1409 // Finally, we have two differing integer types. 1410 return handleIntegerConversion<doIntegralCast, doIntegralCast> 1411 (*this, LHS, RHS, LHSType, RHSType, IsCompAssign); 1412 } 1413 1414 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 1415 // Semantic Analysis for various Expression Types 1416 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 1417 1418 1419 ExprResult 1420 Sema::ActOnGenericSelectionExpr(SourceLocation KeyLoc, 1421 SourceLocation DefaultLoc, 1422 SourceLocation RParenLoc, 1423 Expr *ControllingExpr, 1424 ArrayRef<ParsedType> ArgTypes, 1425 ArrayRef<Expr *> ArgExprs) { 1426 unsigned NumAssocs = ArgTypes.size(); 1427 assert(NumAssocs == ArgExprs.size()); 1428 1429 TypeSourceInfo **Types = new TypeSourceInfo*[NumAssocs]; 1430 for (unsigned i = 0; i < NumAssocs; ++i) { 1431 if (ArgTypes[i]) 1432 (void) GetTypeFromParser(ArgTypes[i], &Types[i]); 1433 else 1434 Types[i] = nullptr; 1435 } 1436 1437 ExprResult ER = CreateGenericSelectionExpr(KeyLoc, DefaultLoc, RParenLoc, 1438 ControllingExpr, 1439 llvm::makeArrayRef(Types, NumAssocs), 1440 ArgExprs); 1441 delete [] Types; 1442 return ER; 1443 } 1444 1445 ExprResult 1446 Sema::CreateGenericSelectionExpr(SourceLocation KeyLoc, 1447 SourceLocation DefaultLoc, 1448 SourceLocation RParenLoc, 1449 Expr *ControllingExpr, 1450 ArrayRef<TypeSourceInfo *> Types, 1451 ArrayRef<Expr *> Exprs) { 1452 unsigned NumAssocs = Types.size(); 1453 assert(NumAssocs == Exprs.size()); 1454 1455 // Decay and strip qualifiers for the controlling expression type, and handle 1456 // placeholder type replacement. See committee discussion from WG14 DR423. 1457 { 1458 EnterExpressionEvaluationContext Unevaluated( 1459 *this, Sema::ExpressionEvaluationContext::Unevaluated); 1460 ExprResult R = DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(ControllingExpr); 1461 if (R.isInvalid()) 1462 return ExprError(); 1463 ControllingExpr = R.get(); 1464 } 1465 1466 // The controlling expression is an unevaluated operand, so side effects are 1467 // likely unintended. 1468 if (!inTemplateInstantiation() && 1469 ControllingExpr->HasSideEffects(Context, false)) 1470 Diag(ControllingExpr->getExprLoc(), 1471 diag::warn_side_effects_unevaluated_context); 1472 1473 bool TypeErrorFound = false, 1474 IsResultDependent = ControllingExpr->isTypeDependent(), 1475 ContainsUnexpandedParameterPack 1476 = ControllingExpr->containsUnexpandedParameterPack(); 1477 1478 for (unsigned i = 0; i < NumAssocs; ++i) { 1479 if (Exprs[i]->containsUnexpandedParameterPack()) 1480 ContainsUnexpandedParameterPack = true; 1481 1482 if (Types[i]) { 1483 if (Types[i]->getType()->containsUnexpandedParameterPack()) 1484 ContainsUnexpandedParameterPack = true; 1485 1486 if (Types[i]->getType()->isDependentType()) { 1487 IsResultDependent = true; 1488 } else { 1489 // C11 6.5.1.1p2 "The type name in a generic association shall specify a 1490 // complete object type other than a variably modified type." 1491 unsigned D = 0; 1492 if (Types[i]->getType()->isIncompleteType()) 1493 D = diag::err_assoc_type_incomplete; 1494 else if (!Types[i]->getType()->isObjectType()) 1495 D = diag::err_assoc_type_nonobject; 1496 else if (Types[i]->getType()->isVariablyModifiedType()) 1497 D = diag::err_assoc_type_variably_modified; 1498 1499 if (D != 0) { 1500 Diag(Types[i]->getTypeLoc().getBeginLoc(), D) 1501 << Types[i]->getTypeLoc().getSourceRange() 1502 << Types[i]->getType(); 1503 TypeErrorFound = true; 1504 } 1505 1506 // C11 6.5.1.1p2 "No two generic associations in the same generic 1507 // selection shall specify compatible types." 1508 for (unsigned j = i+1; j < NumAssocs; ++j) 1509 if (Types[j] && !Types[j]->getType()->isDependentType() && 1510 Context.typesAreCompatible(Types[i]->getType(), 1511 Types[j]->getType())) { 1512 Diag(Types[j]->getTypeLoc().getBeginLoc(), 1513 diag::err_assoc_compatible_types) 1514 << Types[j]->getTypeLoc().getSourceRange() 1515 << Types[j]->getType() 1516 << Types[i]->getType(); 1517 Diag(Types[i]->getTypeLoc().getBeginLoc(), 1518 diag::note_compat_assoc) 1519 << Types[i]->getTypeLoc().getSourceRange() 1520 << Types[i]->getType(); 1521 TypeErrorFound = true; 1522 } 1523 } 1524 } 1525 } 1526 if (TypeErrorFound) 1527 return ExprError(); 1528 1529 // If we determined that the generic selection is result-dependent, don't 1530 // try to compute the result expression. 1531 if (IsResultDependent) 1532 return GenericSelectionExpr::Create(Context, KeyLoc, ControllingExpr, Types, 1533 Exprs, DefaultLoc, RParenLoc, 1534 ContainsUnexpandedParameterPack); 1535 1536 SmallVector<unsigned, 1> CompatIndices; 1537 unsigned DefaultIndex = -1U; 1538 for (unsigned i = 0; i < NumAssocs; ++i) { 1539 if (!Types[i]) 1540 DefaultIndex = i; 1541 else if (Context.typesAreCompatible(ControllingExpr->getType(), 1542 Types[i]->getType())) 1543 CompatIndices.push_back(i); 1544 } 1545 1546 // C11 6.5.1.1p2 "The controlling expression of a generic selection shall have 1547 // type compatible with at most one of the types named in its generic 1548 // association list." 1549 if (CompatIndices.size() > 1) { 1550 // We strip parens here because the controlling expression is typically 1551 // parenthesized in macro definitions. 1552 ControllingExpr = ControllingExpr->IgnoreParens(); 1553 Diag(ControllingExpr->getBeginLoc(), diag::err_generic_sel_multi_match) 1554 << ControllingExpr->getSourceRange() << ControllingExpr->getType() 1555 << (unsigned)CompatIndices.size(); 1556 for (unsigned I : CompatIndices) { 1557 Diag(Types[I]->getTypeLoc().getBeginLoc(), 1558 diag::note_compat_assoc) 1559 << Types[I]->getTypeLoc().getSourceRange() 1560 << Types[I]->getType(); 1561 } 1562 return ExprError(); 1563 } 1564 1565 // C11 6.5.1.1p2 "If a generic selection has no default generic association, 1566 // its controlling expression shall have type compatible with exactly one of 1567 // the types named in its generic association list." 1568 if (DefaultIndex == -1U && CompatIndices.size() == 0) { 1569 // We strip parens here because the controlling expression is typically 1570 // parenthesized in macro definitions. 1571 ControllingExpr = ControllingExpr->IgnoreParens(); 1572 Diag(ControllingExpr->getBeginLoc(), diag::err_generic_sel_no_match) 1573 << ControllingExpr->getSourceRange() << ControllingExpr->getType(); 1574 return ExprError(); 1575 } 1576 1577 // C11 6.5.1.1p3 "If a generic selection has a generic association with a 1578 // type name that is compatible with the type of the controlling expression, 1579 // then the result expression of the generic selection is the expression 1580 // in that generic association. Otherwise, the result expression of the 1581 // generic selection is the expression in the default generic association." 1582 unsigned ResultIndex = 1583 CompatIndices.size() ? CompatIndices[0] : DefaultIndex; 1584 1585 return GenericSelectionExpr::Create( 1586 Context, KeyLoc, ControllingExpr, Types, Exprs, DefaultLoc, RParenLoc, 1587 ContainsUnexpandedParameterPack, ResultIndex); 1588 } 1589 1590 /// getUDSuffixLoc - Create a SourceLocation for a ud-suffix, given the 1591 /// location of the token and the offset of the ud-suffix within it. 1592 static SourceLocation getUDSuffixLoc(Sema &S, SourceLocation TokLoc, 1593 unsigned Offset) { 1594 return Lexer::AdvanceToTokenCharacter(TokLoc, Offset, S.getSourceManager(), 1595 S.getLangOpts()); 1596 } 1597 1598 /// BuildCookedLiteralOperatorCall - A user-defined literal was found. Look up 1599 /// the corresponding cooked (non-raw) literal operator, and build a call to it. 1600 static ExprResult BuildCookedLiteralOperatorCall(Sema &S, Scope *Scope, 1601 IdentifierInfo *UDSuffix, 1602 SourceLocation UDSuffixLoc, 1603 ArrayRef<Expr*> Args, 1604 SourceLocation LitEndLoc) { 1605 assert(Args.size() <= 2 && "too many arguments for literal operator"); 1606 1607 QualType ArgTy[2]; 1608 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx != Args.size(); ++ArgIdx) { 1609 ArgTy[ArgIdx] = Args[ArgIdx]->getType(); 1610 if (ArgTy[ArgIdx]->isArrayType()) 1611 ArgTy[ArgIdx] = S.Context.getArrayDecayedType(ArgTy[ArgIdx]); 1612 } 1613 1614 DeclarationName OpName = 1615 S.Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXLiteralOperatorName(UDSuffix); 1616 DeclarationNameInfo OpNameInfo(OpName, UDSuffixLoc); 1617 OpNameInfo.setCXXLiteralOperatorNameLoc(UDSuffixLoc); 1618 1619 LookupResult R(S, OpName, UDSuffixLoc, Sema::LookupOrdinaryName); 1620 if (S.LookupLiteralOperator(Scope, R, llvm::makeArrayRef(ArgTy, Args.size()), 1621 /*AllowRaw*/ false, /*AllowTemplate*/ false, 1622 /*AllowStringTemplate*/ false, 1623 /*DiagnoseMissing*/ true) == Sema::LOLR_Error) 1624 return ExprError(); 1625 1626 return S.BuildLiteralOperatorCall(R, OpNameInfo, Args, LitEndLoc); 1627 } 1628 1629 /// ActOnStringLiteral - The specified tokens were lexed as pasted string 1630 /// fragments (e.g. "foo" "bar" L"baz"). The result string has to handle string 1631 /// concatenation ([C99 5.1.1.2, translation phase #6]), so it may come from 1632 /// multiple tokens. However, the common case is that StringToks points to one 1633 /// string. 1634 /// 1635 ExprResult 1636 Sema::ActOnStringLiteral(ArrayRef<Token> StringToks, Scope *UDLScope) { 1637 assert(!StringToks.empty() && "Must have at least one string!"); 1638 1639 StringLiteralParser Literal(StringToks, PP); 1640 if (Literal.hadError) 1641 return ExprError(); 1642 1643 SmallVector<SourceLocation, 4> StringTokLocs; 1644 for (const Token &Tok : StringToks) 1645 StringTokLocs.push_back(Tok.getLocation()); 1646 1647 QualType CharTy = Context.CharTy; 1648 StringLiteral::StringKind Kind = StringLiteral::Ascii; 1649 if (Literal.isWide()) { 1650 CharTy = Context.getWideCharType(); 1651 Kind = StringLiteral::Wide; 1652 } else if (Literal.isUTF8()) { 1653 if (getLangOpts().Char8) 1654 CharTy = Context.Char8Ty; 1655 Kind = StringLiteral::UTF8; 1656 } else if (Literal.isUTF16()) { 1657 CharTy = Context.Char16Ty; 1658 Kind = StringLiteral::UTF16; 1659 } else if (Literal.isUTF32()) { 1660 CharTy = Context.Char32Ty; 1661 Kind = StringLiteral::UTF32; 1662 } else if (Literal.isPascal()) { 1663 CharTy = Context.UnsignedCharTy; 1664 } 1665 1666 // Warn on initializing an array of char from a u8 string literal; this 1667 // becomes ill-formed in C++2a. 1668 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && !getLangOpts().CPlusPlus2a && 1669 !getLangOpts().Char8 && Kind == StringLiteral::UTF8) { 1670 Diag(StringTokLocs.front(), diag::warn_cxx2a_compat_utf8_string); 1671 1672 // Create removals for all 'u8' prefixes in the string literal(s). This 1673 // ensures C++2a compatibility (but may change the program behavior when 1674 // built by non-Clang compilers for which the execution character set is 1675 // not always UTF-8). 1676 auto RemovalDiag = PDiag(diag::note_cxx2a_compat_utf8_string_remove_u8); 1677 SourceLocation RemovalDiagLoc; 1678 for (const Token &Tok : StringToks) { 1679 if (Tok.getKind() == tok::utf8_string_literal) { 1680 if (RemovalDiagLoc.isInvalid()) 1681 RemovalDiagLoc = Tok.getLocation(); 1682 RemovalDiag << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(CharSourceRange::getCharRange( 1683 Tok.getLocation(), 1684 Lexer::AdvanceToTokenCharacter(Tok.getLocation(), 2, 1685 getSourceManager(), getLangOpts()))); 1686 } 1687 } 1688 Diag(RemovalDiagLoc, RemovalDiag); 1689 } 1690 1691 QualType StrTy = 1692 Context.getStringLiteralArrayType(CharTy, Literal.GetNumStringChars()); 1693 1694 // Pass &StringTokLocs[0], StringTokLocs.size() to factory! 1695 StringLiteral *Lit = StringLiteral::Create(Context, Literal.GetString(), 1696 Kind, Literal.Pascal, StrTy, 1697 &StringTokLocs[0], 1698 StringTokLocs.size()); 1699 if (Literal.getUDSuffix().empty()) 1700 return Lit; 1701 1702 // We're building a user-defined literal. 1703 IdentifierInfo *UDSuffix = &Context.Idents.get(Literal.getUDSuffix()); 1704 SourceLocation UDSuffixLoc = 1705 getUDSuffixLoc(*this, StringTokLocs[Literal.getUDSuffixToken()], 1706 Literal.getUDSuffixOffset()); 1707 1708 // Make sure we're allowed user-defined literals here. 1709 if (!UDLScope) 1710 return ExprError(Diag(UDSuffixLoc, diag::err_invalid_string_udl)); 1711 1712 // C++11 [lex.ext]p5: The literal L is treated as a call of the form 1713 // operator "" X (str, len) 1714 QualType SizeType = Context.getSizeType(); 1715 1716 DeclarationName OpName = 1717 Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXLiteralOperatorName(UDSuffix); 1718 DeclarationNameInfo OpNameInfo(OpName, UDSuffixLoc); 1719 OpNameInfo.setCXXLiteralOperatorNameLoc(UDSuffixLoc); 1720 1721 QualType ArgTy[] = { 1722 Context.getArrayDecayedType(StrTy), SizeType 1723 }; 1724 1725 LookupResult R(*this, OpName, UDSuffixLoc, LookupOrdinaryName); 1726 switch (LookupLiteralOperator(UDLScope, R, ArgTy, 1727 /*AllowRaw*/ false, /*AllowTemplate*/ false, 1728 /*AllowStringTemplate*/ true, 1729 /*DiagnoseMissing*/ true)) { 1730 1731 case LOLR_Cooked: { 1732 llvm::APInt Len(Context.getIntWidth(SizeType), Literal.GetNumStringChars()); 1733 IntegerLiteral *LenArg = IntegerLiteral::Create(Context, Len, SizeType, 1734 StringTokLocs[0]); 1735 Expr *Args[] = { Lit, LenArg }; 1736 1737 return BuildLiteralOperatorCall(R, OpNameInfo, Args, StringTokLocs.back()); 1738 } 1739 1740 case LOLR_StringTemplate: { 1741 TemplateArgumentListInfo ExplicitArgs; 1742 1743 unsigned CharBits = Context.getIntWidth(CharTy); 1744 bool CharIsUnsigned = CharTy->isUnsignedIntegerType(); 1745 llvm::APSInt Value(CharBits, CharIsUnsigned); 1746 1747 TemplateArgument TypeArg(CharTy); 1748 TemplateArgumentLocInfo TypeArgInfo(Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(CharTy)); 1749 ExplicitArgs.addArgument(TemplateArgumentLoc(TypeArg, TypeArgInfo)); 1750 1751 for (unsigned I = 0, N = Lit->getLength(); I != N; ++I) { 1752 Value = Lit->getCodeUnit(I); 1753 TemplateArgument Arg(Context, Value, CharTy); 1754 TemplateArgumentLocInfo ArgInfo; 1755 ExplicitArgs.addArgument(TemplateArgumentLoc(Arg, ArgInfo)); 1756 } 1757 return BuildLiteralOperatorCall(R, OpNameInfo, None, StringTokLocs.back(), 1758 &ExplicitArgs); 1759 } 1760 case LOLR_Raw: 1761 case LOLR_Template: 1762 case LOLR_ErrorNoDiagnostic: 1763 llvm_unreachable("unexpected literal operator lookup result"); 1764 case LOLR_Error: 1765 return ExprError(); 1766 } 1767 llvm_unreachable("unexpected literal operator lookup result"); 1768 } 1769 1770 DeclRefExpr * 1771 Sema::BuildDeclRefExpr(ValueDecl *D, QualType Ty, ExprValueKind VK, 1772 SourceLocation Loc, 1773 const CXXScopeSpec *SS) { 1774 DeclarationNameInfo NameInfo(D->getDeclName(), Loc); 1775 return BuildDeclRefExpr(D, Ty, VK, NameInfo, SS); 1776 } 1777 1778 DeclRefExpr * 1779 Sema::BuildDeclRefExpr(ValueDecl *D, QualType Ty, ExprValueKind VK, 1780 const DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo, 1781 const CXXScopeSpec *SS, NamedDecl *FoundD, 1782 SourceLocation TemplateKWLoc, 1783 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs) { 1784 NestedNameSpecifierLoc NNS = 1785 SS ? SS->getWithLocInContext(Context) : NestedNameSpecifierLoc(); 1786 return BuildDeclRefExpr(D, Ty, VK, NameInfo, NNS, FoundD, TemplateKWLoc, 1787 TemplateArgs); 1788 } 1789 1790 NonOdrUseReason Sema::getNonOdrUseReasonInCurrentContext(ValueDecl *D) { 1791 // A declaration named in an unevaluated operand never constitutes an odr-use. 1792 if (isUnevaluatedContext()) 1793 return NOUR_Unevaluated; 1794 1795 // C++2a [basic.def.odr]p4: 1796 // A variable x whose name appears as a potentially-evaluated expression e 1797 // is odr-used by e unless [...] x is a reference that is usable in 1798 // constant expressions. 1799 if (VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) { 1800 if (VD->getType()->isReferenceType() && 1801 !(getLangOpts().OpenMP && isOpenMPCapturedDecl(D)) && 1802 VD->isUsableInConstantExpressions(Context)) 1803 return NOUR_Constant; 1804 } 1805 1806 // All remaining non-variable cases constitute an odr-use. For variables, we 1807 // need to wait and see how the expression is used. 1808 return NOUR_None; 1809 } 1810 1811 /// BuildDeclRefExpr - Build an expression that references a 1812 /// declaration that does not require a closure capture. 1813 DeclRefExpr * 1814 Sema::BuildDeclRefExpr(ValueDecl *D, QualType Ty, ExprValueKind VK, 1815 const DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo, 1816 NestedNameSpecifierLoc NNS, NamedDecl *FoundD, 1817 SourceLocation TemplateKWLoc, 1818 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs) { 1819 bool RefersToCapturedVariable = 1820 isa<VarDecl>(D) && 1821 NeedToCaptureVariable(cast<VarDecl>(D), NameInfo.getLoc()); 1822 1823 DeclRefExpr *E = DeclRefExpr::Create( 1824 Context, NNS, TemplateKWLoc, D, RefersToCapturedVariable, NameInfo, Ty, 1825 VK, FoundD, TemplateArgs, getNonOdrUseReasonInCurrentContext(D)); 1826 MarkDeclRefReferenced(E); 1827 1828 if (getLangOpts().ObjCWeak && isa<VarDecl>(D) && 1829 Ty.getObjCLifetime() == Qualifiers::OCL_Weak && !isUnevaluatedContext() && 1830 !Diags.isIgnored(diag::warn_arc_repeated_use_of_weak, E->getBeginLoc())) 1831 getCurFunction()->recordUseOfWeak(E); 1832 1833 FieldDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(D); 1834 if (IndirectFieldDecl *IFD = dyn_cast<IndirectFieldDecl>(D)) 1835 FD = IFD->getAnonField(); 1836 if (FD) { 1837 UnusedPrivateFields.remove(FD); 1838 // Just in case we're building an illegal pointer-to-member. 1839 if (FD->isBitField()) 1840 E->setObjectKind(OK_BitField); 1841 } 1842 1843 // C++ [expr.prim]/8: The expression [...] is a bit-field if the identifier 1844 // designates a bit-field. 1845 if (auto *BD = dyn_cast<BindingDecl>(D)) 1846 if (auto *BE = BD->getBinding()) 1847 E->setObjectKind(BE->getObjectKind()); 1848 1849 return E; 1850 } 1851 1852 /// Decomposes the given name into a DeclarationNameInfo, its location, and 1853 /// possibly a list of template arguments. 1854 /// 1855 /// If this produces template arguments, it is permitted to call 1856 /// DecomposeTemplateName. 1857 /// 1858 /// This actually loses a lot of source location information for 1859 /// non-standard name kinds; we should consider preserving that in 1860 /// some way. 1861 void 1862 Sema::DecomposeUnqualifiedId(const UnqualifiedId &Id, 1863 TemplateArgumentListInfo &Buffer, 1864 DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo, 1865 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *&TemplateArgs) { 1866 if (Id.getKind() == UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_TemplateId) { 1867 Buffer.setLAngleLoc(Id.TemplateId->LAngleLoc); 1868 Buffer.setRAngleLoc(Id.TemplateId->RAngleLoc); 1869 1870 ASTTemplateArgsPtr TemplateArgsPtr(Id.TemplateId->getTemplateArgs(), 1871 Id.TemplateId->NumArgs); 1872 translateTemplateArguments(TemplateArgsPtr, Buffer); 1873 1874 TemplateName TName = Id.TemplateId->Template.get(); 1875 SourceLocation TNameLoc = Id.TemplateId->TemplateNameLoc; 1876 NameInfo = Context.getNameForTemplate(TName, TNameLoc); 1877 TemplateArgs = &Buffer; 1878 } else { 1879 NameInfo = GetNameFromUnqualifiedId(Id); 1880 TemplateArgs = nullptr; 1881 } 1882 } 1883 1884 static void emitEmptyLookupTypoDiagnostic( 1885 const TypoCorrection &TC, Sema &SemaRef, const CXXScopeSpec &SS, 1886 DeclarationName Typo, SourceLocation TypoLoc, ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, 1887 unsigned DiagnosticID, unsigned DiagnosticSuggestID) { 1888 DeclContext *Ctx = 1889 SS.isEmpty() ? nullptr : SemaRef.computeDeclContext(SS, false); 1890 if (!TC) { 1891 // Emit a special diagnostic for failed member lookups. 1892 // FIXME: computing the declaration context might fail here (?) 1893 if (Ctx) 1894 SemaRef.Diag(TypoLoc, diag::err_no_member) << Typo << Ctx 1895 << SS.getRange(); 1896 else 1897 SemaRef.Diag(TypoLoc, DiagnosticID) << Typo; 1898 return; 1899 } 1900 1901 std::string CorrectedStr = TC.getAsString(SemaRef.getLangOpts()); 1902 bool DroppedSpecifier = 1903 TC.WillReplaceSpecifier() && Typo.getAsString() == CorrectedStr; 1904 unsigned NoteID = TC.getCorrectionDeclAs<ImplicitParamDecl>() 1905 ? diag::note_implicit_param_decl 1906 : diag::note_previous_decl; 1907 if (!Ctx) 1908 SemaRef.diagnoseTypo(TC, SemaRef.PDiag(DiagnosticSuggestID) << Typo, 1909 SemaRef.PDiag(NoteID)); 1910 else 1911 SemaRef.diagnoseTypo(TC, SemaRef.PDiag(diag::err_no_member_suggest) 1912 << Typo << Ctx << DroppedSpecifier 1913 << SS.getRange(), 1914 SemaRef.PDiag(NoteID)); 1915 } 1916 1917 /// Diagnose an empty lookup. 1918 /// 1919 /// \return false if new lookup candidates were found 1920 bool Sema::DiagnoseEmptyLookup(Scope *S, CXXScopeSpec &SS, LookupResult &R, 1921 CorrectionCandidateCallback &CCC, 1922 TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs, 1923 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, TypoExpr **Out) { 1924 DeclarationName Name = R.getLookupName(); 1925 1926 unsigned diagnostic = diag::err_undeclared_var_use; 1927 unsigned diagnostic_suggest = diag::err_undeclared_var_use_suggest; 1928 if (Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXOperatorName || 1929 Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXLiteralOperatorName || 1930 Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXConversionFunctionName) { 1931 diagnostic = diag::err_undeclared_use; 1932 diagnostic_suggest = diag::err_undeclared_use_suggest; 1933 } 1934 1935 // If the original lookup was an unqualified lookup, fake an 1936 // unqualified lookup. This is useful when (for example) the 1937 // original lookup would not have found something because it was a 1938 // dependent name. 1939 DeclContext *DC = SS.isEmpty() ? CurContext : nullptr; 1940 while (DC) { 1941 if (isa<CXXRecordDecl>(DC)) { 1942 LookupQualifiedName(R, DC); 1943 1944 if (!R.empty()) { 1945 // Don't give errors about ambiguities in this lookup. 1946 R.suppressDiagnostics(); 1947 1948 // During a default argument instantiation the CurContext points 1949 // to a CXXMethodDecl; but we can't apply a this-> fixit inside a 1950 // function parameter list, hence add an explicit check. 1951 bool isDefaultArgument = 1952 !CodeSynthesisContexts.empty() && 1953 CodeSynthesisContexts.back().Kind == 1954 CodeSynthesisContext::DefaultFunctionArgumentInstantiation; 1955 CXXMethodDecl *CurMethod = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(CurContext); 1956 bool isInstance = CurMethod && 1957 CurMethod->isInstance() && 1958 DC == CurMethod->getParent() && !isDefaultArgument; 1959 1960 // Give a code modification hint to insert 'this->'. 1961 // TODO: fixit for inserting 'Base<T>::' in the other cases. 1962 // Actually quite difficult! 1963 if (getLangOpts().MSVCCompat) 1964 diagnostic = diag::ext_found_via_dependent_bases_lookup; 1965 if (isInstance) { 1966 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic) << Name 1967 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(R.getNameLoc(), "this->"); 1968 CheckCXXThisCapture(R.getNameLoc()); 1969 } else { 1970 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic) << Name; 1971 } 1972 1973 // Do we really want to note all of these? 1974 for (NamedDecl *D : R) 1975 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_dependent_var_use); 1976 1977 // Return true if we are inside a default argument instantiation 1978 // and the found name refers to an instance member function, otherwise 1979 // the function calling DiagnoseEmptyLookup will try to create an 1980 // implicit member call and this is wrong for default argument. 1981 if (isDefaultArgument && ((*R.begin())->isCXXInstanceMember())) { 1982 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_member_call_without_object); 1983 return true; 1984 } 1985 1986 // Tell the callee to try to recover. 1987 return false; 1988 } 1989 1990 R.clear(); 1991 } 1992 1993 // In Microsoft mode, if we are performing lookup from within a friend 1994 // function definition declared at class scope then we must set 1995 // DC to the lexical parent to be able to search into the parent 1996 // class. 1997 if (getLangOpts().MSVCCompat && isa<FunctionDecl>(DC) && 1998 cast<FunctionDecl>(DC)->getFriendObjectKind() && 1999 DC->getLexicalParent()->isRecord()) 2000 DC = DC->getLexicalParent(); 2001 else 2002 DC = DC->getParent(); 2003 } 2004 2005 // We didn't find anything, so try to correct for a typo. 2006 TypoCorrection Corrected; 2007 if (S && Out) { 2008 SourceLocation TypoLoc = R.getNameLoc(); 2009 assert(!ExplicitTemplateArgs && 2010 "Diagnosing an empty lookup with explicit template args!"); 2011 *Out = CorrectTypoDelayed( 2012 R.getLookupNameInfo(), R.getLookupKind(), S, &SS, CCC, 2013 [=](const TypoCorrection &TC) { 2014 emitEmptyLookupTypoDiagnostic(TC, *this, SS, Name, TypoLoc, Args, 2015 diagnostic, diagnostic_suggest); 2016 }, 2017 nullptr, CTK_ErrorRecovery); 2018 if (*Out) 2019 return true; 2020 } else if (S && 2021 (Corrected = CorrectTypo(R.getLookupNameInfo(), R.getLookupKind(), 2022 S, &SS, CCC, CTK_ErrorRecovery))) { 2023 std::string CorrectedStr(Corrected.getAsString(getLangOpts())); 2024 bool DroppedSpecifier = 2025 Corrected.WillReplaceSpecifier() && Name.getAsString() == CorrectedStr; 2026 R.setLookupName(Corrected.getCorrection()); 2027 2028 bool AcceptableWithRecovery = false; 2029 bool AcceptableWithoutRecovery = false; 2030 NamedDecl *ND = Corrected.getFoundDecl(); 2031 if (ND) { 2032 if (Corrected.isOverloaded()) { 2033 OverloadCandidateSet OCS(R.getNameLoc(), 2034 OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Normal); 2035 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best; 2036 for (NamedDecl *CD : Corrected) { 2037 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *FTD = 2038 dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(CD)) 2039 AddTemplateOverloadCandidate( 2040 FTD, DeclAccessPair::make(FTD, AS_none), ExplicitTemplateArgs, 2041 Args, OCS); 2042 else if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(CD)) 2043 if (!ExplicitTemplateArgs || ExplicitTemplateArgs->size() == 0) 2044 AddOverloadCandidate(FD, DeclAccessPair::make(FD, AS_none), 2045 Args, OCS); 2046 } 2047 switch (OCS.BestViableFunction(*this, R.getNameLoc(), Best)) { 2048 case OR_Success: 2049 ND = Best->FoundDecl; 2050 Corrected.setCorrectionDecl(ND); 2051 break; 2052 default: 2053 // FIXME: Arbitrarily pick the first declaration for the note. 2054 Corrected.setCorrectionDecl(ND); 2055 break; 2056 } 2057 } 2058 R.addDecl(ND); 2059 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && ND->isCXXClassMember()) { 2060 CXXRecordDecl *Record = nullptr; 2061 if (Corrected.getCorrectionSpecifier()) { 2062 const Type *Ty = Corrected.getCorrectionSpecifier()->getAsType(); 2063 Record = Ty->getAsCXXRecordDecl(); 2064 } 2065 if (!Record) 2066 Record = cast<CXXRecordDecl>( 2067 ND->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext()); 2068 R.setNamingClass(Record); 2069 } 2070 2071 auto *UnderlyingND = ND->getUnderlyingDecl(); 2072 AcceptableWithRecovery = isa<ValueDecl>(UnderlyingND) || 2073 isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(UnderlyingND); 2074 // FIXME: If we ended up with a typo for a type name or 2075 // Objective-C class name, we're in trouble because the parser 2076 // is in the wrong place to recover. Suggest the typo 2077 // correction, but don't make it a fix-it since we're not going 2078 // to recover well anyway. 2079 AcceptableWithoutRecovery = isa<TypeDecl>(UnderlyingND) || 2080 getAsTypeTemplateDecl(UnderlyingND) || 2081 isa<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(UnderlyingND); 2082 } else { 2083 // FIXME: We found a keyword. Suggest it, but don't provide a fix-it 2084 // because we aren't able to recover. 2085 AcceptableWithoutRecovery = true; 2086 } 2087 2088 if (AcceptableWithRecovery || AcceptableWithoutRecovery) { 2089 unsigned NoteID = Corrected.getCorrectionDeclAs<ImplicitParamDecl>() 2090 ? diag::note_implicit_param_decl 2091 : diag::note_previous_decl; 2092 if (SS.isEmpty()) 2093 diagnoseTypo(Corrected, PDiag(diagnostic_suggest) << Name, 2094 PDiag(NoteID), AcceptableWithRecovery); 2095 else 2096 diagnoseTypo(Corrected, PDiag(diag::err_no_member_suggest) 2097 << Name << computeDeclContext(SS, false) 2098 << DroppedSpecifier << SS.getRange(), 2099 PDiag(NoteID), AcceptableWithRecovery); 2100 2101 // Tell the callee whether to try to recover. 2102 return !AcceptableWithRecovery; 2103 } 2104 } 2105 R.clear(); 2106 2107 // Emit a special diagnostic for failed member lookups. 2108 // FIXME: computing the declaration context might fail here (?) 2109 if (!SS.isEmpty()) { 2110 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member) 2111 << Name << computeDeclContext(SS, false) 2112 << SS.getRange(); 2113 return true; 2114 } 2115 2116 // Give up, we can't recover. 2117 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic) << Name; 2118 return true; 2119 } 2120 2121 /// In Microsoft mode, if we are inside a template class whose parent class has 2122 /// dependent base classes, and we can't resolve an unqualified identifier, then 2123 /// assume the identifier is a member of a dependent base class. We can only 2124 /// recover successfully in static methods, instance methods, and other contexts 2125 /// where 'this' is available. This doesn't precisely match MSVC's 2126 /// instantiation model, but it's close enough. 2127 static Expr * 2128 recoverFromMSUnqualifiedLookup(Sema &S, ASTContext &Context, 2129 DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo, 2130 SourceLocation TemplateKWLoc, 2131 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs) { 2132 // Only try to recover from lookup into dependent bases in static methods or 2133 // contexts where 'this' is available. 2134 QualType ThisType = S.getCurrentThisType(); 2135 const CXXRecordDecl *RD = nullptr; 2136 if (!ThisType.isNull()) 2137 RD = ThisType->getPointeeType()->getAsCXXRecordDecl(); 2138 else if (auto *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(S.CurContext)) 2139 RD = MD->getParent(); 2140 if (!RD || !RD->hasAnyDependentBases()) 2141 return nullptr; 2142 2143 // Diagnose this as unqualified lookup into a dependent base class. If 'this' 2144 // is available, suggest inserting 'this->' as a fixit. 2145 SourceLocation Loc = NameInfo.getLoc(); 2146 auto DB = S.Diag(Loc, diag::ext_undeclared_unqual_id_with_dependent_base); 2147 DB << NameInfo.getName() << RD; 2148 2149 if (!ThisType.isNull()) { 2150 DB << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(Loc, "this->"); 2151 return CXXDependentScopeMemberExpr::Create( 2152 Context, /*This=*/nullptr, ThisType, /*IsArrow=*/true, 2153 /*Op=*/SourceLocation(), NestedNameSpecifierLoc(), TemplateKWLoc, 2154 /*FirstQualifierFoundInScope=*/nullptr, NameInfo, TemplateArgs); 2155 } 2156 2157 // Synthesize a fake NNS that points to the derived class. This will 2158 // perform name lookup during template instantiation. 2159 CXXScopeSpec SS; 2160 auto *NNS = 2161 NestedNameSpecifier::Create(Context, nullptr, true, RD->getTypeForDecl()); 2162 SS.MakeTrivial(Context, NNS, SourceRange(Loc, Loc)); 2163 return DependentScopeDeclRefExpr::Create( 2164 Context, SS.getWithLocInContext(Context), TemplateKWLoc, NameInfo, 2165 TemplateArgs); 2166 } 2167 2168 ExprResult 2169 Sema::ActOnIdExpression(Scope *S, CXXScopeSpec &SS, 2170 SourceLocation TemplateKWLoc, UnqualifiedId &Id, 2171 bool HasTrailingLParen, bool IsAddressOfOperand, 2172 CorrectionCandidateCallback *CCC, 2173 bool IsInlineAsmIdentifier, Token *KeywordReplacement) { 2174 assert(!(IsAddressOfOperand && HasTrailingLParen) && 2175 "cannot be direct & operand and have a trailing lparen"); 2176 if (SS.isInvalid()) 2177 return ExprError(); 2178 2179 TemplateArgumentListInfo TemplateArgsBuffer; 2180 2181 // Decompose the UnqualifiedId into the following data. 2182 DeclarationNameInfo NameInfo; 2183 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs; 2184 DecomposeUnqualifiedId(Id, TemplateArgsBuffer, NameInfo, TemplateArgs); 2185 2186 DeclarationName Name = NameInfo.getName(); 2187 IdentifierInfo *II = Name.getAsIdentifierInfo(); 2188 SourceLocation NameLoc = NameInfo.getLoc(); 2189 2190 if (II && II->isEditorPlaceholder()) { 2191 // FIXME: When typed placeholders are supported we can create a typed 2192 // placeholder expression node. 2193 return ExprError(); 2194 } 2195 2196 // C++ [temp.dep.expr]p3: 2197 // An id-expression is type-dependent if it contains: 2198 // -- an identifier that was declared with a dependent type, 2199 // (note: handled after lookup) 2200 // -- a template-id that is dependent, 2201 // (note: handled in BuildTemplateIdExpr) 2202 // -- a conversion-function-id that specifies a dependent type, 2203 // -- a nested-name-specifier that contains a class-name that 2204 // names a dependent type. 2205 // Determine whether this is a member of an unknown specialization; 2206 // we need to handle these differently. 2207 bool DependentID = false; 2208 if (Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXConversionFunctionName && 2209 Name.getCXXNameType()->isDependentType()) { 2210 DependentID = true; 2211 } else if (SS.isSet()) { 2212 if (DeclContext *DC = computeDeclContext(SS, false)) { 2213 if (RequireCompleteDeclContext(SS, DC)) 2214 return ExprError(); 2215 } else { 2216 DependentID = true; 2217 } 2218 } 2219 2220 if (DependentID) 2221 return ActOnDependentIdExpression(SS, TemplateKWLoc, NameInfo, 2222 IsAddressOfOperand, TemplateArgs); 2223 2224 // Perform the required lookup. 2225 LookupResult R(*this, NameInfo, 2226 (Id.getKind() == UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_ImplicitSelfParam) 2227 ? LookupObjCImplicitSelfParam 2228 : LookupOrdinaryName); 2229 if (TemplateKWLoc.isValid() || TemplateArgs) { 2230 // Lookup the template name again to correctly establish the context in 2231 // which it was found. This is really unfortunate as we already did the 2232 // lookup to determine that it was a template name in the first place. If 2233 // this becomes a performance hit, we can work harder to preserve those 2234 // results until we get here but it's likely not worth it. 2235 bool MemberOfUnknownSpecialization; 2236 AssumedTemplateKind AssumedTemplate; 2237 if (LookupTemplateName(R, S, SS, QualType(), /*EnteringContext=*/false, 2238 MemberOfUnknownSpecialization, TemplateKWLoc, 2239 &AssumedTemplate)) 2240 return ExprError(); 2241 2242 if (MemberOfUnknownSpecialization || 2243 (R.getResultKind() == LookupResult::NotFoundInCurrentInstantiation)) 2244 return ActOnDependentIdExpression(SS, TemplateKWLoc, NameInfo, 2245 IsAddressOfOperand, TemplateArgs); 2246 } else { 2247 bool IvarLookupFollowUp = II && !SS.isSet() && getCurMethodDecl(); 2248 LookupParsedName(R, S, &SS, !IvarLookupFollowUp); 2249 2250 // If the result might be in a dependent base class, this is a dependent 2251 // id-expression. 2252 if (R.getResultKind() == LookupResult::NotFoundInCurrentInstantiation) 2253 return ActOnDependentIdExpression(SS, TemplateKWLoc, NameInfo, 2254 IsAddressOfOperand, TemplateArgs); 2255 2256 // If this reference is in an Objective-C method, then we need to do 2257 // some special Objective-C lookup, too. 2258 if (IvarLookupFollowUp) { 2259 ExprResult E(LookupInObjCMethod(R, S, II, true)); 2260 if (E.isInvalid()) 2261 return ExprError(); 2262 2263 if (Expr *Ex = E.getAs<Expr>()) 2264 return Ex; 2265 } 2266 } 2267 2268 if (R.isAmbiguous()) 2269 return ExprError(); 2270 2271 // This could be an implicitly declared function reference (legal in C90, 2272 // extension in C99, forbidden in C++). 2273 if (R.empty() && HasTrailingLParen && II && !getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 2274 NamedDecl *D = ImplicitlyDefineFunction(NameLoc, *II, S); 2275 if (D) R.addDecl(D); 2276 } 2277 2278 // Determine whether this name might be a candidate for 2279 // argument-dependent lookup. 2280 bool ADL = UseArgumentDependentLookup(SS, R, HasTrailingLParen); 2281 2282 if (R.empty() && !ADL) { 2283 if (SS.isEmpty() && getLangOpts().MSVCCompat) { 2284 if (Expr *E = recoverFromMSUnqualifiedLookup(*this, Context, NameInfo, 2285 TemplateKWLoc, TemplateArgs)) 2286 return E; 2287 } 2288 2289 // Don't diagnose an empty lookup for inline assembly. 2290 if (IsInlineAsmIdentifier) 2291 return ExprError(); 2292 2293 // If this name wasn't predeclared and if this is not a function 2294 // call, diagnose the problem. 2295 TypoExpr *TE = nullptr; 2296 DefaultFilterCCC DefaultValidator(II, SS.isValid() ? SS.getScopeRep() 2297 : nullptr); 2298 DefaultValidator.IsAddressOfOperand = IsAddressOfOperand; 2299 assert((!CCC || CCC->IsAddressOfOperand == IsAddressOfOperand) && 2300 "Typo correction callback misconfigured"); 2301 if (CCC) { 2302 // Make sure the callback knows what the typo being diagnosed is. 2303 CCC->setTypoName(II); 2304 if (SS.isValid()) 2305 CCC->setTypoNNS(SS.getScopeRep()); 2306 } 2307 // FIXME: DiagnoseEmptyLookup produces bad diagnostics if we're looking for 2308 // a template name, but we happen to have always already looked up the name 2309 // before we get here if it must be a template name. 2310 if (DiagnoseEmptyLookup(S, SS, R, CCC ? *CCC : DefaultValidator, nullptr, 2311 None, &TE)) { 2312 if (TE && KeywordReplacement) { 2313 auto &State = getTypoExprState(TE); 2314 auto BestTC = State.Consumer->getNextCorrection(); 2315 if (BestTC.isKeyword()) { 2316 auto *II = BestTC.getCorrectionAsIdentifierInfo(); 2317 if (State.DiagHandler) 2318 State.DiagHandler(BestTC); 2319 KeywordReplacement->startToken(); 2320 KeywordReplacement->setKind(II->getTokenID()); 2321 KeywordReplacement->setIdentifierInfo(II); 2322 KeywordReplacement->setLocation(BestTC.getCorrectionRange().getBegin()); 2323 // Clean up the state associated with the TypoExpr, since it has 2324 // now been diagnosed (without a call to CorrectDelayedTyposInExpr). 2325 clearDelayedTypo(TE); 2326 // Signal that a correction to a keyword was performed by returning a 2327 // valid-but-null ExprResult. 2328 return (Expr*)nullptr; 2329 } 2330 State.Consumer->resetCorrectionStream(); 2331 } 2332 return TE ? TE : ExprError(); 2333 } 2334 2335 assert(!R.empty() && 2336 "DiagnoseEmptyLookup returned false but added no results"); 2337 2338 // If we found an Objective-C instance variable, let 2339 // LookupInObjCMethod build the appropriate expression to 2340 // reference the ivar. 2341 if (ObjCIvarDecl *Ivar = R.getAsSingle<ObjCIvarDecl>()) { 2342 R.clear(); 2343 ExprResult E(LookupInObjCMethod(R, S, Ivar->getIdentifier())); 2344 // In a hopelessly buggy code, Objective-C instance variable 2345 // lookup fails and no expression will be built to reference it. 2346 if (!E.isInvalid() && !E.get()) 2347 return ExprError(); 2348 return E; 2349 } 2350 } 2351 2352 // This is guaranteed from this point on. 2353 assert(!R.empty() || ADL); 2354 2355 // Check whether this might be a C++ implicit instance member access. 2356 // C++ [class.mfct.non-static]p3: 2357 // When an id-expression that is not part of a class member access 2358 // syntax and not used to form a pointer to member is used in the 2359 // body of a non-static member function of class X, if name lookup 2360 // resolves the name in the id-expression to a non-static non-type 2361 // member of some class C, the id-expression is transformed into a 2362 // class member access expression using (*this) as the 2363 // postfix-expression to the left of the . operator. 2364 // 2365 // But we don't actually need to do this for '&' operands if R 2366 // resolved to a function or overloaded function set, because the 2367 // expression is ill-formed if it actually works out to be a 2368 // non-static member function: 2369 // 2370 // C++ [expr.ref]p4: 2371 // Otherwise, if E1.E2 refers to a non-static member function. . . 2372 // [t]he expression can be used only as the left-hand operand of a 2373 // member function call. 2374 // 2375 // There are other safeguards against such uses, but it's important 2376 // to get this right here so that we don't end up making a 2377 // spuriously dependent expression if we're inside a dependent 2378 // instance method. 2379 if (!R.empty() && (*R.begin())->isCXXClassMember()) { 2380 bool MightBeImplicitMember; 2381 if (!IsAddressOfOperand) 2382 MightBeImplicitMember = true; 2383 else if (!SS.isEmpty()) 2384 MightBeImplicitMember = false; 2385 else if (R.isOverloadedResult()) 2386 MightBeImplicitMember = false; 2387 else if (R.isUnresolvableResult()) 2388 MightBeImplicitMember = true; 2389 else 2390 MightBeImplicitMember = isa<FieldDecl>(R.getFoundDecl()) || 2391 isa<IndirectFieldDecl>(R.getFoundDecl()) || 2392 isa<MSPropertyDecl>(R.getFoundDecl()); 2393 2394 if (MightBeImplicitMember) 2395 return BuildPossibleImplicitMemberExpr(SS, TemplateKWLoc, 2396 R, TemplateArgs, S); 2397 } 2398 2399 if (TemplateArgs || TemplateKWLoc.isValid()) { 2400 2401 // In C++1y, if this is a variable template id, then check it 2402 // in BuildTemplateIdExpr(). 2403 // The single lookup result must be a variable template declaration. 2404 if (Id.getKind() == UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_TemplateId && Id.TemplateId && 2405 Id.TemplateId->Kind == TNK_Var_template) { 2406 assert(R.getAsSingle<VarTemplateDecl>() && 2407 "There should only be one declaration found."); 2408 } 2409 2410 return BuildTemplateIdExpr(SS, TemplateKWLoc, R, ADL, TemplateArgs); 2411 } 2412 2413 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R, ADL); 2414 } 2415 2416 /// BuildQualifiedDeclarationNameExpr - Build a C++ qualified 2417 /// declaration name, generally during template instantiation. 2418 /// There's a large number of things which don't need to be done along 2419 /// this path. 2420 ExprResult Sema::BuildQualifiedDeclarationNameExpr( 2421 CXXScopeSpec &SS, const DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo, 2422 bool IsAddressOfOperand, const Scope *S, TypeSourceInfo **RecoveryTSI) { 2423 DeclContext *DC = computeDeclContext(SS, false); 2424 if (!DC) 2425 return BuildDependentDeclRefExpr(SS, /*TemplateKWLoc=*/SourceLocation(), 2426 NameInfo, /*TemplateArgs=*/nullptr); 2427 2428 if (RequireCompleteDeclContext(SS, DC)) 2429 return ExprError(); 2430 2431 LookupResult R(*this, NameInfo, LookupOrdinaryName); 2432 LookupQualifiedName(R, DC); 2433 2434 if (R.isAmbiguous()) 2435 return ExprError(); 2436 2437 if (R.getResultKind() == LookupResult::NotFoundInCurrentInstantiation) 2438 return BuildDependentDeclRefExpr(SS, /*TemplateKWLoc=*/SourceLocation(), 2439 NameInfo, /*TemplateArgs=*/nullptr); 2440 2441 if (R.empty()) { 2442 Diag(NameInfo.getLoc(), diag::err_no_member) 2443 << NameInfo.getName() << DC << SS.getRange(); 2444 return ExprError(); 2445 } 2446 2447 if (const TypeDecl *TD = R.getAsSingle<TypeDecl>()) { 2448 // Diagnose a missing typename if this resolved unambiguously to a type in 2449 // a dependent context. If we can recover with a type, downgrade this to 2450 // a warning in Microsoft compatibility mode. 2451 unsigned DiagID = diag::err_typename_missing; 2452 if (RecoveryTSI && getLangOpts().MSVCCompat) 2453 DiagID = diag::ext_typename_missing; 2454 SourceLocation Loc = SS.getBeginLoc(); 2455 auto D = Diag(Loc, DiagID); 2456 D << SS.getScopeRep() << NameInfo.getName().getAsString() 2457 << SourceRange(Loc, NameInfo.getEndLoc()); 2458 2459 // Don't recover if the caller isn't expecting us to or if we're in a SFINAE 2460 // context. 2461 if (!RecoveryTSI) 2462 return ExprError(); 2463 2464 // Only issue the fixit if we're prepared to recover. 2465 D << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(Loc, "typename "); 2466 2467 // Recover by pretending this was an elaborated type. 2468 QualType Ty = Context.getTypeDeclType(TD); 2469 TypeLocBuilder TLB; 2470 TLB.pushTypeSpec(Ty).setNameLoc(NameInfo.getLoc()); 2471 2472 QualType ET = getElaboratedType(ETK_None, SS, Ty); 2473 ElaboratedTypeLoc QTL = TLB.push<ElaboratedTypeLoc>(ET); 2474 QTL.setElaboratedKeywordLoc(SourceLocation()); 2475 QTL.setQualifierLoc(SS.getWithLocInContext(Context)); 2476 2477 *RecoveryTSI = TLB.getTypeSourceInfo(Context, ET); 2478 2479 return ExprEmpty(); 2480 } 2481 2482 // Defend against this resolving to an implicit member access. We usually 2483 // won't get here if this might be a legitimate a class member (we end up in 2484 // BuildMemberReferenceExpr instead), but this can be valid if we're forming 2485 // a pointer-to-member or in an unevaluated context in C++11. 2486 if (!R.empty() && (*R.begin())->isCXXClassMember() && !IsAddressOfOperand) 2487 return BuildPossibleImplicitMemberExpr(SS, 2488 /*TemplateKWLoc=*/SourceLocation(), 2489 R, /*TemplateArgs=*/nullptr, S); 2490 2491 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R, /* ADL */ false); 2492 } 2493 2494 /// LookupInObjCMethod - The parser has read a name in, and Sema has 2495 /// detected that we're currently inside an ObjC method. Perform some 2496 /// additional lookup. 2497 /// 2498 /// Ideally, most of this would be done by lookup, but there's 2499 /// actually quite a lot of extra work involved. 2500 /// 2501 /// Returns a null sentinel to indicate trivial success. 2502 ExprResult 2503 Sema::LookupInObjCMethod(LookupResult &Lookup, Scope *S, 2504 IdentifierInfo *II, bool AllowBuiltinCreation) { 2505 SourceLocation Loc = Lookup.getNameLoc(); 2506 ObjCMethodDecl *CurMethod = getCurMethodDecl(); 2507 2508 // Check for error condition which is already reported. 2509 if (!CurMethod) 2510 return ExprError(); 2511 2512 // There are two cases to handle here. 1) scoped lookup could have failed, 2513 // in which case we should look for an ivar. 2) scoped lookup could have 2514 // found a decl, but that decl is outside the current instance method (i.e. 2515 // a global variable). In these two cases, we do a lookup for an ivar with 2516 // this name, if the lookup sucedes, we replace it our current decl. 2517 2518 // If we're in a class method, we don't normally want to look for 2519 // ivars. But if we don't find anything else, and there's an 2520 // ivar, that's an error. 2521 bool IsClassMethod = CurMethod->isClassMethod(); 2522 2523 bool LookForIvars; 2524 if (Lookup.empty()) 2525 LookForIvars = true; 2526 else if (IsClassMethod) 2527 LookForIvars = false; 2528 else 2529 LookForIvars = (Lookup.isSingleResult() && 2530 Lookup.getFoundDecl()->isDefinedOutsideFunctionOrMethod()); 2531 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFace = nullptr; 2532 if (LookForIvars) { 2533 IFace = CurMethod->getClassInterface(); 2534 ObjCInterfaceDecl *ClassDeclared; 2535 ObjCIvarDecl *IV = nullptr; 2536 if (IFace && (IV = IFace->lookupInstanceVariable(II, ClassDeclared))) { 2537 // Diagnose using an ivar in a class method. 2538 if (IsClassMethod) 2539 return ExprError(Diag(Loc, diag::err_ivar_use_in_class_method) 2540 << IV->getDeclName()); 2541 2542 // If we're referencing an invalid decl, just return this as a silent 2543 // error node. The error diagnostic was already emitted on the decl. 2544 if (IV->isInvalidDecl()) 2545 return ExprError(); 2546 2547 // Check if referencing a field with __attribute__((deprecated)). 2548 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(IV, Loc)) 2549 return ExprError(); 2550 2551 // Diagnose the use of an ivar outside of the declaring class. 2552 if (IV->getAccessControl() == ObjCIvarDecl::Private && 2553 !declaresSameEntity(ClassDeclared, IFace) && 2554 !getLangOpts().DebuggerSupport) 2555 Diag(Loc, diag::err_private_ivar_access) << IV->getDeclName(); 2556 2557 // FIXME: This should use a new expr for a direct reference, don't 2558 // turn this into Self->ivar, just return a BareIVarExpr or something. 2559 IdentifierInfo &II = Context.Idents.get("self"); 2560 UnqualifiedId SelfName; 2561 SelfName.setIdentifier(&II, SourceLocation()); 2562 SelfName.setKind(UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_ImplicitSelfParam); 2563 CXXScopeSpec SelfScopeSpec; 2564 SourceLocation TemplateKWLoc; 2565 ExprResult SelfExpr = 2566 ActOnIdExpression(S, SelfScopeSpec, TemplateKWLoc, SelfName, 2567 /*HasTrailingLParen=*/false, 2568 /*IsAddressOfOperand=*/false); 2569 if (SelfExpr.isInvalid()) 2570 return ExprError(); 2571 2572 SelfExpr = DefaultLvalueConversion(SelfExpr.get()); 2573 if (SelfExpr.isInvalid()) 2574 return ExprError(); 2575 2576 MarkAnyDeclReferenced(Loc, IV, true); 2577 2578 ObjCMethodFamily MF = CurMethod->getMethodFamily(); 2579 if (MF != OMF_init && MF != OMF_dealloc && MF != OMF_finalize && 2580 !IvarBacksCurrentMethodAccessor(IFace, CurMethod, IV)) 2581 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_direct_ivar_access) << IV->getDeclName(); 2582 2583 ObjCIvarRefExpr *Result = new (Context) 2584 ObjCIvarRefExpr(IV, IV->getUsageType(SelfExpr.get()->getType()), Loc, 2585 IV->getLocation(), SelfExpr.get(), true, true); 2586 2587 if (IV->getType().getObjCLifetime() == Qualifiers::OCL_Weak) { 2588 if (!isUnevaluatedContext() && 2589 !Diags.isIgnored(diag::warn_arc_repeated_use_of_weak, Loc)) 2590 getCurFunction()->recordUseOfWeak(Result); 2591 } 2592 if (getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount) 2593 if (const BlockDecl *BD = CurContext->getInnermostBlockDecl()) 2594 ImplicitlyRetainedSelfLocs.push_back({Loc, BD}); 2595 2596 return Result; 2597 } 2598 } else if (CurMethod->isInstanceMethod()) { 2599 // We should warn if a local variable hides an ivar. 2600 if (ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFace = CurMethod->getClassInterface()) { 2601 ObjCInterfaceDecl *ClassDeclared; 2602 if (ObjCIvarDecl *IV = IFace->lookupInstanceVariable(II, ClassDeclared)) { 2603 if (IV->getAccessControl() != ObjCIvarDecl::Private || 2604 declaresSameEntity(IFace, ClassDeclared)) 2605 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_ivar_use_hidden) << IV->getDeclName(); 2606 } 2607 } 2608 } else if (Lookup.isSingleResult() && 2609 Lookup.getFoundDecl()->isDefinedOutsideFunctionOrMethod()) { 2610 // If accessing a stand-alone ivar in a class method, this is an error. 2611 if (const ObjCIvarDecl *IV = dyn_cast<ObjCIvarDecl>(Lookup.getFoundDecl())) 2612 return ExprError(Diag(Loc, diag::err_ivar_use_in_class_method) 2613 << IV->getDeclName()); 2614 } 2615 2616 if (Lookup.empty() && II && AllowBuiltinCreation) { 2617 // FIXME. Consolidate this with similar code in LookupName. 2618 if (unsigned BuiltinID = II->getBuiltinID()) { 2619 if (!(getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && 2620 Context.BuiltinInfo.isPredefinedLibFunction(BuiltinID))) { 2621 NamedDecl *D = LazilyCreateBuiltin((IdentifierInfo *)II, BuiltinID, 2622 S, Lookup.isForRedeclaration(), 2623 Lookup.getNameLoc()); 2624 if (D) Lookup.addDecl(D); 2625 } 2626 } 2627 } 2628 // Sentinel value saying that we didn't do anything special. 2629 return ExprResult((Expr *)nullptr); 2630 } 2631 2632 /// Cast a base object to a member's actual type. 2633 /// 2634 /// Logically this happens in three phases: 2635 /// 2636 /// * First we cast from the base type to the naming class. 2637 /// The naming class is the class into which we were looking 2638 /// when we found the member; it's the qualifier type if a 2639 /// qualifier was provided, and otherwise it's the base type. 2640 /// 2641 /// * Next we cast from the naming class to the declaring class. 2642 /// If the member we found was brought into a class's scope by 2643 /// a using declaration, this is that class; otherwise it's 2644 /// the class declaring the member. 2645 /// 2646 /// * Finally we cast from the declaring class to the "true" 2647 /// declaring class of the member. This conversion does not 2648 /// obey access control. 2649 ExprResult 2650 Sema::PerformObjectMemberConversion(Expr *From, 2651 NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier, 2652 NamedDecl *FoundDecl, 2653 NamedDecl *Member) { 2654 CXXRecordDecl *RD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Member->getDeclContext()); 2655 if (!RD) 2656 return From; 2657 2658 QualType DestRecordType; 2659 QualType DestType; 2660 QualType FromRecordType; 2661 QualType FromType = From->getType(); 2662 bool PointerConversions = false; 2663 if (isa<FieldDecl>(Member)) { 2664 DestRecordType = Context.getCanonicalType(Context.getTypeDeclType(RD)); 2665 auto FromPtrType = FromType->getAs<PointerType>(); 2666 DestRecordType = Context.getAddrSpaceQualType( 2667 DestRecordType, FromPtrType 2668 ? FromType->getPointeeType().getAddressSpace() 2669 : FromType.getAddressSpace()); 2670 2671 if (FromPtrType) { 2672 DestType = Context.getPointerType(DestRecordType); 2673 FromRecordType = FromPtrType->getPointeeType(); 2674 PointerConversions = true; 2675 } else { 2676 DestType = DestRecordType; 2677 FromRecordType = FromType; 2678 } 2679 } else if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Member)) { 2680 if (Method->isStatic()) 2681 return From; 2682 2683 DestType = Method->getThisType(); 2684 DestRecordType = DestType->getPointeeType(); 2685 2686 if (FromType->getAs<PointerType>()) { 2687 FromRecordType = FromType->getPointeeType(); 2688 PointerConversions = true; 2689 } else { 2690 FromRecordType = FromType; 2691 DestType = DestRecordType; 2692 } 2693 } else { 2694 // No conversion necessary. 2695 return From; 2696 } 2697 2698 if (DestType->isDependentType() || FromType->isDependentType()) 2699 return From; 2700 2701 // If the unqualified types are the same, no conversion is necessary. 2702 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromRecordType, DestRecordType)) 2703 return From; 2704 2705 SourceRange FromRange = From->getSourceRange(); 2706 SourceLocation FromLoc = FromRange.getBegin(); 2707 2708 ExprValueKind VK = From->getValueKind(); 2709 2710 // C++ [class.member.lookup]p8: 2711 // [...] Ambiguities can often be resolved by qualifying a name with its 2712 // class name. 2713 // 2714 // If the member was a qualified name and the qualified referred to a 2715 // specific base subobject type, we'll cast to that intermediate type 2716 // first and then to the object in which the member is declared. That allows 2717 // one to resolve ambiguities in, e.g., a diamond-shaped hierarchy such as: 2718 // 2719 // class Base { public: int x; }; 2720 // class Derived1 : public Base { }; 2721 // class Derived2 : public Base { }; 2722 // class VeryDerived : public Derived1, public Derived2 { void f(); }; 2723 // 2724 // void VeryDerived::f() { 2725 // x = 17; // error: ambiguous base subobjects 2726 // Derived1::x = 17; // okay, pick the Base subobject of Derived1 2727 // } 2728 if (Qualifier && Qualifier->getAsType()) { 2729 QualType QType = QualType(Qualifier->getAsType(), 0); 2730 assert(QType->isRecordType() && "lookup done with non-record type"); 2731 2732 QualType QRecordType = QualType(QType->getAs<RecordType>(), 0); 2733 2734 // In C++98, the qualifier type doesn't actually have to be a base 2735 // type of the object type, in which case we just ignore it. 2736 // Otherwise build the appropriate casts. 2737 if (IsDerivedFrom(FromLoc, FromRecordType, QRecordType)) { 2738 CXXCastPath BasePath; 2739 if (CheckDerivedToBaseConversion(FromRecordType, QRecordType, 2740 FromLoc, FromRange, &BasePath)) 2741 return ExprError(); 2742 2743 if (PointerConversions) 2744 QType = Context.getPointerType(QType); 2745 From = ImpCastExprToType(From, QType, CK_UncheckedDerivedToBase, 2746 VK, &BasePath).get(); 2747 2748 FromType = QType; 2749 FromRecordType = QRecordType; 2750 2751 // If the qualifier type was the same as the destination type, 2752 // we're done. 2753 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromRecordType, DestRecordType)) 2754 return From; 2755 } 2756 } 2757 2758 bool IgnoreAccess = false; 2759 2760 // If we actually found the member through a using declaration, cast 2761 // down to the using declaration's type. 2762 // 2763 // Pointer equality is fine here because only one declaration of a 2764 // class ever has member declarations. 2765 if (FoundDecl->getDeclContext() != Member->getDeclContext()) { 2766 assert(isa<UsingShadowDecl>(FoundDecl)); 2767 QualType URecordType = Context.getTypeDeclType( 2768 cast<CXXRecordDecl>(FoundDecl->getDeclContext())); 2769 2770 // We only need to do this if the naming-class to declaring-class 2771 // conversion is non-trivial. 2772 if (!Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromRecordType, URecordType)) { 2773 assert(IsDerivedFrom(FromLoc, FromRecordType, URecordType)); 2774 CXXCastPath BasePath; 2775 if (CheckDerivedToBaseConversion(FromRecordType, URecordType, 2776 FromLoc, FromRange, &BasePath)) 2777 return ExprError(); 2778 2779 QualType UType = URecordType; 2780 if (PointerConversions) 2781 UType = Context.getPointerType(UType); 2782 From = ImpCastExprToType(From, UType, CK_UncheckedDerivedToBase, 2783 VK, &BasePath).get(); 2784 FromType = UType; 2785 FromRecordType = URecordType; 2786 } 2787 2788 // We don't do access control for the conversion from the 2789 // declaring class to the true declaring class. 2790 IgnoreAccess = true; 2791 } 2792 2793 CXXCastPath BasePath; 2794 if (CheckDerivedToBaseConversion(FromRecordType, DestRecordType, 2795 FromLoc, FromRange, &BasePath, 2796 IgnoreAccess)) 2797 return ExprError(); 2798 2799 return ImpCastExprToType(From, DestType, CK_UncheckedDerivedToBase, 2800 VK, &BasePath); 2801 } 2802 2803 bool Sema::UseArgumentDependentLookup(const CXXScopeSpec &SS, 2804 const LookupResult &R, 2805 bool HasTrailingLParen) { 2806 // Only when used directly as the postfix-expression of a call. 2807 if (!HasTrailingLParen) 2808 return false; 2809 2810 // Never if a scope specifier was provided. 2811 if (SS.isSet()) 2812 return false; 2813 2814 // Only in C++ or ObjC++. 2815 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) 2816 return false; 2817 2818 // Turn off ADL when we find certain kinds of declarations during 2819 // normal lookup: 2820 for (NamedDecl *D : R) { 2821 // C++0x [basic.lookup.argdep]p3: 2822 // -- a declaration of a class member 2823 // Since using decls preserve this property, we check this on the 2824 // original decl. 2825 if (D->isCXXClassMember()) 2826 return false; 2827 2828 // C++0x [basic.lookup.argdep]p3: 2829 // -- a block-scope function declaration that is not a 2830 // using-declaration 2831 // NOTE: we also trigger this for function templates (in fact, we 2832 // don't check the decl type at all, since all other decl types 2833 // turn off ADL anyway). 2834 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D)) 2835 D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl(); 2836 else if (D->getLexicalDeclContext()->isFunctionOrMethod()) 2837 return false; 2838 2839 // C++0x [basic.lookup.argdep]p3: 2840 // -- a declaration that is neither a function or a function 2841 // template 2842 // And also for builtin functions. 2843 if (isa<FunctionDecl>(D)) { 2844 FunctionDecl *FDecl = cast<FunctionDecl>(D); 2845 2846 // But also builtin functions. 2847 if (FDecl->getBuiltinID() && FDecl->isImplicit()) 2848 return false; 2849 } else if (!isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D)) 2850 return false; 2851 } 2852 2853 return true; 2854 } 2855 2856 2857 /// Diagnoses obvious problems with the use of the given declaration 2858 /// as an expression. This is only actually called for lookups that 2859 /// were not overloaded, and it doesn't promise that the declaration 2860 /// will in fact be used. 2861 static bool CheckDeclInExpr(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, NamedDecl *D) { 2862 if (D->isInvalidDecl()) 2863 return true; 2864 2865 if (isa<TypedefNameDecl>(D)) { 2866 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_unexpected_typedef) << D->getDeclName(); 2867 return true; 2868 } 2869 2870 if (isa<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(D)) { 2871 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_unexpected_interface) << D->getDeclName(); 2872 return true; 2873 } 2874 2875 if (isa<NamespaceDecl>(D)) { 2876 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_unexpected_namespace) << D->getDeclName(); 2877 return true; 2878 } 2879 2880 return false; 2881 } 2882 2883 // Certain multiversion types should be treated as overloaded even when there is 2884 // only one result. 2885 static bool ShouldLookupResultBeMultiVersionOverload(const LookupResult &R) { 2886 assert(R.isSingleResult() && "Expected only a single result"); 2887 const auto *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(R.getFoundDecl()); 2888 return FD && 2889 (FD->isCPUDispatchMultiVersion() || FD->isCPUSpecificMultiVersion()); 2890 } 2891 2892 ExprResult Sema::BuildDeclarationNameExpr(const CXXScopeSpec &SS, 2893 LookupResult &R, bool NeedsADL, 2894 bool AcceptInvalidDecl) { 2895 // If this is a single, fully-resolved result and we don't need ADL, 2896 // just build an ordinary singleton decl ref. 2897 if (!NeedsADL && R.isSingleResult() && 2898 !R.getAsSingle<FunctionTemplateDecl>() && 2899 !ShouldLookupResultBeMultiVersionOverload(R)) 2900 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R.getLookupNameInfo(), R.getFoundDecl(), 2901 R.getRepresentativeDecl(), nullptr, 2902 AcceptInvalidDecl); 2903 2904 // We only need to check the declaration if there's exactly one 2905 // result, because in the overloaded case the results can only be 2906 // functions and function templates. 2907 if (R.isSingleResult() && !ShouldLookupResultBeMultiVersionOverload(R) && 2908 CheckDeclInExpr(*this, R.getNameLoc(), R.getFoundDecl())) 2909 return ExprError(); 2910 2911 // Otherwise, just build an unresolved lookup expression. Suppress 2912 // any lookup-related diagnostics; we'll hash these out later, when 2913 // we've picked a target. 2914 R.suppressDiagnostics(); 2915 2916 UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE 2917 = UnresolvedLookupExpr::Create(Context, R.getNamingClass(), 2918 SS.getWithLocInContext(Context), 2919 R.getLookupNameInfo(), 2920 NeedsADL, R.isOverloadedResult(), 2921 R.begin(), R.end()); 2922 2923 return ULE; 2924 } 2925 2926 static void 2927 diagnoseUncapturableValueReference(Sema &S, SourceLocation loc, 2928 ValueDecl *var, DeclContext *DC); 2929 2930 /// Complete semantic analysis for a reference to the given declaration. 2931 ExprResult Sema::BuildDeclarationNameExpr( 2932 const CXXScopeSpec &SS, const DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo, NamedDecl *D, 2933 NamedDecl *FoundD, const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs, 2934 bool AcceptInvalidDecl) { 2935 assert(D && "Cannot refer to a NULL declaration"); 2936 assert(!isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D) && 2937 "Cannot refer unambiguously to a function template"); 2938 2939 SourceLocation Loc = NameInfo.getLoc(); 2940 if (CheckDeclInExpr(*this, Loc, D)) 2941 return ExprError(); 2942 2943 if (TemplateDecl *Template = dyn_cast<TemplateDecl>(D)) { 2944 // Specifically diagnose references to class templates that are missing 2945 // a template argument list. 2946 diagnoseMissingTemplateArguments(TemplateName(Template), Loc); 2947 return ExprError(); 2948 } 2949 2950 // Make sure that we're referring to a value. 2951 ValueDecl *VD = dyn_cast<ValueDecl>(D); 2952 if (!VD) { 2953 Diag(Loc, diag::err_ref_non_value) 2954 << D << SS.getRange(); 2955 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_declared_at); 2956 return ExprError(); 2957 } 2958 2959 // Check whether this declaration can be used. Note that we suppress 2960 // this check when we're going to perform argument-dependent lookup 2961 // on this function name, because this might not be the function 2962 // that overload resolution actually selects. 2963 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(VD, Loc)) 2964 return ExprError(); 2965 2966 // Only create DeclRefExpr's for valid Decl's. 2967 if (VD->isInvalidDecl() && !AcceptInvalidDecl) 2968 return ExprError(); 2969 2970 // Handle members of anonymous structs and unions. If we got here, 2971 // and the reference is to a class member indirect field, then this 2972 // must be the subject of a pointer-to-member expression. 2973 if (IndirectFieldDecl *indirectField = dyn_cast<IndirectFieldDecl>(VD)) 2974 if (!indirectField->isCXXClassMember()) 2975 return BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberReference(SS, NameInfo.getLoc(), 2976 indirectField); 2977 2978 { 2979 QualType type = VD->getType(); 2980 if (type.isNull()) 2981 return ExprError(); 2982 if (auto *FPT = type->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) { 2983 // C++ [except.spec]p17: 2984 // An exception-specification is considered to be needed when: 2985 // - in an expression, the function is the unique lookup result or 2986 // the selected member of a set of overloaded functions. 2987 ResolveExceptionSpec(Loc, FPT); 2988 type = VD->getType(); 2989 } 2990 ExprValueKind valueKind = VK_RValue; 2991 2992 switch (D->getKind()) { 2993 // Ignore all the non-ValueDecl kinds. 2994 #define ABSTRACT_DECL(kind) 2995 #define VALUE(type, base) 2996 #define DECL(type, base) \ 2997 case Decl::type: 2998 #include "clang/AST/DeclNodes.inc" 2999 llvm_unreachable("invalid value decl kind"); 3000 3001 // These shouldn't make it here. 3002 case Decl::ObjCAtDefsField: 3003 llvm_unreachable("forming non-member reference to ivar?"); 3004 3005 // Enum constants are always r-values and never references. 3006 // Unresolved using declarations are dependent. 3007 case Decl::EnumConstant: 3008 case Decl::UnresolvedUsingValue: 3009 case Decl::OMPDeclareReduction: 3010 case Decl::OMPDeclareMapper: 3011 valueKind = VK_RValue; 3012 break; 3013 3014 // Fields and indirect fields that got here must be for 3015 // pointer-to-member expressions; we just call them l-values for 3016 // internal consistency, because this subexpression doesn't really 3017 // exist in the high-level semantics. 3018 case Decl::Field: 3019 case Decl::IndirectField: 3020 case Decl::ObjCIvar: 3021 assert(getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && 3022 "building reference to field in C?"); 3023 3024 // These can't have reference type in well-formed programs, but 3025 // for internal consistency we do this anyway. 3026 type = type.getNonReferenceType(); 3027 valueKind = VK_LValue; 3028 break; 3029 3030 // Non-type template parameters are either l-values or r-values 3031 // depending on the type. 3032 case Decl::NonTypeTemplateParm: { 3033 if (const ReferenceType *reftype = type->getAs<ReferenceType>()) { 3034 type = reftype->getPointeeType(); 3035 valueKind = VK_LValue; // even if the parameter is an r-value reference 3036 break; 3037 } 3038 3039 // For non-references, we need to strip qualifiers just in case 3040 // the template parameter was declared as 'const int' or whatever. 3041 valueKind = VK_RValue; 3042 type = type.getUnqualifiedType(); 3043 break; 3044 } 3045 3046 case Decl::Var: 3047 case Decl::VarTemplateSpecialization: 3048 case Decl::VarTemplatePartialSpecialization: 3049 case Decl::Decomposition: 3050 case Decl::OMPCapturedExpr: 3051 // In C, "extern void blah;" is valid and is an r-value. 3052 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && 3053 !type.hasQualifiers() && 3054 type->isVoidType()) { 3055 valueKind = VK_RValue; 3056 break; 3057 } 3058 LLVM_FALLTHROUGH; 3059 3060 case Decl::ImplicitParam: 3061 case Decl::ParmVar: { 3062 // These are always l-values. 3063 valueKind = VK_LValue; 3064 type = type.getNonReferenceType(); 3065 3066 // FIXME: Does the addition of const really only apply in 3067 // potentially-evaluated contexts? Since the variable isn't actually 3068 // captured in an unevaluated context, it seems that the answer is no. 3069 if (!isUnevaluatedContext()) { 3070 QualType CapturedType = getCapturedDeclRefType(cast<VarDecl>(VD), Loc); 3071 if (!CapturedType.isNull()) 3072 type = CapturedType; 3073 } 3074 3075 break; 3076 } 3077 3078 case Decl::Binding: { 3079 // These are always lvalues. 3080 valueKind = VK_LValue; 3081 type = type.getNonReferenceType(); 3082 // FIXME: Support lambda-capture of BindingDecls, once CWG actually 3083 // decides how that's supposed to work. 3084 auto *BD = cast<BindingDecl>(VD); 3085 if (BD->getDeclContext() != CurContext) { 3086 auto *DD = dyn_cast_or_null<VarDecl>(BD->getDecomposedDecl()); 3087 if (DD && DD->hasLocalStorage()) 3088 diagnoseUncapturableValueReference(*this, Loc, BD, CurContext); 3089 } 3090 break; 3091 } 3092 3093 case Decl::Function: { 3094 if (unsigned BID = cast<FunctionDecl>(VD)->getBuiltinID()) { 3095 if (!Context.BuiltinInfo.isPredefinedLibFunction(BID)) { 3096 type = Context.BuiltinFnTy; 3097 valueKind = VK_RValue; 3098 break; 3099 } 3100 } 3101 3102 const FunctionType *fty = type->castAs<FunctionType>(); 3103 3104 // If we're referring to a function with an __unknown_anytype 3105 // result type, make the entire expression __unknown_anytype. 3106 if (fty->getReturnType() == Context.UnknownAnyTy) { 3107 type = Context.UnknownAnyTy; 3108 valueKind = VK_RValue; 3109 break; 3110 } 3111 3112 // Functions are l-values in C++. 3113 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 3114 valueKind = VK_LValue; 3115 break; 3116 } 3117 3118 // C99 DR 316 says that, if a function type comes from a 3119 // function definition (without a prototype), that type is only 3120 // used for checking compatibility. Therefore, when referencing 3121 // the function, we pretend that we don't have the full function 3122 // type. 3123 if (!cast<FunctionDecl>(VD)->hasPrototype() && 3124 isa<FunctionProtoType>(fty)) 3125 type = Context.getFunctionNoProtoType(fty->getReturnType(), 3126 fty->getExtInfo()); 3127 3128 // Functions are r-values in C. 3129 valueKind = VK_RValue; 3130 break; 3131 } 3132 3133 case Decl::CXXDeductionGuide: 3134 llvm_unreachable("building reference to deduction guide"); 3135 3136 case Decl::MSProperty: 3137 valueKind = VK_LValue; 3138 break; 3139 3140 case Decl::CXXMethod: 3141 // If we're referring to a method with an __unknown_anytype 3142 // result type, make the entire expression __unknown_anytype. 3143 // This should only be possible with a type written directly. 3144 if (const FunctionProtoType *proto 3145 = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(VD->getType())) 3146 if (proto->getReturnType() == Context.UnknownAnyTy) { 3147 type = Context.UnknownAnyTy; 3148 valueKind = VK_RValue; 3149 break; 3150 } 3151 3152 // C++ methods are l-values if static, r-values if non-static. 3153 if (cast<CXXMethodDecl>(VD)->isStatic()) { 3154 valueKind = VK_LValue; 3155 break; 3156 } 3157 LLVM_FALLTHROUGH; 3158 3159 case Decl::CXXConversion: 3160 case Decl::CXXDestructor: 3161 case Decl::CXXConstructor: 3162 valueKind = VK_RValue; 3163 break; 3164 } 3165 3166 return BuildDeclRefExpr(VD, type, valueKind, NameInfo, &SS, FoundD, 3167 /*FIXME: TemplateKWLoc*/ SourceLocation(), 3168 TemplateArgs); 3169 } 3170 } 3171 3172 static void ConvertUTF8ToWideString(unsigned CharByteWidth, StringRef Source, 3173 SmallString<32> &Target) { 3174 Target.resize(CharByteWidth * (Source.size() + 1)); 3175 char *ResultPtr = &Target[0]; 3176 const llvm::UTF8 *ErrorPtr; 3177 bool success = 3178 llvm::ConvertUTF8toWide(CharByteWidth, Source, ResultPtr, ErrorPtr); 3179 (void)success; 3180 assert(success); 3181 Target.resize(ResultPtr - &Target[0]); 3182 } 3183 3184 ExprResult Sema::BuildPredefinedExpr(SourceLocation Loc, 3185 PredefinedExpr::IdentKind IK) { 3186 // Pick the current block, lambda, captured statement or function. 3187 Decl *currentDecl = nullptr; 3188 if (const BlockScopeInfo *BSI = getCurBlock()) 3189 currentDecl = BSI->TheDecl; 3190 else if (const LambdaScopeInfo *LSI = getCurLambda()) 3191 currentDecl = LSI->CallOperator; 3192 else if (const CapturedRegionScopeInfo *CSI = getCurCapturedRegion()) 3193 currentDecl = CSI->TheCapturedDecl; 3194 else 3195 currentDecl = getCurFunctionOrMethodDecl(); 3196 3197 if (!currentDecl) { 3198 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_predef_outside_function); 3199 currentDecl = Context.getTranslationUnitDecl(); 3200 } 3201 3202 QualType ResTy; 3203 StringLiteral *SL = nullptr; 3204 if (cast<DeclContext>(currentDecl)->isDependentContext()) 3205 ResTy = Context.DependentTy; 3206 else { 3207 // Pre-defined identifiers are of type char[x], where x is the length of 3208 // the string. 3209 auto Str = PredefinedExpr::ComputeName(IK, currentDecl); 3210 unsigned Length = Str.length(); 3211 3212 llvm::APInt LengthI(32, Length + 1); 3213 if (IK == PredefinedExpr::LFunction || IK == PredefinedExpr::LFuncSig) { 3214 ResTy = 3215 Context.adjustStringLiteralBaseType(Context.WideCharTy.withConst()); 3216 SmallString<32> RawChars; 3217 ConvertUTF8ToWideString(Context.getTypeSizeInChars(ResTy).getQuantity(), 3218 Str, RawChars); 3219 ResTy = Context.getConstantArrayType(ResTy, LengthI, ArrayType::Normal, 3220 /*IndexTypeQuals*/ 0); 3221 SL = StringLiteral::Create(Context, RawChars, StringLiteral::Wide, 3222 /*Pascal*/ false, ResTy, Loc); 3223 } else { 3224 ResTy = Context.adjustStringLiteralBaseType(Context.CharTy.withConst()); 3225 ResTy = Context.getConstantArrayType(ResTy, LengthI, ArrayType::Normal, 3226 /*IndexTypeQuals*/ 0); 3227 SL = StringLiteral::Create(Context, Str, StringLiteral::Ascii, 3228 /*Pascal*/ false, ResTy, Loc); 3229 } 3230 } 3231 3232 return PredefinedExpr::Create(Context, Loc, ResTy, IK, SL); 3233 } 3234 3235 ExprResult Sema::ActOnPredefinedExpr(SourceLocation Loc, tok::TokenKind Kind) { 3236 PredefinedExpr::IdentKind IK; 3237 3238 switch (Kind) { 3239 default: llvm_unreachable("Unknown simple primary expr!"); 3240 case tok::kw___func__: IK = PredefinedExpr::Func; break; // [C99 6.4.2.2] 3241 case tok::kw___FUNCTION__: IK = PredefinedExpr::Function; break; 3242 case tok::kw___FUNCDNAME__: IK = PredefinedExpr::FuncDName; break; // [MS] 3243 case tok::kw___FUNCSIG__: IK = PredefinedExpr::FuncSig; break; // [MS] 3244 case tok::kw_L__FUNCTION__: IK = PredefinedExpr::LFunction; break; // [MS] 3245 case tok::kw_L__FUNCSIG__: IK = PredefinedExpr::LFuncSig; break; // [MS] 3246 case tok::kw___PRETTY_FUNCTION__: IK = PredefinedExpr::PrettyFunction; break; 3247 } 3248 3249 return BuildPredefinedExpr(Loc, IK); 3250 } 3251 3252 ExprResult Sema::ActOnCharacterConstant(const Token &Tok, Scope *UDLScope) { 3253 SmallString<16> CharBuffer; 3254 bool Invalid = false; 3255 StringRef ThisTok = PP.getSpelling(Tok, CharBuffer, &Invalid); 3256 if (Invalid) 3257 return ExprError(); 3258 3259 CharLiteralParser Literal(ThisTok.begin(), ThisTok.end(), Tok.getLocation(), 3260 PP, Tok.getKind()); 3261 if (Literal.hadError()) 3262 return ExprError(); 3263 3264 QualType Ty; 3265 if (Literal.isWide()) 3266 Ty = Context.WideCharTy; // L'x' -> wchar_t in C and C++. 3267 else if (Literal.isUTF8() && getLangOpts().Char8) 3268 Ty = Context.Char8Ty; // u8'x' -> char8_t when it exists. 3269 else if (Literal.isUTF16()) 3270 Ty = Context.Char16Ty; // u'x' -> char16_t in C11 and C++11. 3271 else if (Literal.isUTF32()) 3272 Ty = Context.Char32Ty; // U'x' -> char32_t in C11 and C++11. 3273 else if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus || Literal.isMultiChar()) 3274 Ty = Context.IntTy; // 'x' -> int in C, 'wxyz' -> int in C++. 3275 else 3276 Ty = Context.CharTy; // 'x' -> char in C++ 3277 3278 CharacterLiteral::CharacterKind Kind = CharacterLiteral::Ascii; 3279 if (Literal.isWide()) 3280 Kind = CharacterLiteral::Wide; 3281 else if (Literal.isUTF16()) 3282 Kind = CharacterLiteral::UTF16; 3283 else if (Literal.isUTF32()) 3284 Kind = CharacterLiteral::UTF32; 3285 else if (Literal.isUTF8()) 3286 Kind = CharacterLiteral::UTF8; 3287 3288 Expr *Lit = new (Context) CharacterLiteral(Literal.getValue(), Kind, Ty, 3289 Tok.getLocation()); 3290 3291 if (Literal.getUDSuffix().empty()) 3292 return Lit; 3293 3294 // We're building a user-defined literal. 3295 IdentifierInfo *UDSuffix = &Context.Idents.get(Literal.getUDSuffix()); 3296 SourceLocation UDSuffixLoc = 3297 getUDSuffixLoc(*this, Tok.getLocation(), Literal.getUDSuffixOffset()); 3298 3299 // Make sure we're allowed user-defined literals here. 3300 if (!UDLScope) 3301 return ExprError(Diag(UDSuffixLoc, diag::err_invalid_character_udl)); 3302 3303 // C++11 [lex.ext]p6: The literal L is treated as a call of the form 3304 // operator "" X (ch) 3305 return BuildCookedLiteralOperatorCall(*this, UDLScope, UDSuffix, UDSuffixLoc, 3306 Lit, Tok.getLocation()); 3307 } 3308 3309 ExprResult Sema::ActOnIntegerConstant(SourceLocation Loc, uint64_t Val) { 3310 unsigned IntSize = Context.getTargetInfo().getIntWidth(); 3311 return IntegerLiteral::Create(Context, llvm::APInt(IntSize, Val), 3312 Context.IntTy, Loc); 3313 } 3314 3315 static Expr *BuildFloatingLiteral(Sema &S, NumericLiteralParser &Literal, 3316 QualType Ty, SourceLocation Loc) { 3317 const llvm::fltSemantics &Format = S.Context.getFloatTypeSemantics(Ty); 3318 3319 using llvm::APFloat; 3320 APFloat Val(Format); 3321 3322 APFloat::opStatus result = Literal.GetFloatValue(Val); 3323 3324 // Overflow is always an error, but underflow is only an error if 3325 // we underflowed to zero (APFloat reports denormals as underflow). 3326 if ((result & APFloat::opOverflow) || 3327 ((result & APFloat::opUnderflow) && Val.isZero())) { 3328 unsigned diagnostic; 3329 SmallString<20> buffer; 3330 if (result & APFloat::opOverflow) { 3331 diagnostic = diag::warn_float_overflow; 3332 APFloat::getLargest(Format).toString(buffer); 3333 } else { 3334 diagnostic = diag::warn_float_underflow; 3335 APFloat::getSmallest(Format).toString(buffer); 3336 } 3337 3338 S.Diag(Loc, diagnostic) 3339 << Ty 3340 << StringRef(buffer.data(), buffer.size()); 3341 } 3342 3343 bool isExact = (result == APFloat::opOK); 3344 return FloatingLiteral::Create(S.Context, Val, isExact, Ty, Loc); 3345 } 3346 3347 bool Sema::CheckLoopHintExpr(Expr *E, SourceLocation Loc) { 3348 assert(E && "Invalid expression"); 3349 3350 if (E->isValueDependent()) 3351 return false; 3352 3353 QualType QT = E->getType(); 3354 if (!QT->isIntegerType() || QT->isBooleanType() || QT->isCharType()) { 3355 Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_pragma_loop_invalid_argument_type) << QT; 3356 return true; 3357 } 3358 3359 llvm::APSInt ValueAPS; 3360 ExprResult R = VerifyIntegerConstantExpression(E, &ValueAPS); 3361 3362 if (R.isInvalid()) 3363 return true; 3364 3365 bool ValueIsPositive = ValueAPS.isStrictlyPositive(); 3366 if (!ValueIsPositive || ValueAPS.getActiveBits() > 31) { 3367 Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_pragma_loop_invalid_argument_value) 3368 << ValueAPS.toString(10) << ValueIsPositive; 3369 return true; 3370 } 3371 3372 return false; 3373 } 3374 3375 ExprResult Sema::ActOnNumericConstant(const Token &Tok, Scope *UDLScope) { 3376 // Fast path for a single digit (which is quite common). A single digit 3377 // cannot have a trigraph, escaped newline, radix prefix, or suffix. 3378 if (Tok.getLength() == 1) { 3379 const char Val = PP.getSpellingOfSingleCharacterNumericConstant(Tok); 3380 return ActOnIntegerConstant(Tok.getLocation(), Val-'0'); 3381 } 3382 3383 SmallString<128> SpellingBuffer; 3384 // NumericLiteralParser wants to overread by one character. Add padding to 3385 // the buffer in case the token is copied to the buffer. If getSpelling() 3386 // returns a StringRef to the memory buffer, it should have a null char at 3387 // the EOF, so it is also safe. 3388 SpellingBuffer.resize(Tok.getLength() + 1); 3389 3390 // Get the spelling of the token, which eliminates trigraphs, etc. 3391 bool Invalid = false; 3392 StringRef TokSpelling = PP.getSpelling(Tok, SpellingBuffer, &Invalid); 3393 if (Invalid) 3394 return ExprError(); 3395 3396 NumericLiteralParser Literal(TokSpelling, Tok.getLocation(), PP); 3397 if (Literal.hadError) 3398 return ExprError(); 3399 3400 if (Literal.hasUDSuffix()) { 3401 // We're building a user-defined literal. 3402 IdentifierInfo *UDSuffix = &Context.Idents.get(Literal.getUDSuffix()); 3403 SourceLocation UDSuffixLoc = 3404 getUDSuffixLoc(*this, Tok.getLocation(), Literal.getUDSuffixOffset()); 3405 3406 // Make sure we're allowed user-defined literals here. 3407 if (!UDLScope) 3408 return ExprError(Diag(UDSuffixLoc, diag::err_invalid_numeric_udl)); 3409 3410 QualType CookedTy; 3411 if (Literal.isFloatingLiteral()) { 3412 // C++11 [lex.ext]p4: If S contains a literal operator with parameter type 3413 // long double, the literal is treated as a call of the form 3414 // operator "" X (f L) 3415 CookedTy = Context.LongDoubleTy; 3416 } else { 3417 // C++11 [lex.ext]p3: If S contains a literal operator with parameter type 3418 // unsigned long long, the literal is treated as a call of the form 3419 // operator "" X (n ULL) 3420 CookedTy = Context.UnsignedLongLongTy; 3421 } 3422 3423 DeclarationName OpName = 3424 Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXLiteralOperatorName(UDSuffix); 3425 DeclarationNameInfo OpNameInfo(OpName, UDSuffixLoc); 3426 OpNameInfo.setCXXLiteralOperatorNameLoc(UDSuffixLoc); 3427 3428 SourceLocation TokLoc = Tok.getLocation(); 3429 3430 // Perform literal operator lookup to determine if we're building a raw 3431 // literal or a cooked one. 3432 LookupResult R(*this, OpName, UDSuffixLoc, LookupOrdinaryName); 3433 switch (LookupLiteralOperator(UDLScope, R, CookedTy, 3434 /*AllowRaw*/ true, /*AllowTemplate*/ true, 3435 /*AllowStringTemplate*/ false, 3436 /*DiagnoseMissing*/ !Literal.isImaginary)) { 3437 case LOLR_ErrorNoDiagnostic: 3438 // Lookup failure for imaginary constants isn't fatal, there's still the 3439 // GNU extension producing _Complex types. 3440 break; 3441 case LOLR_Error: 3442 return ExprError(); 3443 case LOLR_Cooked: { 3444 Expr *Lit; 3445 if (Literal.isFloatingLiteral()) { 3446 Lit = BuildFloatingLiteral(*this, Literal, CookedTy, Tok.getLocation()); 3447 } else { 3448 llvm::APInt ResultVal(Context.getTargetInfo().getLongLongWidth(), 0); 3449 if (Literal.GetIntegerValue(ResultVal)) 3450 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diag::err_integer_literal_too_large) 3451 << /* Unsigned */ 1; 3452 Lit = IntegerLiteral::Create(Context, ResultVal, CookedTy, 3453 Tok.getLocation()); 3454 } 3455 return BuildLiteralOperatorCall(R, OpNameInfo, Lit, TokLoc); 3456 } 3457 3458 case LOLR_Raw: { 3459 // C++11 [lit.ext]p3, p4: If S contains a raw literal operator, the 3460 // literal is treated as a call of the form 3461 // operator "" X ("n") 3462 unsigned Length = Literal.getUDSuffixOffset(); 3463 QualType StrTy = Context.getConstantArrayType( 3464 Context.adjustStringLiteralBaseType(Context.CharTy.withConst()), 3465 llvm::APInt(32, Length + 1), ArrayType::Normal, 0); 3466 Expr *Lit = StringLiteral::Create( 3467 Context, StringRef(TokSpelling.data(), Length), StringLiteral::Ascii, 3468 /*Pascal*/false, StrTy, &TokLoc, 1); 3469 return BuildLiteralOperatorCall(R, OpNameInfo, Lit, TokLoc); 3470 } 3471 3472 case LOLR_Template: { 3473 // C++11 [lit.ext]p3, p4: Otherwise (S contains a literal operator 3474 // template), L is treated as a call fo the form 3475 // operator "" X <'c1', 'c2', ... 'ck'>() 3476 // where n is the source character sequence c1 c2 ... ck. 3477 TemplateArgumentListInfo ExplicitArgs; 3478 unsigned CharBits = Context.getIntWidth(Context.CharTy); 3479 bool CharIsUnsigned = Context.CharTy->isUnsignedIntegerType(); 3480 llvm::APSInt Value(CharBits, CharIsUnsigned); 3481 for (unsigned I = 0, N = Literal.getUDSuffixOffset(); I != N; ++I) { 3482 Value = TokSpelling[I]; 3483 TemplateArgument Arg(Context, Value, Context.CharTy); 3484 TemplateArgumentLocInfo ArgInfo; 3485 ExplicitArgs.addArgument(TemplateArgumentLoc(Arg, ArgInfo)); 3486 } 3487 return BuildLiteralOperatorCall(R, OpNameInfo, None, TokLoc, 3488 &ExplicitArgs); 3489 } 3490 case LOLR_StringTemplate: 3491 llvm_unreachable("unexpected literal operator lookup result"); 3492 } 3493 } 3494 3495 Expr *Res; 3496 3497 if (Literal.isFixedPointLiteral()) { 3498 QualType Ty; 3499 3500 if (Literal.isAccum) { 3501 if (Literal.isHalf) { 3502 Ty = Context.ShortAccumTy; 3503 } else if (Literal.isLong) { 3504 Ty = Context.LongAccumTy; 3505 } else { 3506 Ty = Context.AccumTy; 3507 } 3508 } else if (Literal.isFract) { 3509 if (Literal.isHalf) { 3510 Ty = Context.ShortFractTy; 3511 } else if (Literal.isLong) { 3512 Ty = Context.LongFractTy; 3513 } else { 3514 Ty = Context.FractTy; 3515 } 3516 } 3517 3518 if (Literal.isUnsigned) Ty = Context.getCorrespondingUnsignedType(Ty); 3519 3520 bool isSigned = !Literal.isUnsigned; 3521 unsigned scale = Context.getFixedPointScale(Ty); 3522 unsigned bit_width = Context.getTypeInfo(Ty).Width; 3523 3524 llvm::APInt Val(bit_width, 0, isSigned); 3525 bool Overflowed = Literal.GetFixedPointValue(Val, scale); 3526 bool ValIsZero = Val.isNullValue() && !Overflowed; 3527 3528 auto MaxVal = Context.getFixedPointMax(Ty).getValue(); 3529 if (Literal.isFract && Val == MaxVal + 1 && !ValIsZero) 3530 // Clause 6.4.4 - The value of a constant shall be in the range of 3531 // representable values for its type, with exception for constants of a 3532 // fract type with a value of exactly 1; such a constant shall denote 3533 // the maximal value for the type. 3534 --Val; 3535 else if (Val.ugt(MaxVal) || Overflowed) 3536 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diag::err_too_large_for_fixed_point); 3537 3538 Res = FixedPointLiteral::CreateFromRawInt(Context, Val, Ty, 3539 Tok.getLocation(), scale); 3540 } else if (Literal.isFloatingLiteral()) { 3541 QualType Ty; 3542 if (Literal.isHalf){ 3543 if (getOpenCLOptions().isEnabled("cl_khr_fp16")) 3544 Ty = Context.HalfTy; 3545 else { 3546 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diag::err_half_const_requires_fp16); 3547 return ExprError(); 3548 } 3549 } else if (Literal.isFloat) 3550 Ty = Context.FloatTy; 3551 else if (Literal.isLong) 3552 Ty = Context.LongDoubleTy; 3553 else if (Literal.isFloat16) 3554 Ty = Context.Float16Ty; 3555 else if (Literal.isFloat128) 3556 Ty = Context.Float128Ty; 3557 else 3558 Ty = Context.DoubleTy; 3559 3560 Res = BuildFloatingLiteral(*this, Literal, Ty, Tok.getLocation()); 3561 3562 if (Ty == Context.DoubleTy) { 3563 if (getLangOpts().SinglePrecisionConstants) { 3564 const BuiltinType *BTy = Ty->getAs<BuiltinType>(); 3565 if (BTy->getKind() != BuiltinType::Float) { 3566 Res = ImpCastExprToType(Res, Context.FloatTy, CK_FloatingCast).get(); 3567 } 3568 } else if (getLangOpts().OpenCL && 3569 !getOpenCLOptions().isEnabled("cl_khr_fp64")) { 3570 // Impose single-precision float type when cl_khr_fp64 is not enabled. 3571 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diag::warn_double_const_requires_fp64); 3572 Res = ImpCastExprToType(Res, Context.FloatTy, CK_FloatingCast).get(); 3573 } 3574 } 3575 } else if (!Literal.isIntegerLiteral()) { 3576 return ExprError(); 3577 } else { 3578 QualType Ty; 3579 3580 // 'long long' is a C99 or C++11 feature. 3581 if (!getLangOpts().C99 && Literal.isLongLong) { 3582 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) 3583 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), 3584 getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11 ? 3585 diag::warn_cxx98_compat_longlong : diag::ext_cxx11_longlong); 3586 else 3587 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diag::ext_c99_longlong); 3588 } 3589 3590 // Get the value in the widest-possible width. 3591 unsigned MaxWidth = Context.getTargetInfo().getIntMaxTWidth(); 3592 llvm::APInt ResultVal(MaxWidth, 0); 3593 3594 if (Literal.GetIntegerValue(ResultVal)) { 3595 // If this value didn't fit into uintmax_t, error and force to ull. 3596 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diag::err_integer_literal_too_large) 3597 << /* Unsigned */ 1; 3598 Ty = Context.UnsignedLongLongTy; 3599 assert(Context.getTypeSize(Ty) == ResultVal.getBitWidth() && 3600 "long long is not intmax_t?"); 3601 } else { 3602 // If this value fits into a ULL, try to figure out what else it fits into 3603 // according to the rules of C99 6.4.4.1p5. 3604 3605 // Octal, Hexadecimal, and integers with a U suffix are allowed to 3606 // be an unsigned int. 3607 bool AllowUnsigned = Literal.isUnsigned || Literal.getRadix() != 10; 3608 3609 // Check from smallest to largest, picking the smallest type we can. 3610 unsigned Width = 0; 3611 3612 // Microsoft specific integer suffixes are explicitly sized. 3613 if (Literal.MicrosoftInteger) { 3614 if (Literal.MicrosoftInteger == 8 && !Literal.isUnsigned) { 3615 Width = 8; 3616 Ty = Context.CharTy; 3617 } else { 3618 Width = Literal.MicrosoftInteger; 3619 Ty = Context.getIntTypeForBitwidth(Width, 3620 /*Signed=*/!Literal.isUnsigned); 3621 } 3622 } 3623 3624 if (Ty.isNull() && !Literal.isLong && !Literal.isLongLong) { 3625 // Are int/unsigned possibilities? 3626 unsigned IntSize = Context.getTargetInfo().getIntWidth(); 3627 3628 // Does it fit in a unsigned int? 3629 if (ResultVal.isIntN(IntSize)) { 3630 // Does it fit in a signed int? 3631 if (!Literal.isUnsigned && ResultVal[IntSize-1] == 0) 3632 Ty = Context.IntTy; 3633 else if (AllowUnsigned) 3634 Ty = Context.UnsignedIntTy; 3635 Width = IntSize; 3636 } 3637 } 3638 3639 // Are long/unsigned long possibilities? 3640 if (Ty.isNull() && !Literal.isLongLong) { 3641 unsigned LongSize = Context.getTargetInfo().getLongWidth(); 3642 3643 // Does it fit in a unsigned long? 3644 if (ResultVal.isIntN(LongSize)) { 3645 // Does it fit in a signed long? 3646 if (!Literal.isUnsigned && ResultVal[LongSize-1] == 0) 3647 Ty = Context.LongTy; 3648 else if (AllowUnsigned) 3649 Ty = Context.UnsignedLongTy; 3650 // Check according to the rules of C90 6.1.3.2p5. C++03 [lex.icon]p2 3651 // is compatible. 3652 else if (!getLangOpts().C99 && !getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11) { 3653 const unsigned LongLongSize = 3654 Context.getTargetInfo().getLongLongWidth(); 3655 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), 3656 getLangOpts().CPlusPlus 3657 ? Literal.isLong 3658 ? diag::warn_old_implicitly_unsigned_long_cxx 3659 : /*C++98 UB*/ diag:: 3660 ext_old_implicitly_unsigned_long_cxx 3661 : diag::warn_old_implicitly_unsigned_long) 3662 << (LongLongSize > LongSize ? /*will have type 'long long'*/ 0 3663 : /*will be ill-formed*/ 1); 3664 Ty = Context.UnsignedLongTy; 3665 } 3666 Width = LongSize; 3667 } 3668 } 3669 3670 // Check long long if needed. 3671 if (Ty.isNull()) { 3672 unsigned LongLongSize = Context.getTargetInfo().getLongLongWidth(); 3673 3674 // Does it fit in a unsigned long long? 3675 if (ResultVal.isIntN(LongLongSize)) { 3676 // Does it fit in a signed long long? 3677 // To be compatible with MSVC, hex integer literals ending with the 3678 // LL or i64 suffix are always signed in Microsoft mode. 3679 if (!Literal.isUnsigned && (ResultVal[LongLongSize-1] == 0 || 3680 (getLangOpts().MSVCCompat && Literal.isLongLong))) 3681 Ty = Context.LongLongTy; 3682 else if (AllowUnsigned) 3683 Ty = Context.UnsignedLongLongTy; 3684 Width = LongLongSize; 3685 } 3686 } 3687 3688 // If we still couldn't decide a type, we probably have something that 3689 // does not fit in a signed long long, but has no U suffix. 3690 if (Ty.isNull()) { 3691 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diag::ext_integer_literal_too_large_for_signed); 3692 Ty = Context.UnsignedLongLongTy; 3693 Width = Context.getTargetInfo().getLongLongWidth(); 3694 } 3695 3696 if (ResultVal.getBitWidth() != Width) 3697 ResultVal = ResultVal.trunc(Width); 3698 } 3699 Res = IntegerLiteral::Create(Context, ResultVal, Ty, Tok.getLocation()); 3700 } 3701 3702 // If this is an imaginary literal, create the ImaginaryLiteral wrapper. 3703 if (Literal.isImaginary) { 3704 Res = new (Context) ImaginaryLiteral(Res, 3705 Context.getComplexType(Res->getType())); 3706 3707 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diag::ext_imaginary_constant); 3708 } 3709 return Res; 3710 } 3711 3712 ExprResult Sema::ActOnParenExpr(SourceLocation L, SourceLocation R, Expr *E) { 3713 assert(E && "ActOnParenExpr() missing expr"); 3714 return new (Context) ParenExpr(L, R, E); 3715 } 3716 3717 static bool CheckVecStepTraitOperandType(Sema &S, QualType T, 3718 SourceLocation Loc, 3719 SourceRange ArgRange) { 3720 // [OpenCL 1.1 6.11.12] "The vec_step built-in function takes a built-in 3721 // scalar or vector data type argument..." 3722 // Every built-in scalar type (OpenCL 1.1 6.1.1) is either an arithmetic 3723 // type (C99 6.2.5p18) or void. 3724 if (!(T->isArithmeticType() || T->isVoidType() || T->isVectorType())) { 3725 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_vecstep_non_scalar_vector_type) 3726 << T << ArgRange; 3727 return true; 3728 } 3729 3730 assert((T->isVoidType() || !T->isIncompleteType()) && 3731 "Scalar types should always be complete"); 3732 return false; 3733 } 3734 3735 static bool CheckExtensionTraitOperandType(Sema &S, QualType T, 3736 SourceLocation Loc, 3737 SourceRange ArgRange, 3738 UnaryExprOrTypeTrait TraitKind) { 3739 // Invalid types must be hard errors for SFINAE in C++. 3740 if (S.LangOpts.CPlusPlus) 3741 return true; 3742 3743 // C99 6.5.3.4p1: 3744 if (T->isFunctionType() && 3745 (TraitKind == UETT_SizeOf || TraitKind == UETT_AlignOf || 3746 TraitKind == UETT_PreferredAlignOf)) { 3747 // sizeof(function)/alignof(function) is allowed as an extension. 3748 S.Diag(Loc, diag::ext_sizeof_alignof_function_type) 3749 << TraitKind << ArgRange; 3750 return false; 3751 } 3752 3753 // Allow sizeof(void)/alignof(void) as an extension, unless in OpenCL where 3754 // this is an error (OpenCL v1.1 s6.3.k) 3755 if (T->isVoidType()) { 3756 unsigned DiagID = S.LangOpts.OpenCL ? diag::err_opencl_sizeof_alignof_type 3757 : diag::ext_sizeof_alignof_void_type; 3758 S.Diag(Loc, DiagID) << TraitKind << ArgRange; 3759 return false; 3760 } 3761 3762 return true; 3763 } 3764 3765 static bool CheckObjCTraitOperandConstraints(Sema &S, QualType T, 3766 SourceLocation Loc, 3767 SourceRange ArgRange, 3768 UnaryExprOrTypeTrait TraitKind) { 3769 // Reject sizeof(interface) and sizeof(interface<proto>) if the 3770 // runtime doesn't allow it. 3771 if (!S.LangOpts.ObjCRuntime.allowsSizeofAlignof() && T->isObjCObjectType()) { 3772 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_sizeof_nonfragile_interface) 3773 << T << (TraitKind == UETT_SizeOf) 3774 << ArgRange; 3775 return true; 3776 } 3777 3778 return false; 3779 } 3780 3781 /// Check whether E is a pointer from a decayed array type (the decayed 3782 /// pointer type is equal to T) and emit a warning if it is. 3783 static void warnOnSizeofOnArrayDecay(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, QualType T, 3784 Expr *E) { 3785 // Don't warn if the operation changed the type. 3786 if (T != E->getType()) 3787 return; 3788 3789 // Now look for array decays. 3790 ImplicitCastExpr *ICE = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(E); 3791 if (!ICE || ICE->getCastKind() != CK_ArrayToPointerDecay) 3792 return; 3793 3794 S.Diag(Loc, diag::warn_sizeof_array_decay) << ICE->getSourceRange() 3795 << ICE->getType() 3796 << ICE->getSubExpr()->getType(); 3797 } 3798 3799 /// Check the constraints on expression operands to unary type expression 3800 /// and type traits. 3801 /// 3802 /// Completes any types necessary and validates the constraints on the operand 3803 /// expression. The logic mostly mirrors the type-based overload, but may modify 3804 /// the expression as it completes the type for that expression through template 3805 /// instantiation, etc. 3806 bool Sema::CheckUnaryExprOrTypeTraitOperand(Expr *E, 3807 UnaryExprOrTypeTrait ExprKind) { 3808 QualType ExprTy = E->getType(); 3809 assert(!ExprTy->isReferenceType()); 3810 3811 if (ExprKind == UETT_VecStep) 3812 return CheckVecStepTraitOperandType(*this, ExprTy, E->getExprLoc(), 3813 E->getSourceRange()); 3814 3815 // Whitelist some types as extensions 3816 if (!CheckExtensionTraitOperandType(*this, ExprTy, E->getExprLoc(), 3817 E->getSourceRange(), ExprKind)) 3818 return false; 3819 3820 // 'alignof' applied to an expression only requires the base element type of 3821 // the expression to be complete. 'sizeof' requires the expression's type to 3822 // be complete (and will attempt to complete it if it's an array of unknown 3823 // bound). 3824 if (ExprKind == UETT_AlignOf || ExprKind == UETT_PreferredAlignOf) { 3825 if (RequireCompleteType(E->getExprLoc(), 3826 Context.getBaseElementType(E->getType()), 3827 diag::err_sizeof_alignof_incomplete_type, ExprKind, 3828 E->getSourceRange())) 3829 return true; 3830 } else { 3831 if (RequireCompleteExprType(E, diag::err_sizeof_alignof_incomplete_type, 3832 ExprKind, E->getSourceRange())) 3833 return true; 3834 } 3835 3836 // Completing the expression's type may have changed it. 3837 ExprTy = E->getType(); 3838 assert(!ExprTy->isReferenceType()); 3839 3840 if (ExprTy->isFunctionType()) { 3841 Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_sizeof_alignof_function_type) 3842 << ExprKind << E->getSourceRange(); 3843 return true; 3844 } 3845 3846 // The operand for sizeof and alignof is in an unevaluated expression context, 3847 // so side effects could result in unintended consequences. 3848 if ((ExprKind == UETT_SizeOf || ExprKind == UETT_AlignOf || 3849 ExprKind == UETT_PreferredAlignOf) && 3850 !inTemplateInstantiation() && E->HasSideEffects(Context, false)) 3851 Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::warn_side_effects_unevaluated_context); 3852 3853 if (CheckObjCTraitOperandConstraints(*this, ExprTy, E->getExprLoc(), 3854 E->getSourceRange(), ExprKind)) 3855 return true; 3856 3857 if (ExprKind == UETT_SizeOf) { 3858 if (DeclRefExpr *DeclRef = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(E->IgnoreParens())) { 3859 if (ParmVarDecl *PVD = dyn_cast<ParmVarDecl>(DeclRef->getFoundDecl())) { 3860 QualType OType = PVD->getOriginalType(); 3861 QualType Type = PVD->getType(); 3862 if (Type->isPointerType() && OType->isArrayType()) { 3863 Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::warn_sizeof_array_param) 3864 << Type << OType; 3865 Diag(PVD->getLocation(), diag::note_declared_at); 3866 } 3867 } 3868 } 3869 3870 // Warn on "sizeof(array op x)" and "sizeof(x op array)", where the array 3871 // decays into a pointer and returns an unintended result. This is most 3872 // likely a typo for "sizeof(array) op x". 3873 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(E->IgnoreParens())) { 3874 warnOnSizeofOnArrayDecay(*this, BO->getOperatorLoc(), BO->getType(), 3875 BO->getLHS()); 3876 warnOnSizeofOnArrayDecay(*this, BO->getOperatorLoc(), BO->getType(), 3877 BO->getRHS()); 3878 } 3879 } 3880 3881 return false; 3882 } 3883 3884 /// Check the constraints on operands to unary expression and type 3885 /// traits. 3886 /// 3887 /// This will complete any types necessary, and validate the various constraints 3888 /// on those operands. 3889 /// 3890 /// The UsualUnaryConversions() function is *not* called by this routine. 3891 /// C99 6.3.2.1p[2-4] all state: 3892 /// Except when it is the operand of the sizeof operator ... 3893 /// 3894 /// C++ [expr.sizeof]p4 3895 /// The lvalue-to-rvalue, array-to-pointer, and function-to-pointer 3896 /// standard conversions are not applied to the operand of sizeof. 3897 /// 3898 /// This policy is followed for all of the unary trait expressions. 3899 bool Sema::CheckUnaryExprOrTypeTraitOperand(QualType ExprType, 3900 SourceLocation OpLoc, 3901 SourceRange ExprRange, 3902 UnaryExprOrTypeTrait ExprKind) { 3903 if (ExprType->isDependentType()) 3904 return false; 3905 3906 // C++ [expr.sizeof]p2: 3907 // When applied to a reference or a reference type, the result 3908 // is the size of the referenced type. 3909 // C++11 [expr.alignof]p3: 3910 // When alignof is applied to a reference type, the result 3911 // shall be the alignment of the referenced type. 3912 if (const ReferenceType *Ref = ExprType->getAs<ReferenceType>()) 3913 ExprType = Ref->getPointeeType(); 3914 3915 // C11 6.5.3.4/3, C++11 [expr.alignof]p3: 3916 // When alignof or _Alignof is applied to an array type, the result 3917 // is the alignment of the element type. 3918 if (ExprKind == UETT_AlignOf || ExprKind == UETT_PreferredAlignOf || 3919 ExprKind == UETT_OpenMPRequiredSimdAlign) 3920 ExprType = Context.getBaseElementType(ExprType); 3921 3922 if (ExprKind == UETT_VecStep) 3923 return CheckVecStepTraitOperandType(*this, ExprType, OpLoc, ExprRange); 3924 3925 // Whitelist some types as extensions 3926 if (!CheckExtensionTraitOperandType(*this, ExprType, OpLoc, ExprRange, 3927 ExprKind)) 3928 return false; 3929 3930 if (RequireCompleteType(OpLoc, ExprType, 3931 diag::err_sizeof_alignof_incomplete_type, 3932 ExprKind, ExprRange)) 3933 return true; 3934 3935 if (ExprType->isFunctionType()) { 3936 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_sizeof_alignof_function_type) 3937 << ExprKind << ExprRange; 3938 return true; 3939 } 3940 3941 if (CheckObjCTraitOperandConstraints(*this, ExprType, OpLoc, ExprRange, 3942 ExprKind)) 3943 return true; 3944 3945 return false; 3946 } 3947 3948 static bool CheckAlignOfExpr(Sema &S, Expr *E, UnaryExprOrTypeTrait ExprKind) { 3949 E = E->IgnoreParens(); 3950 3951 // Cannot know anything else if the expression is dependent. 3952 if (E->isTypeDependent()) 3953 return false; 3954 3955 if (E->getObjectKind() == OK_BitField) { 3956 S.Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_sizeof_alignof_typeof_bitfield) 3957 << 1 << E->getSourceRange(); 3958 return true; 3959 } 3960 3961 ValueDecl *D = nullptr; 3962 if (DeclRefExpr *DRE = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(E)) { 3963 D = DRE->getDecl(); 3964 } else if (MemberExpr *ME = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(E)) { 3965 D = ME->getMemberDecl(); 3966 } 3967 3968 // If it's a field, require the containing struct to have a 3969 // complete definition so that we can compute the layout. 3970 // 3971 // This can happen in C++11 onwards, either by naming the member 3972 // in a way that is not transformed into a member access expression 3973 // (in an unevaluated operand, for instance), or by naming the member 3974 // in a trailing-return-type. 3975 // 3976 // For the record, since __alignof__ on expressions is a GCC 3977 // extension, GCC seems to permit this but always gives the 3978 // nonsensical answer 0. 3979 // 3980 // We don't really need the layout here --- we could instead just 3981 // directly check for all the appropriate alignment-lowing 3982 // attributes --- but that would require duplicating a lot of 3983 // logic that just isn't worth duplicating for such a marginal 3984 // use-case. 3985 if (FieldDecl *FD = dyn_cast_or_null<FieldDecl>(D)) { 3986 // Fast path this check, since we at least know the record has a 3987 // definition if we can find a member of it. 3988 if (!FD->getParent()->isCompleteDefinition()) { 3989 S.Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_alignof_member_of_incomplete_type) 3990 << E->getSourceRange(); 3991 return true; 3992 } 3993 3994 // Otherwise, if it's a field, and the field doesn't have 3995 // reference type, then it must have a complete type (or be a 3996 // flexible array member, which we explicitly want to 3997 // white-list anyway), which makes the following checks trivial. 3998 if (!FD->getType()->isReferenceType()) 3999 return false; 4000 } 4001 4002 return S.CheckUnaryExprOrTypeTraitOperand(E, ExprKind); 4003 } 4004 4005 bool Sema::CheckVecStepExpr(Expr *E) { 4006 E = E->IgnoreParens(); 4007 4008 // Cannot know anything else if the expression is dependent. 4009 if (E->isTypeDependent()) 4010 return false; 4011 4012 return CheckUnaryExprOrTypeTraitOperand(E, UETT_VecStep); 4013 } 4014 4015 static void captureVariablyModifiedType(ASTContext &Context, QualType T, 4016 CapturingScopeInfo *CSI) { 4017 assert(T->isVariablyModifiedType()); 4018 assert(CSI != nullptr); 4019 4020 // We're going to walk down into the type and look for VLA expressions. 4021 do { 4022 const Type *Ty = T.getTypePtr(); 4023 switch (Ty->getTypeClass()) { 4024 #define TYPE(Class, Base) 4025 #define ABSTRACT_TYPE(Class, Base) 4026 #define NON_CANONICAL_TYPE(Class, Base) 4027 #define DEPENDENT_TYPE(Class, Base) case Type::Class: 4028 #define NON_CANONICAL_UNLESS_DEPENDENT_TYPE(Class, Base) 4029 #include "clang/AST/TypeNodes.def" 4030 T = QualType(); 4031 break; 4032 // These types are never variably-modified. 4033 case Type::Builtin: 4034 case Type::Complex: 4035 case Type::Vector: 4036 case Type::ExtVector: 4037 case Type::Record: 4038 case Type::Enum: 4039 case Type::Elaborated: 4040 case Type::TemplateSpecialization: 4041 case Type::ObjCObject: 4042 case Type::ObjCInterface: 4043 case Type::ObjCObjectPointer: 4044 case Type::ObjCTypeParam: 4045 case Type::Pipe: 4046 llvm_unreachable("type class is never variably-modified!"); 4047 case Type::Adjusted: 4048 T = cast<AdjustedType>(Ty)->getOriginalType(); 4049 break; 4050 case Type::Decayed: 4051 T = cast<DecayedType>(Ty)->getPointeeType(); 4052 break; 4053 case Type::Pointer: 4054 T = cast<PointerType>(Ty)->getPointeeType(); 4055 break; 4056 case Type::BlockPointer: 4057 T = cast<BlockPointerType>(Ty)->getPointeeType(); 4058 break; 4059 case Type::LValueReference: 4060 case Type::RValueReference: 4061 T = cast<ReferenceType>(Ty)->getPointeeType(); 4062 break; 4063 case Type::MemberPointer: 4064 T = cast<MemberPointerType>(Ty)->getPointeeType(); 4065 break; 4066 case Type::ConstantArray: 4067 case Type::IncompleteArray: 4068 // Losing element qualification here is fine. 4069 T = cast<ArrayType>(Ty)->getElementType(); 4070 break; 4071 case Type::VariableArray: { 4072 // Losing element qualification here is fine. 4073 const VariableArrayType *VAT = cast<VariableArrayType>(Ty); 4074 4075 // Unknown size indication requires no size computation. 4076 // Otherwise, evaluate and record it. 4077 auto Size = VAT->getSizeExpr(); 4078 if (Size && !CSI->isVLATypeCaptured(VAT) && 4079 (isa<CapturedRegionScopeInfo>(CSI) || isa<LambdaScopeInfo>(CSI))) 4080 CSI->addVLATypeCapture(Size->getExprLoc(), VAT, Context.getSizeType()); 4081 4082 T = VAT->getElementType(); 4083 break; 4084 } 4085 case Type::FunctionProto: 4086 case Type::FunctionNoProto: 4087 T = cast<FunctionType>(Ty)->getReturnType(); 4088 break; 4089 case Type::Paren: 4090 case Type::TypeOf: 4091 case Type::UnaryTransform: 4092 case Type::Attributed: 4093 case Type::SubstTemplateTypeParm: 4094 case Type::PackExpansion: 4095 case Type::MacroQualified: 4096 // Keep walking after single level desugaring. 4097 T = T.getSingleStepDesugaredType(Context); 4098 break; 4099 case Type::Typedef: 4100 T = cast<TypedefType>(Ty)->desugar(); 4101 break; 4102 case Type::Decltype: 4103 T = cast<DecltypeType>(Ty)->desugar(); 4104 break; 4105 case Type::Auto: 4106 case Type::DeducedTemplateSpecialization: 4107 T = cast<DeducedType>(Ty)->getDeducedType(); 4108 break; 4109 case Type::TypeOfExpr: 4110 T = cast<TypeOfExprType>(Ty)->getUnderlyingExpr()->getType(); 4111 break; 4112 case Type::Atomic: 4113 T = cast<AtomicType>(Ty)->getValueType(); 4114 break; 4115 } 4116 } while (!T.isNull() && T->isVariablyModifiedType()); 4117 } 4118 4119 /// Build a sizeof or alignof expression given a type operand. 4120 ExprResult 4121 Sema::CreateUnaryExprOrTypeTraitExpr(TypeSourceInfo *TInfo, 4122 SourceLocation OpLoc, 4123 UnaryExprOrTypeTrait ExprKind, 4124 SourceRange R) { 4125 if (!TInfo) 4126 return ExprError(); 4127 4128 QualType T = TInfo->getType(); 4129 4130 if (!T->isDependentType() && 4131 CheckUnaryExprOrTypeTraitOperand(T, OpLoc, R, ExprKind)) 4132 return ExprError(); 4133 4134 if (T->isVariablyModifiedType() && FunctionScopes.size() > 1) { 4135 if (auto *TT = T->getAs<TypedefType>()) { 4136 for (auto I = FunctionScopes.rbegin(), 4137 E = std::prev(FunctionScopes.rend()); 4138 I != E; ++I) { 4139 auto *CSI = dyn_cast<CapturingScopeInfo>(*I); 4140 if (CSI == nullptr) 4141 break; 4142 DeclContext *DC = nullptr; 4143 if (auto *LSI = dyn_cast<LambdaScopeInfo>(CSI)) 4144 DC = LSI->CallOperator; 4145 else if (auto *CRSI = dyn_cast<CapturedRegionScopeInfo>(CSI)) 4146 DC = CRSI->TheCapturedDecl; 4147 else if (auto *BSI = dyn_cast<BlockScopeInfo>(CSI)) 4148 DC = BSI->TheDecl; 4149 if (DC) { 4150 if (DC->containsDecl(TT->getDecl())) 4151 break; 4152 captureVariablyModifiedType(Context, T, CSI); 4153 } 4154 } 4155 } 4156 } 4157 4158 // C99 6.5.3.4p4: the type (an unsigned integer type) is size_t. 4159 return new (Context) UnaryExprOrTypeTraitExpr( 4160 ExprKind, TInfo, Context.getSizeType(), OpLoc, R.getEnd()); 4161 } 4162 4163 /// Build a sizeof or alignof expression given an expression 4164 /// operand. 4165 ExprResult 4166 Sema::CreateUnaryExprOrTypeTraitExpr(Expr *E, SourceLocation OpLoc, 4167 UnaryExprOrTypeTrait ExprKind) { 4168 ExprResult PE = CheckPlaceholderExpr(E); 4169 if (PE.isInvalid()) 4170 return ExprError(); 4171 4172 E = PE.get(); 4173 4174 // Verify that the operand is valid. 4175 bool isInvalid = false; 4176 if (E->isTypeDependent()) { 4177 // Delay type-checking for type-dependent expressions. 4178 } else if (ExprKind == UETT_AlignOf || ExprKind == UETT_PreferredAlignOf) { 4179 isInvalid = CheckAlignOfExpr(*this, E, ExprKind); 4180 } else if (ExprKind == UETT_VecStep) { 4181 isInvalid = CheckVecStepExpr(E); 4182 } else if (ExprKind == UETT_OpenMPRequiredSimdAlign) { 4183 Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_openmp_default_simd_align_expr); 4184 isInvalid = true; 4185 } else if (E->refersToBitField()) { // C99 6.5.3.4p1. 4186 Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_sizeof_alignof_typeof_bitfield) << 0; 4187 isInvalid = true; 4188 } else { 4189 isInvalid = CheckUnaryExprOrTypeTraitOperand(E, UETT_SizeOf); 4190 } 4191 4192 if (isInvalid) 4193 return ExprError(); 4194 4195 if (ExprKind == UETT_SizeOf && E->getType()->isVariableArrayType()) { 4196 PE = TransformToPotentiallyEvaluated(E); 4197 if (PE.isInvalid()) return ExprError(); 4198 E = PE.get(); 4199 } 4200 4201 // C99 6.5.3.4p4: the type (an unsigned integer type) is size_t. 4202 return new (Context) UnaryExprOrTypeTraitExpr( 4203 ExprKind, E, Context.getSizeType(), OpLoc, E->getSourceRange().getEnd()); 4204 } 4205 4206 /// ActOnUnaryExprOrTypeTraitExpr - Handle @c sizeof(type) and @c sizeof @c 4207 /// expr and the same for @c alignof and @c __alignof 4208 /// Note that the ArgRange is invalid if isType is false. 4209 ExprResult 4210 Sema::ActOnUnaryExprOrTypeTraitExpr(SourceLocation OpLoc, 4211 UnaryExprOrTypeTrait ExprKind, bool IsType, 4212 void *TyOrEx, SourceRange ArgRange) { 4213 // If error parsing type, ignore. 4214 if (!TyOrEx) return ExprError(); 4215 4216 if (IsType) { 4217 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo; 4218 (void) GetTypeFromParser(ParsedType::getFromOpaquePtr(TyOrEx), &TInfo); 4219 return CreateUnaryExprOrTypeTraitExpr(TInfo, OpLoc, ExprKind, ArgRange); 4220 } 4221 4222 Expr *ArgEx = (Expr *)TyOrEx; 4223 ExprResult Result = CreateUnaryExprOrTypeTraitExpr(ArgEx, OpLoc, ExprKind); 4224 return Result; 4225 } 4226 4227 static QualType CheckRealImagOperand(Sema &S, ExprResult &V, SourceLocation Loc, 4228 bool IsReal) { 4229 if (V.get()->isTypeDependent()) 4230 return S.Context.DependentTy; 4231 4232 // _Real and _Imag are only l-values for normal l-values. 4233 if (V.get()->getObjectKind() != OK_Ordinary) { 4234 V = S.DefaultLvalueConversion(V.get()); 4235 if (V.isInvalid()) 4236 return QualType(); 4237 } 4238 4239 // These operators return the element type of a complex type. 4240 if (const ComplexType *CT = V.get()->getType()->getAs<ComplexType>()) 4241 return CT->getElementType(); 4242 4243 // Otherwise they pass through real integer and floating point types here. 4244 if (V.get()->getType()->isArithmeticType()) 4245 return V.get()->getType(); 4246 4247 // Test for placeholders. 4248 ExprResult PR = S.CheckPlaceholderExpr(V.get()); 4249 if (PR.isInvalid()) return QualType(); 4250 if (PR.get() != V.get()) { 4251 V = PR; 4252 return CheckRealImagOperand(S, V, Loc, IsReal); 4253 } 4254 4255 // Reject anything else. 4256 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_realimag_invalid_type) << V.get()->getType() 4257 << (IsReal ? "__real" : "__imag"); 4258 return QualType(); 4259 } 4260 4261 4262 4263 ExprResult 4264 Sema::ActOnPostfixUnaryOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation OpLoc, 4265 tok::TokenKind Kind, Expr *Input) { 4266 UnaryOperatorKind Opc; 4267 switch (Kind) { 4268 default: llvm_unreachable("Unknown unary op!"); 4269 case tok::plusplus: Opc = UO_PostInc; break; 4270 case tok::minusminus: Opc = UO_PostDec; break; 4271 } 4272 4273 // Since this might is a postfix expression, get rid of ParenListExprs. 4274 ExprResult Result = MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(S, Input); 4275 if (Result.isInvalid()) return ExprError(); 4276 Input = Result.get(); 4277 4278 return BuildUnaryOp(S, OpLoc, Opc, Input); 4279 } 4280 4281 /// Diagnose if arithmetic on the given ObjC pointer is illegal. 4282 /// 4283 /// \return true on error 4284 static bool checkArithmeticOnObjCPointer(Sema &S, 4285 SourceLocation opLoc, 4286 Expr *op) { 4287 assert(op->getType()->isObjCObjectPointerType()); 4288 if (S.LangOpts.ObjCRuntime.allowsPointerArithmetic() && 4289 !S.LangOpts.ObjCSubscriptingLegacyRuntime) 4290 return false; 4291 4292 S.Diag(opLoc, diag::err_arithmetic_nonfragile_interface) 4293 << op->getType()->castAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType() 4294 << op->getSourceRange(); 4295 return true; 4296 } 4297 4298 static bool isMSPropertySubscriptExpr(Sema &S, Expr *Base) { 4299 auto *BaseNoParens = Base->IgnoreParens(); 4300 if (auto *MSProp = dyn_cast<MSPropertyRefExpr>(BaseNoParens)) 4301 return MSProp->getPropertyDecl()->getType()->isArrayType(); 4302 return isa<MSPropertySubscriptExpr>(BaseNoParens); 4303 } 4304 4305 ExprResult 4306 Sema::ActOnArraySubscriptExpr(Scope *S, Expr *base, SourceLocation lbLoc, 4307 Expr *idx, SourceLocation rbLoc) { 4308 if (base && !base->getType().isNull() && 4309 base->getType()->isSpecificPlaceholderType(BuiltinType::OMPArraySection)) 4310 return ActOnOMPArraySectionExpr(base, lbLoc, idx, SourceLocation(), 4311 /*Length=*/nullptr, rbLoc); 4312 4313 // Since this might be a postfix expression, get rid of ParenListExprs. 4314 if (isa<ParenListExpr>(base)) { 4315 ExprResult result = MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(S, base); 4316 if (result.isInvalid()) return ExprError(); 4317 base = result.get(); 4318 } 4319 4320 // A comma-expression as the index is deprecated in C++2a onwards. 4321 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus2a && 4322 ((isa<BinaryOperator>(idx) && cast<BinaryOperator>(idx)->isCommaOp()) || 4323 (isa<CXXOperatorCallExpr>(idx) && 4324 cast<CXXOperatorCallExpr>(idx)->getOperator() == OO_Comma))) { 4325 Diag(idx->getExprLoc(), diag::warn_deprecated_comma_subscript) 4326 << SourceRange(base->getBeginLoc(), rbLoc); 4327 } 4328 4329 // Handle any non-overload placeholder types in the base and index 4330 // expressions. We can't handle overloads here because the other 4331 // operand might be an overloadable type, in which case the overload 4332 // resolution for the operator overload should get the first crack 4333 // at the overload. 4334 bool IsMSPropertySubscript = false; 4335 if (base->getType()->isNonOverloadPlaceholderType()) { 4336 IsMSPropertySubscript = isMSPropertySubscriptExpr(*this, base); 4337 if (!IsMSPropertySubscript) { 4338 ExprResult result = CheckPlaceholderExpr(base); 4339 if (result.isInvalid()) 4340 return ExprError(); 4341 base = result.get(); 4342 } 4343 } 4344 if (idx->getType()->isNonOverloadPlaceholderType()) { 4345 ExprResult result = CheckPlaceholderExpr(idx); 4346 if (result.isInvalid()) return ExprError(); 4347 idx = result.get(); 4348 } 4349 4350 // Build an unanalyzed expression if either operand is type-dependent. 4351 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && 4352 (base->isTypeDependent() || idx->isTypeDependent())) { 4353 return new (Context) ArraySubscriptExpr(base, idx, Context.DependentTy, 4354 VK_LValue, OK_Ordinary, rbLoc); 4355 } 4356 4357 // MSDN, property (C++) 4358 // https://msdn.microsoft.com/en-us/library/yhfk0thd(v=vs.120).aspx 4359 // This attribute can also be used in the declaration of an empty array in a 4360 // class or structure definition. For example: 4361 // __declspec(property(get=GetX, put=PutX)) int x[]; 4362 // The above statement indicates that x[] can be used with one or more array 4363 // indices. In this case, i=p->x[a][b] will be turned into i=p->GetX(a, b), 4364 // and p->x[a][b] = i will be turned into p->PutX(a, b, i); 4365 if (IsMSPropertySubscript) { 4366 // Build MS property subscript expression if base is MS property reference 4367 // or MS property subscript. 4368 return new (Context) MSPropertySubscriptExpr( 4369 base, idx, Context.PseudoObjectTy, VK_LValue, OK_Ordinary, rbLoc); 4370 } 4371 4372 // Use C++ overloaded-operator rules if either operand has record 4373 // type. The spec says to do this if either type is *overloadable*, 4374 // but enum types can't declare subscript operators or conversion 4375 // operators, so there's nothing interesting for overload resolution 4376 // to do if there aren't any record types involved. 4377 // 4378 // ObjC pointers have their own subscripting logic that is not tied 4379 // to overload resolution and so should not take this path. 4380 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && 4381 (base->getType()->isRecordType() || 4382 (!base->getType()->isObjCObjectPointerType() && 4383 idx->getType()->isRecordType()))) { 4384 return CreateOverloadedArraySubscriptExpr(lbLoc, rbLoc, base, idx); 4385 } 4386 4387 ExprResult Res = CreateBuiltinArraySubscriptExpr(base, lbLoc, idx, rbLoc); 4388 4389 if (!Res.isInvalid() && isa<ArraySubscriptExpr>(Res.get())) 4390 CheckSubscriptAccessOfNoDeref(cast<ArraySubscriptExpr>(Res.get())); 4391 4392 return Res; 4393 } 4394 4395 void Sema::CheckAddressOfNoDeref(const Expr *E) { 4396 ExpressionEvaluationContextRecord &LastRecord = ExprEvalContexts.back(); 4397 const Expr *StrippedExpr = E->IgnoreParenImpCasts(); 4398 4399 // For expressions like `&(*s).b`, the base is recorded and what should be 4400 // checked. 4401 const MemberExpr *Member = nullptr; 4402 while ((Member = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(StrippedExpr)) && !Member->isArrow()) 4403 StrippedExpr = Member->getBase()->IgnoreParenImpCasts(); 4404 4405 LastRecord.PossibleDerefs.erase(StrippedExpr); 4406 } 4407 4408 void Sema::CheckSubscriptAccessOfNoDeref(const ArraySubscriptExpr *E) { 4409 QualType ResultTy = E->getType(); 4410 ExpressionEvaluationContextRecord &LastRecord = ExprEvalContexts.back(); 4411 4412 // Bail if the element is an array since it is not memory access. 4413 if (isa<ArrayType>(ResultTy)) 4414 return; 4415 4416 if (ResultTy->hasAttr(attr::NoDeref)) { 4417 LastRecord.PossibleDerefs.insert(E); 4418 return; 4419 } 4420 4421 // Check if the base type is a pointer to a member access of a struct 4422 // marked with noderef. 4423 const Expr *Base = E->getBase(); 4424 QualType BaseTy = Base->getType(); 4425 if (!(isa<ArrayType>(BaseTy) || isa<PointerType>(BaseTy))) 4426 // Not a pointer access 4427 return; 4428 4429 const MemberExpr *Member = nullptr; 4430 while ((Member = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(Base->IgnoreParenCasts())) && 4431 Member->isArrow()) 4432 Base = Member->getBase(); 4433 4434 if (const auto *Ptr = dyn_cast<PointerType>(Base->getType())) { 4435 if (Ptr->getPointeeType()->hasAttr(attr::NoDeref)) 4436 LastRecord.PossibleDerefs.insert(E); 4437 } 4438 } 4439 4440 ExprResult Sema::ActOnOMPArraySectionExpr(Expr *Base, SourceLocation LBLoc, 4441 Expr *LowerBound, 4442 SourceLocation ColonLoc, Expr *Length, 4443 SourceLocation RBLoc) { 4444 if (Base->getType()->isPlaceholderType() && 4445 !Base->getType()->isSpecificPlaceholderType( 4446 BuiltinType::OMPArraySection)) { 4447 ExprResult Result = CheckPlaceholderExpr(Base); 4448 if (Result.isInvalid()) 4449 return ExprError(); 4450 Base = Result.get(); 4451 } 4452 if (LowerBound && LowerBound->getType()->isNonOverloadPlaceholderType()) { 4453 ExprResult Result = CheckPlaceholderExpr(LowerBound); 4454 if (Result.isInvalid()) 4455 return ExprError(); 4456 Result = DefaultLvalueConversion(Result.get()); 4457 if (Result.isInvalid()) 4458 return ExprError(); 4459 LowerBound = Result.get(); 4460 } 4461 if (Length && Length->getType()->isNonOverloadPlaceholderType()) { 4462 ExprResult Result = CheckPlaceholderExpr(Length); 4463 if (Result.isInvalid()) 4464 return ExprError(); 4465 Result = DefaultLvalueConversion(Result.get()); 4466 if (Result.isInvalid()) 4467 return ExprError(); 4468 Length = Result.get(); 4469 } 4470 4471 // Build an unanalyzed expression if either operand is type-dependent. 4472 if (Base->isTypeDependent() || 4473 (LowerBound && 4474 (LowerBound->isTypeDependent() || LowerBound->isValueDependent())) || 4475 (Length && (Length->isTypeDependent() || Length->isValueDependent()))) { 4476 return new (Context) 4477 OMPArraySectionExpr(Base, LowerBound, Length, Context.DependentTy, 4478 VK_LValue, OK_Ordinary, ColonLoc, RBLoc); 4479 } 4480 4481 // Perform default conversions. 4482 QualType OriginalTy = OMPArraySectionExpr::getBaseOriginalType(Base); 4483 QualType ResultTy; 4484 if (OriginalTy->isAnyPointerType()) { 4485 ResultTy = OriginalTy->getPointeeType(); 4486 } else if (OriginalTy->isArrayType()) { 4487 ResultTy = OriginalTy->getAsArrayTypeUnsafe()->getElementType(); 4488 } else { 4489 return ExprError( 4490 Diag(Base->getExprLoc(), diag::err_omp_typecheck_section_value) 4491 << Base->getSourceRange()); 4492 } 4493 // C99 6.5.2.1p1 4494 if (LowerBound) { 4495 auto Res = PerformOpenMPImplicitIntegerConversion(LowerBound->getExprLoc(), 4496 LowerBound); 4497 if (Res.isInvalid()) 4498 return ExprError(Diag(LowerBound->getExprLoc(), 4499 diag::err_omp_typecheck_section_not_integer) 4500 << 0 << LowerBound->getSourceRange()); 4501 LowerBound = Res.get(); 4502 4503 if (LowerBound->getType()->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Char_S) || 4504 LowerBound->getType()->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Char_U)) 4505 Diag(LowerBound->getExprLoc(), diag::warn_omp_section_is_char) 4506 << 0 << LowerBound->getSourceRange(); 4507 } 4508 if (Length) { 4509 auto Res = 4510 PerformOpenMPImplicitIntegerConversion(Length->getExprLoc(), Length); 4511 if (Res.isInvalid()) 4512 return ExprError(Diag(Length->getExprLoc(), 4513 diag::err_omp_typecheck_section_not_integer) 4514 << 1 << Length->getSourceRange()); 4515 Length = Res.get(); 4516 4517 if (Length->getType()->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Char_S) || 4518 Length->getType()->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Char_U)) 4519 Diag(Length->getExprLoc(), diag::warn_omp_section_is_char) 4520 << 1 << Length->getSourceRange(); 4521 } 4522 4523 // C99 6.5.2.1p1: "shall have type "pointer to *object* type". Similarly, 4524 // C++ [expr.sub]p1: The type "T" shall be a completely-defined object 4525 // type. Note that functions are not objects, and that (in C99 parlance) 4526 // incomplete types are not object types. 4527 if (ResultTy->isFunctionType()) { 4528 Diag(Base->getExprLoc(), diag::err_omp_section_function_type) 4529 << ResultTy << Base->getSourceRange(); 4530 return ExprError(); 4531 } 4532 4533 if (RequireCompleteType(Base->getExprLoc(), ResultTy, 4534 diag::err_omp_section_incomplete_type, Base)) 4535 return ExprError(); 4536 4537 if (LowerBound && !OriginalTy->isAnyPointerType()) { 4538 Expr::EvalResult Result; 4539 if (LowerBound->EvaluateAsInt(Result, Context)) { 4540 // OpenMP 4.5, [2.4 Array Sections] 4541 // The array section must be a subset of the original array. 4542 llvm::APSInt LowerBoundValue = Result.Val.getInt(); 4543 if (LowerBoundValue.isNegative()) { 4544 Diag(LowerBound->getExprLoc(), diag::err_omp_section_not_subset_of_array) 4545 << LowerBound->getSourceRange(); 4546 return ExprError(); 4547 } 4548 } 4549 } 4550 4551 if (Length) { 4552 Expr::EvalResult Result; 4553 if (Length->EvaluateAsInt(Result, Context)) { 4554 // OpenMP 4.5, [2.4 Array Sections] 4555 // The length must evaluate to non-negative integers. 4556 llvm::APSInt LengthValue = Result.Val.getInt(); 4557 if (LengthValue.isNegative()) { 4558 Diag(Length->getExprLoc(), diag::err_omp_section_length_negative) 4559 << LengthValue.toString(/*Radix=*/10, /*Signed=*/true) 4560 << Length->getSourceRange(); 4561 return ExprError(); 4562 } 4563 } 4564 } else if (ColonLoc.isValid() && 4565 (OriginalTy.isNull() || (!OriginalTy->isConstantArrayType() && 4566 !OriginalTy->isVariableArrayType()))) { 4567 // OpenMP 4.5, [2.4 Array Sections] 4568 // When the size of the array dimension is not known, the length must be 4569 // specified explicitly. 4570 Diag(ColonLoc, diag::err_omp_section_length_undefined) 4571 << (!OriginalTy.isNull() && OriginalTy->isArrayType()); 4572 return ExprError(); 4573 } 4574 4575 if (!Base->getType()->isSpecificPlaceholderType( 4576 BuiltinType::OMPArraySection)) { 4577 ExprResult Result = DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Base); 4578 if (Result.isInvalid()) 4579 return ExprError(); 4580 Base = Result.get(); 4581 } 4582 return new (Context) 4583 OMPArraySectionExpr(Base, LowerBound, Length, Context.OMPArraySectionTy, 4584 VK_LValue, OK_Ordinary, ColonLoc, RBLoc); 4585 } 4586 4587 ExprResult 4588 Sema::CreateBuiltinArraySubscriptExpr(Expr *Base, SourceLocation LLoc, 4589 Expr *Idx, SourceLocation RLoc) { 4590 Expr *LHSExp = Base; 4591 Expr *RHSExp = Idx; 4592 4593 ExprValueKind VK = VK_LValue; 4594 ExprObjectKind OK = OK_Ordinary; 4595 4596 // Per C++ core issue 1213, the result is an xvalue if either operand is 4597 // a non-lvalue array, and an lvalue otherwise. 4598 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11) { 4599 for (auto *Op : {LHSExp, RHSExp}) { 4600 Op = Op->IgnoreImplicit(); 4601 if (Op->getType()->isArrayType() && !Op->isLValue()) 4602 VK = VK_XValue; 4603 } 4604 } 4605 4606 // Perform default conversions. 4607 if (!LHSExp->getType()->getAs<VectorType>()) { 4608 ExprResult Result = DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(LHSExp); 4609 if (Result.isInvalid()) 4610 return ExprError(); 4611 LHSExp = Result.get(); 4612 } 4613 ExprResult Result = DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(RHSExp); 4614 if (Result.isInvalid()) 4615 return ExprError(); 4616 RHSExp = Result.get(); 4617 4618 QualType LHSTy = LHSExp->getType(), RHSTy = RHSExp->getType(); 4619 4620 // C99 6.5.2.1p2: the expression e1[e2] is by definition precisely equivalent 4621 // to the expression *((e1)+(e2)). This means the array "Base" may actually be 4622 // in the subscript position. As a result, we need to derive the array base 4623 // and index from the expression types. 4624 Expr *BaseExpr, *IndexExpr; 4625 QualType ResultType; 4626 if (LHSTy->isDependentType() || RHSTy->isDependentType()) { 4627 BaseExpr = LHSExp; 4628 IndexExpr = RHSExp; 4629 ResultType = Context.DependentTy; 4630 } else if (const PointerType *PTy = LHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()) { 4631 BaseExpr = LHSExp; 4632 IndexExpr = RHSExp; 4633 ResultType = PTy->getPointeeType(); 4634 } else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *PTy = 4635 LHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) { 4636 BaseExpr = LHSExp; 4637 IndexExpr = RHSExp; 4638 4639 // Use custom logic if this should be the pseudo-object subscript 4640 // expression. 4641 if (!LangOpts.isSubscriptPointerArithmetic()) 4642 return BuildObjCSubscriptExpression(RLoc, BaseExpr, IndexExpr, nullptr, 4643 nullptr); 4644 4645 ResultType = PTy->getPointeeType(); 4646 } else if (const PointerType *PTy = RHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()) { 4647 // Handle the uncommon case of "123[Ptr]". 4648 BaseExpr = RHSExp; 4649 IndexExpr = LHSExp; 4650 ResultType = PTy->getPointeeType(); 4651 } else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *PTy = 4652 RHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) { 4653 // Handle the uncommon case of "123[Ptr]". 4654 BaseExpr = RHSExp; 4655 IndexExpr = LHSExp; 4656 ResultType = PTy->getPointeeType(); 4657 if (!LangOpts.isSubscriptPointerArithmetic()) { 4658 Diag(LLoc, diag::err_subscript_nonfragile_interface) 4659 << ResultType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange(); 4660 return ExprError(); 4661 } 4662 } else if (const VectorType *VTy = LHSTy->getAs<VectorType>()) { 4663 BaseExpr = LHSExp; // vectors: V[123] 4664 IndexExpr = RHSExp; 4665 // We apply C++ DR1213 to vector subscripting too. 4666 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11 && LHSExp->getValueKind() == VK_RValue) { 4667 ExprResult Materialized = TemporaryMaterializationConversion(LHSExp); 4668 if (Materialized.isInvalid()) 4669 return ExprError(); 4670 LHSExp = Materialized.get(); 4671 } 4672 VK = LHSExp->getValueKind(); 4673 if (VK != VK_RValue) 4674 OK = OK_VectorComponent; 4675 4676 ResultType = VTy->getElementType(); 4677 QualType BaseType = BaseExpr->getType(); 4678 Qualifiers BaseQuals = BaseType.getQualifiers(); 4679 Qualifiers MemberQuals = ResultType.getQualifiers(); 4680 Qualifiers Combined = BaseQuals + MemberQuals; 4681 if (Combined != MemberQuals) 4682 ResultType = Context.getQualifiedType(ResultType, Combined); 4683 } else if (LHSTy->isArrayType()) { 4684 // If we see an array that wasn't promoted by 4685 // DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion, it must be an array that 4686 // wasn't promoted because of the C90 rule that doesn't 4687 // allow promoting non-lvalue arrays. Warn, then 4688 // force the promotion here. 4689 Diag(LHSExp->getBeginLoc(), diag::ext_subscript_non_lvalue) 4690 << LHSExp->getSourceRange(); 4691 LHSExp = ImpCastExprToType(LHSExp, Context.getArrayDecayedType(LHSTy), 4692 CK_ArrayToPointerDecay).get(); 4693 LHSTy = LHSExp->getType(); 4694 4695 BaseExpr = LHSExp; 4696 IndexExpr = RHSExp; 4697 ResultType = LHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType(); 4698 } else if (RHSTy->isArrayType()) { 4699 // Same as previous, except for 123[f().a] case 4700 Diag(RHSExp->getBeginLoc(), diag::ext_subscript_non_lvalue) 4701 << RHSExp->getSourceRange(); 4702 RHSExp = ImpCastExprToType(RHSExp, Context.getArrayDecayedType(RHSTy), 4703 CK_ArrayToPointerDecay).get(); 4704 RHSTy = RHSExp->getType(); 4705 4706 BaseExpr = RHSExp; 4707 IndexExpr = LHSExp; 4708 ResultType = RHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType(); 4709 } else { 4710 return ExprError(Diag(LLoc, diag::err_typecheck_subscript_value) 4711 << LHSExp->getSourceRange() << RHSExp->getSourceRange()); 4712 } 4713 // C99 6.5.2.1p1 4714 if (!IndexExpr->getType()->isIntegerType() && !IndexExpr->isTypeDependent()) 4715 return ExprError(Diag(LLoc, diag::err_typecheck_subscript_not_integer) 4716 << IndexExpr->getSourceRange()); 4717 4718 if ((IndexExpr->getType()->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Char_S) || 4719 IndexExpr->getType()->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Char_U)) 4720 && !IndexExpr->isTypeDependent()) 4721 Diag(LLoc, diag::warn_subscript_is_char) << IndexExpr->getSourceRange(); 4722 4723 // C99 6.5.2.1p1: "shall have type "pointer to *object* type". Similarly, 4724 // C++ [expr.sub]p1: The type "T" shall be a completely-defined object 4725 // type. Note that Functions are not objects, and that (in C99 parlance) 4726 // incomplete types are not object types. 4727 if (ResultType->isFunctionType()) { 4728 Diag(BaseExpr->getBeginLoc(), diag::err_subscript_function_type) 4729 << ResultType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange(); 4730 return ExprError(); 4731 } 4732 4733 if (ResultType->isVoidType() && !getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 4734 // GNU extension: subscripting on pointer to void 4735 Diag(LLoc, diag::ext_gnu_subscript_void_type) 4736 << BaseExpr->getSourceRange(); 4737 4738 // C forbids expressions of unqualified void type from being l-values. 4739 // See IsCForbiddenLValueType. 4740 if (!ResultType.hasQualifiers()) VK = VK_RValue; 4741 } else if (!ResultType->isDependentType() && 4742 RequireCompleteType(LLoc, ResultType, 4743 diag::err_subscript_incomplete_type, BaseExpr)) 4744 return ExprError(); 4745 4746 assert(VK == VK_RValue || LangOpts.CPlusPlus || 4747 !ResultType.isCForbiddenLValueType()); 4748 4749 if (LHSExp->IgnoreParenImpCasts()->getType()->isVariablyModifiedType() && 4750 FunctionScopes.size() > 1) { 4751 if (auto *TT = 4752 LHSExp->IgnoreParenImpCasts()->getType()->getAs<TypedefType>()) { 4753 for (auto I = FunctionScopes.rbegin(), 4754 E = std::prev(FunctionScopes.rend()); 4755 I != E; ++I) { 4756 auto *CSI = dyn_cast<CapturingScopeInfo>(*I); 4757 if (CSI == nullptr) 4758 break; 4759 DeclContext *DC = nullptr; 4760 if (auto *LSI = dyn_cast<LambdaScopeInfo>(CSI)) 4761 DC = LSI->CallOperator; 4762 else if (auto *CRSI = dyn_cast<CapturedRegionScopeInfo>(CSI)) 4763 DC = CRSI->TheCapturedDecl; 4764 else if (auto *BSI = dyn_cast<BlockScopeInfo>(CSI)) 4765 DC = BSI->TheDecl; 4766 if (DC) { 4767 if (DC->containsDecl(TT->getDecl())) 4768 break; 4769 captureVariablyModifiedType( 4770 Context, LHSExp->IgnoreParenImpCasts()->getType(), CSI); 4771 } 4772 } 4773 } 4774 } 4775 4776 return new (Context) 4777 ArraySubscriptExpr(LHSExp, RHSExp, ResultType, VK, OK, RLoc); 4778 } 4779 4780 bool Sema::CheckCXXDefaultArgExpr(SourceLocation CallLoc, FunctionDecl *FD, 4781 ParmVarDecl *Param) { 4782 if (Param->hasUnparsedDefaultArg()) { 4783 Diag(CallLoc, 4784 diag::err_use_of_default_argument_to_function_declared_later) << 4785 FD << cast<CXXRecordDecl>(FD->getDeclContext())->getDeclName(); 4786 Diag(UnparsedDefaultArgLocs[Param], 4787 diag::note_default_argument_declared_here); 4788 return true; 4789 } 4790 4791 if (Param->hasUninstantiatedDefaultArg()) { 4792 Expr *UninstExpr = Param->getUninstantiatedDefaultArg(); 4793 4794 EnterExpressionEvaluationContext EvalContext( 4795 *this, ExpressionEvaluationContext::PotentiallyEvaluated, Param); 4796 4797 // Instantiate the expression. 4798 // 4799 // FIXME: Pass in a correct Pattern argument, otherwise 4800 // getTemplateInstantiationArgs uses the lexical context of FD, e.g. 4801 // 4802 // template<typename T> 4803 // struct A { 4804 // static int FooImpl(); 4805 // 4806 // template<typename Tp> 4807 // // bug: default argument A<T>::FooImpl() is evaluated with 2-level 4808 // // template argument list [[T], [Tp]], should be [[Tp]]. 4809 // friend A<Tp> Foo(int a); 4810 // }; 4811 // 4812 // template<typename T> 4813 // A<T> Foo(int a = A<T>::FooImpl()); 4814 MultiLevelTemplateArgumentList MutiLevelArgList 4815 = getTemplateInstantiationArgs(FD, nullptr, /*RelativeToPrimary=*/true); 4816 4817 InstantiatingTemplate Inst(*this, CallLoc, Param, 4818 MutiLevelArgList.getInnermost()); 4819 if (Inst.isInvalid()) 4820 return true; 4821 if (Inst.isAlreadyInstantiating()) { 4822 Diag(Param->getBeginLoc(), diag::err_recursive_default_argument) << FD; 4823 Param->setInvalidDecl(); 4824 return true; 4825 } 4826 4827 ExprResult Result; 4828 { 4829 // C++ [dcl.fct.default]p5: 4830 // The names in the [default argument] expression are bound, and 4831 // the semantic constraints are checked, at the point where the 4832 // default argument expression appears. 4833 ContextRAII SavedContext(*this, FD); 4834 LocalInstantiationScope Local(*this); 4835 Result = SubstInitializer(UninstExpr, MutiLevelArgList, 4836 /*DirectInit*/false); 4837 } 4838 if (Result.isInvalid()) 4839 return true; 4840 4841 // Check the expression as an initializer for the parameter. 4842 InitializedEntity Entity 4843 = InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context, Param); 4844 InitializationKind Kind = InitializationKind::CreateCopy( 4845 Param->getLocation(), 4846 /*FIXME:EqualLoc*/ UninstExpr->getBeginLoc()); 4847 Expr *ResultE = Result.getAs<Expr>(); 4848 4849 InitializationSequence InitSeq(*this, Entity, Kind, ResultE); 4850 Result = InitSeq.Perform(*this, Entity, Kind, ResultE); 4851 if (Result.isInvalid()) 4852 return true; 4853 4854 Result = 4855 ActOnFinishFullExpr(Result.getAs<Expr>(), Param->getOuterLocStart(), 4856 /*DiscardedValue*/ false); 4857 if (Result.isInvalid()) 4858 return true; 4859 4860 // Remember the instantiated default argument. 4861 Param->setDefaultArg(Result.getAs<Expr>()); 4862 if (ASTMutationListener *L = getASTMutationListener()) { 4863 L->DefaultArgumentInstantiated(Param); 4864 } 4865 } 4866 4867 // If the default argument expression is not set yet, we are building it now. 4868 if (!Param->hasInit()) { 4869 Diag(Param->getBeginLoc(), diag::err_recursive_default_argument) << FD; 4870 Param->setInvalidDecl(); 4871 return true; 4872 } 4873 4874 // If the default expression creates temporaries, we need to 4875 // push them to the current stack of expression temporaries so they'll 4876 // be properly destroyed. 4877 // FIXME: We should really be rebuilding the default argument with new 4878 // bound temporaries; see the comment in PR5810. 4879 // We don't need to do that with block decls, though, because 4880 // blocks in default argument expression can never capture anything. 4881 if (auto Init = dyn_cast<ExprWithCleanups>(Param->getInit())) { 4882 // Set the "needs cleanups" bit regardless of whether there are 4883 // any explicit objects. 4884 Cleanup.setExprNeedsCleanups(Init->cleanupsHaveSideEffects()); 4885 4886 // Append all the objects to the cleanup list. Right now, this 4887 // should always be a no-op, because blocks in default argument 4888 // expressions should never be able to capture anything. 4889 assert(!Init->getNumObjects() && 4890 "default argument expression has capturing blocks?"); 4891 } 4892 4893 // We already type-checked the argument, so we know it works. 4894 // Just mark all of the declarations in this potentially-evaluated expression 4895 // as being "referenced". 4896 EnterExpressionEvaluationContext EvalContext( 4897 *this, ExpressionEvaluationContext::PotentiallyEvaluated, Param); 4898 MarkDeclarationsReferencedInExpr(Param->getDefaultArg(), 4899 /*SkipLocalVariables=*/true); 4900 return false; 4901 } 4902 4903 ExprResult Sema::BuildCXXDefaultArgExpr(SourceLocation CallLoc, 4904 FunctionDecl *FD, ParmVarDecl *Param) { 4905 if (CheckCXXDefaultArgExpr(CallLoc, FD, Param)) 4906 return ExprError(); 4907 return CXXDefaultArgExpr::Create(Context, CallLoc, Param, CurContext); 4908 } 4909 4910 Sema::VariadicCallType 4911 Sema::getVariadicCallType(FunctionDecl *FDecl, const FunctionProtoType *Proto, 4912 Expr *Fn) { 4913 if (Proto && Proto->isVariadic()) { 4914 if (dyn_cast_or_null<CXXConstructorDecl>(FDecl)) 4915 return VariadicConstructor; 4916 else if (Fn && Fn->getType()->isBlockPointerType()) 4917 return VariadicBlock; 4918 else if (FDecl) { 4919 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast_or_null<CXXMethodDecl>(FDecl)) 4920 if (Method->isInstance()) 4921 return VariadicMethod; 4922 } else if (Fn && Fn->getType() == Context.BoundMemberTy) 4923 return VariadicMethod; 4924 return VariadicFunction; 4925 } 4926 return VariadicDoesNotApply; 4927 } 4928 4929 namespace { 4930 class FunctionCallCCC final : public FunctionCallFilterCCC { 4931 public: 4932 FunctionCallCCC(Sema &SemaRef, const IdentifierInfo *FuncName, 4933 unsigned NumArgs, MemberExpr *ME) 4934 : FunctionCallFilterCCC(SemaRef, NumArgs, false, ME), 4935 FunctionName(FuncName) {} 4936 4937 bool ValidateCandidate(const TypoCorrection &candidate) override { 4938 if (!candidate.getCorrectionSpecifier() || 4939 candidate.getCorrectionAsIdentifierInfo() != FunctionName) { 4940 return false; 4941 } 4942 4943 return FunctionCallFilterCCC::ValidateCandidate(candidate); 4944 } 4945 4946 std::unique_ptr<CorrectionCandidateCallback> clone() override { 4947 return std::make_unique<FunctionCallCCC>(*this); 4948 } 4949 4950 private: 4951 const IdentifierInfo *const FunctionName; 4952 }; 4953 } 4954 4955 static TypoCorrection TryTypoCorrectionForCall(Sema &S, Expr *Fn, 4956 FunctionDecl *FDecl, 4957 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args) { 4958 MemberExpr *ME = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(Fn); 4959 DeclarationName FuncName = FDecl->getDeclName(); 4960 SourceLocation NameLoc = ME ? ME->getMemberLoc() : Fn->getBeginLoc(); 4961 4962 FunctionCallCCC CCC(S, FuncName.getAsIdentifierInfo(), Args.size(), ME); 4963 if (TypoCorrection Corrected = S.CorrectTypo( 4964 DeclarationNameInfo(FuncName, NameLoc), Sema::LookupOrdinaryName, 4965 S.getScopeForContext(S.CurContext), nullptr, CCC, 4966 Sema::CTK_ErrorRecovery)) { 4967 if (NamedDecl *ND = Corrected.getFoundDecl()) { 4968 if (Corrected.isOverloaded()) { 4969 OverloadCandidateSet OCS(NameLoc, OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Normal); 4970 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best; 4971 for (NamedDecl *CD : Corrected) { 4972 if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(CD)) 4973 S.AddOverloadCandidate(FD, DeclAccessPair::make(FD, AS_none), Args, 4974 OCS); 4975 } 4976 switch (OCS.BestViableFunction(S, NameLoc, Best)) { 4977 case OR_Success: 4978 ND = Best->FoundDecl; 4979 Corrected.setCorrectionDecl(ND); 4980 break; 4981 default: 4982 break; 4983 } 4984 } 4985 ND = ND->getUnderlyingDecl(); 4986 if (isa<ValueDecl>(ND) || isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(ND)) 4987 return Corrected; 4988 } 4989 } 4990 return TypoCorrection(); 4991 } 4992 4993 /// ConvertArgumentsForCall - Converts the arguments specified in 4994 /// Args/NumArgs to the parameter types of the function FDecl with 4995 /// function prototype Proto. Call is the call expression itself, and 4996 /// Fn is the function expression. For a C++ member function, this 4997 /// routine does not attempt to convert the object argument. Returns 4998 /// true if the call is ill-formed. 4999 bool 5000 Sema::ConvertArgumentsForCall(CallExpr *Call, Expr *Fn, 5001 FunctionDecl *FDecl, 5002 const FunctionProtoType *Proto, 5003 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, 5004 SourceLocation RParenLoc, 5005 bool IsExecConfig) { 5006 // Bail out early if calling a builtin with custom typechecking. 5007 if (FDecl) 5008 if (unsigned ID = FDecl->getBuiltinID()) 5009 if (Context.BuiltinInfo.hasCustomTypechecking(ID)) 5010 return false; 5011 5012 // C99 6.5.2.2p7 - the arguments are implicitly converted, as if by 5013 // assignment, to the types of the corresponding parameter, ... 5014 unsigned NumParams = Proto->getNumParams(); 5015 bool Invalid = false; 5016 unsigned MinArgs = FDecl ? FDecl->getMinRequiredArguments() : NumParams; 5017 unsigned FnKind = Fn->getType()->isBlockPointerType() 5018 ? 1 /* block */ 5019 : (IsExecConfig ? 3 /* kernel function (exec config) */ 5020 : 0 /* function */); 5021 5022 // If too few arguments are available (and we don't have default 5023 // arguments for the remaining parameters), don't make the call. 5024 if (Args.size() < NumParams) { 5025 if (Args.size() < MinArgs) { 5026 TypoCorrection TC; 5027 if (FDecl && (TC = TryTypoCorrectionForCall(*this, Fn, FDecl, Args))) { 5028 unsigned diag_id = 5029 MinArgs == NumParams && !Proto->isVariadic() 5030 ? diag::err_typecheck_call_too_few_args_suggest 5031 : diag::err_typecheck_call_too_few_args_at_least_suggest; 5032 diagnoseTypo(TC, PDiag(diag_id) << FnKind << MinArgs 5033 << static_cast<unsigned>(Args.size()) 5034 << TC.getCorrectionRange()); 5035 } else if (MinArgs == 1 && FDecl && FDecl->getParamDecl(0)->getDeclName()) 5036 Diag(RParenLoc, 5037 MinArgs == NumParams && !Proto->isVariadic() 5038 ? diag::err_typecheck_call_too_few_args_one 5039 : diag::err_typecheck_call_too_few_args_at_least_one) 5040 << FnKind << FDecl->getParamDecl(0) << Fn->getSourceRange(); 5041 else 5042 Diag(RParenLoc, MinArgs == NumParams && !Proto->isVariadic() 5043 ? diag::err_typecheck_call_too_few_args 5044 : diag::err_typecheck_call_too_few_args_at_least) 5045 << FnKind << MinArgs << static_cast<unsigned>(Args.size()) 5046 << Fn->getSourceRange(); 5047 5048 // Emit the location of the prototype. 5049 if (!TC && FDecl && !FDecl->getBuiltinID() && !IsExecConfig) 5050 Diag(FDecl->getBeginLoc(), diag::note_callee_decl) << FDecl; 5051 5052 return true; 5053 } 5054 // We reserve space for the default arguments when we create 5055 // the call expression, before calling ConvertArgumentsForCall. 5056 assert((Call->getNumArgs() == NumParams) && 5057 "We should have reserved space for the default arguments before!"); 5058 } 5059 5060 // If too many are passed and not variadic, error on the extras and drop 5061 // them. 5062 if (Args.size() > NumParams) { 5063 if (!Proto->isVariadic()) { 5064 TypoCorrection TC; 5065 if (FDecl && (TC = TryTypoCorrectionForCall(*this, Fn, FDecl, Args))) { 5066 unsigned diag_id = 5067 MinArgs == NumParams && !Proto->isVariadic() 5068 ? diag::err_typecheck_call_too_many_args_suggest 5069 : diag::err_typecheck_call_too_many_args_at_most_suggest; 5070 diagnoseTypo(TC, PDiag(diag_id) << FnKind << NumParams 5071 << static_cast<unsigned>(Args.size()) 5072 << TC.getCorrectionRange()); 5073 } else if (NumParams == 1 && FDecl && 5074 FDecl->getParamDecl(0)->getDeclName()) 5075 Diag(Args[NumParams]->getBeginLoc(), 5076 MinArgs == NumParams 5077 ? diag::err_typecheck_call_too_many_args_one 5078 : diag::err_typecheck_call_too_many_args_at_most_one) 5079 << FnKind << FDecl->getParamDecl(0) 5080 << static_cast<unsigned>(Args.size()) << Fn->getSourceRange() 5081 << SourceRange(Args[NumParams]->getBeginLoc(), 5082 Args.back()->getEndLoc()); 5083 else 5084 Diag(Args[NumParams]->getBeginLoc(), 5085 MinArgs == NumParams 5086 ? diag::err_typecheck_call_too_many_args 5087 : diag::err_typecheck_call_too_many_args_at_most) 5088 << FnKind << NumParams << static_cast<unsigned>(Args.size()) 5089 << Fn->getSourceRange() 5090 << SourceRange(Args[NumParams]->getBeginLoc(), 5091 Args.back()->getEndLoc()); 5092 5093 // Emit the location of the prototype. 5094 if (!TC && FDecl && !FDecl->getBuiltinID() && !IsExecConfig) 5095 Diag(FDecl->getBeginLoc(), diag::note_callee_decl) << FDecl; 5096 5097 // This deletes the extra arguments. 5098 Call->shrinkNumArgs(NumParams); 5099 return true; 5100 } 5101 } 5102 SmallVector<Expr *, 8> AllArgs; 5103 VariadicCallType CallType = getVariadicCallType(FDecl, Proto, Fn); 5104 5105 Invalid = GatherArgumentsForCall(Call->getBeginLoc(), FDecl, Proto, 0, Args, 5106 AllArgs, CallType); 5107 if (Invalid) 5108 return true; 5109 unsigned TotalNumArgs = AllArgs.size(); 5110 for (unsigned i = 0; i < TotalNumArgs; ++i) 5111 Call->setArg(i, AllArgs[i]); 5112 5113 return false; 5114 } 5115 5116 bool Sema::GatherArgumentsForCall(SourceLocation CallLoc, FunctionDecl *FDecl, 5117 const FunctionProtoType *Proto, 5118 unsigned FirstParam, ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, 5119 SmallVectorImpl<Expr *> &AllArgs, 5120 VariadicCallType CallType, bool AllowExplicit, 5121 bool IsListInitialization) { 5122 unsigned NumParams = Proto->getNumParams(); 5123 bool Invalid = false; 5124 size_t ArgIx = 0; 5125 // Continue to check argument types (even if we have too few/many args). 5126 for (unsigned i = FirstParam; i < NumParams; i++) { 5127 QualType ProtoArgType = Proto->getParamType(i); 5128 5129 Expr *Arg; 5130 ParmVarDecl *Param = FDecl ? FDecl->getParamDecl(i) : nullptr; 5131 if (ArgIx < Args.size()) { 5132 Arg = Args[ArgIx++]; 5133 5134 if (RequireCompleteType(Arg->getBeginLoc(), ProtoArgType, 5135 diag::err_call_incomplete_argument, Arg)) 5136 return true; 5137 5138 // Strip the unbridged-cast placeholder expression off, if applicable. 5139 bool CFAudited = false; 5140 if (Arg->getType() == Context.ARCUnbridgedCastTy && 5141 FDecl && FDecl->hasAttr<CFAuditedTransferAttr>() && 5142 (!Param || !Param->hasAttr<CFConsumedAttr>())) 5143 Arg = stripARCUnbridgedCast(Arg); 5144 else if (getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount && 5145 FDecl && FDecl->hasAttr<CFAuditedTransferAttr>() && 5146 (!Param || !Param->hasAttr<CFConsumedAttr>())) 5147 CFAudited = true; 5148 5149 if (Proto->getExtParameterInfo(i).isNoEscape()) 5150 if (auto *BE = dyn_cast<BlockExpr>(Arg->IgnoreParenNoopCasts(Context))) 5151 BE->getBlockDecl()->setDoesNotEscape(); 5152 5153 InitializedEntity Entity = 5154 Param ? InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context, Param, 5155 ProtoArgType) 5156 : InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter( 5157 Context, ProtoArgType, Proto->isParamConsumed(i)); 5158 5159 // Remember that parameter belongs to a CF audited API. 5160 if (CFAudited) 5161 Entity.setParameterCFAudited(); 5162 5163 ExprResult ArgE = PerformCopyInitialization( 5164 Entity, SourceLocation(), Arg, IsListInitialization, AllowExplicit); 5165 if (ArgE.isInvalid()) 5166 return true; 5167 5168 Arg = ArgE.getAs<Expr>(); 5169 } else { 5170 assert(Param && "can't use default arguments without a known callee"); 5171 5172 ExprResult ArgExpr = BuildCXXDefaultArgExpr(CallLoc, FDecl, Param); 5173 if (ArgExpr.isInvalid()) 5174 return true; 5175 5176 Arg = ArgExpr.getAs<Expr>(); 5177 } 5178 5179 // Check for array bounds violations for each argument to the call. This 5180 // check only triggers warnings when the argument isn't a more complex Expr 5181 // with its own checking, such as a BinaryOperator. 5182 CheckArrayAccess(Arg); 5183 5184 // Check for violations of C99 static array rules (C99 6.7.5.3p7). 5185 CheckStaticArrayArgument(CallLoc, Param, Arg); 5186 5187 AllArgs.push_back(Arg); 5188 } 5189 5190 // If this is a variadic call, handle args passed through "...". 5191 if (CallType != VariadicDoesNotApply) { 5192 // Assume that extern "C" functions with variadic arguments that 5193 // return __unknown_anytype aren't *really* variadic. 5194 if (Proto->getReturnType() == Context.UnknownAnyTy && FDecl && 5195 FDecl->isExternC()) { 5196 for (Expr *A : Args.slice(ArgIx)) { 5197 QualType paramType; // ignored 5198 ExprResult arg = checkUnknownAnyArg(CallLoc, A, paramType); 5199 Invalid |= arg.isInvalid(); 5200 AllArgs.push_back(arg.get()); 5201 } 5202 5203 // Otherwise do argument promotion, (C99 6.5.2.2p7). 5204 } else { 5205 for (Expr *A : Args.slice(ArgIx)) { 5206 ExprResult Arg = DefaultVariadicArgumentPromotion(A, CallType, FDecl); 5207 Invalid |= Arg.isInvalid(); 5208 AllArgs.push_back(Arg.get()); 5209 } 5210 } 5211 5212 // Check for array bounds violations. 5213 for (Expr *A : Args.slice(ArgIx)) 5214 CheckArrayAccess(A); 5215 } 5216 return Invalid; 5217 } 5218 5219 static void DiagnoseCalleeStaticArrayParam(Sema &S, ParmVarDecl *PVD) { 5220 TypeLoc TL = PVD->getTypeSourceInfo()->getTypeLoc(); 5221 if (DecayedTypeLoc DTL = TL.getAs<DecayedTypeLoc>()) 5222 TL = DTL.getOriginalLoc(); 5223 if (ArrayTypeLoc ATL = TL.getAs<ArrayTypeLoc>()) 5224 S.Diag(PVD->getLocation(), diag::note_callee_static_array) 5225 << ATL.getLocalSourceRange(); 5226 } 5227 5228 /// CheckStaticArrayArgument - If the given argument corresponds to a static 5229 /// array parameter, check that it is non-null, and that if it is formed by 5230 /// array-to-pointer decay, the underlying array is sufficiently large. 5231 /// 5232 /// C99 6.7.5.3p7: If the keyword static also appears within the [ and ] of the 5233 /// array type derivation, then for each call to the function, the value of the 5234 /// corresponding actual argument shall provide access to the first element of 5235 /// an array with at least as many elements as specified by the size expression. 5236 void 5237 Sema::CheckStaticArrayArgument(SourceLocation CallLoc, 5238 ParmVarDecl *Param, 5239 const Expr *ArgExpr) { 5240 // Static array parameters are not supported in C++. 5241 if (!Param || getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) 5242 return; 5243 5244 QualType OrigTy = Param->getOriginalType(); 5245 5246 const ArrayType *AT = Context.getAsArrayType(OrigTy); 5247 if (!AT || AT->getSizeModifier() != ArrayType::Static) 5248 return; 5249 5250 if (ArgExpr->isNullPointerConstant(Context, 5251 Expr::NPC_NeverValueDependent)) { 5252 Diag(CallLoc, diag::warn_null_arg) << ArgExpr->getSourceRange(); 5253 DiagnoseCalleeStaticArrayParam(*this, Param); 5254 return; 5255 } 5256 5257 const ConstantArrayType *CAT = dyn_cast<ConstantArrayType>(AT); 5258 if (!CAT) 5259 return; 5260 5261 const ConstantArrayType *ArgCAT = 5262 Context.getAsConstantArrayType(ArgExpr->IgnoreParenCasts()->getType()); 5263 if (!ArgCAT) 5264 return; 5265 5266 if (getASTContext().hasSameUnqualifiedType(CAT->getElementType(), 5267 ArgCAT->getElementType())) { 5268 if (ArgCAT->getSize().ult(CAT->getSize())) { 5269 Diag(CallLoc, diag::warn_static_array_too_small) 5270 << ArgExpr->getSourceRange() 5271 << (unsigned)ArgCAT->getSize().getZExtValue() 5272 << (unsigned)CAT->getSize().getZExtValue() << 0; 5273 DiagnoseCalleeStaticArrayParam(*this, Param); 5274 } 5275 return; 5276 } 5277 5278 Optional<CharUnits> ArgSize = 5279 getASTContext().getTypeSizeInCharsIfKnown(ArgCAT); 5280 Optional<CharUnits> ParmSize = getASTContext().getTypeSizeInCharsIfKnown(CAT); 5281 if (ArgSize && ParmSize && *ArgSize < *ParmSize) { 5282 Diag(CallLoc, diag::warn_static_array_too_small) 5283 << ArgExpr->getSourceRange() << (unsigned)ArgSize->getQuantity() 5284 << (unsigned)ParmSize->getQuantity() << 1; 5285 DiagnoseCalleeStaticArrayParam(*this, Param); 5286 } 5287 } 5288 5289 /// Given a function expression of unknown-any type, try to rebuild it 5290 /// to have a function type. 5291 static ExprResult rebuildUnknownAnyFunction(Sema &S, Expr *fn); 5292 5293 /// Is the given type a placeholder that we need to lower out 5294 /// immediately during argument processing? 5295 static bool isPlaceholderToRemoveAsArg(QualType type) { 5296 // Placeholders are never sugared. 5297 const BuiltinType *placeholder = dyn_cast<BuiltinType>(type); 5298 if (!placeholder) return false; 5299 5300 switch (placeholder->getKind()) { 5301 // Ignore all the non-placeholder types. 5302 #define IMAGE_TYPE(ImgType, Id, SingletonId, Access, Suffix) \ 5303 case BuiltinType::Id: 5304 #include "clang/Basic/OpenCLImageTypes.def" 5305 #define EXT_OPAQUE_TYPE(ExtType, Id, Ext) \ 5306 case BuiltinType::Id: 5307 #include "clang/Basic/OpenCLExtensionTypes.def" 5308 // In practice we'll never use this, since all SVE types are sugared 5309 // via TypedefTypes rather than exposed directly as BuiltinTypes. 5310 #define SVE_TYPE(Name, Id, SingletonId) \ 5311 case BuiltinType::Id: 5312 #include "clang/Basic/AArch64SVEACLETypes.def" 5313 #define PLACEHOLDER_TYPE(ID, SINGLETON_ID) 5314 #define BUILTIN_TYPE(ID, SINGLETON_ID) case BuiltinType::ID: 5315 #include "clang/AST/BuiltinTypes.def" 5316 return false; 5317 5318 // We cannot lower out overload sets; they might validly be resolved 5319 // by the call machinery. 5320 case BuiltinType::Overload: 5321 return false; 5322 5323 // Unbridged casts in ARC can be handled in some call positions and 5324 // should be left in place. 5325 case BuiltinType::ARCUnbridgedCast: 5326 return false; 5327 5328 // Pseudo-objects should be converted as soon as possible. 5329 case BuiltinType::PseudoObject: 5330 return true; 5331 5332 // The debugger mode could theoretically but currently does not try 5333 // to resolve unknown-typed arguments based on known parameter types. 5334 case BuiltinType::UnknownAny: 5335 return true; 5336 5337 // These are always invalid as call arguments and should be reported. 5338 case BuiltinType::BoundMember: 5339 case BuiltinType::BuiltinFn: 5340 case BuiltinType::OMPArraySection: 5341 return true; 5342 5343 } 5344 llvm_unreachable("bad builtin type kind"); 5345 } 5346 5347 /// Check an argument list for placeholders that we won't try to 5348 /// handle later. 5349 static bool checkArgsForPlaceholders(Sema &S, MultiExprArg args) { 5350 // Apply this processing to all the arguments at once instead of 5351 // dying at the first failure. 5352 bool hasInvalid = false; 5353 for (size_t i = 0, e = args.size(); i != e; i++) { 5354 if (isPlaceholderToRemoveAsArg(args[i]->getType())) { 5355 ExprResult result = S.CheckPlaceholderExpr(args[i]); 5356 if (result.isInvalid()) hasInvalid = true; 5357 else args[i] = result.get(); 5358 } else if (hasInvalid) { 5359 (void)S.CorrectDelayedTyposInExpr(args[i]); 5360 } 5361 } 5362 return hasInvalid; 5363 } 5364 5365 /// If a builtin function has a pointer argument with no explicit address 5366 /// space, then it should be able to accept a pointer to any address 5367 /// space as input. In order to do this, we need to replace the 5368 /// standard builtin declaration with one that uses the same address space 5369 /// as the call. 5370 /// 5371 /// \returns nullptr If this builtin is not a candidate for a rewrite i.e. 5372 /// it does not contain any pointer arguments without 5373 /// an address space qualifer. Otherwise the rewritten 5374 /// FunctionDecl is returned. 5375 /// TODO: Handle pointer return types. 5376 static FunctionDecl *rewriteBuiltinFunctionDecl(Sema *Sema, ASTContext &Context, 5377 FunctionDecl *FDecl, 5378 MultiExprArg ArgExprs) { 5379 5380 QualType DeclType = FDecl->getType(); 5381 const FunctionProtoType *FT = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(DeclType); 5382 5383 if (!Context.BuiltinInfo.hasPtrArgsOrResult(FDecl->getBuiltinID()) || !FT || 5384 ArgExprs.size() < FT->getNumParams()) 5385 return nullptr; 5386 5387 bool NeedsNewDecl = false; 5388 unsigned i = 0; 5389 SmallVector<QualType, 8> OverloadParams; 5390 5391 for (QualType ParamType : FT->param_types()) { 5392 5393 // Convert array arguments to pointer to simplify type lookup. 5394 ExprResult ArgRes = 5395 Sema->DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(ArgExprs[i++]); 5396 if (ArgRes.isInvalid()) 5397 return nullptr; 5398 Expr *Arg = ArgRes.get(); 5399 QualType ArgType = Arg->getType(); 5400 if (!ParamType->isPointerType() || 5401 ParamType.getQualifiers().hasAddressSpace() || 5402 !ArgType->isPointerType() || 5403 !ArgType->getPointeeType().getQualifiers().hasAddressSpace()) { 5404 OverloadParams.push_back(ParamType); 5405 continue; 5406 } 5407 5408 QualType PointeeType = ParamType->getPointeeType(); 5409 if (PointeeType.getQualifiers().hasAddressSpace()) 5410 continue; 5411 5412 NeedsNewDecl = true; 5413 LangAS AS = ArgType->getPointeeType().getAddressSpace(); 5414 5415 PointeeType = Context.getAddrSpaceQualType(PointeeType, AS); 5416 OverloadParams.push_back(Context.getPointerType(PointeeType)); 5417 } 5418 5419 if (!NeedsNewDecl) 5420 return nullptr; 5421 5422 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo EPI; 5423 EPI.Variadic = FT->isVariadic(); 5424 QualType OverloadTy = Context.getFunctionType(FT->getReturnType(), 5425 OverloadParams, EPI); 5426 DeclContext *Parent = FDecl->getParent(); 5427 FunctionDecl *OverloadDecl = FunctionDecl::Create(Context, Parent, 5428 FDecl->getLocation(), 5429 FDecl->getLocation(), 5430 FDecl->getIdentifier(), 5431 OverloadTy, 5432 /*TInfo=*/nullptr, 5433 SC_Extern, false, 5434 /*hasPrototype=*/true); 5435 SmallVector<ParmVarDecl*, 16> Params; 5436 FT = cast<FunctionProtoType>(OverloadTy); 5437 for (unsigned i = 0, e = FT->getNumParams(); i != e; ++i) { 5438 QualType ParamType = FT->getParamType(i); 5439 ParmVarDecl *Parm = 5440 ParmVarDecl::Create(Context, OverloadDecl, SourceLocation(), 5441 SourceLocation(), nullptr, ParamType, 5442 /*TInfo=*/nullptr, SC_None, nullptr); 5443 Parm->setScopeInfo(0, i); 5444 Params.push_back(Parm); 5445 } 5446 OverloadDecl->setParams(Params); 5447 return OverloadDecl; 5448 } 5449 5450 static void checkDirectCallValidity(Sema &S, const Expr *Fn, 5451 FunctionDecl *Callee, 5452 MultiExprArg ArgExprs) { 5453 // `Callee` (when called with ArgExprs) may be ill-formed. enable_if (and 5454 // similar attributes) really don't like it when functions are called with an 5455 // invalid number of args. 5456 if (S.TooManyArguments(Callee->getNumParams(), ArgExprs.size(), 5457 /*PartialOverloading=*/false) && 5458 !Callee->isVariadic()) 5459 return; 5460 if (Callee->getMinRequiredArguments() > ArgExprs.size()) 5461 return; 5462 5463 if (const EnableIfAttr *Attr = S.CheckEnableIf(Callee, ArgExprs, true)) { 5464 S.Diag(Fn->getBeginLoc(), 5465 isa<CXXMethodDecl>(Callee) 5466 ? diag::err_ovl_no_viable_member_function_in_call 5467 : diag::err_ovl_no_viable_function_in_call) 5468 << Callee << Callee->getSourceRange(); 5469 S.Diag(Callee->getLocation(), 5470 diag::note_ovl_candidate_disabled_by_function_cond_attr) 5471 << Attr->getCond()->getSourceRange() << Attr->getMessage(); 5472 return; 5473 } 5474 } 5475 5476 static bool enclosingClassIsRelatedToClassInWhichMembersWereFound( 5477 const UnresolvedMemberExpr *const UME, Sema &S) { 5478 5479 const auto GetFunctionLevelDCIfCXXClass = 5480 [](Sema &S) -> const CXXRecordDecl * { 5481 const DeclContext *const DC = S.getFunctionLevelDeclContext(); 5482 if (!DC || !DC->getParent()) 5483 return nullptr; 5484 5485 // If the call to some member function was made from within a member 5486 // function body 'M' return return 'M's parent. 5487 if (const auto *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(DC)) 5488 return MD->getParent()->getCanonicalDecl(); 5489 // else the call was made from within a default member initializer of a 5490 // class, so return the class. 5491 if (const auto *RD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(DC)) 5492 return RD->getCanonicalDecl(); 5493 return nullptr; 5494 }; 5495 // If our DeclContext is neither a member function nor a class (in the 5496 // case of a lambda in a default member initializer), we can't have an 5497 // enclosing 'this'. 5498 5499 const CXXRecordDecl *const CurParentClass = GetFunctionLevelDCIfCXXClass(S); 5500 if (!CurParentClass) 5501 return false; 5502 5503 // The naming class for implicit member functions call is the class in which 5504 // name lookup starts. 5505 const CXXRecordDecl *const NamingClass = 5506 UME->getNamingClass()->getCanonicalDecl(); 5507 assert(NamingClass && "Must have naming class even for implicit access"); 5508 5509 // If the unresolved member functions were found in a 'naming class' that is 5510 // related (either the same or derived from) to the class that contains the 5511 // member function that itself contained the implicit member access. 5512 5513 return CurParentClass == NamingClass || 5514 CurParentClass->isDerivedFrom(NamingClass); 5515 } 5516 5517 static void 5518 tryImplicitlyCaptureThisIfImplicitMemberFunctionAccessWithDependentArgs( 5519 Sema &S, const UnresolvedMemberExpr *const UME, SourceLocation CallLoc) { 5520 5521 if (!UME) 5522 return; 5523 5524 LambdaScopeInfo *const CurLSI = S.getCurLambda(); 5525 // Only try and implicitly capture 'this' within a C++ Lambda if it hasn't 5526 // already been captured, or if this is an implicit member function call (if 5527 // it isn't, an attempt to capture 'this' should already have been made). 5528 if (!CurLSI || CurLSI->ImpCaptureStyle == CurLSI->ImpCap_None || 5529 !UME->isImplicitAccess() || CurLSI->isCXXThisCaptured()) 5530 return; 5531 5532 // Check if the naming class in which the unresolved members were found is 5533 // related (same as or is a base of) to the enclosing class. 5534 5535 if (!enclosingClassIsRelatedToClassInWhichMembersWereFound(UME, S)) 5536 return; 5537 5538 5539 DeclContext *EnclosingFunctionCtx = S.CurContext->getParent()->getParent(); 5540 // If the enclosing function is not dependent, then this lambda is 5541 // capture ready, so if we can capture this, do so. 5542 if (!EnclosingFunctionCtx->isDependentContext()) { 5543 // If the current lambda and all enclosing lambdas can capture 'this' - 5544 // then go ahead and capture 'this' (since our unresolved overload set 5545 // contains at least one non-static member function). 5546 if (!S.CheckCXXThisCapture(CallLoc, /*Explcit*/ false, /*Diagnose*/ false)) 5547 S.CheckCXXThisCapture(CallLoc); 5548 } else if (S.CurContext->isDependentContext()) { 5549 // ... since this is an implicit member reference, that might potentially 5550 // involve a 'this' capture, mark 'this' for potential capture in 5551 // enclosing lambdas. 5552 if (CurLSI->ImpCaptureStyle != CurLSI->ImpCap_None) 5553 CurLSI->addPotentialThisCapture(CallLoc); 5554 } 5555 } 5556 5557 ExprResult Sema::ActOnCallExpr(Scope *Scope, Expr *Fn, SourceLocation LParenLoc, 5558 MultiExprArg ArgExprs, SourceLocation RParenLoc, 5559 Expr *ExecConfig) { 5560 ExprResult Call = 5561 BuildCallExpr(Scope, Fn, LParenLoc, ArgExprs, RParenLoc, ExecConfig); 5562 if (Call.isInvalid()) 5563 return Call; 5564 5565 // Diagnose uses of the C++20 "ADL-only template-id call" feature in earlier 5566 // language modes. 5567 if (auto *ULE = dyn_cast<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(Fn)) { 5568 if (ULE->hasExplicitTemplateArgs() && 5569 ULE->decls_begin() == ULE->decls_end()) { 5570 Diag(Fn->getExprLoc(), getLangOpts().CPlusPlus2a 5571 ? diag::warn_cxx17_compat_adl_only_template_id 5572 : diag::ext_adl_only_template_id) 5573 << ULE->getName(); 5574 } 5575 } 5576 5577 return Call; 5578 } 5579 5580 /// BuildCallExpr - Handle a call to Fn with the specified array of arguments. 5581 /// This provides the location of the left/right parens and a list of comma 5582 /// locations. 5583 ExprResult Sema::BuildCallExpr(Scope *Scope, Expr *Fn, SourceLocation LParenLoc, 5584 MultiExprArg ArgExprs, SourceLocation RParenLoc, 5585 Expr *ExecConfig, bool IsExecConfig) { 5586 // Since this might be a postfix expression, get rid of ParenListExprs. 5587 ExprResult Result = MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(Scope, Fn); 5588 if (Result.isInvalid()) return ExprError(); 5589 Fn = Result.get(); 5590 5591 if (checkArgsForPlaceholders(*this, ArgExprs)) 5592 return ExprError(); 5593 5594 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 5595 // If this is a pseudo-destructor expression, build the call immediately. 5596 if (isa<CXXPseudoDestructorExpr>(Fn)) { 5597 if (!ArgExprs.empty()) { 5598 // Pseudo-destructor calls should not have any arguments. 5599 Diag(Fn->getBeginLoc(), diag::err_pseudo_dtor_call_with_args) 5600 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval( 5601 SourceRange(ArgExprs.front()->getBeginLoc(), 5602 ArgExprs.back()->getEndLoc())); 5603 } 5604 5605 return CallExpr::Create(Context, Fn, /*Args=*/{}, Context.VoidTy, 5606 VK_RValue, RParenLoc); 5607 } 5608 if (Fn->getType() == Context.PseudoObjectTy) { 5609 ExprResult result = CheckPlaceholderExpr(Fn); 5610 if (result.isInvalid()) return ExprError(); 5611 Fn = result.get(); 5612 } 5613 5614 // Determine whether this is a dependent call inside a C++ template, 5615 // in which case we won't do any semantic analysis now. 5616 if (Fn->isTypeDependent() || Expr::hasAnyTypeDependentArguments(ArgExprs)) { 5617 if (ExecConfig) { 5618 return CUDAKernelCallExpr::Create( 5619 Context, Fn, cast<CallExpr>(ExecConfig), ArgExprs, 5620 Context.DependentTy, VK_RValue, RParenLoc); 5621 } else { 5622 5623 tryImplicitlyCaptureThisIfImplicitMemberFunctionAccessWithDependentArgs( 5624 *this, dyn_cast<UnresolvedMemberExpr>(Fn->IgnoreParens()), 5625 Fn->getBeginLoc()); 5626 5627 return CallExpr::Create(Context, Fn, ArgExprs, Context.DependentTy, 5628 VK_RValue, RParenLoc); 5629 } 5630 } 5631 5632 // Determine whether this is a call to an object (C++ [over.call.object]). 5633 if (Fn->getType()->isRecordType()) 5634 return BuildCallToObjectOfClassType(Scope, Fn, LParenLoc, ArgExprs, 5635 RParenLoc); 5636 5637 if (Fn->getType() == Context.UnknownAnyTy) { 5638 ExprResult result = rebuildUnknownAnyFunction(*this, Fn); 5639 if (result.isInvalid()) return ExprError(); 5640 Fn = result.get(); 5641 } 5642 5643 if (Fn->getType() == Context.BoundMemberTy) { 5644 return BuildCallToMemberFunction(Scope, Fn, LParenLoc, ArgExprs, 5645 RParenLoc); 5646 } 5647 } 5648 5649 // Check for overloaded calls. This can happen even in C due to extensions. 5650 if (Fn->getType() == Context.OverloadTy) { 5651 OverloadExpr::FindResult find = OverloadExpr::find(Fn); 5652 5653 // We aren't supposed to apply this logic if there's an '&' involved. 5654 if (!find.HasFormOfMemberPointer) { 5655 if (Expr::hasAnyTypeDependentArguments(ArgExprs)) 5656 return CallExpr::Create(Context, Fn, ArgExprs, Context.DependentTy, 5657 VK_RValue, RParenLoc); 5658 OverloadExpr *ovl = find.Expression; 5659 if (UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE = dyn_cast<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(ovl)) 5660 return BuildOverloadedCallExpr( 5661 Scope, Fn, ULE, LParenLoc, ArgExprs, RParenLoc, ExecConfig, 5662 /*AllowTypoCorrection=*/true, find.IsAddressOfOperand); 5663 return BuildCallToMemberFunction(Scope, Fn, LParenLoc, ArgExprs, 5664 RParenLoc); 5665 } 5666 } 5667 5668 // If we're directly calling a function, get the appropriate declaration. 5669 if (Fn->getType() == Context.UnknownAnyTy) { 5670 ExprResult result = rebuildUnknownAnyFunction(*this, Fn); 5671 if (result.isInvalid()) return ExprError(); 5672 Fn = result.get(); 5673 } 5674 5675 Expr *NakedFn = Fn->IgnoreParens(); 5676 5677 bool CallingNDeclIndirectly = false; 5678 NamedDecl *NDecl = nullptr; 5679 if (UnaryOperator *UnOp = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(NakedFn)) { 5680 if (UnOp->getOpcode() == UO_AddrOf) { 5681 CallingNDeclIndirectly = true; 5682 NakedFn = UnOp->getSubExpr()->IgnoreParens(); 5683 } 5684 } 5685 5686 if (auto *DRE = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(NakedFn)) { 5687 NDecl = DRE->getDecl(); 5688 5689 FunctionDecl *FDecl = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(NDecl); 5690 if (FDecl && FDecl->getBuiltinID()) { 5691 // Rewrite the function decl for this builtin by replacing parameters 5692 // with no explicit address space with the address space of the arguments 5693 // in ArgExprs. 5694 if ((FDecl = 5695 rewriteBuiltinFunctionDecl(this, Context, FDecl, ArgExprs))) { 5696 NDecl = FDecl; 5697 Fn = DeclRefExpr::Create( 5698 Context, FDecl->getQualifierLoc(), SourceLocation(), FDecl, false, 5699 SourceLocation(), FDecl->getType(), Fn->getValueKind(), FDecl, 5700 nullptr, DRE->isNonOdrUse()); 5701 } 5702 } 5703 } else if (isa<MemberExpr>(NakedFn)) 5704 NDecl = cast<MemberExpr>(NakedFn)->getMemberDecl(); 5705 5706 if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast_or_null<FunctionDecl>(NDecl)) { 5707 if (CallingNDeclIndirectly && !checkAddressOfFunctionIsAvailable( 5708 FD, /*Complain=*/true, Fn->getBeginLoc())) 5709 return ExprError(); 5710 5711 if (getLangOpts().OpenCL && checkOpenCLDisabledDecl(*FD, *Fn)) 5712 return ExprError(); 5713 5714 checkDirectCallValidity(*this, Fn, FD, ArgExprs); 5715 } 5716 5717 return BuildResolvedCallExpr(Fn, NDecl, LParenLoc, ArgExprs, RParenLoc, 5718 ExecConfig, IsExecConfig); 5719 } 5720 5721 /// ActOnAsTypeExpr - create a new asType (bitcast) from the arguments. 5722 /// 5723 /// __builtin_astype( value, dst type ) 5724 /// 5725 ExprResult Sema::ActOnAsTypeExpr(Expr *E, ParsedType ParsedDestTy, 5726 SourceLocation BuiltinLoc, 5727 SourceLocation RParenLoc) { 5728 ExprValueKind VK = VK_RValue; 5729 ExprObjectKind OK = OK_Ordinary; 5730 QualType DstTy = GetTypeFromParser(ParsedDestTy); 5731 QualType SrcTy = E->getType(); 5732 if (Context.getTypeSize(DstTy) != Context.getTypeSize(SrcTy)) 5733 return ExprError(Diag(BuiltinLoc, 5734 diag::err_invalid_astype_of_different_size) 5735 << DstTy 5736 << SrcTy 5737 << E->getSourceRange()); 5738 return new (Context) AsTypeExpr(E, DstTy, VK, OK, BuiltinLoc, RParenLoc); 5739 } 5740 5741 /// ActOnConvertVectorExpr - create a new convert-vector expression from the 5742 /// provided arguments. 5743 /// 5744 /// __builtin_convertvector( value, dst type ) 5745 /// 5746 ExprResult Sema::ActOnConvertVectorExpr(Expr *E, ParsedType ParsedDestTy, 5747 SourceLocation BuiltinLoc, 5748 SourceLocation RParenLoc) { 5749 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo; 5750 GetTypeFromParser(ParsedDestTy, &TInfo); 5751 return SemaConvertVectorExpr(E, TInfo, BuiltinLoc, RParenLoc); 5752 } 5753 5754 /// BuildResolvedCallExpr - Build a call to a resolved expression, 5755 /// i.e. an expression not of \p OverloadTy. The expression should 5756 /// unary-convert to an expression of function-pointer or 5757 /// block-pointer type. 5758 /// 5759 /// \param NDecl the declaration being called, if available 5760 ExprResult Sema::BuildResolvedCallExpr(Expr *Fn, NamedDecl *NDecl, 5761 SourceLocation LParenLoc, 5762 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, 5763 SourceLocation RParenLoc, Expr *Config, 5764 bool IsExecConfig, ADLCallKind UsesADL) { 5765 FunctionDecl *FDecl = dyn_cast_or_null<FunctionDecl>(NDecl); 5766 unsigned BuiltinID = (FDecl ? FDecl->getBuiltinID() : 0); 5767 5768 // Functions with 'interrupt' attribute cannot be called directly. 5769 if (FDecl && FDecl->hasAttr<AnyX86InterruptAttr>()) { 5770 Diag(Fn->getExprLoc(), diag::err_anyx86_interrupt_called); 5771 return ExprError(); 5772 } 5773 5774 // Interrupt handlers don't save off the VFP regs automatically on ARM, 5775 // so there's some risk when calling out to non-interrupt handler functions 5776 // that the callee might not preserve them. This is easy to diagnose here, 5777 // but can be very challenging to debug. 5778 if (auto *Caller = getCurFunctionDecl()) 5779 if (Caller->hasAttr<ARMInterruptAttr>()) { 5780 bool VFP = Context.getTargetInfo().hasFeature("vfp"); 5781 if (VFP && (!FDecl || !FDecl->hasAttr<ARMInterruptAttr>())) 5782 Diag(Fn->getExprLoc(), diag::warn_arm_interrupt_calling_convention); 5783 } 5784 5785 // Promote the function operand. 5786 // We special-case function promotion here because we only allow promoting 5787 // builtin functions to function pointers in the callee of a call. 5788 ExprResult Result; 5789 QualType ResultTy; 5790 if (BuiltinID && 5791 Fn->getType()->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::BuiltinFn)) { 5792 // Extract the return type from the (builtin) function pointer type. 5793 // FIXME Several builtins still have setType in 5794 // Sema::CheckBuiltinFunctionCall. One should review their definitions in 5795 // Builtins.def to ensure they are correct before removing setType calls. 5796 QualType FnPtrTy = Context.getPointerType(FDecl->getType()); 5797 Result = ImpCastExprToType(Fn, FnPtrTy, CK_BuiltinFnToFnPtr).get(); 5798 ResultTy = FDecl->getCallResultType(); 5799 } else { 5800 Result = CallExprUnaryConversions(Fn); 5801 ResultTy = Context.BoolTy; 5802 } 5803 if (Result.isInvalid()) 5804 return ExprError(); 5805 Fn = Result.get(); 5806 5807 // Check for a valid function type, but only if it is not a builtin which 5808 // requires custom type checking. These will be handled by 5809 // CheckBuiltinFunctionCall below just after creation of the call expression. 5810 const FunctionType *FuncT = nullptr; 5811 if (!BuiltinID || !Context.BuiltinInfo.hasCustomTypechecking(BuiltinID)) { 5812 retry: 5813 if (const PointerType *PT = Fn->getType()->getAs<PointerType>()) { 5814 // C99 6.5.2.2p1 - "The expression that denotes the called function shall 5815 // have type pointer to function". 5816 FuncT = PT->getPointeeType()->getAs<FunctionType>(); 5817 if (!FuncT) 5818 return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_typecheck_call_not_function) 5819 << Fn->getType() << Fn->getSourceRange()); 5820 } else if (const BlockPointerType *BPT = 5821 Fn->getType()->getAs<BlockPointerType>()) { 5822 FuncT = BPT->getPointeeType()->castAs<FunctionType>(); 5823 } else { 5824 // Handle calls to expressions of unknown-any type. 5825 if (Fn->getType() == Context.UnknownAnyTy) { 5826 ExprResult rewrite = rebuildUnknownAnyFunction(*this, Fn); 5827 if (rewrite.isInvalid()) 5828 return ExprError(); 5829 Fn = rewrite.get(); 5830 goto retry; 5831 } 5832 5833 return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_typecheck_call_not_function) 5834 << Fn->getType() << Fn->getSourceRange()); 5835 } 5836 } 5837 5838 // Get the number of parameters in the function prototype, if any. 5839 // We will allocate space for max(Args.size(), NumParams) arguments 5840 // in the call expression. 5841 const auto *Proto = dyn_cast_or_null<FunctionProtoType>(FuncT); 5842 unsigned NumParams = Proto ? Proto->getNumParams() : 0; 5843 5844 CallExpr *TheCall; 5845 if (Config) { 5846 assert(UsesADL == ADLCallKind::NotADL && 5847 "CUDAKernelCallExpr should not use ADL"); 5848 TheCall = 5849 CUDAKernelCallExpr::Create(Context, Fn, cast<CallExpr>(Config), Args, 5850 ResultTy, VK_RValue, RParenLoc, NumParams); 5851 } else { 5852 TheCall = CallExpr::Create(Context, Fn, Args, ResultTy, VK_RValue, 5853 RParenLoc, NumParams, UsesADL); 5854 } 5855 5856 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 5857 // Forget about the nulled arguments since typo correction 5858 // do not handle them well. 5859 TheCall->shrinkNumArgs(Args.size()); 5860 // C cannot always handle TypoExpr nodes in builtin calls and direct 5861 // function calls as their argument checking don't necessarily handle 5862 // dependent types properly, so make sure any TypoExprs have been 5863 // dealt with. 5864 ExprResult Result = CorrectDelayedTyposInExpr(TheCall); 5865 if (!Result.isUsable()) return ExprError(); 5866 CallExpr *TheOldCall = TheCall; 5867 TheCall = dyn_cast<CallExpr>(Result.get()); 5868 bool CorrectedTypos = TheCall != TheOldCall; 5869 if (!TheCall) return Result; 5870 Args = llvm::makeArrayRef(TheCall->getArgs(), TheCall->getNumArgs()); 5871 5872 // A new call expression node was created if some typos were corrected. 5873 // However it may not have been constructed with enough storage. In this 5874 // case, rebuild the node with enough storage. The waste of space is 5875 // immaterial since this only happens when some typos were corrected. 5876 if (CorrectedTypos && Args.size() < NumParams) { 5877 if (Config) 5878 TheCall = CUDAKernelCallExpr::Create( 5879 Context, Fn, cast<CallExpr>(Config), Args, ResultTy, VK_RValue, 5880 RParenLoc, NumParams); 5881 else 5882 TheCall = CallExpr::Create(Context, Fn, Args, ResultTy, VK_RValue, 5883 RParenLoc, NumParams, UsesADL); 5884 } 5885 // We can now handle the nulled arguments for the default arguments. 5886 TheCall->setNumArgsUnsafe(std::max<unsigned>(Args.size(), NumParams)); 5887 } 5888 5889 // Bail out early if calling a builtin with custom type checking. 5890 if (BuiltinID && Context.BuiltinInfo.hasCustomTypechecking(BuiltinID)) 5891 return CheckBuiltinFunctionCall(FDecl, BuiltinID, TheCall); 5892 5893 if (getLangOpts().CUDA) { 5894 if (Config) { 5895 // CUDA: Kernel calls must be to global functions 5896 if (FDecl && !FDecl->hasAttr<CUDAGlobalAttr>()) 5897 return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc,diag::err_kern_call_not_global_function) 5898 << FDecl << Fn->getSourceRange()); 5899 5900 // CUDA: Kernel function must have 'void' return type 5901 if (!FuncT->getReturnType()->isVoidType()) 5902 return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_kern_type_not_void_return) 5903 << Fn->getType() << Fn->getSourceRange()); 5904 } else { 5905 // CUDA: Calls to global functions must be configured 5906 if (FDecl && FDecl->hasAttr<CUDAGlobalAttr>()) 5907 return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_global_call_not_config) 5908 << FDecl << Fn->getSourceRange()); 5909 } 5910 } 5911 5912 // Check for a valid return type 5913 if (CheckCallReturnType(FuncT->getReturnType(), Fn->getBeginLoc(), TheCall, 5914 FDecl)) 5915 return ExprError(); 5916 5917 // We know the result type of the call, set it. 5918 TheCall->setType(FuncT->getCallResultType(Context)); 5919 TheCall->setValueKind(Expr::getValueKindForType(FuncT->getReturnType())); 5920 5921 if (Proto) { 5922 if (ConvertArgumentsForCall(TheCall, Fn, FDecl, Proto, Args, RParenLoc, 5923 IsExecConfig)) 5924 return ExprError(); 5925 } else { 5926 assert(isa<FunctionNoProtoType>(FuncT) && "Unknown FunctionType!"); 5927 5928 if (FDecl) { 5929 // Check if we have too few/too many template arguments, based 5930 // on our knowledge of the function definition. 5931 const FunctionDecl *Def = nullptr; 5932 if (FDecl->hasBody(Def) && Args.size() != Def->param_size()) { 5933 Proto = Def->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>(); 5934 if (!Proto || !(Proto->isVariadic() && Args.size() >= Def->param_size())) 5935 Diag(RParenLoc, diag::warn_call_wrong_number_of_arguments) 5936 << (Args.size() > Def->param_size()) << FDecl << Fn->getSourceRange(); 5937 } 5938 5939 // If the function we're calling isn't a function prototype, but we have 5940 // a function prototype from a prior declaratiom, use that prototype. 5941 if (!FDecl->hasPrototype()) 5942 Proto = FDecl->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>(); 5943 } 5944 5945 // Promote the arguments (C99 6.5.2.2p6). 5946 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Args.size(); i != e; i++) { 5947 Expr *Arg = Args[i]; 5948 5949 if (Proto && i < Proto->getNumParams()) { 5950 InitializedEntity Entity = InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter( 5951 Context, Proto->getParamType(i), Proto->isParamConsumed(i)); 5952 ExprResult ArgE = 5953 PerformCopyInitialization(Entity, SourceLocation(), Arg); 5954 if (ArgE.isInvalid()) 5955 return true; 5956 5957 Arg = ArgE.getAs<Expr>(); 5958 5959 } else { 5960 ExprResult ArgE = DefaultArgumentPromotion(Arg); 5961 5962 if (ArgE.isInvalid()) 5963 return true; 5964 5965 Arg = ArgE.getAs<Expr>(); 5966 } 5967 5968 if (RequireCompleteType(Arg->getBeginLoc(), Arg->getType(), 5969 diag::err_call_incomplete_argument, Arg)) 5970 return ExprError(); 5971 5972 TheCall->setArg(i, Arg); 5973 } 5974 } 5975 5976 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast_or_null<CXXMethodDecl>(FDecl)) 5977 if (!Method->isStatic()) 5978 return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_member_call_without_object) 5979 << Fn->getSourceRange()); 5980 5981 // Check for sentinels 5982 if (NDecl) 5983 DiagnoseSentinelCalls(NDecl, LParenLoc, Args); 5984 5985 // Do special checking on direct calls to functions. 5986 if (FDecl) { 5987 if (CheckFunctionCall(FDecl, TheCall, Proto)) 5988 return ExprError(); 5989 5990 checkFortifiedBuiltinMemoryFunction(FDecl, TheCall); 5991 5992 if (BuiltinID) 5993 return CheckBuiltinFunctionCall(FDecl, BuiltinID, TheCall); 5994 } else if (NDecl) { 5995 if (CheckPointerCall(NDecl, TheCall, Proto)) 5996 return ExprError(); 5997 } else { 5998 if (CheckOtherCall(TheCall, Proto)) 5999 return ExprError(); 6000 } 6001 6002 return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall); 6003 } 6004 6005 ExprResult 6006 Sema::ActOnCompoundLiteral(SourceLocation LParenLoc, ParsedType Ty, 6007 SourceLocation RParenLoc, Expr *InitExpr) { 6008 assert(Ty && "ActOnCompoundLiteral(): missing type"); 6009 assert(InitExpr && "ActOnCompoundLiteral(): missing expression"); 6010 6011 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo; 6012 QualType literalType = GetTypeFromParser(Ty, &TInfo); 6013 if (!TInfo) 6014 TInfo = Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(literalType); 6015 6016 return BuildCompoundLiteralExpr(LParenLoc, TInfo, RParenLoc, InitExpr); 6017 } 6018 6019 ExprResult 6020 Sema::BuildCompoundLiteralExpr(SourceLocation LParenLoc, TypeSourceInfo *TInfo, 6021 SourceLocation RParenLoc, Expr *LiteralExpr) { 6022 QualType literalType = TInfo->getType(); 6023 6024 if (literalType->isArrayType()) { 6025 if (RequireCompleteType(LParenLoc, Context.getBaseElementType(literalType), 6026 diag::err_illegal_decl_array_incomplete_type, 6027 SourceRange(LParenLoc, 6028 LiteralExpr->getSourceRange().getEnd()))) 6029 return ExprError(); 6030 if (literalType->isVariableArrayType()) 6031 return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_variable_object_no_init) 6032 << SourceRange(LParenLoc, LiteralExpr->getSourceRange().getEnd())); 6033 } else if (!literalType->isDependentType() && 6034 RequireCompleteType(LParenLoc, literalType, 6035 diag::err_typecheck_decl_incomplete_type, 6036 SourceRange(LParenLoc, LiteralExpr->getSourceRange().getEnd()))) 6037 return ExprError(); 6038 6039 InitializedEntity Entity 6040 = InitializedEntity::InitializeCompoundLiteralInit(TInfo); 6041 InitializationKind Kind 6042 = InitializationKind::CreateCStyleCast(LParenLoc, 6043 SourceRange(LParenLoc, RParenLoc), 6044 /*InitList=*/true); 6045 InitializationSequence InitSeq(*this, Entity, Kind, LiteralExpr); 6046 ExprResult Result = InitSeq.Perform(*this, Entity, Kind, LiteralExpr, 6047 &literalType); 6048 if (Result.isInvalid()) 6049 return ExprError(); 6050 LiteralExpr = Result.get(); 6051 6052 bool isFileScope = !CurContext->isFunctionOrMethod(); 6053 6054 // In C, compound literals are l-values for some reason. 6055 // For GCC compatibility, in C++, file-scope array compound literals with 6056 // constant initializers are also l-values, and compound literals are 6057 // otherwise prvalues. 6058 // 6059 // (GCC also treats C++ list-initialized file-scope array prvalues with 6060 // constant initializers as l-values, but that's non-conforming, so we don't 6061 // follow it there.) 6062 // 6063 // FIXME: It would be better to handle the lvalue cases as materializing and 6064 // lifetime-extending a temporary object, but our materialized temporaries 6065 // representation only supports lifetime extension from a variable, not "out 6066 // of thin air". 6067 // FIXME: For C++, we might want to instead lifetime-extend only if a pointer 6068 // is bound to the result of applying array-to-pointer decay to the compound 6069 // literal. 6070 // FIXME: GCC supports compound literals of reference type, which should 6071 // obviously have a value kind derived from the kind of reference involved. 6072 ExprValueKind VK = 6073 (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && !(isFileScope && literalType->isArrayType())) 6074 ? VK_RValue 6075 : VK_LValue; 6076 6077 if (isFileScope) 6078 if (auto ILE = dyn_cast<InitListExpr>(LiteralExpr)) 6079 for (unsigned i = 0, j = ILE->getNumInits(); i != j; i++) { 6080 Expr *Init = ILE->getInit(i); 6081 ILE->setInit(i, ConstantExpr::Create(Context, Init)); 6082 } 6083 6084 Expr *E = new (Context) CompoundLiteralExpr(LParenLoc, TInfo, literalType, 6085 VK, LiteralExpr, isFileScope); 6086 if (isFileScope) { 6087 if (!LiteralExpr->isTypeDependent() && 6088 !LiteralExpr->isValueDependent() && 6089 !literalType->isDependentType()) // C99 6.5.2.5p3 6090 if (CheckForConstantInitializer(LiteralExpr, literalType)) 6091 return ExprError(); 6092 } else if (literalType.getAddressSpace() != LangAS::opencl_private && 6093 literalType.getAddressSpace() != LangAS::Default) { 6094 // Embedded-C extensions to C99 6.5.2.5: 6095 // "If the compound literal occurs inside the body of a function, the 6096 // type name shall not be qualified by an address-space qualifier." 6097 Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_compound_literal_with_address_space) 6098 << SourceRange(LParenLoc, LiteralExpr->getSourceRange().getEnd()); 6099 return ExprError(); 6100 } 6101 6102 return MaybeBindToTemporary(E); 6103 } 6104 6105 ExprResult 6106 Sema::ActOnInitList(SourceLocation LBraceLoc, MultiExprArg InitArgList, 6107 SourceLocation RBraceLoc) { 6108 // Immediately handle non-overload placeholders. Overloads can be 6109 // resolved contextually, but everything else here can't. 6110 for (unsigned I = 0, E = InitArgList.size(); I != E; ++I) { 6111 if (InitArgList[I]->getType()->isNonOverloadPlaceholderType()) { 6112 ExprResult result = CheckPlaceholderExpr(InitArgList[I]); 6113 6114 // Ignore failures; dropping the entire initializer list because 6115 // of one failure would be terrible for indexing/etc. 6116 if (result.isInvalid()) continue; 6117 6118 InitArgList[I] = result.get(); 6119 } 6120 } 6121 6122 // Semantic analysis for initializers is done by ActOnDeclarator() and 6123 // CheckInitializer() - it requires knowledge of the object being initialized. 6124 6125 InitListExpr *E = new (Context) InitListExpr(Context, LBraceLoc, InitArgList, 6126 RBraceLoc); 6127 E->setType(Context.VoidTy); // FIXME: just a place holder for now. 6128 return E; 6129 } 6130 6131 /// Do an explicit extend of the given block pointer if we're in ARC. 6132 void Sema::maybeExtendBlockObject(ExprResult &E) { 6133 assert(E.get()->getType()->isBlockPointerType()); 6134 assert(E.get()->isRValue()); 6135 6136 // Only do this in an r-value context. 6137 if (!getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount) return; 6138 6139 E = ImplicitCastExpr::Create(Context, E.get()->getType(), 6140 CK_ARCExtendBlockObject, E.get(), 6141 /*base path*/ nullptr, VK_RValue); 6142 Cleanup.setExprNeedsCleanups(true); 6143 } 6144 6145 /// Prepare a conversion of the given expression to an ObjC object 6146 /// pointer type. 6147 CastKind Sema::PrepareCastToObjCObjectPointer(ExprResult &E) { 6148 QualType type = E.get()->getType(); 6149 if (type->isObjCObjectPointerType()) { 6150 return CK_BitCast; 6151 } else if (type->isBlockPointerType()) { 6152 maybeExtendBlockObject(E); 6153 return CK_BlockPointerToObjCPointerCast; 6154 } else { 6155 assert(type->isPointerType()); 6156 return CK_CPointerToObjCPointerCast; 6157 } 6158 } 6159 6160 /// Prepares for a scalar cast, performing all the necessary stages 6161 /// except the final cast and returning the kind required. 6162 CastKind Sema::PrepareScalarCast(ExprResult &Src, QualType DestTy) { 6163 // Both Src and Dest are scalar types, i.e. arithmetic or pointer. 6164 // Also, callers should have filtered out the invalid cases with 6165 // pointers. Everything else should be possible. 6166 6167 QualType SrcTy = Src.get()->getType(); 6168 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(SrcTy, DestTy)) 6169 return CK_NoOp; 6170 6171 switch (Type::ScalarTypeKind SrcKind = SrcTy->getScalarTypeKind()) { 6172 case Type::STK_MemberPointer: 6173 llvm_unreachable("member pointer type in C"); 6174 6175 case Type::STK_CPointer: 6176 case Type::STK_BlockPointer: 6177 case Type::STK_ObjCObjectPointer: 6178 switch (DestTy->getScalarTypeKind()) { 6179 case Type::STK_CPointer: { 6180 LangAS SrcAS = SrcTy->getPointeeType().getAddressSpace(); 6181 LangAS DestAS = DestTy->getPointeeType().getAddressSpace(); 6182 if (SrcAS != DestAS) 6183 return CK_AddressSpaceConversion; 6184 if (Context.hasCvrSimilarType(SrcTy, DestTy)) 6185 return CK_NoOp; 6186 return CK_BitCast; 6187 } 6188 case Type::STK_BlockPointer: 6189 return (SrcKind == Type::STK_BlockPointer 6190 ? CK_BitCast : CK_AnyPointerToBlockPointerCast); 6191 case Type::STK_ObjCObjectPointer: 6192 if (SrcKind == Type::STK_ObjCObjectPointer) 6193 return CK_BitCast; 6194 if (SrcKind == Type::STK_CPointer) 6195 return CK_CPointerToObjCPointerCast; 6196 maybeExtendBlockObject(Src); 6197 return CK_BlockPointerToObjCPointerCast; 6198 case Type::STK_Bool: 6199 return CK_PointerToBoolean; 6200 case Type::STK_Integral: 6201 return CK_PointerToIntegral; 6202 case Type::STK_Floating: 6203 case Type::STK_FloatingComplex: 6204 case Type::STK_IntegralComplex: 6205 case Type::STK_MemberPointer: 6206 case Type::STK_FixedPoint: 6207 llvm_unreachable("illegal cast from pointer"); 6208 } 6209 llvm_unreachable("Should have returned before this"); 6210 6211 case Type::STK_FixedPoint: 6212 switch (DestTy->getScalarTypeKind()) { 6213 case Type::STK_FixedPoint: 6214 return CK_FixedPointCast; 6215 case Type::STK_Bool: 6216 return CK_FixedPointToBoolean; 6217 case Type::STK_Integral: 6218 return CK_FixedPointToIntegral; 6219 case Type::STK_Floating: 6220 case Type::STK_IntegralComplex: 6221 case Type::STK_FloatingComplex: 6222 Diag(Src.get()->getExprLoc(), 6223 diag::err_unimplemented_conversion_with_fixed_point_type) 6224 << DestTy; 6225 return CK_IntegralCast; 6226 case Type::STK_CPointer: 6227 case Type::STK_ObjCObjectPointer: 6228 case Type::STK_BlockPointer: 6229 case Type::STK_MemberPointer: 6230 llvm_unreachable("illegal cast to pointer type"); 6231 } 6232 llvm_unreachable("Should have returned before this"); 6233 6234 case Type::STK_Bool: // casting from bool is like casting from an integer 6235 case Type::STK_Integral: 6236 switch (DestTy->getScalarTypeKind()) { 6237 case Type::STK_CPointer: 6238 case Type::STK_ObjCObjectPointer: 6239 case Type::STK_BlockPointer: 6240 if (Src.get()->isNullPointerConstant(Context, 6241 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) 6242 return CK_NullToPointer; 6243 return CK_IntegralToPointer; 6244 case Type::STK_Bool: 6245 return CK_IntegralToBoolean; 6246 case Type::STK_Integral: 6247 return CK_IntegralCast; 6248 case Type::STK_Floating: 6249 return CK_IntegralToFloating; 6250 case Type::STK_IntegralComplex: 6251 Src = ImpCastExprToType(Src.get(), 6252 DestTy->castAs<ComplexType>()->getElementType(), 6253 CK_IntegralCast); 6254 return CK_IntegralRealToComplex; 6255 case Type::STK_FloatingComplex: 6256 Src = ImpCastExprToType(Src.get(), 6257 DestTy->castAs<ComplexType>()->getElementType(), 6258 CK_IntegralToFloating); 6259 return CK_FloatingRealToComplex; 6260 case Type::STK_MemberPointer: 6261 llvm_unreachable("member pointer type in C"); 6262 case Type::STK_FixedPoint: 6263 return CK_IntegralToFixedPoint; 6264 } 6265 llvm_unreachable("Should have returned before this"); 6266 6267 case Type::STK_Floating: 6268 switch (DestTy->getScalarTypeKind()) { 6269 case Type::STK_Floating: 6270 return CK_FloatingCast; 6271 case Type::STK_Bool: 6272 return CK_FloatingToBoolean; 6273 case Type::STK_Integral: 6274 return CK_FloatingToIntegral; 6275 case Type::STK_FloatingComplex: 6276 Src = ImpCastExprToType(Src.get(), 6277 DestTy->castAs<ComplexType>()->getElementType(), 6278 CK_FloatingCast); 6279 return CK_FloatingRealToComplex; 6280 case Type::STK_IntegralComplex: 6281 Src = ImpCastExprToType(Src.get(), 6282 DestTy->castAs<ComplexType>()->getElementType(), 6283 CK_FloatingToIntegral); 6284 return CK_IntegralRealToComplex; 6285 case Type::STK_CPointer: 6286 case Type::STK_ObjCObjectPointer: 6287 case Type::STK_BlockPointer: 6288 llvm_unreachable("valid float->pointer cast?"); 6289 case Type::STK_MemberPointer: 6290 llvm_unreachable("member pointer type in C"); 6291 case Type::STK_FixedPoint: 6292 Diag(Src.get()->getExprLoc(), 6293 diag::err_unimplemented_conversion_with_fixed_point_type) 6294 << SrcTy; 6295 return CK_IntegralCast; 6296 } 6297 llvm_unreachable("Should have returned before this"); 6298 6299 case Type::STK_FloatingComplex: 6300 switch (DestTy->getScalarTypeKind()) { 6301 case Type::STK_FloatingComplex: 6302 return CK_FloatingComplexCast; 6303 case Type::STK_IntegralComplex: 6304 return CK_FloatingComplexToIntegralComplex; 6305 case Type::STK_Floating: { 6306 QualType ET = SrcTy->castAs<ComplexType>()->getElementType(); 6307 if (Context.hasSameType(ET, DestTy)) 6308 return CK_FloatingComplexToReal; 6309 Src = ImpCastExprToType(Src.get(), ET, CK_FloatingComplexToReal); 6310 return CK_FloatingCast; 6311 } 6312 case Type::STK_Bool: 6313 return CK_FloatingComplexToBoolean; 6314 case Type::STK_Integral: 6315 Src = ImpCastExprToType(Src.get(), 6316 SrcTy->castAs<ComplexType>()->getElementType(), 6317 CK_FloatingComplexToReal); 6318 return CK_FloatingToIntegral; 6319 case Type::STK_CPointer: 6320 case Type::STK_ObjCObjectPointer: 6321 case Type::STK_BlockPointer: 6322 llvm_unreachable("valid complex float->pointer cast?"); 6323 case Type::STK_MemberPointer: 6324 llvm_unreachable("member pointer type in C"); 6325 case Type::STK_FixedPoint: 6326 Diag(Src.get()->getExprLoc(), 6327 diag::err_unimplemented_conversion_with_fixed_point_type) 6328 << SrcTy; 6329 return CK_IntegralCast; 6330 } 6331 llvm_unreachable("Should have returned before this"); 6332 6333 case Type::STK_IntegralComplex: 6334 switch (DestTy->getScalarTypeKind()) { 6335 case Type::STK_FloatingComplex: 6336 return CK_IntegralComplexToFloatingComplex; 6337 case Type::STK_IntegralComplex: 6338 return CK_IntegralComplexCast; 6339 case Type::STK_Integral: { 6340 QualType ET = SrcTy->castAs<ComplexType>()->getElementType(); 6341 if (Context.hasSameType(ET, DestTy)) 6342 return CK_IntegralComplexToReal; 6343 Src = ImpCastExprToType(Src.get(), ET, CK_IntegralComplexToReal); 6344 return CK_IntegralCast; 6345 } 6346 case Type::STK_Bool: 6347 return CK_IntegralComplexToBoolean; 6348 case Type::STK_Floating: 6349 Src = ImpCastExprToType(Src.get(), 6350 SrcTy->castAs<ComplexType>()->getElementType(), 6351 CK_IntegralComplexToReal); 6352 return CK_IntegralToFloating; 6353 case Type::STK_CPointer: 6354 case Type::STK_ObjCObjectPointer: 6355 case Type::STK_BlockPointer: 6356 llvm_unreachable("valid complex int->pointer cast?"); 6357 case Type::STK_MemberPointer: 6358 llvm_unreachable("member pointer type in C"); 6359 case Type::STK_FixedPoint: 6360 Diag(Src.get()->getExprLoc(), 6361 diag::err_unimplemented_conversion_with_fixed_point_type) 6362 << SrcTy; 6363 return CK_IntegralCast; 6364 } 6365 llvm_unreachable("Should have returned before this"); 6366 } 6367 6368 llvm_unreachable("Unhandled scalar cast"); 6369 } 6370 6371 static bool breakDownVectorType(QualType type, uint64_t &len, 6372 QualType &eltType) { 6373 // Vectors are simple. 6374 if (const VectorType *vecType = type->getAs<VectorType>()) { 6375 len = vecType->getNumElements(); 6376 eltType = vecType->getElementType(); 6377 assert(eltType->isScalarType()); 6378 return true; 6379 } 6380 6381 // We allow lax conversion to and from non-vector types, but only if 6382 // they're real types (i.e. non-complex, non-pointer scalar types). 6383 if (!type->isRealType()) return false; 6384 6385 len = 1; 6386 eltType = type; 6387 return true; 6388 } 6389 6390 /// Are the two types lax-compatible vector types? That is, given 6391 /// that one of them is a vector, do they have equal storage sizes, 6392 /// where the storage size is the number of elements times the element 6393 /// size? 6394 /// 6395 /// This will also return false if either of the types is neither a 6396 /// vector nor a real type. 6397 bool Sema::areLaxCompatibleVectorTypes(QualType srcTy, QualType destTy) { 6398 assert(destTy->isVectorType() || srcTy->isVectorType()); 6399 6400 // Disallow lax conversions between scalars and ExtVectors (these 6401 // conversions are allowed for other vector types because common headers 6402 // depend on them). Most scalar OP ExtVector cases are handled by the 6403 // splat path anyway, which does what we want (convert, not bitcast). 6404 // What this rules out for ExtVectors is crazy things like char4*float. 6405 if (srcTy->isScalarType() && destTy->isExtVectorType()) return false; 6406 if (destTy->isScalarType() && srcTy->isExtVectorType()) return false; 6407 6408 uint64_t srcLen, destLen; 6409 QualType srcEltTy, destEltTy; 6410 if (!breakDownVectorType(srcTy, srcLen, srcEltTy)) return false; 6411 if (!breakDownVectorType(destTy, destLen, destEltTy)) return false; 6412 6413 // ASTContext::getTypeSize will return the size rounded up to a 6414 // power of 2, so instead of using that, we need to use the raw 6415 // element size multiplied by the element count. 6416 uint64_t srcEltSize = Context.getTypeSize(srcEltTy); 6417 uint64_t destEltSize = Context.getTypeSize(destEltTy); 6418 6419 return (srcLen * srcEltSize == destLen * destEltSize); 6420 } 6421 6422 /// Is this a legal conversion between two types, one of which is 6423 /// known to be a vector type? 6424 bool Sema::isLaxVectorConversion(QualType srcTy, QualType destTy) { 6425 assert(destTy->isVectorType() || srcTy->isVectorType()); 6426 6427 if (!Context.getLangOpts().LaxVectorConversions) 6428 return false; 6429 return areLaxCompatibleVectorTypes(srcTy, destTy); 6430 } 6431 6432 bool Sema::CheckVectorCast(SourceRange R, QualType VectorTy, QualType Ty, 6433 CastKind &Kind) { 6434 assert(VectorTy->isVectorType() && "Not a vector type!"); 6435 6436 if (Ty->isVectorType() || Ty->isIntegralType(Context)) { 6437 if (!areLaxCompatibleVectorTypes(Ty, VectorTy)) 6438 return Diag(R.getBegin(), 6439 Ty->isVectorType() ? 6440 diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_vectors : 6441 diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_vector_and_integer) 6442 << VectorTy << Ty << R; 6443 } else 6444 return Diag(R.getBegin(), 6445 diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_vector_and_scalar) 6446 << VectorTy << Ty << R; 6447 6448 Kind = CK_BitCast; 6449 return false; 6450 } 6451 6452 ExprResult Sema::prepareVectorSplat(QualType VectorTy, Expr *SplattedExpr) { 6453 QualType DestElemTy = VectorTy->castAs<VectorType>()->getElementType(); 6454 6455 if (DestElemTy == SplattedExpr->getType()) 6456 return SplattedExpr; 6457 6458 assert(DestElemTy->isFloatingType() || 6459 DestElemTy->isIntegralOrEnumerationType()); 6460 6461 CastKind CK; 6462 if (VectorTy->isExtVectorType() && SplattedExpr->getType()->isBooleanType()) { 6463 // OpenCL requires that we convert `true` boolean expressions to -1, but 6464 // only when splatting vectors. 6465 if (DestElemTy->isFloatingType()) { 6466 // To avoid having to have a CK_BooleanToSignedFloating cast kind, we cast 6467 // in two steps: boolean to signed integral, then to floating. 6468 ExprResult CastExprRes = ImpCastExprToType(SplattedExpr, Context.IntTy, 6469 CK_BooleanToSignedIntegral); 6470 SplattedExpr = CastExprRes.get(); 6471 CK = CK_IntegralToFloating; 6472 } else { 6473 CK = CK_BooleanToSignedIntegral; 6474 } 6475 } else { 6476 ExprResult CastExprRes = SplattedExpr; 6477 CK = PrepareScalarCast(CastExprRes, DestElemTy); 6478 if (CastExprRes.isInvalid()) 6479 return ExprError(); 6480 SplattedExpr = CastExprRes.get(); 6481 } 6482 return ImpCastExprToType(SplattedExpr, DestElemTy, CK); 6483 } 6484 6485 ExprResult Sema::CheckExtVectorCast(SourceRange R, QualType DestTy, 6486 Expr *CastExpr, CastKind &Kind) { 6487 assert(DestTy->isExtVectorType() && "Not an extended vector type!"); 6488 6489 QualType SrcTy = CastExpr->getType(); 6490 6491 // If SrcTy is a VectorType, the total size must match to explicitly cast to 6492 // an ExtVectorType. 6493 // In OpenCL, casts between vectors of different types are not allowed. 6494 // (See OpenCL 6.2). 6495 if (SrcTy->isVectorType()) { 6496 if (!areLaxCompatibleVectorTypes(SrcTy, DestTy) || 6497 (getLangOpts().OpenCL && 6498 !Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(DestTy, SrcTy))) { 6499 Diag(R.getBegin(),diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_ext_vectors) 6500 << DestTy << SrcTy << R; 6501 return ExprError(); 6502 } 6503 Kind = CK_BitCast; 6504 return CastExpr; 6505 } 6506 6507 // All non-pointer scalars can be cast to ExtVector type. The appropriate 6508 // conversion will take place first from scalar to elt type, and then 6509 // splat from elt type to vector. 6510 if (SrcTy->isPointerType()) 6511 return Diag(R.getBegin(), 6512 diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_vector_and_scalar) 6513 << DestTy << SrcTy << R; 6514 6515 Kind = CK_VectorSplat; 6516 return prepareVectorSplat(DestTy, CastExpr); 6517 } 6518 6519 ExprResult 6520 Sema::ActOnCastExpr(Scope *S, SourceLocation LParenLoc, 6521 Declarator &D, ParsedType &Ty, 6522 SourceLocation RParenLoc, Expr *CastExpr) { 6523 assert(!D.isInvalidType() && (CastExpr != nullptr) && 6524 "ActOnCastExpr(): missing type or expr"); 6525 6526 TypeSourceInfo *castTInfo = GetTypeForDeclaratorCast(D, CastExpr->getType()); 6527 if (D.isInvalidType()) 6528 return ExprError(); 6529 6530 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 6531 // Check that there are no default arguments (C++ only). 6532 CheckExtraCXXDefaultArguments(D); 6533 } else { 6534 // Make sure any TypoExprs have been dealt with. 6535 ExprResult Res = CorrectDelayedTyposInExpr(CastExpr); 6536 if (!Res.isUsable()) 6537 return ExprError(); 6538 CastExpr = Res.get(); 6539 } 6540 6541 checkUnusedDeclAttributes(D); 6542 6543 QualType castType = castTInfo->getType(); 6544 Ty = CreateParsedType(castType, castTInfo); 6545 6546 bool isVectorLiteral = false; 6547 6548 // Check for an altivec or OpenCL literal, 6549 // i.e. all the elements are integer constants. 6550 ParenExpr *PE = dyn_cast<ParenExpr>(CastExpr); 6551 ParenListExpr *PLE = dyn_cast<ParenListExpr>(CastExpr); 6552 if ((getLangOpts().AltiVec || getLangOpts().ZVector || getLangOpts().OpenCL) 6553 && castType->isVectorType() && (PE || PLE)) { 6554 if (PLE && PLE->getNumExprs() == 0) { 6555 Diag(PLE->getExprLoc(), diag::err_altivec_empty_initializer); 6556 return ExprError(); 6557 } 6558 if (PE || PLE->getNumExprs() == 1) { 6559 Expr *E = (PE ? PE->getSubExpr() : PLE->getExpr(0)); 6560 if (!E->getType()->isVectorType()) 6561 isVectorLiteral = true; 6562 } 6563 else 6564 isVectorLiteral = true; 6565 } 6566 6567 // If this is a vector initializer, '(' type ')' '(' init, ..., init ')' 6568 // then handle it as such. 6569 if (isVectorLiteral) 6570 return BuildVectorLiteral(LParenLoc, RParenLoc, CastExpr, castTInfo); 6571 6572 // If the Expr being casted is a ParenListExpr, handle it specially. 6573 // This is not an AltiVec-style cast, so turn the ParenListExpr into a 6574 // sequence of BinOp comma operators. 6575 if (isa<ParenListExpr>(CastExpr)) { 6576 ExprResult Result = MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(S, CastExpr); 6577 if (Result.isInvalid()) return ExprError(); 6578 CastExpr = Result.get(); 6579 } 6580 6581 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && !castType->isVoidType() && 6582 !getSourceManager().isInSystemMacro(LParenLoc)) 6583 Diag(LParenLoc, diag::warn_old_style_cast) << CastExpr->getSourceRange(); 6584 6585 CheckTollFreeBridgeCast(castType, CastExpr); 6586 6587 CheckObjCBridgeRelatedCast(castType, CastExpr); 6588 6589 DiscardMisalignedMemberAddress(castType.getTypePtr(), CastExpr); 6590 6591 return BuildCStyleCastExpr(LParenLoc, castTInfo, RParenLoc, CastExpr); 6592 } 6593 6594 ExprResult Sema::BuildVectorLiteral(SourceLocation LParenLoc, 6595 SourceLocation RParenLoc, Expr *E, 6596 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo) { 6597 assert((isa<ParenListExpr>(E) || isa<ParenExpr>(E)) && 6598 "Expected paren or paren list expression"); 6599 6600 Expr **exprs; 6601 unsigned numExprs; 6602 Expr *subExpr; 6603 SourceLocation LiteralLParenLoc, LiteralRParenLoc; 6604 if (ParenListExpr *PE = dyn_cast<ParenListExpr>(E)) { 6605 LiteralLParenLoc = PE->getLParenLoc(); 6606 LiteralRParenLoc = PE->getRParenLoc(); 6607 exprs = PE->getExprs(); 6608 numExprs = PE->getNumExprs(); 6609 } else { // isa<ParenExpr> by assertion at function entrance 6610 LiteralLParenLoc = cast<ParenExpr>(E)->getLParen(); 6611 LiteralRParenLoc = cast<ParenExpr>(E)->getRParen(); 6612 subExpr = cast<ParenExpr>(E)->getSubExpr(); 6613 exprs = &subExpr; 6614 numExprs = 1; 6615 } 6616 6617 QualType Ty = TInfo->getType(); 6618 assert(Ty->isVectorType() && "Expected vector type"); 6619 6620 SmallVector<Expr *, 8> initExprs; 6621 const VectorType *VTy = Ty->getAs<VectorType>(); 6622 unsigned numElems = Ty->getAs<VectorType>()->getNumElements(); 6623 6624 // '(...)' form of vector initialization in AltiVec: the number of 6625 // initializers must be one or must match the size of the vector. 6626 // If a single value is specified in the initializer then it will be 6627 // replicated to all the components of the vector 6628 if (VTy->getVectorKind() == VectorType::AltiVecVector) { 6629 // The number of initializers must be one or must match the size of the 6630 // vector. If a single value is specified in the initializer then it will 6631 // be replicated to all the components of the vector 6632 if (numExprs == 1) { 6633 QualType ElemTy = Ty->getAs<VectorType>()->getElementType(); 6634 ExprResult Literal = DefaultLvalueConversion(exprs[0]); 6635 if (Literal.isInvalid()) 6636 return ExprError(); 6637 Literal = ImpCastExprToType(Literal.get(), ElemTy, 6638 PrepareScalarCast(Literal, ElemTy)); 6639 return BuildCStyleCastExpr(LParenLoc, TInfo, RParenLoc, Literal.get()); 6640 } 6641 else if (numExprs < numElems) { 6642 Diag(E->getExprLoc(), 6643 diag::err_incorrect_number_of_vector_initializers); 6644 return ExprError(); 6645 } 6646 else 6647 initExprs.append(exprs, exprs + numExprs); 6648 } 6649 else { 6650 // For OpenCL, when the number of initializers is a single value, 6651 // it will be replicated to all components of the vector. 6652 if (getLangOpts().OpenCL && 6653 VTy->getVectorKind() == VectorType::GenericVector && 6654 numExprs == 1) { 6655 QualType ElemTy = Ty->getAs<VectorType>()->getElementType(); 6656 ExprResult Literal = DefaultLvalueConversion(exprs[0]); 6657 if (Literal.isInvalid()) 6658 return ExprError(); 6659 Literal = ImpCastExprToType(Literal.get(), ElemTy, 6660 PrepareScalarCast(Literal, ElemTy)); 6661 return BuildCStyleCastExpr(LParenLoc, TInfo, RParenLoc, Literal.get()); 6662 } 6663 6664 initExprs.append(exprs, exprs + numExprs); 6665 } 6666 // FIXME: This means that pretty-printing the final AST will produce curly 6667 // braces instead of the original commas. 6668 InitListExpr *initE = new (Context) InitListExpr(Context, LiteralLParenLoc, 6669 initExprs, LiteralRParenLoc); 6670 initE->setType(Ty); 6671 return BuildCompoundLiteralExpr(LParenLoc, TInfo, RParenLoc, initE); 6672 } 6673 6674 /// This is not an AltiVec-style cast or or C++ direct-initialization, so turn 6675 /// the ParenListExpr into a sequence of comma binary operators. 6676 ExprResult 6677 Sema::MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(Scope *S, Expr *OrigExpr) { 6678 ParenListExpr *E = dyn_cast<ParenListExpr>(OrigExpr); 6679 if (!E) 6680 return OrigExpr; 6681 6682 ExprResult Result(E->getExpr(0)); 6683 6684 for (unsigned i = 1, e = E->getNumExprs(); i != e && !Result.isInvalid(); ++i) 6685 Result = ActOnBinOp(S, E->getExprLoc(), tok::comma, Result.get(), 6686 E->getExpr(i)); 6687 6688 if (Result.isInvalid()) return ExprError(); 6689 6690 return ActOnParenExpr(E->getLParenLoc(), E->getRParenLoc(), Result.get()); 6691 } 6692 6693 ExprResult Sema::ActOnParenListExpr(SourceLocation L, 6694 SourceLocation R, 6695 MultiExprArg Val) { 6696 return ParenListExpr::Create(Context, L, Val, R); 6697 } 6698 6699 /// Emit a specialized diagnostic when one expression is a null pointer 6700 /// constant and the other is not a pointer. Returns true if a diagnostic is 6701 /// emitted. 6702 bool Sema::DiagnoseConditionalForNull(Expr *LHSExpr, Expr *RHSExpr, 6703 SourceLocation QuestionLoc) { 6704 Expr *NullExpr = LHSExpr; 6705 Expr *NonPointerExpr = RHSExpr; 6706 Expr::NullPointerConstantKind NullKind = 6707 NullExpr->isNullPointerConstant(Context, 6708 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull); 6709 6710 if (NullKind == Expr::NPCK_NotNull) { 6711 NullExpr = RHSExpr; 6712 NonPointerExpr = LHSExpr; 6713 NullKind = 6714 NullExpr->isNullPointerConstant(Context, 6715 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull); 6716 } 6717 6718 if (NullKind == Expr::NPCK_NotNull) 6719 return false; 6720 6721 if (NullKind == Expr::NPCK_ZeroExpression) 6722 return false; 6723 6724 if (NullKind == Expr::NPCK_ZeroLiteral) { 6725 // In this case, check to make sure that we got here from a "NULL" 6726 // string in the source code. 6727 NullExpr = NullExpr->IgnoreParenImpCasts(); 6728 SourceLocation loc = NullExpr->getExprLoc(); 6729 if (!findMacroSpelling(loc, "NULL")) 6730 return false; 6731 } 6732 6733 int DiagType = (NullKind == Expr::NPCK_CXX11_nullptr); 6734 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::err_typecheck_cond_incompatible_operands_null) 6735 << NonPointerExpr->getType() << DiagType 6736 << NonPointerExpr->getSourceRange(); 6737 return true; 6738 } 6739 6740 /// Return false if the condition expression is valid, true otherwise. 6741 static bool checkCondition(Sema &S, Expr *Cond, SourceLocation QuestionLoc) { 6742 QualType CondTy = Cond->getType(); 6743 6744 // OpenCL v1.1 s6.3.i says the condition cannot be a floating point type. 6745 if (S.getLangOpts().OpenCL && CondTy->isFloatingType()) { 6746 S.Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::err_typecheck_cond_expect_nonfloat) 6747 << CondTy << Cond->getSourceRange(); 6748 return true; 6749 } 6750 6751 // C99 6.5.15p2 6752 if (CondTy->isScalarType()) return false; 6753 6754 S.Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::err_typecheck_cond_expect_scalar) 6755 << CondTy << Cond->getSourceRange(); 6756 return true; 6757 } 6758 6759 /// Handle when one or both operands are void type. 6760 static QualType checkConditionalVoidType(Sema &S, ExprResult &LHS, 6761 ExprResult &RHS) { 6762 Expr *LHSExpr = LHS.get(); 6763 Expr *RHSExpr = RHS.get(); 6764 6765 if (!LHSExpr->getType()->isVoidType()) 6766 S.Diag(RHSExpr->getBeginLoc(), diag::ext_typecheck_cond_one_void) 6767 << RHSExpr->getSourceRange(); 6768 if (!RHSExpr->getType()->isVoidType()) 6769 S.Diag(LHSExpr->getBeginLoc(), diag::ext_typecheck_cond_one_void) 6770 << LHSExpr->getSourceRange(); 6771 LHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), S.Context.VoidTy, CK_ToVoid); 6772 RHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), S.Context.VoidTy, CK_ToVoid); 6773 return S.Context.VoidTy; 6774 } 6775 6776 /// Return false if the NullExpr can be promoted to PointerTy, 6777 /// true otherwise. 6778 static bool checkConditionalNullPointer(Sema &S, ExprResult &NullExpr, 6779 QualType PointerTy) { 6780 if ((!PointerTy->isAnyPointerType() && !PointerTy->isBlockPointerType()) || 6781 !NullExpr.get()->isNullPointerConstant(S.Context, 6782 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) 6783 return true; 6784 6785 NullExpr = S.ImpCastExprToType(NullExpr.get(), PointerTy, CK_NullToPointer); 6786 return false; 6787 } 6788 6789 /// Checks compatibility between two pointers and return the resulting 6790 /// type. 6791 static QualType checkConditionalPointerCompatibility(Sema &S, ExprResult &LHS, 6792 ExprResult &RHS, 6793 SourceLocation Loc) { 6794 QualType LHSTy = LHS.get()->getType(); 6795 QualType RHSTy = RHS.get()->getType(); 6796 6797 if (S.Context.hasSameType(LHSTy, RHSTy)) { 6798 // Two identical pointers types are always compatible. 6799 return LHSTy; 6800 } 6801 6802 QualType lhptee, rhptee; 6803 6804 // Get the pointee types. 6805 bool IsBlockPointer = false; 6806 if (const BlockPointerType *LHSBTy = LHSTy->getAs<BlockPointerType>()) { 6807 lhptee = LHSBTy->getPointeeType(); 6808 rhptee = RHSTy->castAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType(); 6809 IsBlockPointer = true; 6810 } else { 6811 lhptee = LHSTy->castAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType(); 6812 rhptee = RHSTy->castAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType(); 6813 } 6814 6815 // C99 6.5.15p6: If both operands are pointers to compatible types or to 6816 // differently qualified versions of compatible types, the result type is 6817 // a pointer to an appropriately qualified version of the composite 6818 // type. 6819 6820 // Only CVR-qualifiers exist in the standard, and the differently-qualified 6821 // clause doesn't make sense for our extensions. E.g. address space 2 should 6822 // be incompatible with address space 3: they may live on different devices or 6823 // anything. 6824 Qualifiers lhQual = lhptee.getQualifiers(); 6825 Qualifiers rhQual = rhptee.getQualifiers(); 6826 6827 LangAS ResultAddrSpace = LangAS::Default; 6828 LangAS LAddrSpace = lhQual.getAddressSpace(); 6829 LangAS RAddrSpace = rhQual.getAddressSpace(); 6830 6831 // OpenCL v1.1 s6.5 - Conversion between pointers to distinct address 6832 // spaces is disallowed. 6833 if (lhQual.isAddressSpaceSupersetOf(rhQual)) 6834 ResultAddrSpace = LAddrSpace; 6835 else if (rhQual.isAddressSpaceSupersetOf(lhQual)) 6836 ResultAddrSpace = RAddrSpace; 6837 else { 6838 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_op_on_nonoverlapping_address_space_pointers) 6839 << LHSTy << RHSTy << 2 << LHS.get()->getSourceRange() 6840 << RHS.get()->getSourceRange(); 6841 return QualType(); 6842 } 6843 6844 unsigned MergedCVRQual = lhQual.getCVRQualifiers() | rhQual.getCVRQualifiers(); 6845 auto LHSCastKind = CK_BitCast, RHSCastKind = CK_BitCast; 6846 lhQual.removeCVRQualifiers(); 6847 rhQual.removeCVRQualifiers(); 6848 6849 // OpenCL v2.0 specification doesn't extend compatibility of type qualifiers 6850 // (C99 6.7.3) for address spaces. We assume that the check should behave in 6851 // the same manner as it's defined for CVR qualifiers, so for OpenCL two 6852 // qual types are compatible iff 6853 // * corresponded types are compatible 6854 // * CVR qualifiers are equal 6855 // * address spaces are equal 6856 // Thus for conditional operator we merge CVR and address space unqualified 6857 // pointees and if there is a composite type we return a pointer to it with 6858 // merged qualifiers. 6859 LHSCastKind = 6860 LAddrSpace == ResultAddrSpace ? CK_BitCast : CK_AddressSpaceConversion; 6861 RHSCastKind = 6862 RAddrSpace == ResultAddrSpace ? CK_BitCast : CK_AddressSpaceConversion; 6863 lhQual.removeAddressSpace(); 6864 rhQual.removeAddressSpace(); 6865 6866 lhptee = S.Context.getQualifiedType(lhptee.getUnqualifiedType(), lhQual); 6867 rhptee = S.Context.getQualifiedType(rhptee.getUnqualifiedType(), rhQual); 6868 6869 QualType CompositeTy = S.Context.mergeTypes(lhptee, rhptee); 6870 6871 if (CompositeTy.isNull()) { 6872 // In this situation, we assume void* type. No especially good 6873 // reason, but this is what gcc does, and we do have to pick 6874 // to get a consistent AST. 6875 QualType incompatTy; 6876 incompatTy = S.Context.getPointerType( 6877 S.Context.getAddrSpaceQualType(S.Context.VoidTy, ResultAddrSpace)); 6878 LHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), incompatTy, LHSCastKind); 6879 RHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), incompatTy, RHSCastKind); 6880 6881 // FIXME: For OpenCL the warning emission and cast to void* leaves a room 6882 // for casts between types with incompatible address space qualifiers. 6883 // For the following code the compiler produces casts between global and 6884 // local address spaces of the corresponded innermost pointees: 6885 // local int *global *a; 6886 // global int *global *b; 6887 // a = (0 ? a : b); // see C99 6.5.16.1.p1. 6888 S.Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_cond_incompatible_pointers) 6889 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS.get()->getSourceRange() 6890 << RHS.get()->getSourceRange(); 6891 6892 return incompatTy; 6893 } 6894 6895 // The pointer types are compatible. 6896 // In case of OpenCL ResultTy should have the address space qualifier 6897 // which is a superset of address spaces of both the 2nd and the 3rd 6898 // operands of the conditional operator. 6899 QualType ResultTy = [&, ResultAddrSpace]() { 6900 if (S.getLangOpts().OpenCL) { 6901 Qualifiers CompositeQuals = CompositeTy.getQualifiers(); 6902 CompositeQuals.setAddressSpace(ResultAddrSpace); 6903 return S.Context 6904 .getQualifiedType(CompositeTy.getUnqualifiedType(), CompositeQuals) 6905 .withCVRQualifiers(MergedCVRQual); 6906 } 6907 return CompositeTy.withCVRQualifiers(MergedCVRQual); 6908 }(); 6909 if (IsBlockPointer) 6910 ResultTy = S.Context.getBlockPointerType(ResultTy); 6911 else 6912 ResultTy = S.Context.getPointerType(ResultTy); 6913 6914 LHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), ResultTy, LHSCastKind); 6915 RHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), ResultTy, RHSCastKind); 6916 return ResultTy; 6917 } 6918 6919 /// Return the resulting type when the operands are both block pointers. 6920 static QualType checkConditionalBlockPointerCompatibility(Sema &S, 6921 ExprResult &LHS, 6922 ExprResult &RHS, 6923 SourceLocation Loc) { 6924 QualType LHSTy = LHS.get()->getType(); 6925 QualType RHSTy = RHS.get()->getType(); 6926 6927 if (!LHSTy->isBlockPointerType() || !RHSTy->isBlockPointerType()) { 6928 if (LHSTy->isVoidPointerType() || RHSTy->isVoidPointerType()) { 6929 QualType destType = S.Context.getPointerType(S.Context.VoidTy); 6930 LHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), destType, CK_BitCast); 6931 RHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), destType, CK_BitCast); 6932 return destType; 6933 } 6934 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_cond_incompatible_operands) 6935 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS.get()->getSourceRange() 6936 << RHS.get()->getSourceRange(); 6937 return QualType(); 6938 } 6939 6940 // We have 2 block pointer types. 6941 return checkConditionalPointerCompatibility(S, LHS, RHS, Loc); 6942 } 6943 6944 /// Return the resulting type when the operands are both pointers. 6945 static QualType 6946 checkConditionalObjectPointersCompatibility(Sema &S, ExprResult &LHS, 6947 ExprResult &RHS, 6948 SourceLocation Loc) { 6949 // get the pointer types 6950 QualType LHSTy = LHS.get()->getType(); 6951 QualType RHSTy = RHS.get()->getType(); 6952 6953 // get the "pointed to" types 6954 QualType lhptee = LHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType(); 6955 QualType rhptee = RHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType(); 6956 6957 // ignore qualifiers on void (C99 6.5.15p3, clause 6) 6958 if (lhptee->isVoidType() && rhptee->isIncompleteOrObjectType()) { 6959 // Figure out necessary qualifiers (C99 6.5.15p6) 6960 QualType destPointee 6961 = S.Context.getQualifiedType(lhptee, rhptee.getQualifiers()); 6962 QualType destType = S.Context.getPointerType(destPointee); 6963 // Add qualifiers if necessary. 6964 LHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), destType, CK_NoOp); 6965 // Promote to void*. 6966 RHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), destType, CK_BitCast); 6967 return destType; 6968 } 6969 if (rhptee->isVoidType() && lhptee->isIncompleteOrObjectType()) { 6970 QualType destPointee 6971 = S.Context.getQualifiedType(rhptee, lhptee.getQualifiers()); 6972 QualType destType = S.Context.getPointerType(destPointee); 6973 // Add qualifiers if necessary. 6974 RHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), destType, CK_NoOp); 6975 // Promote to void*. 6976 LHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), destType, CK_BitCast); 6977 return destType; 6978 } 6979 6980 return checkConditionalPointerCompatibility(S, LHS, RHS, Loc); 6981 } 6982 6983 /// Return false if the first expression is not an integer and the second 6984 /// expression is not a pointer, true otherwise. 6985 static bool checkPointerIntegerMismatch(Sema &S, ExprResult &Int, 6986 Expr* PointerExpr, SourceLocation Loc, 6987 bool IsIntFirstExpr) { 6988 if (!PointerExpr->getType()->isPointerType() || 6989 !Int.get()->getType()->isIntegerType()) 6990 return false; 6991 6992 Expr *Expr1 = IsIntFirstExpr ? Int.get() : PointerExpr; 6993 Expr *Expr2 = IsIntFirstExpr ? PointerExpr : Int.get(); 6994 6995 S.Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_cond_pointer_integer_mismatch) 6996 << Expr1->getType() << Expr2->getType() 6997 << Expr1->getSourceRange() << Expr2->getSourceRange(); 6998 Int = S.ImpCastExprToType(Int.get(), PointerExpr->getType(), 6999 CK_IntegralToPointer); 7000 return true; 7001 } 7002 7003 /// Simple conversion between integer and floating point types. 7004 /// 7005 /// Used when handling the OpenCL conditional operator where the 7006 /// condition is a vector while the other operands are scalar. 7007 /// 7008 /// OpenCL v1.1 s6.3.i and s6.11.6 together require that the scalar 7009 /// types are either integer or floating type. Between the two 7010 /// operands, the type with the higher rank is defined as the "result 7011 /// type". The other operand needs to be promoted to the same type. No 7012 /// other type promotion is allowed. We cannot use 7013 /// UsualArithmeticConversions() for this purpose, since it always 7014 /// promotes promotable types. 7015 static QualType OpenCLArithmeticConversions(Sema &S, ExprResult &LHS, 7016 ExprResult &RHS, 7017 SourceLocation QuestionLoc) { 7018 LHS = S.DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(LHS.get()); 7019 if (LHS.isInvalid()) 7020 return QualType(); 7021 RHS = S.DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(RHS.get()); 7022 if (RHS.isInvalid()) 7023 return QualType(); 7024 7025 // For conversion purposes, we ignore any qualifiers. 7026 // For example, "const float" and "float" are equivalent. 7027 QualType LHSType = 7028 S.Context.getCanonicalType(LHS.get()->getType()).getUnqualifiedType(); 7029 QualType RHSType = 7030 S.Context.getCanonicalType(RHS.get()->getType()).getUnqualifiedType(); 7031 7032 if (!LHSType->isIntegerType() && !LHSType->isRealFloatingType()) { 7033 S.Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::err_typecheck_cond_expect_int_float) 7034 << LHSType << LHS.get()->getSourceRange(); 7035 return QualType(); 7036 } 7037 7038 if (!RHSType->isIntegerType() && !RHSType->isRealFloatingType()) { 7039 S.Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::err_typecheck_cond_expect_int_float) 7040 << RHSType << RHS.get()->getSourceRange(); 7041 return QualType(); 7042 } 7043 7044 // If both types are identical, no conversion is needed. 7045 if (LHSType == RHSType) 7046 return LHSType; 7047 7048 // Now handle "real" floating types (i.e. float, double, long double). 7049 if (LHSType->isRealFloatingType() || RHSType->isRealFloatingType()) 7050 return handleFloatConversion(S, LHS, RHS, LHSType, RHSType, 7051 /*IsCompAssign = */ false); 7052 7053 // Finally, we have two differing integer types. 7054 return handleIntegerConversion<doIntegralCast, doIntegralCast> 7055 (S, LHS, RHS, LHSType, RHSType, /*IsCompAssign = */ false); 7056 } 7057 7058 /// Convert scalar operands to a vector that matches the 7059 /// condition in length. 7060 /// 7061 /// Used when handling the OpenCL conditional operator where the 7062 /// condition is a vector while the other operands are scalar. 7063 /// 7064 /// We first compute the "result type" for the scalar operands 7065 /// according to OpenCL v1.1 s6.3.i. Both operands are then converted 7066 /// into a vector of that type where the length matches the condition 7067 /// vector type. s6.11.6 requires that the element types of the result 7068 /// and the condition must have the same number of bits. 7069 static QualType 7070 OpenCLConvertScalarsToVectors(Sema &S, ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS, 7071 QualType CondTy, SourceLocation QuestionLoc) { 7072 QualType ResTy = OpenCLArithmeticConversions(S, LHS, RHS, QuestionLoc); 7073 if (ResTy.isNull()) return QualType(); 7074 7075 const VectorType *CV = CondTy->getAs<VectorType>(); 7076 assert(CV); 7077 7078 // Determine the vector result type 7079 unsigned NumElements = CV->getNumElements(); 7080 QualType VectorTy = S.Context.getExtVectorType(ResTy, NumElements); 7081 7082 // Ensure that all types have the same number of bits 7083 if (S.Context.getTypeSize(CV->getElementType()) 7084 != S.Context.getTypeSize(ResTy)) { 7085 // Since VectorTy is created internally, it does not pretty print 7086 // with an OpenCL name. Instead, we just print a description. 7087 std::string EleTyName = ResTy.getUnqualifiedType().getAsString(); 7088 SmallString<64> Str; 7089 llvm::raw_svector_ostream OS(Str); 7090 OS << "(vector of " << NumElements << " '" << EleTyName << "' values)"; 7091 S.Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::err_conditional_vector_element_size) 7092 << CondTy << OS.str(); 7093 return QualType(); 7094 } 7095 7096 // Convert operands to the vector result type 7097 LHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), VectorTy, CK_VectorSplat); 7098 RHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), VectorTy, CK_VectorSplat); 7099 7100 return VectorTy; 7101 } 7102 7103 /// Return false if this is a valid OpenCL condition vector 7104 static bool checkOpenCLConditionVector(Sema &S, Expr *Cond, 7105 SourceLocation QuestionLoc) { 7106 // OpenCL v1.1 s6.11.6 says the elements of the vector must be of 7107 // integral type. 7108 const VectorType *CondTy = Cond->getType()->getAs<VectorType>(); 7109 assert(CondTy); 7110 QualType EleTy = CondTy->getElementType(); 7111 if (EleTy->isIntegerType()) return false; 7112 7113 S.Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::err_typecheck_cond_expect_nonfloat) 7114 << Cond->getType() << Cond->getSourceRange(); 7115 return true; 7116 } 7117 7118 /// Return false if the vector condition type and the vector 7119 /// result type are compatible. 7120 /// 7121 /// OpenCL v1.1 s6.11.6 requires that both vector types have the same 7122 /// number of elements, and their element types have the same number 7123 /// of bits. 7124 static bool checkVectorResult(Sema &S, QualType CondTy, QualType VecResTy, 7125 SourceLocation QuestionLoc) { 7126 const VectorType *CV = CondTy->getAs<VectorType>(); 7127 const VectorType *RV = VecResTy->getAs<VectorType>(); 7128 assert(CV && RV); 7129 7130 if (CV->getNumElements() != RV->getNumElements()) { 7131 S.Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::err_conditional_vector_size) 7132 << CondTy << VecResTy; 7133 return true; 7134 } 7135 7136 QualType CVE = CV->getElementType(); 7137 QualType RVE = RV->getElementType(); 7138 7139 if (S.Context.getTypeSize(CVE) != S.Context.getTypeSize(RVE)) { 7140 S.Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::err_conditional_vector_element_size) 7141 << CondTy << VecResTy; 7142 return true; 7143 } 7144 7145 return false; 7146 } 7147 7148 /// Return the resulting type for the conditional operator in 7149 /// OpenCL (aka "ternary selection operator", OpenCL v1.1 7150 /// s6.3.i) when the condition is a vector type. 7151 static QualType 7152 OpenCLCheckVectorConditional(Sema &S, ExprResult &Cond, 7153 ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS, 7154 SourceLocation QuestionLoc) { 7155 Cond = S.DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Cond.get()); 7156 if (Cond.isInvalid()) 7157 return QualType(); 7158 QualType CondTy = Cond.get()->getType(); 7159 7160 if (checkOpenCLConditionVector(S, Cond.get(), QuestionLoc)) 7161 return QualType(); 7162 7163 // If either operand is a vector then find the vector type of the 7164 // result as specified in OpenCL v1.1 s6.3.i. 7165 if (LHS.get()->getType()->isVectorType() || 7166 RHS.get()->getType()->isVectorType()) { 7167 QualType VecResTy = S.CheckVectorOperands(LHS, RHS, QuestionLoc, 7168 /*isCompAssign*/false, 7169 /*AllowBothBool*/true, 7170 /*AllowBoolConversions*/false); 7171 if (VecResTy.isNull()) return QualType(); 7172 // The result type must match the condition type as specified in 7173 // OpenCL v1.1 s6.11.6. 7174 if (checkVectorResult(S, CondTy, VecResTy, QuestionLoc)) 7175 return QualType(); 7176 return VecResTy; 7177 } 7178 7179 // Both operands are scalar. 7180 return OpenCLConvertScalarsToVectors(S, LHS, RHS, CondTy, QuestionLoc); 7181 } 7182 7183 /// Return true if the Expr is block type 7184 static bool checkBlockType(Sema &S, const Expr *E) { 7185 if (const CallExpr *CE = dyn_cast<CallExpr>(E)) { 7186 QualType Ty = CE->getCallee()->getType(); 7187 if (Ty->isBlockPointerType()) { 7188 S.Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_opencl_ternary_with_block); 7189 return true; 7190 } 7191 } 7192 return false; 7193 } 7194 7195 /// Note that LHS is not null here, even if this is the gnu "x ?: y" extension. 7196 /// In that case, LHS = cond. 7197 /// C99 6.5.15 7198 QualType Sema::CheckConditionalOperands(ExprResult &Cond, ExprResult &LHS, 7199 ExprResult &RHS, ExprValueKind &VK, 7200 ExprObjectKind &OK, 7201 SourceLocation QuestionLoc) { 7202 7203 ExprResult LHSResult = CheckPlaceholderExpr(LHS.get()); 7204 if (!LHSResult.isUsable()) return QualType(); 7205 LHS = LHSResult; 7206 7207 ExprResult RHSResult = CheckPlaceholderExpr(RHS.get()); 7208 if (!RHSResult.isUsable()) return QualType(); 7209 RHS = RHSResult; 7210 7211 // C++ is sufficiently different to merit its own checker. 7212 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) 7213 return CXXCheckConditionalOperands(Cond, LHS, RHS, VK, OK, QuestionLoc); 7214 7215 VK = VK_RValue; 7216 OK = OK_Ordinary; 7217 7218 // The OpenCL operator with a vector condition is sufficiently 7219 // different to merit its own checker. 7220 if (getLangOpts().OpenCL && Cond.get()->getType()->isVectorType()) 7221 return OpenCLCheckVectorConditional(*this, Cond, LHS, RHS, QuestionLoc); 7222 7223 // First, check the condition. 7224 Cond = UsualUnaryConversions(Cond.get()); 7225 if (Cond.isInvalid()) 7226 return QualType(); 7227 if (checkCondition(*this, Cond.get(), QuestionLoc)) 7228 return QualType(); 7229 7230 // Now check the two expressions. 7231 if (LHS.get()->getType()->isVectorType() || 7232 RHS.get()->getType()->isVectorType()) 7233 return CheckVectorOperands(LHS, RHS, QuestionLoc, /*isCompAssign*/false, 7234 /*AllowBothBool*/true, 7235 /*AllowBoolConversions*/false); 7236 7237 QualType ResTy = UsualArithmeticConversions(LHS, RHS); 7238 if (LHS.isInvalid() || RHS.isInvalid()) 7239 return QualType(); 7240 7241 QualType LHSTy = LHS.get()->getType(); 7242 QualType RHSTy = RHS.get()->getType(); 7243 7244 // Diagnose attempts to convert between __float128 and long double where 7245 // such conversions currently can't be handled. 7246 if (unsupportedTypeConversion(*this, LHSTy, RHSTy)) { 7247 Diag(QuestionLoc, 7248 diag::err_typecheck_cond_incompatible_operands) << LHSTy << RHSTy 7249 << LHS.get()->getSourceRange() << RHS.get()->getSourceRange(); 7250 return QualType(); 7251 } 7252 7253 // OpenCL v2.0 s6.12.5 - Blocks cannot be used as expressions of the ternary 7254 // selection operator (?:). 7255 if (getLangOpts().OpenCL && 7256 (checkBlockType(*this, LHS.get()) | checkBlockType(*this, RHS.get()))) { 7257 return QualType(); 7258 } 7259 7260 // If both operands have arithmetic type, do the usual arithmetic conversions 7261 // to find a common type: C99 6.5.15p3,5. 7262 if (LHSTy->isArithmeticType() && RHSTy->isArithmeticType()) { 7263 LHS = ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), ResTy, PrepareScalarCast(LHS, ResTy)); 7264 RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), ResTy, PrepareScalarCast(RHS, ResTy)); 7265 7266 return ResTy; 7267 } 7268 7269 // If both operands are the same structure or union type, the result is that 7270 // type. 7271 if (const RecordType *LHSRT = LHSTy->getAs<RecordType>()) { // C99 6.5.15p3 7272 if (const RecordType *RHSRT = RHSTy->getAs<RecordType>()) 7273 if (LHSRT->getDecl() == RHSRT->getDecl()) 7274 // "If both the operands have structure or union type, the result has 7275 // that type." This implies that CV qualifiers are dropped. 7276 return LHSTy.getUnqualifiedType(); 7277 // FIXME: Type of conditional expression must be complete in C mode. 7278 } 7279 7280 // C99 6.5.15p5: "If both operands have void type, the result has void type." 7281 // The following || allows only one side to be void (a GCC-ism). 7282 if (LHSTy->isVoidType() || RHSTy->isVoidType()) { 7283 return checkConditionalVoidType(*this, LHS, RHS); 7284 } 7285 7286 // C99 6.5.15p6 - "if one operand is a null pointer constant, the result has 7287 // the type of the other operand." 7288 if (!checkConditionalNullPointer(*this, RHS, LHSTy)) return LHSTy; 7289 if (!checkConditionalNullPointer(*this, LHS, RHSTy)) return RHSTy; 7290 7291 // All objective-c pointer type analysis is done here. 7292 QualType compositeType = FindCompositeObjCPointerType(LHS, RHS, 7293 QuestionLoc); 7294 if (LHS.isInvalid() || RHS.isInvalid()) 7295 return QualType(); 7296 if (!compositeType.isNull()) 7297 return compositeType; 7298 7299 7300 // Handle block pointer types. 7301 if (LHSTy->isBlockPointerType() || RHSTy->isBlockPointerType()) 7302 return checkConditionalBlockPointerCompatibility(*this, LHS, RHS, 7303 QuestionLoc); 7304 7305 // Check constraints for C object pointers types (C99 6.5.15p3,6). 7306 if (LHSTy->isPointerType() && RHSTy->isPointerType()) 7307 return checkConditionalObjectPointersCompatibility(*this, LHS, RHS, 7308 QuestionLoc); 7309 7310 // GCC compatibility: soften pointer/integer mismatch. Note that 7311 // null pointers have been filtered out by this point. 7312 if (checkPointerIntegerMismatch(*this, LHS, RHS.get(), QuestionLoc, 7313 /*IsIntFirstExpr=*/true)) 7314 return RHSTy; 7315 if (checkPointerIntegerMismatch(*this, RHS, LHS.get(), QuestionLoc, 7316 /*IsIntFirstExpr=*/false)) 7317 return LHSTy; 7318 7319 // Emit a better diagnostic if one of the expressions is a null pointer 7320 // constant and the other is not a pointer type. In this case, the user most 7321 // likely forgot to take the address of the other expression. 7322 if (DiagnoseConditionalForNull(LHS.get(), RHS.get(), QuestionLoc)) 7323 return QualType(); 7324 7325 // Otherwise, the operands are not compatible. 7326 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::err_typecheck_cond_incompatible_operands) 7327 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS.get()->getSourceRange() 7328 << RHS.get()->getSourceRange(); 7329 return QualType(); 7330 } 7331 7332 /// FindCompositeObjCPointerType - Helper method to find composite type of 7333 /// two objective-c pointer types of the two input expressions. 7334 QualType Sema::FindCompositeObjCPointerType(ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS, 7335 SourceLocation QuestionLoc) { 7336 QualType LHSTy = LHS.get()->getType(); 7337 QualType RHSTy = RHS.get()->getType(); 7338 7339 // Handle things like Class and struct objc_class*. Here we case the result 7340 // to the pseudo-builtin, because that will be implicitly cast back to the 7341 // redefinition type if an attempt is made to access its fields. 7342 if (LHSTy->isObjCClassType() && 7343 (Context.hasSameType(RHSTy, Context.getObjCClassRedefinitionType()))) { 7344 RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), LHSTy, CK_CPointerToObjCPointerCast); 7345 return LHSTy; 7346 } 7347 if (RHSTy->isObjCClassType() && 7348 (Context.hasSameType(LHSTy, Context.getObjCClassRedefinitionType()))) { 7349 LHS = ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), RHSTy, CK_CPointerToObjCPointerCast); 7350 return RHSTy; 7351 } 7352 // And the same for struct objc_object* / id 7353 if (LHSTy->isObjCIdType() && 7354 (Context.hasSameType(RHSTy, Context.getObjCIdRedefinitionType()))) { 7355 RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), LHSTy, CK_CPointerToObjCPointerCast); 7356 return LHSTy; 7357 } 7358 if (RHSTy->isObjCIdType() && 7359 (Context.hasSameType(LHSTy, Context.getObjCIdRedefinitionType()))) { 7360 LHS = ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), RHSTy, CK_CPointerToObjCPointerCast); 7361 return RHSTy; 7362 } 7363 // And the same for struct objc_selector* / SEL 7364 if (Context.isObjCSelType(LHSTy) && 7365 (Context.hasSameType(RHSTy, Context.getObjCSelRedefinitionType()))) { 7366 RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), LHSTy, CK_BitCast); 7367 return LHSTy; 7368 } 7369 if (Context.isObjCSelType(RHSTy) && 7370 (Context.hasSameType(LHSTy, Context.getObjCSelRedefinitionType()))) { 7371 LHS = ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), RHSTy, CK_BitCast); 7372 return RHSTy; 7373 } 7374 // Check constraints for Objective-C object pointers types. 7375 if (LHSTy->isObjCObjectPointerType() && RHSTy->isObjCObjectPointerType()) { 7376 7377 if (Context.getCanonicalType(LHSTy) == Context.getCanonicalType(RHSTy)) { 7378 // Two identical object pointer types are always compatible. 7379 return LHSTy; 7380 } 7381 const ObjCObjectPointerType *LHSOPT = LHSTy->castAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(); 7382 const ObjCObjectPointerType *RHSOPT = RHSTy->castAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(); 7383 QualType compositeType = LHSTy; 7384 7385 // If both operands are interfaces and either operand can be 7386 // assigned to the other, use that type as the composite 7387 // type. This allows 7388 // xxx ? (A*) a : (B*) b 7389 // where B is a subclass of A. 7390 // 7391 // Additionally, as for assignment, if either type is 'id' 7392 // allow silent coercion. Finally, if the types are 7393 // incompatible then make sure to use 'id' as the composite 7394 // type so the result is acceptable for sending messages to. 7395 7396 // FIXME: Consider unifying with 'areComparableObjCPointerTypes'. 7397 // It could return the composite type. 7398 if (!(compositeType = 7399 Context.areCommonBaseCompatible(LHSOPT, RHSOPT)).isNull()) { 7400 // Nothing more to do. 7401 } else if (Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(LHSOPT, RHSOPT)) { 7402 compositeType = RHSOPT->isObjCBuiltinType() ? RHSTy : LHSTy; 7403 } else if (Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(RHSOPT, LHSOPT)) { 7404 compositeType = LHSOPT->isObjCBuiltinType() ? LHSTy : RHSTy; 7405 } else if ((LHSTy->isObjCQualifiedIdType() || 7406 RHSTy->isObjCQualifiedIdType()) && 7407 Context.ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible(LHSTy, RHSTy, true)) { 7408 // Need to handle "id<xx>" explicitly. 7409 // GCC allows qualified id and any Objective-C type to devolve to 7410 // id. Currently localizing to here until clear this should be 7411 // part of ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible. 7412 compositeType = Context.getObjCIdType(); 7413 } else if (LHSTy->isObjCIdType() || RHSTy->isObjCIdType()) { 7414 compositeType = Context.getObjCIdType(); 7415 } else { 7416 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::ext_typecheck_cond_incompatible_operands) 7417 << LHSTy << RHSTy 7418 << LHS.get()->getSourceRange() << RHS.get()->getSourceRange(); 7419 QualType incompatTy = Context.getObjCIdType(); 7420 LHS = ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), incompatTy, CK_BitCast); 7421 RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), incompatTy, CK_BitCast); 7422 return incompatTy; 7423 } 7424 // The object pointer types are compatible. 7425 LHS = ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), compositeType, CK_BitCast); 7426 RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), compositeType, CK_BitCast); 7427 return compositeType; 7428 } 7429 // Check Objective-C object pointer types and 'void *' 7430 if (LHSTy->isVoidPointerType() && RHSTy->isObjCObjectPointerType()) { 7431 if (getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount) { 7432 // ARC forbids the implicit conversion of object pointers to 'void *', 7433 // so these types are not compatible. 7434 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::err_cond_voidptr_arc) << LHSTy << RHSTy 7435 << LHS.get()->getSourceRange() << RHS.get()->getSourceRange(); 7436 LHS = RHS = true; 7437 return QualType(); 7438 } 7439 QualType lhptee = LHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType(); 7440 QualType rhptee = RHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType(); 7441 QualType destPointee 7442 = Context.getQualifiedType(lhptee, rhptee.getQualifiers()); 7443 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(destPointee); 7444 // Add qualifiers if necessary. 7445 LHS = ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), destType, CK_NoOp); 7446 // Promote to void*. 7447 RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), destType, CK_BitCast); 7448 return destType; 7449 } 7450 if (LHSTy->isObjCObjectPointerType() && RHSTy->isVoidPointerType()) { 7451 if (getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount) { 7452 // ARC forbids the implicit conversion of object pointers to 'void *', 7453 // so these types are not compatible. 7454 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::err_cond_voidptr_arc) << LHSTy << RHSTy 7455 << LHS.get()->getSourceRange() << RHS.get()->getSourceRange(); 7456 LHS = RHS = true; 7457 return QualType(); 7458 } 7459 QualType lhptee = LHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType(); 7460 QualType rhptee = RHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType(); 7461 QualType destPointee 7462 = Context.getQualifiedType(rhptee, lhptee.getQualifiers()); 7463 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(destPointee); 7464 // Add qualifiers if necessary. 7465 RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), destType, CK_NoOp); 7466 // Promote to void*. 7467 LHS = ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), destType, CK_BitCast); 7468 return destType; 7469 } 7470 return QualType(); 7471 } 7472 7473 /// SuggestParentheses - Emit a note with a fixit hint that wraps 7474 /// ParenRange in parentheses. 7475 static void SuggestParentheses(Sema &Self, SourceLocation Loc, 7476 const PartialDiagnostic &Note, 7477 SourceRange ParenRange) { 7478 SourceLocation EndLoc = Self.getLocForEndOfToken(ParenRange.getEnd()); 7479 if (ParenRange.getBegin().isFileID() && ParenRange.getEnd().isFileID() && 7480 EndLoc.isValid()) { 7481 Self.Diag(Loc, Note) 7482 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(ParenRange.getBegin(), "(") 7483 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(EndLoc, ")"); 7484 } else { 7485 // We can't display the parentheses, so just show the bare note. 7486 Self.Diag(Loc, Note) << ParenRange; 7487 } 7488 } 7489 7490 static bool IsArithmeticOp(BinaryOperatorKind Opc) { 7491 return BinaryOperator::isAdditiveOp(Opc) || 7492 BinaryOperator::isMultiplicativeOp(Opc) || 7493 BinaryOperator::isShiftOp(Opc); 7494 } 7495 7496 /// IsArithmeticBinaryExpr - Returns true if E is an arithmetic binary 7497 /// expression, either using a built-in or overloaded operator, 7498 /// and sets *OpCode to the opcode and *RHSExprs to the right-hand side 7499 /// expression. 7500 static bool IsArithmeticBinaryExpr(Expr *E, BinaryOperatorKind *Opcode, 7501 Expr **RHSExprs) { 7502 // Don't strip parenthesis: we should not warn if E is in parenthesis. 7503 E = E->IgnoreImpCasts(); 7504 E = E->IgnoreConversionOperator(); 7505 E = E->IgnoreImpCasts(); 7506 if (auto *MTE = dyn_cast<MaterializeTemporaryExpr>(E)) { 7507 E = MTE->GetTemporaryExpr(); 7508 E = E->IgnoreImpCasts(); 7509 } 7510 7511 // Built-in binary operator. 7512 if (BinaryOperator *OP = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(E)) { 7513 if (IsArithmeticOp(OP->getOpcode())) { 7514 *Opcode = OP->getOpcode(); 7515 *RHSExprs = OP->getRHS(); 7516 return true; 7517 } 7518 } 7519 7520 // Overloaded operator. 7521 if (CXXOperatorCallExpr *Call = dyn_cast<CXXOperatorCallExpr>(E)) { 7522 if (Call->getNumArgs() != 2) 7523 return false; 7524 7525 // Make sure this is really a binary operator that is safe to pass into 7526 // BinaryOperator::getOverloadedOpcode(), e.g. it's not a subscript op. 7527 OverloadedOperatorKind OO = Call->getOperator(); 7528 if (OO < OO_Plus || OO > OO_Arrow || 7529 OO == OO_PlusPlus || OO == OO_MinusMinus) 7530 return false; 7531 7532 BinaryOperatorKind OpKind = BinaryOperator::getOverloadedOpcode(OO); 7533 if (IsArithmeticOp(OpKind)) { 7534 *Opcode = OpKind; 7535 *RHSExprs = Call->getArg(1); 7536 return true; 7537 } 7538 } 7539 7540 return false; 7541 } 7542 7543 /// ExprLooksBoolean - Returns true if E looks boolean, i.e. it has boolean type 7544 /// or is a logical expression such as (x==y) which has int type, but is 7545 /// commonly interpreted as boolean. 7546 static bool ExprLooksBoolean(Expr *E) { 7547 E = E->IgnoreParenImpCasts(); 7548 7549 if (E->getType()->isBooleanType()) 7550 return true; 7551 if (BinaryOperator *OP = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(E)) 7552 return OP->isComparisonOp() || OP->isLogicalOp(); 7553 if (UnaryOperator *OP = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(E)) 7554 return OP->getOpcode() == UO_LNot; 7555 if (E->getType()->isPointerType()) 7556 return true; 7557 // FIXME: What about overloaded operator calls returning "unspecified boolean 7558 // type"s (commonly pointer-to-members)? 7559 7560 return false; 7561 } 7562 7563 /// DiagnoseConditionalPrecedence - Emit a warning when a conditional operator 7564 /// and binary operator are mixed in a way that suggests the programmer assumed 7565 /// the conditional operator has higher precedence, for example: 7566 /// "int x = a + someBinaryCondition ? 1 : 2". 7567 static void DiagnoseConditionalPrecedence(Sema &Self, 7568 SourceLocation OpLoc, 7569 Expr *Condition, 7570 Expr *LHSExpr, 7571 Expr *RHSExpr) { 7572 BinaryOperatorKind CondOpcode; 7573 Expr *CondRHS; 7574 7575 if (!IsArithmeticBinaryExpr(Condition, &CondOpcode, &CondRHS)) 7576 return; 7577 if (!ExprLooksBoolean(CondRHS)) 7578 return; 7579 7580 // The condition is an arithmetic binary expression, with a right- 7581 // hand side that looks boolean, so warn. 7582 7583 Self.Diag(OpLoc, diag::warn_precedence_conditional) 7584 << Condition->getSourceRange() 7585 << BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(CondOpcode); 7586 7587 SuggestParentheses( 7588 Self, OpLoc, 7589 Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_silence) 7590 << BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(CondOpcode), 7591 SourceRange(Condition->getBeginLoc(), Condition->getEndLoc())); 7592 7593 SuggestParentheses(Self, OpLoc, 7594 Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_conditional_first), 7595 SourceRange(CondRHS->getBeginLoc(), RHSExpr->getEndLoc())); 7596 } 7597 7598 /// Compute the nullability of a conditional expression. 7599 static QualType computeConditionalNullability(QualType ResTy, bool IsBin, 7600 QualType LHSTy, QualType RHSTy, 7601 ASTContext &Ctx) { 7602 if (!ResTy->isAnyPointerType()) 7603 return ResTy; 7604 7605 auto GetNullability = [&Ctx](QualType Ty) { 7606 Optional<NullabilityKind> Kind = Ty->getNullability(Ctx); 7607 if (Kind) 7608 return *Kind; 7609 return NullabilityKind::Unspecified; 7610 }; 7611 7612 auto LHSKind = GetNullability(LHSTy), RHSKind = GetNullability(RHSTy); 7613 NullabilityKind MergedKind; 7614 7615 // Compute nullability of a binary conditional expression. 7616 if (IsBin) { 7617 if (LHSKind == NullabilityKind::NonNull) 7618 MergedKind = NullabilityKind::NonNull; 7619 else 7620 MergedKind = RHSKind; 7621 // Compute nullability of a normal conditional expression. 7622 } else { 7623 if (LHSKind == NullabilityKind::Nullable || 7624 RHSKind == NullabilityKind::Nullable) 7625 MergedKind = NullabilityKind::Nullable; 7626 else if (LHSKind == NullabilityKind::NonNull) 7627 MergedKind = RHSKind; 7628 else if (RHSKind == NullabilityKind::NonNull) 7629 MergedKind = LHSKind; 7630 else 7631 MergedKind = NullabilityKind::Unspecified; 7632 } 7633 7634 // Return if ResTy already has the correct nullability. 7635 if (GetNullability(ResTy) == MergedKind) 7636 return ResTy; 7637 7638 // Strip all nullability from ResTy. 7639 while (ResTy->getNullability(Ctx)) 7640 ResTy = ResTy.getSingleStepDesugaredType(Ctx); 7641 7642 // Create a new AttributedType with the new nullability kind. 7643 auto NewAttr = AttributedType::getNullabilityAttrKind(MergedKind); 7644 return Ctx.getAttributedType(NewAttr, ResTy, ResTy); 7645 } 7646 7647 /// ActOnConditionalOp - Parse a ?: operation. Note that 'LHS' may be null 7648 /// in the case of a the GNU conditional expr extension. 7649 ExprResult Sema::ActOnConditionalOp(SourceLocation QuestionLoc, 7650 SourceLocation ColonLoc, 7651 Expr *CondExpr, Expr *LHSExpr, 7652 Expr *RHSExpr) { 7653 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 7654 // C cannot handle TypoExpr nodes in the condition because it 7655 // doesn't handle dependent types properly, so make sure any TypoExprs have 7656 // been dealt with before checking the operands. 7657 ExprResult CondResult = CorrectDelayedTyposInExpr(CondExpr); 7658 ExprResult LHSResult = CorrectDelayedTyposInExpr(LHSExpr); 7659 ExprResult RHSResult = CorrectDelayedTyposInExpr(RHSExpr); 7660 7661 if (!CondResult.isUsable()) 7662 return ExprError(); 7663 7664 if (LHSExpr) { 7665 if (!LHSResult.isUsable()) 7666 return ExprError(); 7667 } 7668 7669 if (!RHSResult.isUsable()) 7670 return ExprError(); 7671 7672 CondExpr = CondResult.get(); 7673 LHSExpr = LHSResult.get(); 7674 RHSExpr = RHSResult.get(); 7675 } 7676 7677 // If this is the gnu "x ?: y" extension, analyze the types as though the LHS 7678 // was the condition. 7679 OpaqueValueExpr *opaqueValue = nullptr; 7680 Expr *commonExpr = nullptr; 7681 if (!LHSExpr) { 7682 commonExpr = CondExpr; 7683 // Lower out placeholder types first. This is important so that we don't 7684 // try to capture a placeholder. This happens in few cases in C++; such 7685 // as Objective-C++'s dictionary subscripting syntax. 7686 if (commonExpr->hasPlaceholderType()) { 7687 ExprResult result = CheckPlaceholderExpr(commonExpr); 7688 if (!result.isUsable()) return ExprError(); 7689 commonExpr = result.get(); 7690 } 7691 // We usually want to apply unary conversions *before* saving, except 7692 // in the special case of a C++ l-value conditional. 7693 if (!(getLangOpts().CPlusPlus 7694 && !commonExpr->isTypeDependent() 7695 && commonExpr->getValueKind() == RHSExpr->getValueKind() 7696 && commonExpr->isGLValue() 7697 && commonExpr->isOrdinaryOrBitFieldObject() 7698 && RHSExpr->isOrdinaryOrBitFieldObject() 7699 && Context.hasSameType(commonExpr->getType(), RHSExpr->getType()))) { 7700 ExprResult commonRes = UsualUnaryConversions(commonExpr); 7701 if (commonRes.isInvalid()) 7702 return ExprError(); 7703 commonExpr = commonRes.get(); 7704 } 7705 7706 // If the common expression is a class or array prvalue, materialize it 7707 // so that we can safely refer to it multiple times. 7708 if (commonExpr->isRValue() && (commonExpr->getType()->isRecordType() || 7709 commonExpr->getType()->isArrayType())) { 7710 ExprResult MatExpr = TemporaryMaterializationConversion(commonExpr); 7711 if (MatExpr.isInvalid()) 7712 return ExprError(); 7713 commonExpr = MatExpr.get(); 7714 } 7715 7716 opaqueValue = new (Context) OpaqueValueExpr(commonExpr->getExprLoc(), 7717 commonExpr->getType(), 7718 commonExpr->getValueKind(), 7719 commonExpr->getObjectKind(), 7720 commonExpr); 7721 LHSExpr = CondExpr = opaqueValue; 7722 } 7723 7724 QualType LHSTy = LHSExpr->getType(), RHSTy = RHSExpr->getType(); 7725 ExprValueKind VK = VK_RValue; 7726 ExprObjectKind OK = OK_Ordinary; 7727 ExprResult Cond = CondExpr, LHS = LHSExpr, RHS = RHSExpr; 7728 QualType result = CheckConditionalOperands(Cond, LHS, RHS, 7729 VK, OK, QuestionLoc); 7730 if (result.isNull() || Cond.isInvalid() || LHS.isInvalid() || 7731 RHS.isInvalid()) 7732 return ExprError(); 7733 7734 DiagnoseConditionalPrecedence(*this, QuestionLoc, Cond.get(), LHS.get(), 7735 RHS.get()); 7736 7737 CheckBoolLikeConversion(Cond.get(), QuestionLoc); 7738 7739 result = computeConditionalNullability(result, commonExpr, LHSTy, RHSTy, 7740 Context); 7741 7742 if (!commonExpr) 7743 return new (Context) 7744 ConditionalOperator(Cond.get(), QuestionLoc, LHS.get(), ColonLoc, 7745 RHS.get(), result, VK, OK); 7746 7747 return new (Context) BinaryConditionalOperator( 7748 commonExpr, opaqueValue, Cond.get(), LHS.get(), RHS.get(), QuestionLoc, 7749 ColonLoc, result, VK, OK); 7750 } 7751 7752 // checkPointerTypesForAssignment - This is a very tricky routine (despite 7753 // being closely modeled after the C99 spec:-). The odd characteristic of this 7754 // routine is it effectively iqnores the qualifiers on the top level pointee. 7755 // This circumvents the usual type rules specified in 6.2.7p1 & 6.7.5.[1-3]. 7756 // FIXME: add a couple examples in this comment. 7757 static Sema::AssignConvertType 7758 checkPointerTypesForAssignment(Sema &S, QualType LHSType, QualType RHSType) { 7759 assert(LHSType.isCanonical() && "LHS not canonicalized!"); 7760 assert(RHSType.isCanonical() && "RHS not canonicalized!"); 7761 7762 // get the "pointed to" type (ignoring qualifiers at the top level) 7763 const Type *lhptee, *rhptee; 7764 Qualifiers lhq, rhq; 7765 std::tie(lhptee, lhq) = 7766 cast<PointerType>(LHSType)->getPointeeType().split().asPair(); 7767 std::tie(rhptee, rhq) = 7768 cast<PointerType>(RHSType)->getPointeeType().split().asPair(); 7769 7770 Sema::AssignConvertType ConvTy = Sema::Compatible; 7771 7772 // C99 6.5.16.1p1: This following citation is common to constraints 7773 // 3 & 4 (below). ...and the type *pointed to* by the left has all the 7774 // qualifiers of the type *pointed to* by the right; 7775 7776 // As a special case, 'non-__weak A *' -> 'non-__weak const *' is okay. 7777 if (lhq.getObjCLifetime() != rhq.getObjCLifetime() && 7778 lhq.compatiblyIncludesObjCLifetime(rhq)) { 7779 // Ignore lifetime for further calculation. 7780 lhq.removeObjCLifetime(); 7781 rhq.removeObjCLifetime(); 7782 } 7783 7784 if (!lhq.compatiblyIncludes(rhq)) { 7785 // Treat address-space mismatches as fatal. 7786 if (!lhq.isAddressSpaceSupersetOf(rhq)) 7787 return Sema::IncompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers; 7788 7789 // It's okay to add or remove GC or lifetime qualifiers when converting to 7790 // and from void*. 7791 else if (lhq.withoutObjCGCAttr().withoutObjCLifetime() 7792 .compatiblyIncludes( 7793 rhq.withoutObjCGCAttr().withoutObjCLifetime()) 7794 && (lhptee->isVoidType() || rhptee->isVoidType())) 7795 ; // keep old 7796 7797 // Treat lifetime mismatches as fatal. 7798 else if (lhq.getObjCLifetime() != rhq.getObjCLifetime()) 7799 ConvTy = Sema::IncompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers; 7800 7801 // For GCC/MS compatibility, other qualifier mismatches are treated 7802 // as still compatible in C. 7803 else ConvTy = Sema::CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers; 7804 } 7805 7806 // C99 6.5.16.1p1 (constraint 4): If one operand is a pointer to an object or 7807 // incomplete type and the other is a pointer to a qualified or unqualified 7808 // version of void... 7809 if (lhptee->isVoidType()) { 7810 if (rhptee->isIncompleteOrObjectType()) 7811 return ConvTy; 7812 7813 // As an extension, we allow cast to/from void* to function pointer. 7814 assert(rhptee->isFunctionType()); 7815 return Sema::FunctionVoidPointer; 7816 } 7817 7818 if (rhptee->isVoidType()) { 7819 if (lhptee->isIncompleteOrObjectType()) 7820 return ConvTy; 7821 7822 // As an extension, we allow cast to/from void* to function pointer. 7823 assert(lhptee->isFunctionType()); 7824 return Sema::FunctionVoidPointer; 7825 } 7826 7827 // C99 6.5.16.1p1 (constraint 3): both operands are pointers to qualified or 7828 // unqualified versions of compatible types, ... 7829 QualType ltrans = QualType(lhptee, 0), rtrans = QualType(rhptee, 0); 7830 if (!S.Context.typesAreCompatible(ltrans, rtrans)) { 7831 // Check if the pointee types are compatible ignoring the sign. 7832 // We explicitly check for char so that we catch "char" vs 7833 // "unsigned char" on systems where "char" is unsigned. 7834 if (lhptee->isCharType()) 7835 ltrans = S.Context.UnsignedCharTy; 7836 else if (lhptee->hasSignedIntegerRepresentation()) 7837 ltrans = S.Context.getCorrespondingUnsignedType(ltrans); 7838 7839 if (rhptee->isCharType()) 7840 rtrans = S.Context.UnsignedCharTy; 7841 else if (rhptee->hasSignedIntegerRepresentation()) 7842 rtrans = S.Context.getCorrespondingUnsignedType(rtrans); 7843 7844 if (ltrans == rtrans) { 7845 // Types are compatible ignoring the sign. Qualifier incompatibility 7846 // takes priority over sign incompatibility because the sign 7847 // warning can be disabled. 7848 if (ConvTy != Sema::Compatible) 7849 return ConvTy; 7850 7851 return Sema::IncompatiblePointerSign; 7852 } 7853 7854 // If we are a multi-level pointer, it's possible that our issue is simply 7855 // one of qualification - e.g. char ** -> const char ** is not allowed. If 7856 // the eventual target type is the same and the pointers have the same 7857 // level of indirection, this must be the issue. 7858 if (isa<PointerType>(lhptee) && isa<PointerType>(rhptee)) { 7859 do { 7860 std::tie(lhptee, lhq) = 7861 cast<PointerType>(lhptee)->getPointeeType().split().asPair(); 7862 std::tie(rhptee, rhq) = 7863 cast<PointerType>(rhptee)->getPointeeType().split().asPair(); 7864 7865 // Inconsistent address spaces at this point is invalid, even if the 7866 // address spaces would be compatible. 7867 // FIXME: This doesn't catch address space mismatches for pointers of 7868 // different nesting levels, like: 7869 // __local int *** a; 7870 // int ** b = a; 7871 // It's not clear how to actually determine when such pointers are 7872 // invalidly incompatible. 7873 if (lhq.getAddressSpace() != rhq.getAddressSpace()) 7874 return Sema::IncompatibleNestedPointerAddressSpaceMismatch; 7875 7876 } while (isa<PointerType>(lhptee) && isa<PointerType>(rhptee)); 7877 7878 if (lhptee == rhptee) 7879 return Sema::IncompatibleNestedPointerQualifiers; 7880 } 7881 7882 // General pointer incompatibility takes priority over qualifiers. 7883 return Sema::IncompatiblePointer; 7884 } 7885 if (!S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && 7886 S.IsFunctionConversion(ltrans, rtrans, ltrans)) 7887 return Sema::IncompatiblePointer; 7888 return ConvTy; 7889 } 7890 7891 /// checkBlockPointerTypesForAssignment - This routine determines whether two 7892 /// block pointer types are compatible or whether a block and normal pointer 7893 /// are compatible. It is more restrict than comparing two function pointer 7894 // types. 7895 static Sema::AssignConvertType 7896 checkBlockPointerTypesForAssignment(Sema &S, QualType LHSType, 7897 QualType RHSType) { 7898 assert(LHSType.isCanonical() && "LHS not canonicalized!"); 7899 assert(RHSType.isCanonical() && "RHS not canonicalized!"); 7900 7901 QualType lhptee, rhptee; 7902 7903 // get the "pointed to" type (ignoring qualifiers at the top level) 7904 lhptee = cast<BlockPointerType>(LHSType)->getPointeeType(); 7905 rhptee = cast<BlockPointerType>(RHSType)->getPointeeType(); 7906 7907 // In C++, the types have to match exactly. 7908 if (S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) 7909 return Sema::IncompatibleBlockPointer; 7910 7911 Sema::AssignConvertType ConvTy = Sema::Compatible; 7912 7913 // For blocks we enforce that qualifiers are identical. 7914 Qualifiers LQuals = lhptee.getLocalQualifiers(); 7915 Qualifiers RQuals = rhptee.getLocalQualifiers(); 7916 if (S.getLangOpts().OpenCL) { 7917 LQuals.removeAddressSpace(); 7918 RQuals.removeAddressSpace(); 7919 } 7920 if (LQuals != RQuals) 7921 ConvTy = Sema::CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers; 7922 7923 // FIXME: OpenCL doesn't define the exact compile time semantics for a block 7924 // assignment. 7925 // The current behavior is similar to C++ lambdas. A block might be 7926 // assigned to a variable iff its return type and parameters are compatible 7927 // (C99 6.2.7) with the corresponding return type and parameters of the LHS of 7928 // an assignment. Presumably it should behave in way that a function pointer 7929 // assignment does in C, so for each parameter and return type: 7930 // * CVR and address space of LHS should be a superset of CVR and address 7931 // space of RHS. 7932 // * unqualified types should be compatible. 7933 if (S.getLangOpts().OpenCL) { 7934 if (!S.Context.typesAreBlockPointerCompatible( 7935 S.Context.getQualifiedType(LHSType.getUnqualifiedType(), LQuals), 7936 S.Context.getQualifiedType(RHSType.getUnqualifiedType(), RQuals))) 7937 return Sema::IncompatibleBlockPointer; 7938 } else if (!S.Context.typesAreBlockPointerCompatible(LHSType, RHSType)) 7939 return Sema::IncompatibleBlockPointer; 7940 7941 return ConvTy; 7942 } 7943 7944 /// checkObjCPointerTypesForAssignment - Compares two objective-c pointer types 7945 /// for assignment compatibility. 7946 static Sema::AssignConvertType 7947 checkObjCPointerTypesForAssignment(Sema &S, QualType LHSType, 7948 QualType RHSType) { 7949 assert(LHSType.isCanonical() && "LHS was not canonicalized!"); 7950 assert(RHSType.isCanonical() && "RHS was not canonicalized!"); 7951 7952 if (LHSType->isObjCBuiltinType()) { 7953 // Class is not compatible with ObjC object pointers. 7954 if (LHSType->isObjCClassType() && !RHSType->isObjCBuiltinType() && 7955 !RHSType->isObjCQualifiedClassType()) 7956 return Sema::IncompatiblePointer; 7957 return Sema::Compatible; 7958 } 7959 if (RHSType->isObjCBuiltinType()) { 7960 if (RHSType->isObjCClassType() && !LHSType->isObjCBuiltinType() && 7961 !LHSType->isObjCQualifiedClassType()) 7962 return Sema::IncompatiblePointer; 7963 return Sema::Compatible; 7964 } 7965 QualType lhptee = LHSType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType(); 7966 QualType rhptee = RHSType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType(); 7967 7968 if (!lhptee.isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(rhptee) && 7969 // make an exception for id<P> 7970 !LHSType->isObjCQualifiedIdType()) 7971 return Sema::CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers; 7972 7973 if (S.Context.typesAreCompatible(LHSType, RHSType)) 7974 return Sema::Compatible; 7975 if (LHSType->isObjCQualifiedIdType() || RHSType->isObjCQualifiedIdType()) 7976 return Sema::IncompatibleObjCQualifiedId; 7977 return Sema::IncompatiblePointer; 7978 } 7979 7980 Sema::AssignConvertType 7981 Sema::CheckAssignmentConstraints(SourceLocation Loc, 7982 QualType LHSType, QualType RHSType) { 7983 // Fake up an opaque expression. We don't actually care about what 7984 // cast operations are required, so if CheckAssignmentConstraints 7985 // adds casts to this they'll be wasted, but fortunately that doesn't 7986 // usually happen on valid code. 7987 OpaqueValueExpr RHSExpr(Loc, RHSType, VK_RValue); 7988 ExprResult RHSPtr = &RHSExpr; 7989 CastKind K; 7990 7991 return CheckAssignmentConstraints(LHSType, RHSPtr, K, /*ConvertRHS=*/false); 7992 } 7993 7994 /// This helper function returns true if QT is a vector type that has element 7995 /// type ElementType. 7996 static bool isVector(QualType QT, QualType ElementType) { 7997 if (const VectorType *VT = QT->getAs<VectorType>()) 7998 return VT->getElementType() == ElementType; 7999 return false; 8000 } 8001 8002 /// CheckAssignmentConstraints (C99 6.5.16) - This routine currently 8003 /// has code to accommodate several GCC extensions when type checking 8004 /// pointers. Here are some objectionable examples that GCC considers warnings: 8005 /// 8006 /// int a, *pint; 8007 /// short *pshort; 8008 /// struct foo *pfoo; 8009 /// 8010 /// pint = pshort; // warning: assignment from incompatible pointer type 8011 /// a = pint; // warning: assignment makes integer from pointer without a cast 8012 /// pint = a; // warning: assignment makes pointer from integer without a cast 8013 /// pint = pfoo; // warning: assignment from incompatible pointer type 8014 /// 8015 /// As a result, the code for dealing with pointers is more complex than the 8016 /// C99 spec dictates. 8017 /// 8018 /// Sets 'Kind' for any result kind except Incompatible. 8019 Sema::AssignConvertType 8020 Sema::CheckAssignmentConstraints(QualType LHSType, ExprResult &RHS, 8021 CastKind &Kind, bool ConvertRHS) { 8022 QualType RHSType = RHS.get()->getType(); 8023 QualType OrigLHSType = LHSType; 8024 8025 // Get canonical types. We're not formatting these types, just comparing 8026 // them. 8027 LHSType = Context.getCanonicalType(LHSType).getUnqualifiedType(); 8028 RHSType = Context.getCanonicalType(RHSType).getUnqualifiedType(); 8029 8030 // Common case: no conversion required. 8031 if (LHSType == RHSType) { 8032 Kind = CK_NoOp; 8033 return Compatible; 8034 } 8035 8036 // If we have an atomic type, try a non-atomic assignment, then just add an 8037 // atomic qualification step. 8038 if (const AtomicType *AtomicTy = dyn_cast<AtomicType>(LHSType)) { 8039 Sema::AssignConvertType result = 8040 CheckAssignmentConstraints(AtomicTy->getValueType(), RHS, Kind); 8041 if (result != Compatible) 8042 return result; 8043 if (Kind != CK_NoOp && ConvertRHS) 8044 RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), AtomicTy->getValueType(), Kind); 8045 Kind = CK_NonAtomicToAtomic; 8046 return Compatible; 8047 } 8048 8049 // If the left-hand side is a reference type, then we are in a 8050 // (rare!) case where we've allowed the use of references in C, 8051 // e.g., as a parameter type in a built-in function. In this case, 8052 // just make sure that the type referenced is compatible with the 8053 // right-hand side type. The caller is responsible for adjusting 8054 // LHSType so that the resulting expression does not have reference 8055 // type. 8056 if (const ReferenceType *LHSTypeRef = LHSType->getAs<ReferenceType>()) { 8057 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(LHSTypeRef->getPointeeType(), RHSType)) { 8058 Kind = CK_LValueBitCast; 8059 return Compatible; 8060 } 8061 return Incompatible; 8062 } 8063 8064 // Allow scalar to ExtVector assignments, and assignments of an ExtVector type 8065 // to the same ExtVector type. 8066 if (LHSType->isExtVectorType()) { 8067 if (RHSType->isExtVectorType()) 8068 return Incompatible; 8069 if (RHSType->isArithmeticType()) { 8070 // CK_VectorSplat does T -> vector T, so first cast to the element type. 8071 if (ConvertRHS) 8072 RHS = prepareVectorSplat(LHSType, RHS.get()); 8073 Kind = CK_VectorSplat; 8074 return Compatible; 8075 } 8076 } 8077 8078 // Conversions to or from vector type. 8079 if (LHSType->isVectorType() || RHSType->isVectorType()) { 8080 if (LHSType->isVectorType() && RHSType->isVectorType()) { 8081 // Allow assignments of an AltiVec vector type to an equivalent GCC 8082 // vector type and vice versa 8083 if (Context.areCompatibleVectorTypes(LHSType, RHSType)) { 8084 Kind = CK_BitCast; 8085 return Compatible; 8086 } 8087 8088 // If we are allowing lax vector conversions, and LHS and RHS are both 8089 // vectors, the total size only needs to be the same. This is a bitcast; 8090 // no bits are changed but the result type is different. 8091 if (isLaxVectorConversion(RHSType, LHSType)) { 8092 Kind = CK_BitCast; 8093 return IncompatibleVectors; 8094 } 8095 } 8096 8097 // When the RHS comes from another lax conversion (e.g. binops between 8098 // scalars and vectors) the result is canonicalized as a vector. When the 8099 // LHS is also a vector, the lax is allowed by the condition above. Handle 8100 // the case where LHS is a scalar. 8101 if (LHSType->isScalarType()) { 8102 const VectorType *VecType = RHSType->getAs<VectorType>(); 8103 if (VecType && VecType->getNumElements() == 1 && 8104 isLaxVectorConversion(RHSType, LHSType)) { 8105 ExprResult *VecExpr = &RHS; 8106 *VecExpr = ImpCastExprToType(VecExpr->get(), LHSType, CK_BitCast); 8107 Kind = CK_BitCast; 8108 return Compatible; 8109 } 8110 } 8111 8112 return Incompatible; 8113 } 8114 8115 // Diagnose attempts to convert between __float128 and long double where 8116 // such conversions currently can't be handled. 8117 if (unsupportedTypeConversion(*this, LHSType, RHSType)) 8118 return Incompatible; 8119 8120 // Disallow assigning a _Complex to a real type in C++ mode since it simply 8121 // discards the imaginary part. 8122 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && RHSType->getAs<ComplexType>() && 8123 !LHSType->getAs<ComplexType>()) 8124 return Incompatible; 8125 8126 // Arithmetic conversions. 8127 if (LHSType->isArithmeticType() && RHSType->isArithmeticType() && 8128 !(getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && LHSType->isEnumeralType())) { 8129 if (ConvertRHS) 8130 Kind = PrepareScalarCast(RHS, LHSType); 8131 return Compatible; 8132 } 8133 8134 // Conversions to normal pointers. 8135 if (const PointerType *LHSPointer = dyn_cast<PointerType>(LHSType)) { 8136 // U* -> T* 8137 if (isa<PointerType>(RHSType)) { 8138 LangAS AddrSpaceL = LHSPointer->getPointeeType().getAddressSpace(); 8139 LangAS AddrSpaceR = RHSType->getPointeeType().getAddressSpace(); 8140 if (AddrSpaceL != AddrSpaceR) 8141 Kind = CK_AddressSpaceConversion; 8142 else if (Context.hasCvrSimilarType(RHSType, LHSType)) 8143 Kind = CK_NoOp; 8144 else 8145 Kind = CK_BitCast; 8146 return checkPointerTypesForAssignment(*this, LHSType, RHSType); 8147 } 8148 8149 // int -> T* 8150 if (RHSType->isIntegerType()) { 8151 Kind = CK_IntegralToPointer; // FIXME: null? 8152 return IntToPointer; 8153 } 8154 8155 // C pointers are not compatible with ObjC object pointers, 8156 // with two exceptions: 8157 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(RHSType)) { 8158 // - conversions to void* 8159 if (LHSPointer->getPointeeType()->isVoidType()) { 8160 Kind = CK_BitCast; 8161 return Compatible; 8162 } 8163 8164 // - conversions from 'Class' to the redefinition type 8165 if (RHSType->isObjCClassType() && 8166 Context.hasSameType(LHSType, 8167 Context.getObjCClassRedefinitionType())) { 8168 Kind = CK_BitCast; 8169 return Compatible; 8170 } 8171 8172 Kind = CK_BitCast; 8173 return IncompatiblePointer; 8174 } 8175 8176 // U^ -> void* 8177 if (RHSType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()) { 8178 if (LHSPointer->getPointeeType()->isVoidType()) { 8179 LangAS AddrSpaceL = LHSPointer->getPointeeType().getAddressSpace(); 8180 LangAS AddrSpaceR = RHSType->getAs<BlockPointerType>() 8181 ->getPointeeType() 8182 .getAddressSpace(); 8183 Kind = 8184 AddrSpaceL != AddrSpaceR ? CK_AddressSpaceConversion : CK_BitCast; 8185 return Compatible; 8186 } 8187 } 8188 8189 return Incompatible; 8190 } 8191 8192 // Conversions to block pointers. 8193 if (isa<BlockPointerType>(LHSType)) { 8194 // U^ -> T^ 8195 if (RHSType->isBlockPointerType()) { 8196 LangAS AddrSpaceL = LHSType->getAs<BlockPointerType>() 8197 ->getPointeeType() 8198 .getAddressSpace(); 8199 LangAS AddrSpaceR = RHSType->getAs<BlockPointerType>() 8200 ->getPointeeType() 8201 .getAddressSpace(); 8202 Kind = AddrSpaceL != AddrSpaceR ? CK_AddressSpaceConversion : CK_BitCast; 8203 return checkBlockPointerTypesForAssignment(*this, LHSType, RHSType); 8204 } 8205 8206 // int or null -> T^ 8207 if (RHSType->isIntegerType()) { 8208 Kind = CK_IntegralToPointer; // FIXME: null 8209 return IntToBlockPointer; 8210 } 8211 8212 // id -> T^ 8213 if (getLangOpts().ObjC && RHSType->isObjCIdType()) { 8214 Kind = CK_AnyPointerToBlockPointerCast; 8215 return Compatible; 8216 } 8217 8218 // void* -> T^ 8219 if (const PointerType *RHSPT = RHSType->getAs<PointerType>()) 8220 if (RHSPT->getPointeeType()->isVoidType()) { 8221 Kind = CK_AnyPointerToBlockPointerCast; 8222 return Compatible; 8223 } 8224 8225 return Incompatible; 8226 } 8227 8228 // Conversions to Objective-C pointers. 8229 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(LHSType)) { 8230 // A* -> B* 8231 if (RHSType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) { 8232 Kind = CK_BitCast; 8233 Sema::AssignConvertType result = 8234 checkObjCPointerTypesForAssignment(*this, LHSType, RHSType); 8235 if (getLangOpts().allowsNonTrivialObjCLifetimeQualifiers() && 8236 result == Compatible && 8237 !CheckObjCARCUnavailableWeakConversion(OrigLHSType, RHSType)) 8238 result = IncompatibleObjCWeakRef; 8239 return result; 8240 } 8241 8242 // int or null -> A* 8243 if (RHSType->isIntegerType()) { 8244 Kind = CK_IntegralToPointer; // FIXME: null 8245 return IntToPointer; 8246 } 8247 8248 // In general, C pointers are not compatible with ObjC object pointers, 8249 // with two exceptions: 8250 if (isa<PointerType>(RHSType)) { 8251 Kind = CK_CPointerToObjCPointerCast; 8252 8253 // - conversions from 'void*' 8254 if (RHSType->isVoidPointerType()) { 8255 return Compatible; 8256 } 8257 8258 // - conversions to 'Class' from its redefinition type 8259 if (LHSType->isObjCClassType() && 8260 Context.hasSameType(RHSType, 8261 Context.getObjCClassRedefinitionType())) { 8262 return Compatible; 8263 } 8264 8265 return IncompatiblePointer; 8266 } 8267 8268 // Only under strict condition T^ is compatible with an Objective-C pointer. 8269 if (RHSType->isBlockPointerType() && 8270 LHSType->isBlockCompatibleObjCPointerType(Context)) { 8271 if (ConvertRHS) 8272 maybeExtendBlockObject(RHS); 8273 Kind = CK_BlockPointerToObjCPointerCast; 8274 return Compatible; 8275 } 8276 8277 return Incompatible; 8278 } 8279 8280 // Conversions from pointers that are not covered by the above. 8281 if (isa<PointerType>(RHSType)) { 8282 // T* -> _Bool 8283 if (LHSType == Context.BoolTy) { 8284 Kind = CK_PointerToBoolean; 8285 return Compatible; 8286 } 8287 8288 // T* -> int 8289 if (LHSType->isIntegerType()) { 8290 Kind = CK_PointerToIntegral; 8291 return PointerToInt; 8292 } 8293 8294 return Incompatible; 8295 } 8296 8297 // Conversions from Objective-C pointers that are not covered by the above. 8298 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(RHSType)) { 8299 // T* -> _Bool 8300 if (LHSType == Context.BoolTy) { 8301 Kind = CK_PointerToBoolean; 8302 return Compatible; 8303 } 8304 8305 // T* -> int 8306 if (LHSType->isIntegerType()) { 8307 Kind = CK_PointerToIntegral; 8308 return PointerToInt; 8309 } 8310 8311 return Incompatible; 8312 } 8313 8314 // struct A -> struct B 8315 if (isa<TagType>(LHSType) && isa<TagType>(RHSType)) { 8316 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(LHSType, RHSType)) { 8317 Kind = CK_NoOp; 8318 return Compatible; 8319 } 8320 } 8321 8322 if (LHSType->isSamplerT() && RHSType->isIntegerType()) { 8323 Kind = CK_IntToOCLSampler; 8324 return Compatible; 8325 } 8326 8327 return Incompatible; 8328 } 8329 8330 /// Constructs a transparent union from an expression that is 8331 /// used to initialize the transparent union. 8332 static void ConstructTransparentUnion(Sema &S, ASTContext &C, 8333 ExprResult &EResult, QualType UnionType, 8334 FieldDecl *Field) { 8335 // Build an initializer list that designates the appropriate member 8336 // of the transparent union. 8337 Expr *E = EResult.get(); 8338 InitListExpr *Initializer = new (C) InitListExpr(C, SourceLocation(), 8339 E, SourceLocation()); 8340 Initializer->setType(UnionType); 8341 Initializer->setInitializedFieldInUnion(Field); 8342 8343 // Build a compound literal constructing a value of the transparent 8344 // union type from this initializer list. 8345 TypeSourceInfo *unionTInfo = C.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(UnionType); 8346 EResult = new (C) CompoundLiteralExpr(SourceLocation(), unionTInfo, UnionType, 8347 VK_RValue, Initializer, false); 8348 } 8349 8350 Sema::AssignConvertType 8351 Sema::CheckTransparentUnionArgumentConstraints(QualType ArgType, 8352 ExprResult &RHS) { 8353 QualType RHSType = RHS.get()->getType(); 8354 8355 // If the ArgType is a Union type, we want to handle a potential 8356 // transparent_union GCC extension. 8357 const RecordType *UT = ArgType->getAsUnionType(); 8358 if (!UT || !UT->getDecl()->hasAttr<TransparentUnionAttr>()) 8359 return Incompatible; 8360 8361 // The field to initialize within the transparent union. 8362 RecordDecl *UD = UT->getDecl(); 8363 FieldDecl *InitField = nullptr; 8364 // It's compatible if the expression matches any of the fields. 8365 for (auto *it : UD->fields()) { 8366 if (it->getType()->isPointerType()) { 8367 // If the transparent union contains a pointer type, we allow: 8368 // 1) void pointer 8369 // 2) null pointer constant 8370 if (RHSType->isPointerType()) 8371 if (RHSType->castAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->isVoidType()) { 8372 RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), it->getType(), CK_BitCast); 8373 InitField = it; 8374 break; 8375 } 8376 8377 if (RHS.get()->isNullPointerConstant(Context, 8378 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) { 8379 RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), it->getType(), 8380 CK_NullToPointer); 8381 InitField = it; 8382 break; 8383 } 8384 } 8385 8386 CastKind Kind; 8387 if (CheckAssignmentConstraints(it->getType(), RHS, Kind) 8388 == Compatible) { 8389 RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), it->getType(), Kind); 8390 InitField = it; 8391 break; 8392 } 8393 } 8394 8395 if (!InitField) 8396 return Incompatible; 8397 8398 ConstructTransparentUnion(*this, Context, RHS, ArgType, InitField); 8399 return Compatible; 8400 } 8401 8402 Sema::AssignConvertType 8403 Sema::CheckSingleAssignmentConstraints(QualType LHSType, ExprResult &CallerRHS, 8404 bool Diagnose, 8405 bool DiagnoseCFAudited, 8406 bool ConvertRHS) { 8407 // We need to be able to tell the caller whether we diagnosed a problem, if 8408 // they ask us to issue diagnostics. 8409 assert((ConvertRHS || !Diagnose) && "can't indicate whether we diagnosed"); 8410 8411 // If ConvertRHS is false, we want to leave the caller's RHS untouched. Sadly, 8412 // we can't avoid *all* modifications at the moment, so we need some somewhere 8413 // to put the updated value. 8414 ExprResult LocalRHS = CallerRHS; 8415 ExprResult &RHS = ConvertRHS ? CallerRHS : LocalRHS; 8416 8417 if (const auto *LHSPtrType = LHSType->getAs<PointerType>()) { 8418 if (const auto *RHSPtrType = RHS.get()->getType()->getAs<PointerType>()) { 8419 if (RHSPtrType->getPointeeType()->hasAttr(attr::NoDeref) && 8420 !LHSPtrType->getPointeeType()->hasAttr(attr::NoDeref)) { 8421 Diag(RHS.get()->getExprLoc(), 8422 diag::warn_noderef_to_dereferenceable_pointer) 8423 << RHS.get()->getSourceRange(); 8424 } 8425 } 8426 } 8427 8428 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 8429 if (!LHSType->isRecordType() && !LHSType->isAtomicType()) { 8430 // C++ 5.17p3: If the left operand is not of class type, the 8431 // expression is implicitly converted (C++ 4) to the 8432 // cv-unqualified type of the left operand. 8433 QualType RHSType = RHS.get()->getType(); 8434 if (Diagnose) { 8435 RHS = PerformImplicitConversion(RHS.get(), LHSType.getUnqualifiedType(), 8436 AA_Assigning); 8437 } else { 8438 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS = 8439 TryImplicitConversion(RHS.get(), LHSType.getUnqualifiedType(), 8440 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false, 8441 /*AllowExplicit=*/false, 8442 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false, 8443 /*CStyle=*/false, 8444 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/false); 8445 if (ICS.isFailure()) 8446 return Incompatible; 8447 RHS = PerformImplicitConversion(RHS.get(), LHSType.getUnqualifiedType(), 8448 ICS, AA_Assigning); 8449 } 8450 if (RHS.isInvalid()) 8451 return Incompatible; 8452 Sema::AssignConvertType result = Compatible; 8453 if (getLangOpts().allowsNonTrivialObjCLifetimeQualifiers() && 8454 !CheckObjCARCUnavailableWeakConversion(LHSType, RHSType)) 8455 result = IncompatibleObjCWeakRef; 8456 return result; 8457 } 8458 8459 // FIXME: Currently, we fall through and treat C++ classes like C 8460 // structures. 8461 // FIXME: We also fall through for atomics; not sure what should 8462 // happen there, though. 8463 } else if (RHS.get()->getType() == Context.OverloadTy) { 8464 // As a set of extensions to C, we support overloading on functions. These 8465 // functions need to be resolved here. 8466 DeclAccessPair DAP; 8467 if (FunctionDecl *FD = ResolveAddressOfOverloadedFunction( 8468 RHS.get(), LHSType, /*Complain=*/false, DAP)) 8469 RHS = FixOverloadedFunctionReference(RHS.get(), DAP, FD); 8470 else 8471 return Incompatible; 8472 } 8473 8474 // C99 6.5.16.1p1: the left operand is a pointer and the right is 8475 // a null pointer constant. 8476 if ((LHSType->isPointerType() || LHSType->isObjCObjectPointerType() || 8477 LHSType->isBlockPointerType()) && 8478 RHS.get()->isNullPointerConstant(Context, 8479 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) { 8480 if (Diagnose || ConvertRHS) { 8481 CastKind Kind; 8482 CXXCastPath Path; 8483 CheckPointerConversion(RHS.get(), LHSType, Kind, Path, 8484 /*IgnoreBaseAccess=*/false, Diagnose); 8485 if (ConvertRHS) 8486 RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), LHSType, Kind, VK_RValue, &Path); 8487 } 8488 return Compatible; 8489 } 8490 8491 // OpenCL queue_t type assignment. 8492 if (LHSType->isQueueT() && RHS.get()->isNullPointerConstant( 8493 Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) { 8494 RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), LHSType, CK_NullToPointer); 8495 return Compatible; 8496 } 8497 8498 // This check seems unnatural, however it is necessary to ensure the proper 8499 // conversion of functions/arrays. If the conversion were done for all 8500 // DeclExpr's (created by ActOnIdExpression), it would mess up the unary 8501 // expressions that suppress this implicit conversion (&, sizeof). 8502 // 8503 // Suppress this for references: C++ 8.5.3p5. 8504 if (!LHSType->isReferenceType()) { 8505 // FIXME: We potentially allocate here even if ConvertRHS is false. 8506 RHS = DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(RHS.get(), Diagnose); 8507 if (RHS.isInvalid()) 8508 return Incompatible; 8509 } 8510 CastKind Kind; 8511 Sema::AssignConvertType result = 8512 CheckAssignmentConstraints(LHSType, RHS, Kind, ConvertRHS); 8513 8514 // C99 6.5.16.1p2: The value of the right operand is converted to the 8515 // type of the assignment expression. 8516 // CheckAssignmentConstraints allows the left-hand side to be a reference, 8517 // so that we can use references in built-in functions even in C. 8518 // The getNonReferenceType() call makes sure that the resulting expression 8519 // does not have reference type. 8520 if (result != Incompatible && RHS.get()->getType() != LHSType) { 8521 QualType Ty = LHSType.getNonLValueExprType(Context); 8522 Expr *E = RHS.get(); 8523 8524 // Check for various Objective-C errors. If we are not reporting 8525 // diagnostics and just checking for errors, e.g., during overload 8526 // resolution, return Incompatible to indicate the failure. 8527 if (getLangOpts().allowsNonTrivialObjCLifetimeQualifiers() && 8528 CheckObjCConversion(SourceRange(), Ty, E, CCK_ImplicitConversion, 8529 Diagnose, DiagnoseCFAudited) != ACR_okay) { 8530 if (!Diagnose) 8531 return Incompatible; 8532 } 8533 if (getLangOpts().ObjC && 8534 (CheckObjCBridgeRelatedConversions(E->getBeginLoc(), LHSType, 8535 E->getType(), E, Diagnose) || 8536 ConversionToObjCStringLiteralCheck(LHSType, E, Diagnose))) { 8537 if (!Diagnose) 8538 return Incompatible; 8539 // Replace the expression with a corrected version and continue so we 8540 // can find further errors. 8541 RHS = E; 8542 return Compatible; 8543 } 8544 8545 if (ConvertRHS) 8546 RHS = ImpCastExprToType(E, Ty, Kind); 8547 } 8548 8549 return result; 8550 } 8551 8552 namespace { 8553 /// The original operand to an operator, prior to the application of the usual 8554 /// arithmetic conversions and converting the arguments of a builtin operator 8555 /// candidate. 8556 struct OriginalOperand { 8557 explicit OriginalOperand(Expr *Op) : Orig(Op), Conversion(nullptr) { 8558 if (auto *MTE = dyn_cast<MaterializeTemporaryExpr>(Op)) 8559 Op = MTE->GetTemporaryExpr(); 8560 if (auto *BTE = dyn_cast<CXXBindTemporaryExpr>(Op)) 8561 Op = BTE->getSubExpr(); 8562 if (auto *ICE = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(Op)) { 8563 Orig = ICE->getSubExprAsWritten(); 8564 Conversion = ICE->getConversionFunction(); 8565 } 8566 } 8567 8568 QualType getType() const { return Orig->getType(); } 8569 8570 Expr *Orig; 8571 NamedDecl *Conversion; 8572 }; 8573 } 8574 8575 QualType Sema::InvalidOperands(SourceLocation Loc, ExprResult &LHS, 8576 ExprResult &RHS) { 8577 OriginalOperand OrigLHS(LHS.get()), OrigRHS(RHS.get()); 8578 8579 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_invalid_operands) 8580 << OrigLHS.getType() << OrigRHS.getType() 8581 << LHS.get()->getSourceRange() << RHS.get()->getSourceRange(); 8582 8583 // If a user-defined conversion was applied to either of the operands prior 8584 // to applying the built-in operator rules, tell the user about it. 8585 if (OrigLHS.Conversion) { 8586 Diag(OrigLHS.Conversion->getLocation(), 8587 diag::note_typecheck_invalid_operands_converted) 8588 << 0 << LHS.get()->getType(); 8589 } 8590 if (OrigRHS.Conversion) { 8591 Diag(OrigRHS.Conversion->getLocation(), 8592 diag::note_typecheck_invalid_operands_converted) 8593 << 1 << RHS.get()->getType(); 8594 } 8595 8596 return QualType(); 8597 } 8598 8599 // Diagnose cases where a scalar was implicitly converted to a vector and 8600 // diagnose the underlying types. Otherwise, diagnose the error 8601 // as invalid vector logical operands for non-C++ cases. 8602 QualType Sema::InvalidLogicalVectorOperands(SourceLocation Loc, ExprResult &LHS, 8603 ExprResult &RHS) { 8604 QualType LHSType = LHS.get()->IgnoreImpCasts()->getType(); 8605 QualType RHSType = RHS.get()->IgnoreImpCasts()->getType(); 8606 8607 bool LHSNatVec = LHSType->isVectorType(); 8608 bool RHSNatVec = RHSType->isVectorType(); 8609 8610 if (!(LHSNatVec && RHSNatVec)) { 8611 Expr *Vector = LHSNatVec ? LHS.get() : RHS.get(); 8612 Expr *NonVector = !LHSNatVec ? LHS.get() : RHS.get(); 8613 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_logical_vector_expr_gnu_cpp_restrict) 8614 << 0 << Vector->getType() << NonVector->IgnoreImpCasts()->getType() 8615 << Vector->getSourceRange(); 8616 return QualType(); 8617 } 8618 8619 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_logical_vector_expr_gnu_cpp_restrict) 8620 << 1 << LHSType << RHSType << LHS.get()->getSourceRange() 8621 << RHS.get()->getSourceRange(); 8622 8623 return QualType(); 8624 } 8625 8626 /// Try to convert a value of non-vector type to a vector type by converting 8627 /// the type to the element type of the vector and then performing a splat. 8628 /// If the language is OpenCL, we only use conversions that promote scalar 8629 /// rank; for C, Obj-C, and C++ we allow any real scalar conversion except 8630 /// for float->int. 8631 /// 8632 /// OpenCL V2.0 6.2.6.p2: 8633 /// An error shall occur if any scalar operand type has greater rank 8634 /// than the type of the vector element. 8635 /// 8636 /// \param scalar - if non-null, actually perform the conversions 8637 /// \return true if the operation fails (but without diagnosing the failure) 8638 static bool tryVectorConvertAndSplat(Sema &S, ExprResult *scalar, 8639 QualType scalarTy, 8640 QualType vectorEltTy, 8641 QualType vectorTy, 8642 unsigned &DiagID) { 8643 // The conversion to apply to the scalar before splatting it, 8644 // if necessary. 8645 CastKind scalarCast = CK_NoOp; 8646 8647 if (vectorEltTy->isIntegralType(S.Context)) { 8648 if (S.getLangOpts().OpenCL && (scalarTy->isRealFloatingType() || 8649 (scalarTy->isIntegerType() && 8650 S.Context.getIntegerTypeOrder(vectorEltTy, scalarTy) < 0))) { 8651 DiagID = diag::err_opencl_scalar_type_rank_greater_than_vector_type; 8652 return true; 8653 } 8654 if (!scalarTy->isIntegralType(S.Context)) 8655 return true; 8656 scalarCast = CK_IntegralCast; 8657 } else if (vectorEltTy->isRealFloatingType()) { 8658 if (scalarTy->isRealFloatingType()) { 8659 if (S.getLangOpts().OpenCL && 8660 S.Context.getFloatingTypeOrder(vectorEltTy, scalarTy) < 0) { 8661 DiagID = diag::err_opencl_scalar_type_rank_greater_than_vector_type; 8662 return true; 8663 } 8664 scalarCast = CK_FloatingCast; 8665 } 8666 else if (scalarTy->isIntegralType(S.Context)) 8667 scalarCast = CK_IntegralToFloating; 8668 else 8669 return true; 8670 } else { 8671 return true; 8672 } 8673 8674 // Adjust scalar if desired. 8675 if (scalar) { 8676 if (scalarCast != CK_NoOp) 8677 *scalar = S.ImpCastExprToType(scalar->get(), vectorEltTy, scalarCast); 8678 *scalar = S.ImpCastExprToType(scalar->get(), vectorTy, CK_VectorSplat); 8679 } 8680 return false; 8681 } 8682 8683 /// Convert vector E to a vector with the same number of elements but different 8684 /// element type. 8685 static ExprResult convertVector(Expr *E, QualType ElementType, Sema &S) { 8686 const auto *VecTy = E->getType()->getAs<VectorType>(); 8687 assert(VecTy && "Expression E must be a vector"); 8688 QualType NewVecTy = S.Context.getVectorType(ElementType, 8689 VecTy->getNumElements(), 8690 VecTy->getVectorKind()); 8691 8692 // Look through the implicit cast. Return the subexpression if its type is 8693 // NewVecTy. 8694 if (auto *ICE = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(E)) 8695 if (ICE->getSubExpr()->getType() == NewVecTy) 8696 return ICE->getSubExpr(); 8697 8698 auto Cast = ElementType->isIntegerType() ? CK_IntegralCast : CK_FloatingCast; 8699 return S.ImpCastExprToType(E, NewVecTy, Cast); 8700 } 8701 8702 /// Test if a (constant) integer Int can be casted to another integer type 8703 /// IntTy without losing precision. 8704 static bool canConvertIntToOtherIntTy(Sema &S, ExprResult *Int, 8705 QualType OtherIntTy) { 8706 QualType IntTy = Int->get()->getType().getUnqualifiedType(); 8707 8708 // Reject cases where the value of the Int is unknown as that would 8709 // possibly cause truncation, but accept cases where the scalar can be 8710 // demoted without loss of precision. 8711 Expr::EvalResult EVResult; 8712 bool CstInt = Int->get()->EvaluateAsInt(EVResult, S.Context); 8713 int Order = S.Context.getIntegerTypeOrder(OtherIntTy, IntTy); 8714 bool IntSigned = IntTy->hasSignedIntegerRepresentation(); 8715 bool OtherIntSigned = OtherIntTy->hasSignedIntegerRepresentation(); 8716 8717 if (CstInt) { 8718 // If the scalar is constant and is of a higher order and has more active 8719 // bits that the vector element type, reject it. 8720 llvm::APSInt Result = EVResult.Val.getInt(); 8721 unsigned NumBits = IntSigned 8722 ? (Result.isNegative() ? Result.getMinSignedBits() 8723 : Result.getActiveBits()) 8724 : Result.getActiveBits(); 8725 if (Order < 0 && S.Context.getIntWidth(OtherIntTy) < NumBits) 8726 return true; 8727 8728 // If the signedness of the scalar type and the vector element type 8729 // differs and the number of bits is greater than that of the vector 8730 // element reject it. 8731 return (IntSigned != OtherIntSigned && 8732 NumBits > S.Context.getIntWidth(OtherIntTy)); 8733 } 8734 8735 // Reject cases where the value of the scalar is not constant and it's 8736 // order is greater than that of the vector element type. 8737 return (Order < 0); 8738 } 8739 8740 /// Test if a (constant) integer Int can be casted to floating point type 8741 /// FloatTy without losing precision. 8742 static bool canConvertIntTyToFloatTy(Sema &S, ExprResult *Int, 8743 QualType FloatTy) { 8744 QualType IntTy = Int->get()->getType().getUnqualifiedType(); 8745 8746 // Determine if the integer constant can be expressed as a floating point 8747 // number of the appropriate type. 8748 Expr::EvalResult EVResult; 8749 bool CstInt = Int->get()->EvaluateAsInt(EVResult, S.Context); 8750 8751 uint64_t Bits = 0; 8752 if (CstInt) { 8753 // Reject constants that would be truncated if they were converted to 8754 // the floating point type. Test by simple to/from conversion. 8755 // FIXME: Ideally the conversion to an APFloat and from an APFloat 8756 // could be avoided if there was a convertFromAPInt method 8757 // which could signal back if implicit truncation occurred. 8758 llvm::APSInt Result = EVResult.Val.getInt(); 8759 llvm::APFloat Float(S.Context.getFloatTypeSemantics(FloatTy)); 8760 Float.convertFromAPInt(Result, IntTy->hasSignedIntegerRepresentation(), 8761 llvm::APFloat::rmTowardZero); 8762 llvm::APSInt ConvertBack(S.Context.getIntWidth(IntTy), 8763 !IntTy->hasSignedIntegerRepresentation()); 8764 bool Ignored = false; 8765 Float.convertToInteger(ConvertBack, llvm::APFloat::rmNearestTiesToEven, 8766 &Ignored); 8767 if (Result != ConvertBack) 8768 return true; 8769 } else { 8770 // Reject types that cannot be fully encoded into the mantissa of 8771 // the float. 8772 Bits = S.Context.getTypeSize(IntTy); 8773 unsigned FloatPrec = llvm::APFloat::semanticsPrecision( 8774 S.Context.getFloatTypeSemantics(FloatTy)); 8775 if (Bits > FloatPrec) 8776 return true; 8777 } 8778 8779 return false; 8780 } 8781 8782 /// Attempt to convert and splat Scalar into a vector whose types matches 8783 /// Vector following GCC conversion rules. The rule is that implicit 8784 /// conversion can occur when Scalar can be casted to match Vector's element 8785 /// type without causing truncation of Scalar. 8786 static bool tryGCCVectorConvertAndSplat(Sema &S, ExprResult *Scalar, 8787 ExprResult *Vector) { 8788 QualType ScalarTy = Scalar->get()->getType().getUnqualifiedType(); 8789 QualType VectorTy = Vector->get()->getType().getUnqualifiedType(); 8790 const VectorType *VT = VectorTy->getAs<VectorType>(); 8791 8792 assert(!isa<ExtVectorType>(VT) && 8793 "ExtVectorTypes should not be handled here!"); 8794 8795 QualType VectorEltTy = VT->getElementType(); 8796 8797 // Reject cases where the vector element type or the scalar element type are 8798 // not integral or floating point types. 8799 if (!VectorEltTy->isArithmeticType() || !ScalarTy->isArithmeticType()) 8800 return true; 8801 8802 // The conversion to apply to the scalar before splatting it, 8803 // if necessary. 8804 CastKind ScalarCast = CK_NoOp; 8805 8806 // Accept cases where the vector elements are integers and the scalar is 8807 // an integer. 8808 // FIXME: Notionally if the scalar was a floating point value with a precise 8809 // integral representation, we could cast it to an appropriate integer 8810 // type and then perform the rest of the checks here. GCC will perform 8811 // this conversion in some cases as determined by the input language. 8812 // We should accept it on a language independent basis. 8813 if (VectorEltTy->isIntegralType(S.Context) && 8814 ScalarTy->isIntegralType(S.Context) && 8815 S.Context.getIntegerTypeOrder(VectorEltTy, ScalarTy)) { 8816 8817 if (canConvertIntToOtherIntTy(S, Scalar, VectorEltTy)) 8818 return true; 8819 8820 ScalarCast = CK_IntegralCast; 8821 } else if (VectorEltTy->isRealFloatingType()) { 8822 if (ScalarTy->isRealFloatingType()) { 8823 8824 // Reject cases where the scalar type is not a constant and has a higher 8825 // Order than the vector element type. 8826 llvm::APFloat Result(0.0); 8827 bool CstScalar = Scalar->get()->EvaluateAsFloat(Result, S.Context); 8828 int Order = S.Context.getFloatingTypeOrder(VectorEltTy, ScalarTy); 8829 if (!CstScalar && Order < 0) 8830 return true; 8831 8832 // If the scalar cannot be safely casted to the vector element type, 8833 // reject it. 8834 if (CstScalar) { 8835 bool Truncated = false; 8836 Result.convert(S.Context.getFloatTypeSemantics(VectorEltTy), 8837 llvm::APFloat::rmNearestTiesToEven, &Truncated); 8838 if (Truncated) 8839 return true; 8840 } 8841 8842 ScalarCast = CK_FloatingCast; 8843 } else if (ScalarTy->isIntegralType(S.Context)) { 8844 if (canConvertIntTyToFloatTy(S, Scalar, VectorEltTy)) 8845 return true; 8846 8847 ScalarCast = CK_IntegralToFloating; 8848 } else 8849 return true; 8850 } 8851 8852 // Adjust scalar if desired. 8853 if (Scalar) { 8854 if (ScalarCast != CK_NoOp) 8855 *Scalar = S.ImpCastExprToType(Scalar->get(), VectorEltTy, ScalarCast); 8856 *Scalar = S.ImpCastExprToType(Scalar->get(), VectorTy, CK_VectorSplat); 8857 } 8858 return false; 8859 } 8860 8861 QualType Sema::CheckVectorOperands(ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS, 8862 SourceLocation Loc, bool IsCompAssign, 8863 bool AllowBothBool, 8864 bool AllowBoolConversions) { 8865 if (!IsCompAssign) { 8866 LHS = DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(LHS.get()); 8867 if (LHS.isInvalid()) 8868 return QualType(); 8869 } 8870 RHS = DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(RHS.get()); 8871 if (RHS.isInvalid()) 8872 return QualType(); 8873 8874 // For conversion purposes, we ignore any qualifiers. 8875 // For example, "const float" and "float" are equivalent. 8876 QualType LHSType = LHS.get()->getType().getUnqualifiedType(); 8877 QualType RHSType = RHS.get()->getType().getUnqualifiedType(); 8878 8879 const VectorType *LHSVecType = LHSType->getAs<VectorType>(); 8880 const VectorType *RHSVecType = RHSType->getAs<VectorType>(); 8881 assert(LHSVecType || RHSVecType); 8882 8883 // AltiVec-style "vector bool op vector bool" combinations are allowed 8884 // for some operators but not others. 8885 if (!AllowBothBool && 8886 LHSVecType && LHSVecType->getVectorKind() == VectorType::AltiVecBool && 8887 RHSVecType && RHSVecType->getVectorKind() == VectorType::AltiVecBool) 8888 return InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS); 8889 8890 // If the vector types are identical, return. 8891 if (Context.hasSameType(LHSType, RHSType)) 8892 return LHSType; 8893 8894 // If we have compatible AltiVec and GCC vector types, use the AltiVec type. 8895 if (LHSVecType && RHSVecType && 8896 Context.areCompatibleVectorTypes(LHSType, RHSType)) { 8897 if (isa<ExtVectorType>(LHSVecType)) { 8898 RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), LHSType, CK_BitCast); 8899 return LHSType; 8900 } 8901 8902 if (!IsCompAssign) 8903 LHS = ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), RHSType, CK_BitCast); 8904 return RHSType; 8905 } 8906 8907 // AllowBoolConversions says that bool and non-bool AltiVec vectors 8908 // can be mixed, with the result being the non-bool type. The non-bool 8909 // operand must have integer element type. 8910 if (AllowBoolConversions && LHSVecType && RHSVecType && 8911 LHSVecType->getNumElements() == RHSVecType->getNumElements() && 8912 (Context.getTypeSize(LHSVecType->getElementType()) == 8913 Context.getTypeSize(RHSVecType->getElementType()))) { 8914 if (LHSVecType->getVectorKind() == VectorType::AltiVecVector && 8915 LHSVecType->getElementType()->isIntegerType() && 8916 RHSVecType->getVectorKind() == VectorType::AltiVecBool) { 8917 RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), LHSType, CK_BitCast); 8918 return LHSType; 8919 } 8920 if (!IsCompAssign && 8921 LHSVecType->getVectorKind() == VectorType::AltiVecBool && 8922 RHSVecType->getVectorKind() == VectorType::AltiVecVector && 8923 RHSVecType->getElementType()->isIntegerType()) { 8924 LHS = ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), RHSType, CK_BitCast); 8925 return RHSType; 8926 } 8927 } 8928 8929 // If there's a vector type and a scalar, try to convert the scalar to 8930 // the vector element type and splat. 8931 unsigned DiagID = diag::err_typecheck_vector_not_convertable; 8932 if (!RHSVecType) { 8933 if (isa<ExtVectorType>(LHSVecType)) { 8934 if (!tryVectorConvertAndSplat(*this, &RHS, RHSType, 8935 LHSVecType->getElementType(), LHSType, 8936 DiagID)) 8937 return LHSType; 8938 } else { 8939 if (!tryGCCVectorConvertAndSplat(*this, &RHS, &LHS)) 8940 return LHSType; 8941 } 8942 } 8943 if (!LHSVecType) { 8944 if (isa<ExtVectorType>(RHSVecType)) { 8945 if (!tryVectorConvertAndSplat(*this, (IsCompAssign ? nullptr : &LHS), 8946 LHSType, RHSVecType->getElementType(), 8947 RHSType, DiagID)) 8948 return RHSType; 8949 } else { 8950 if (LHS.get()->getValueKind() == VK_LValue || 8951 !tryGCCVectorConvertAndSplat(*this, &LHS, &RHS)) 8952 return RHSType; 8953 } 8954 } 8955 8956 // FIXME: The code below also handles conversion between vectors and 8957 // non-scalars, we should break this down into fine grained specific checks 8958 // and emit proper diagnostics. 8959 QualType VecType = LHSVecType ? LHSType : RHSType; 8960 const VectorType *VT = LHSVecType ? LHSVecType : RHSVecType; 8961 QualType OtherType = LHSVecType ? RHSType : LHSType; 8962 ExprResult *OtherExpr = LHSVecType ? &RHS : &LHS; 8963 if (isLaxVectorConversion(OtherType, VecType)) { 8964 // If we're allowing lax vector conversions, only the total (data) size 8965 // needs to be the same. For non compound assignment, if one of the types is 8966 // scalar, the result is always the vector type. 8967 if (!IsCompAssign) { 8968 *OtherExpr = ImpCastExprToType(OtherExpr->get(), VecType, CK_BitCast); 8969 return VecType; 8970 // In a compound assignment, lhs += rhs, 'lhs' is a lvalue src, forbidding 8971 // any implicit cast. Here, the 'rhs' should be implicit casted to 'lhs' 8972 // type. Note that this is already done by non-compound assignments in 8973 // CheckAssignmentConstraints. If it's a scalar type, only bitcast for 8974 // <1 x T> -> T. The result is also a vector type. 8975 } else if (OtherType->isExtVectorType() || OtherType->isVectorType() || 8976 (OtherType->isScalarType() && VT->getNumElements() == 1)) { 8977 ExprResult *RHSExpr = &RHS; 8978 *RHSExpr = ImpCastExprToType(RHSExpr->get(), LHSType, CK_BitCast); 8979 return VecType; 8980 } 8981 } 8982 8983 // Okay, the expression is invalid. 8984 8985 // If there's a non-vector, non-real operand, diagnose that. 8986 if ((!RHSVecType && !RHSType->isRealType()) || 8987 (!LHSVecType && !LHSType->isRealType())) { 8988 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_vector_not_convertable_non_scalar) 8989 << LHSType << RHSType 8990 << LHS.get()->getSourceRange() << RHS.get()->getSourceRange(); 8991 return QualType(); 8992 } 8993 8994 // OpenCL V1.1 6.2.6.p1: 8995 // If the operands are of more than one vector type, then an error shall 8996 // occur. Implicit conversions between vector types are not permitted, per 8997 // section 6.2.1. 8998 if (getLangOpts().OpenCL && 8999 RHSVecType && isa<ExtVectorType>(RHSVecType) && 9000 LHSVecType && isa<ExtVectorType>(LHSVecType)) { 9001 Diag(Loc, diag::err_opencl_implicit_vector_conversion) << LHSType 9002 << RHSType; 9003 return QualType(); 9004 } 9005 9006 9007 // If there is a vector type that is not a ExtVector and a scalar, we reach 9008 // this point if scalar could not be converted to the vector's element type 9009 // without truncation. 9010 if ((RHSVecType && !isa<ExtVectorType>(RHSVecType)) || 9011 (LHSVecType && !isa<ExtVectorType>(LHSVecType))) { 9012 QualType Scalar = LHSVecType ? RHSType : LHSType; 9013 QualType Vector = LHSVecType ? LHSType : RHSType; 9014 unsigned ScalarOrVector = LHSVecType && RHSVecType ? 1 : 0; 9015 Diag(Loc, 9016 diag::err_typecheck_vector_not_convertable_implict_truncation) 9017 << ScalarOrVector << Scalar << Vector; 9018 9019 return QualType(); 9020 } 9021 9022 // Otherwise, use the generic diagnostic. 9023 Diag(Loc, DiagID) 9024 << LHSType << RHSType 9025 << LHS.get()->getSourceRange() << RHS.get()->getSourceRange(); 9026 return QualType(); 9027 } 9028 9029 // checkArithmeticNull - Detect when a NULL constant is used improperly in an 9030 // expression. These are mainly cases where the null pointer is used as an 9031 // integer instead of a pointer. 9032 static void checkArithmeticNull(Sema &S, ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS, 9033 SourceLocation Loc, bool IsCompare) { 9034 // The canonical way to check for a GNU null is with isNullPointerConstant, 9035 // but we use a bit of a hack here for speed; this is a relatively 9036 // hot path, and isNullPointerConstant is slow. 9037 bool LHSNull = isa<GNUNullExpr>(LHS.get()->IgnoreParenImpCasts()); 9038 bool RHSNull = isa<GNUNullExpr>(RHS.get()->IgnoreParenImpCasts()); 9039 9040 QualType NonNullType = LHSNull ? RHS.get()->getType() : LHS.get()->getType(); 9041 9042 // Avoid analyzing cases where the result will either be invalid (and 9043 // diagnosed as such) or entirely valid and not something to warn about. 9044 if ((!LHSNull && !RHSNull) || NonNullType->isBlockPointerType() || 9045 NonNullType->isMemberPointerType() || NonNullType->isFunctionType()) 9046 return; 9047 9048 // Comparison operations would not make sense with a null pointer no matter 9049 // what the other expression is. 9050 if (!IsCompare) { 9051 S.Diag(Loc, diag::warn_null_in_arithmetic_operation) 9052 << (LHSNull ? LHS.get()->getSourceRange() : SourceRange()) 9053 << (RHSNull ? RHS.get()->getSourceRange() : SourceRange()); 9054 return; 9055 } 9056 9057 // The rest of the operations only make sense with a null pointer 9058 // if the other expression is a pointer. 9059 if (LHSNull == RHSNull || NonNullType->isAnyPointerType() || 9060 NonNullType->canDecayToPointerType()) 9061 return; 9062 9063 S.Diag(Loc, diag::warn_null_in_comparison_operation) 9064 << LHSNull /* LHS is NULL */ << NonNullType 9065 << LHS.get()->getSourceRange() << RHS.get()->getSourceRange(); 9066 } 9067 9068 static void DiagnoseDivisionSizeofPointer(Sema &S, Expr *LHS, Expr *RHS, 9069 SourceLocation Loc) { 9070 const auto *LUE = dyn_cast<UnaryExprOrTypeTraitExpr>(LHS); 9071 const auto *RUE = dyn_cast<UnaryExprOrTypeTraitExpr>(RHS); 9072 if (!LUE || !RUE) 9073 return; 9074 if (LUE->getKind() != UETT_SizeOf || LUE->isArgumentType() || 9075 RUE->getKind() != UETT_SizeOf) 9076 return; 9077 9078 QualType LHSTy = LUE->getArgumentExpr()->IgnoreParens()->getType(); 9079 QualType RHSTy; 9080 9081 if (RUE->isArgumentType()) 9082 RHSTy = RUE->getArgumentType(); 9083 else 9084 RHSTy = RUE->getArgumentExpr()->IgnoreParens()->getType(); 9085 9086 if (!LHSTy->isPointerType() || RHSTy->isPointerType()) 9087 return; 9088 if (LHSTy->getPointeeType() != RHSTy) 9089 return; 9090 9091 S.Diag(Loc, diag::warn_division_sizeof_ptr) << LHS << LHS->getSourceRange(); 9092 } 9093 9094 static void DiagnoseBadDivideOrRemainderValues(Sema& S, ExprResult &LHS, 9095 ExprResult &RHS, 9096 SourceLocation Loc, bool IsDiv) { 9097 // Check for division/remainder by zero. 9098 Expr::EvalResult RHSValue; 9099 if (!RHS.get()->isValueDependent() && 9100 RHS.get()->EvaluateAsInt(RHSValue, S.Context) && 9101 RHSValue.Val.getInt() == 0) 9102 S.DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, RHS.get(), 9103 S.PDiag(diag::warn_remainder_division_by_zero) 9104 << IsDiv << RHS.get()->getSourceRange()); 9105 } 9106 9107 QualType Sema::CheckMultiplyDivideOperands(ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS, 9108 SourceLocation Loc, 9109 bool IsCompAssign, bool IsDiv) { 9110 checkArithmeticNull(*this, LHS, RHS, Loc, /*IsCompare=*/false); 9111 9112 if (LHS.get()->getType()->isVectorType() || 9113 RHS.get()->getType()->isVectorType()) 9114 return CheckVectorOperands(LHS, RHS, Loc, IsCompAssign, 9115 /*AllowBothBool*/getLangOpts().AltiVec, 9116 /*AllowBoolConversions*/false); 9117 9118 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(LHS, RHS, IsCompAssign); 9119 if (LHS.isInvalid() || RHS.isInvalid()) 9120 return QualType(); 9121 9122 9123 if (compType.isNull() || !compType->isArithmeticType()) 9124 return InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS); 9125 if (IsDiv) { 9126 DiagnoseBadDivideOrRemainderValues(*this, LHS, RHS, Loc, IsDiv); 9127 DiagnoseDivisionSizeofPointer(*this, LHS.get(), RHS.get(), Loc); 9128 } 9129 return compType; 9130 } 9131 9132 QualType Sema::CheckRemainderOperands( 9133 ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS, SourceLocation Loc, bool IsCompAssign) { 9134 checkArithmeticNull(*this, LHS, RHS, Loc, /*IsCompare=*/false); 9135 9136 if (LHS.get()->getType()->isVectorType() || 9137 RHS.get()->getType()->isVectorType()) { 9138 if (LHS.get()->getType()->hasIntegerRepresentation() && 9139 RHS.get()->getType()->hasIntegerRepresentation()) 9140 return CheckVectorOperands(LHS, RHS, Loc, IsCompAssign, 9141 /*AllowBothBool*/getLangOpts().AltiVec, 9142 /*AllowBoolConversions*/false); 9143 return InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS); 9144 } 9145 9146 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(LHS, RHS, IsCompAssign); 9147 if (LHS.isInvalid() || RHS.isInvalid()) 9148 return QualType(); 9149 9150 if (compType.isNull() || !compType->isIntegerType()) 9151 return InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS); 9152 DiagnoseBadDivideOrRemainderValues(*this, LHS, RHS, Loc, false /* IsDiv */); 9153 return compType; 9154 } 9155 9156 /// Diagnose invalid arithmetic on two void pointers. 9157 static void diagnoseArithmeticOnTwoVoidPointers(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, 9158 Expr *LHSExpr, Expr *RHSExpr) { 9159 S.Diag(Loc, S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus 9160 ? diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_void_type 9161 : diag::ext_gnu_void_ptr) 9162 << 1 /* two pointers */ << LHSExpr->getSourceRange() 9163 << RHSExpr->getSourceRange(); 9164 } 9165 9166 /// Diagnose invalid arithmetic on a void pointer. 9167 static void diagnoseArithmeticOnVoidPointer(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, 9168 Expr *Pointer) { 9169 S.Diag(Loc, S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus 9170 ? diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_void_type 9171 : diag::ext_gnu_void_ptr) 9172 << 0 /* one pointer */ << Pointer->getSourceRange(); 9173 } 9174 9175 /// Diagnose invalid arithmetic on a null pointer. 9176 /// 9177 /// If \p IsGNUIdiom is true, the operation is using the 'p = (i8*)nullptr + n' 9178 /// idiom, which we recognize as a GNU extension. 9179 /// 9180 static void diagnoseArithmeticOnNullPointer(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, 9181 Expr *Pointer, bool IsGNUIdiom) { 9182 if (IsGNUIdiom) 9183 S.Diag(Loc, diag::warn_gnu_null_ptr_arith) 9184 << Pointer->getSourceRange(); 9185 else 9186 S.Diag(Loc, diag::warn_pointer_arith_null_ptr) 9187 << S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus << Pointer->getSourceRange(); 9188 } 9189 9190 /// Diagnose invalid arithmetic on two function pointers. 9191 static void diagnoseArithmeticOnTwoFunctionPointers(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, 9192 Expr *LHS, Expr *RHS) { 9193 assert(LHS->getType()->isAnyPointerType()); 9194 assert(RHS->getType()->isAnyPointerType()); 9195 S.Diag(Loc, S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus 9196 ? diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_function_type 9197 : diag::ext_gnu_ptr_func_arith) 9198 << 1 /* two pointers */ << LHS->getType()->getPointeeType() 9199 // We only show the second type if it differs from the first. 9200 << (unsigned)!S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(LHS->getType(), 9201 RHS->getType()) 9202 << RHS->getType()->getPointeeType() 9203 << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange(); 9204 } 9205 9206 /// Diagnose invalid arithmetic on a function pointer. 9207 static void diagnoseArithmeticOnFunctionPointer(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, 9208 Expr *Pointer) { 9209 assert(Pointer->getType()->isAnyPointerType()); 9210 S.Diag(Loc, S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus 9211 ? diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_function_type 9212 : diag::ext_gnu_ptr_func_arith) 9213 << 0 /* one pointer */ << Pointer->getType()->getPointeeType() 9214 << 0 /* one pointer, so only one type */ 9215 << Pointer->getSourceRange(); 9216 } 9217 9218 /// Emit error if Operand is incomplete pointer type 9219 /// 9220 /// \returns True if pointer has incomplete type 9221 static bool checkArithmeticIncompletePointerType(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, 9222 Expr *Operand) { 9223 QualType ResType = Operand->getType(); 9224 if (const AtomicType *ResAtomicType = ResType->getAs<AtomicType>()) 9225 ResType = ResAtomicType->getValueType(); 9226 9227 assert(ResType->isAnyPointerType() && !ResType->isDependentType()); 9228 QualType PointeeTy = ResType->getPointeeType(); 9229 return S.RequireCompleteType(Loc, PointeeTy, 9230 diag::err_typecheck_arithmetic_incomplete_type, 9231 PointeeTy, Operand->getSourceRange()); 9232 } 9233 9234 /// Check the validity of an arithmetic pointer operand. 9235 /// 9236 /// If the operand has pointer type, this code will check for pointer types 9237 /// which are invalid in arithmetic operations. These will be diagnosed 9238 /// appropriately, including whether or not the use is supported as an 9239 /// extension. 9240 /// 9241 /// \returns True when the operand is valid to use (even if as an extension). 9242 static bool checkArithmeticOpPointerOperand(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, 9243 Expr *Operand) { 9244 QualType ResType = Operand->getType(); 9245 if (const AtomicType *ResAtomicType = ResType->getAs<AtomicType>()) 9246 ResType = ResAtomicType->getValueType(); 9247 9248 if (!ResType->isAnyPointerType()) return true; 9249 9250 QualType PointeeTy = ResType->getPointeeType(); 9251 if (PointeeTy->isVoidType()) { 9252 diagnoseArithmeticOnVoidPointer(S, Loc, Operand); 9253 return !S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus; 9254 } 9255 if (PointeeTy->isFunctionType()) { 9256 diagnoseArithmeticOnFunctionPointer(S, Loc, Operand); 9257 return !S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus; 9258 } 9259 9260 if (checkArithmeticIncompletePointerType(S, Loc, Operand)) return false; 9261 9262 return true; 9263 } 9264 9265 /// Check the validity of a binary arithmetic operation w.r.t. pointer 9266 /// operands. 9267 /// 9268 /// This routine will diagnose any invalid arithmetic on pointer operands much 9269 /// like \see checkArithmeticOpPointerOperand. However, it has special logic 9270 /// for emitting a single diagnostic even for operations where both LHS and RHS 9271 /// are (potentially problematic) pointers. 9272 /// 9273 /// \returns True when the operand is valid to use (even if as an extension). 9274 static bool checkArithmeticBinOpPointerOperands(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, 9275 Expr *LHSExpr, Expr *RHSExpr) { 9276 bool isLHSPointer = LHSExpr->getType()->isAnyPointerType(); 9277 bool isRHSPointer = RHSExpr->getType()->isAnyPointerType(); 9278 if (!isLHSPointer && !isRHSPointer) return true; 9279 9280 QualType LHSPointeeTy, RHSPointeeTy; 9281 if (isLHSPointer) LHSPointeeTy = LHSExpr->getType()->getPointeeType(); 9282 if (isRHSPointer) RHSPointeeTy = RHSExpr->getType()->getPointeeType(); 9283 9284 // if both are pointers check if operation is valid wrt address spaces 9285 if (S.getLangOpts().OpenCL && isLHSPointer && isRHSPointer) { 9286 const PointerType *lhsPtr = LHSExpr->getType()->getAs<PointerType>(); 9287 const PointerType *rhsPtr = RHSExpr->getType()->getAs<PointerType>(); 9288 if (!lhsPtr->isAddressSpaceOverlapping(*rhsPtr)) { 9289 S.Diag(Loc, 9290 diag::err_typecheck_op_on_nonoverlapping_address_space_pointers) 9291 << LHSExpr->getType() << RHSExpr->getType() << 1 /*arithmetic op*/ 9292 << LHSExpr->getSourceRange() << RHSExpr->getSourceRange(); 9293 return false; 9294 } 9295 } 9296 9297 // Check for arithmetic on pointers to incomplete types. 9298 bool isLHSVoidPtr = isLHSPointer && LHSPointeeTy->isVoidType(); 9299 bool isRHSVoidPtr = isRHSPointer && RHSPointeeTy->isVoidType(); 9300 if (isLHSVoidPtr || isRHSVoidPtr) { 9301 if (!isRHSVoidPtr) diagnoseArithmeticOnVoidPointer(S, Loc, LHSExpr); 9302 else if (!isLHSVoidPtr) diagnoseArithmeticOnVoidPointer(S, Loc, RHSExpr); 9303 else diagnoseArithmeticOnTwoVoidPointers(S, Loc, LHSExpr, RHSExpr); 9304 9305 return !S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus; 9306 } 9307 9308 bool isLHSFuncPtr = isLHSPointer && LHSPointeeTy->isFunctionType(); 9309 bool isRHSFuncPtr = isRHSPointer && RHSPointeeTy->isFunctionType(); 9310 if (isLHSFuncPtr || isRHSFuncPtr) { 9311 if (!isRHSFuncPtr) diagnoseArithmeticOnFunctionPointer(S, Loc, LHSExpr); 9312 else if (!isLHSFuncPtr) diagnoseArithmeticOnFunctionPointer(S, Loc, 9313 RHSExpr); 9314 else diagnoseArithmeticOnTwoFunctionPointers(S, Loc, LHSExpr, RHSExpr); 9315 9316 return !S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus; 9317 } 9318 9319 if (isLHSPointer && checkArithmeticIncompletePointerType(S, Loc, LHSExpr)) 9320 return false; 9321 if (isRHSPointer && checkArithmeticIncompletePointerType(S, Loc, RHSExpr)) 9322 return false; 9323 9324 return true; 9325 } 9326 9327 /// diagnoseStringPlusInt - Emit a warning when adding an integer to a string 9328 /// literal. 9329 static void diagnoseStringPlusInt(Sema &Self, SourceLocation OpLoc, 9330 Expr *LHSExpr, Expr *RHSExpr) { 9331 StringLiteral* StrExpr = dyn_cast<StringLiteral>(LHSExpr->IgnoreImpCasts()); 9332 Expr* IndexExpr = RHSExpr; 9333 if (!StrExpr) { 9334 StrExpr = dyn_cast<StringLiteral>(RHSExpr->IgnoreImpCasts()); 9335 IndexExpr = LHSExpr; 9336 } 9337 9338 bool IsStringPlusInt = StrExpr && 9339 IndexExpr->getType()->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType(); 9340 if (!IsStringPlusInt || IndexExpr->isValueDependent()) 9341 return; 9342 9343 SourceRange DiagRange(LHSExpr->getBeginLoc(), RHSExpr->getEndLoc()); 9344 Self.Diag(OpLoc, diag::warn_string_plus_int) 9345 << DiagRange << IndexExpr->IgnoreImpCasts()->getType(); 9346 9347 // Only print a fixit for "str" + int, not for int + "str". 9348 if (IndexExpr == RHSExpr) { 9349 SourceLocation EndLoc = Self.getLocForEndOfToken(RHSExpr->getEndLoc()); 9350 Self.Diag(OpLoc, diag::note_string_plus_scalar_silence) 9351 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(LHSExpr->getBeginLoc(), "&") 9352 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(SourceRange(OpLoc), "[") 9353 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(EndLoc, "]"); 9354 } else 9355 Self.Diag(OpLoc, diag::note_string_plus_scalar_silence); 9356 } 9357 9358 /// Emit a warning when adding a char literal to a string. 9359 static void diagnoseStringPlusChar(Sema &Self, SourceLocation OpLoc, 9360 Expr *LHSExpr, Expr *RHSExpr) { 9361 const Expr *StringRefExpr = LHSExpr; 9362 const CharacterLiteral *CharExpr = 9363 dyn_cast<CharacterLiteral>(RHSExpr->IgnoreImpCasts()); 9364 9365 if (!CharExpr) { 9366 CharExpr = dyn_cast<CharacterLiteral>(LHSExpr->IgnoreImpCasts()); 9367 StringRefExpr = RHSExpr; 9368 } 9369 9370 if (!CharExpr || !StringRefExpr) 9371 return; 9372 9373 const QualType StringType = StringRefExpr->getType(); 9374 9375 // Return if not a PointerType. 9376 if (!StringType->isAnyPointerType()) 9377 return; 9378 9379 // Return if not a CharacterType. 9380 if (!StringType->getPointeeType()->isAnyCharacterType()) 9381 return; 9382 9383 ASTContext &Ctx = Self.getASTContext(); 9384 SourceRange DiagRange(LHSExpr->getBeginLoc(), RHSExpr->getEndLoc()); 9385 9386 const QualType CharType = CharExpr->getType(); 9387 if (!CharType->isAnyCharacterType() && 9388 CharType->isIntegerType() && 9389 llvm::isUIntN(Ctx.getCharWidth(), CharExpr->getValue())) { 9390 Self.Diag(OpLoc, diag::warn_string_plus_char) 9391 << DiagRange << Ctx.CharTy; 9392 } else { 9393 Self.Diag(OpLoc, diag::warn_string_plus_char) 9394 << DiagRange << CharExpr->getType(); 9395 } 9396 9397 // Only print a fixit for str + char, not for char + str. 9398 if (isa<CharacterLiteral>(RHSExpr->IgnoreImpCasts())) { 9399 SourceLocation EndLoc = Self.getLocForEndOfToken(RHSExpr->getEndLoc()); 9400 Self.Diag(OpLoc, diag::note_string_plus_scalar_silence) 9401 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(LHSExpr->getBeginLoc(), "&") 9402 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(SourceRange(OpLoc), "[") 9403 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(EndLoc, "]"); 9404 } else { 9405 Self.Diag(OpLoc, diag::note_string_plus_scalar_silence); 9406 } 9407 } 9408 9409 /// Emit error when two pointers are incompatible. 9410 static void diagnosePointerIncompatibility(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, 9411 Expr *LHSExpr, Expr *RHSExpr) { 9412 assert(LHSExpr->getType()->isAnyPointerType()); 9413 assert(RHSExpr->getType()->isAnyPointerType()); 9414 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_sub_ptr_compatible) 9415 << LHSExpr->getType() << RHSExpr->getType() << LHSExpr->getSourceRange() 9416 << RHSExpr->getSourceRange(); 9417 } 9418 9419 // C99 6.5.6 9420 QualType Sema::CheckAdditionOperands(ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS, 9421 SourceLocation Loc, BinaryOperatorKind Opc, 9422 QualType* CompLHSTy) { 9423 checkArithmeticNull(*this, LHS, RHS, Loc, /*IsCompare=*/false); 9424 9425 if (LHS.get()->getType()->isVectorType() || 9426 RHS.get()->getType()->isVectorType()) { 9427 QualType compType = CheckVectorOperands( 9428 LHS, RHS, Loc, CompLHSTy, 9429 /*AllowBothBool*/getLangOpts().AltiVec, 9430 /*AllowBoolConversions*/getLangOpts().ZVector); 9431 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = compType; 9432 return compType; 9433 } 9434 9435 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(LHS, RHS, CompLHSTy); 9436 if (LHS.isInvalid() || RHS.isInvalid()) 9437 return QualType(); 9438 9439 // Diagnose "string literal" '+' int and string '+' "char literal". 9440 if (Opc == BO_Add) { 9441 diagnoseStringPlusInt(*this, Loc, LHS.get(), RHS.get()); 9442 diagnoseStringPlusChar(*this, Loc, LHS.get(), RHS.get()); 9443 } 9444 9445 // handle the common case first (both operands are arithmetic). 9446 if (!compType.isNull() && compType->isArithmeticType()) { 9447 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = compType; 9448 return compType; 9449 } 9450 9451 // Type-checking. Ultimately the pointer's going to be in PExp; 9452 // note that we bias towards the LHS being the pointer. 9453 Expr *PExp = LHS.get(), *IExp = RHS.get(); 9454 9455 bool isObjCPointer; 9456 if (PExp->getType()->isPointerType()) { 9457 isObjCPointer = false; 9458 } else if (PExp->getType()->isObjCObjectPointerType()) { 9459 isObjCPointer = true; 9460 } else { 9461 std::swap(PExp, IExp); 9462 if (PExp->getType()->isPointerType()) { 9463 isObjCPointer = false; 9464 } else if (PExp->getType()->isObjCObjectPointerType()) { 9465 isObjCPointer = true; 9466 } else { 9467 return InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS); 9468 } 9469 } 9470 assert(PExp->getType()->isAnyPointerType()); 9471 9472 if (!IExp->getType()->isIntegerType()) 9473 return InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS); 9474 9475 // Adding to a null pointer results in undefined behavior. 9476 if (PExp->IgnoreParenCasts()->isNullPointerConstant( 9477 Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull)) { 9478 // In C++ adding zero to a null pointer is defined. 9479 Expr::EvalResult KnownVal; 9480 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus || 9481 (!IExp->isValueDependent() && 9482 (!IExp->EvaluateAsInt(KnownVal, Context) || 9483 KnownVal.Val.getInt() != 0))) { 9484 // Check the conditions to see if this is the 'p = nullptr + n' idiom. 9485 bool IsGNUIdiom = BinaryOperator::isNullPointerArithmeticExtension( 9486 Context, BO_Add, PExp, IExp); 9487 diagnoseArithmeticOnNullPointer(*this, Loc, PExp, IsGNUIdiom); 9488 } 9489 } 9490 9491 if (!checkArithmeticOpPointerOperand(*this, Loc, PExp)) 9492 return QualType(); 9493 9494 if (isObjCPointer && checkArithmeticOnObjCPointer(*this, Loc, PExp)) 9495 return QualType(); 9496 9497 // Check array bounds for pointer arithemtic 9498 CheckArrayAccess(PExp, IExp); 9499 9500 if (CompLHSTy) { 9501 QualType LHSTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(LHS.get()); 9502 if (LHSTy.isNull()) { 9503 LHSTy = LHS.get()->getType(); 9504 if (LHSTy->isPromotableIntegerType()) 9505 LHSTy = Context.getPromotedIntegerType(LHSTy); 9506 } 9507 *CompLHSTy = LHSTy; 9508 } 9509 9510 return PExp->getType(); 9511 } 9512 9513 // C99 6.5.6 9514 QualType Sema::CheckSubtractionOperands(ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS, 9515 SourceLocation Loc, 9516 QualType* CompLHSTy) { 9517 checkArithmeticNull(*this, LHS, RHS, Loc, /*IsCompare=*/false); 9518 9519 if (LHS.get()->getType()->isVectorType() || 9520 RHS.get()->getType()->isVectorType()) { 9521 QualType compType = CheckVectorOperands( 9522 LHS, RHS, Loc, CompLHSTy, 9523 /*AllowBothBool*/getLangOpts().AltiVec, 9524 /*AllowBoolConversions*/getLangOpts().ZVector); 9525 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = compType; 9526 return compType; 9527 } 9528 9529 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(LHS, RHS, CompLHSTy); 9530 if (LHS.isInvalid() || RHS.isInvalid()) 9531 return QualType(); 9532 9533 // Enforce type constraints: C99 6.5.6p3. 9534 9535 // Handle the common case first (both operands are arithmetic). 9536 if (!compType.isNull() && compType->isArithmeticType()) { 9537 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = compType; 9538 return compType; 9539 } 9540 9541 // Either ptr - int or ptr - ptr. 9542 if (LHS.get()->getType()->isAnyPointerType()) { 9543 QualType lpointee = LHS.get()->getType()->getPointeeType(); 9544 9545 // Diagnose bad cases where we step over interface counts. 9546 if (LHS.get()->getType()->isObjCObjectPointerType() && 9547 checkArithmeticOnObjCPointer(*this, Loc, LHS.get())) 9548 return QualType(); 9549 9550 // The result type of a pointer-int computation is the pointer type. 9551 if (RHS.get()->getType()->isIntegerType()) { 9552 // Subtracting from a null pointer should produce a warning. 9553 // The last argument to the diagnose call says this doesn't match the 9554 // GNU int-to-pointer idiom. 9555 if (LHS.get()->IgnoreParenCasts()->isNullPointerConstant(Context, 9556 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull)) { 9557 // In C++ adding zero to a null pointer is defined. 9558 Expr::EvalResult KnownVal; 9559 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus || 9560 (!RHS.get()->isValueDependent() && 9561 (!RHS.get()->EvaluateAsInt(KnownVal, Context) || 9562 KnownVal.Val.getInt() != 0))) { 9563 diagnoseArithmeticOnNullPointer(*this, Loc, LHS.get(), false); 9564 } 9565 } 9566 9567 if (!checkArithmeticOpPointerOperand(*this, Loc, LHS.get())) 9568 return QualType(); 9569 9570 // Check array bounds for pointer arithemtic 9571 CheckArrayAccess(LHS.get(), RHS.get(), /*ArraySubscriptExpr*/nullptr, 9572 /*AllowOnePastEnd*/true, /*IndexNegated*/true); 9573 9574 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = LHS.get()->getType(); 9575 return LHS.get()->getType(); 9576 } 9577 9578 // Handle pointer-pointer subtractions. 9579 if (const PointerType *RHSPTy 9580 = RHS.get()->getType()->getAs<PointerType>()) { 9581 QualType rpointee = RHSPTy->getPointeeType(); 9582 9583 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 9584 // Pointee types must be the same: C++ [expr.add] 9585 if (!Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(lpointee, rpointee)) { 9586 diagnosePointerIncompatibility(*this, Loc, LHS.get(), RHS.get()); 9587 } 9588 } else { 9589 // Pointee types must be compatible C99 6.5.6p3 9590 if (!Context.typesAreCompatible( 9591 Context.getCanonicalType(lpointee).getUnqualifiedType(), 9592 Context.getCanonicalType(rpointee).getUnqualifiedType())) { 9593 diagnosePointerIncompatibility(*this, Loc, LHS.get(), RHS.get()); 9594 return QualType(); 9595 } 9596 } 9597 9598 if (!checkArithmeticBinOpPointerOperands(*this, Loc, 9599 LHS.get(), RHS.get())) 9600 return QualType(); 9601 9602 // FIXME: Add warnings for nullptr - ptr. 9603 9604 // The pointee type may have zero size. As an extension, a structure or 9605 // union may have zero size or an array may have zero length. In this 9606 // case subtraction does not make sense. 9607 if (!rpointee->isVoidType() && !rpointee->isFunctionType()) { 9608 CharUnits ElementSize = Context.getTypeSizeInChars(rpointee); 9609 if (ElementSize.isZero()) { 9610 Diag(Loc,diag::warn_sub_ptr_zero_size_types) 9611 << rpointee.getUnqualifiedType() 9612 << LHS.get()->getSourceRange() << RHS.get()->getSourceRange(); 9613 } 9614 } 9615 9616 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = LHS.get()->getType(); 9617 return Context.getPointerDiffType(); 9618 } 9619 } 9620 9621 return InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS); 9622 } 9623 9624 static bool isScopedEnumerationType(QualType T) { 9625 if (const EnumType *ET = T->getAs<EnumType>()) 9626 return ET->getDecl()->isScoped(); 9627 return false; 9628 } 9629 9630 static void DiagnoseBadShiftValues(Sema& S, ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS, 9631 SourceLocation Loc, BinaryOperatorKind Opc, 9632 QualType LHSType) { 9633 // OpenCL 6.3j: shift values are effectively % word size of LHS (more defined), 9634 // so skip remaining warnings as we don't want to modify values within Sema. 9635 if (S.getLangOpts().OpenCL) 9636 return; 9637 9638 // Check right/shifter operand 9639 Expr::EvalResult RHSResult; 9640 if (RHS.get()->isValueDependent() || 9641 !RHS.get()->EvaluateAsInt(RHSResult, S.Context)) 9642 return; 9643 llvm::APSInt Right = RHSResult.Val.getInt(); 9644 9645 if (Right.isNegative()) { 9646 S.DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, RHS.get(), 9647 S.PDiag(diag::warn_shift_negative) 9648 << RHS.get()->getSourceRange()); 9649 return; 9650 } 9651 llvm::APInt LeftBits(Right.getBitWidth(), 9652 S.Context.getTypeSize(LHS.get()->getType())); 9653 if (Right.uge(LeftBits)) { 9654 S.DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, RHS.get(), 9655 S.PDiag(diag::warn_shift_gt_typewidth) 9656 << RHS.get()->getSourceRange()); 9657 return; 9658 } 9659 if (Opc != BO_Shl) 9660 return; 9661 9662 // When left shifting an ICE which is signed, we can check for overflow which 9663 // according to C++ standards prior to C++2a has undefined behavior 9664 // ([expr.shift] 5.8/2). Unsigned integers have defined behavior modulo one 9665 // more than the maximum value representable in the result type, so never 9666 // warn for those. (FIXME: Unsigned left-shift overflow in a constant 9667 // expression is still probably a bug.) 9668 Expr::EvalResult LHSResult; 9669 if (LHS.get()->isValueDependent() || 9670 LHSType->hasUnsignedIntegerRepresentation() || 9671 !LHS.get()->EvaluateAsInt(LHSResult, S.Context)) 9672 return; 9673 llvm::APSInt Left = LHSResult.Val.getInt(); 9674 9675 // If LHS does not have a signed type and non-negative value 9676 // then, the behavior is undefined before C++2a. Warn about it. 9677 if (Left.isNegative() && !S.getLangOpts().isSignedOverflowDefined() && 9678 !S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus2a) { 9679 S.DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, LHS.get(), 9680 S.PDiag(diag::warn_shift_lhs_negative) 9681 << LHS.get()->getSourceRange()); 9682 return; 9683 } 9684 9685 llvm::APInt ResultBits = 9686 static_cast<llvm::APInt&>(Right) + Left.getMinSignedBits(); 9687 if (LeftBits.uge(ResultBits)) 9688 return; 9689 llvm::APSInt Result = Left.extend(ResultBits.getLimitedValue()); 9690 Result = Result.shl(Right); 9691 9692 // Print the bit representation of the signed integer as an unsigned 9693 // hexadecimal number. 9694 SmallString<40> HexResult; 9695 Result.toString(HexResult, 16, /*Signed =*/false, /*Literal =*/true); 9696 9697 // If we are only missing a sign bit, this is less likely to result in actual 9698 // bugs -- if the result is cast back to an unsigned type, it will have the 9699 // expected value. Thus we place this behind a different warning that can be 9700 // turned off separately if needed. 9701 if (LeftBits == ResultBits - 1) { 9702 S.Diag(Loc, diag::warn_shift_result_sets_sign_bit) 9703 << HexResult << LHSType 9704 << LHS.get()->getSourceRange() << RHS.get()->getSourceRange(); 9705 return; 9706 } 9707 9708 S.Diag(Loc, diag::warn_shift_result_gt_typewidth) 9709 << HexResult.str() << Result.getMinSignedBits() << LHSType 9710 << Left.getBitWidth() << LHS.get()->getSourceRange() 9711 << RHS.get()->getSourceRange(); 9712 } 9713 9714 /// Return the resulting type when a vector is shifted 9715 /// by a scalar or vector shift amount. 9716 static QualType checkVectorShift(Sema &S, ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS, 9717 SourceLocation Loc, bool IsCompAssign) { 9718 // OpenCL v1.1 s6.3.j says RHS can be a vector only if LHS is a vector. 9719 if ((S.LangOpts.OpenCL || S.LangOpts.ZVector) && 9720 !LHS.get()->getType()->isVectorType()) { 9721 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_shift_rhs_only_vector) 9722 << RHS.get()->getType() << LHS.get()->getType() 9723 << LHS.get()->getSourceRange() << RHS.get()->getSourceRange(); 9724 return QualType(); 9725 } 9726 9727 if (!IsCompAssign) { 9728 LHS = S.UsualUnaryConversions(LHS.get()); 9729 if (LHS.isInvalid()) return QualType(); 9730 } 9731 9732 RHS = S.UsualUnaryConversions(RHS.get()); 9733 if (RHS.isInvalid()) return QualType(); 9734 9735 QualType LHSType = LHS.get()->getType(); 9736 // Note that LHS might be a scalar because the routine calls not only in 9737 // OpenCL case. 9738 const VectorType *LHSVecTy = LHSType->getAs<VectorType>(); 9739 QualType LHSEleType = LHSVecTy ? LHSVecTy->getElementType() : LHSType; 9740 9741 // Note that RHS might not be a vector. 9742 QualType RHSType = RHS.get()->getType(); 9743 const VectorType *RHSVecTy = RHSType->getAs<VectorType>(); 9744 QualType RHSEleType = RHSVecTy ? RHSVecTy->getElementType() : RHSType; 9745 9746 // The operands need to be integers. 9747 if (!LHSEleType->isIntegerType()) { 9748 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_expect_int) 9749 << LHS.get()->getType() << LHS.get()->getSourceRange(); 9750 return QualType(); 9751 } 9752 9753 if (!RHSEleType->isIntegerType()) { 9754 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_expect_int) 9755 << RHS.get()->getType() << RHS.get()->getSourceRange(); 9756 return QualType(); 9757 } 9758 9759 if (!LHSVecTy) { 9760 assert(RHSVecTy); 9761 if (IsCompAssign) 9762 return RHSType; 9763 if (LHSEleType != RHSEleType) { 9764 LHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(),RHSEleType, CK_IntegralCast); 9765 LHSEleType = RHSEleType; 9766 } 9767 QualType VecTy = 9768 S.Context.getExtVectorType(LHSEleType, RHSVecTy->getNumElements()); 9769 LHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), VecTy, CK_VectorSplat); 9770 LHSType = VecTy; 9771 } else if (RHSVecTy) { 9772 // OpenCL v1.1 s6.3.j says that for vector types, the operators 9773 // are applied component-wise. So if RHS is a vector, then ensure 9774 // that the number of elements is the same as LHS... 9775 if (RHSVecTy->getNumElements() != LHSVecTy->getNumElements()) { 9776 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_vector_lengths_not_equal) 9777 << LHS.get()->getType() << RHS.get()->getType() 9778 << LHS.get()->getSourceRange() << RHS.get()->getSourceRange(); 9779 return QualType(); 9780 } 9781 if (!S.LangOpts.OpenCL && !S.LangOpts.ZVector) { 9782 const BuiltinType *LHSBT = LHSEleType->getAs<clang::BuiltinType>(); 9783 const BuiltinType *RHSBT = RHSEleType->getAs<clang::BuiltinType>(); 9784 if (LHSBT != RHSBT && 9785 S.Context.getTypeSize(LHSBT) != S.Context.getTypeSize(RHSBT)) { 9786 S.Diag(Loc, diag::warn_typecheck_vector_element_sizes_not_equal) 9787 << LHS.get()->getType() << RHS.get()->getType() 9788 << LHS.get()->getSourceRange() << RHS.get()->getSourceRange(); 9789 } 9790 } 9791 } else { 9792 // ...else expand RHS to match the number of elements in LHS. 9793 QualType VecTy = 9794 S.Context.getExtVectorType(RHSEleType, LHSVecTy->getNumElements()); 9795 RHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), VecTy, CK_VectorSplat); 9796 } 9797 9798 return LHSType; 9799 } 9800 9801 // C99 6.5.7 9802 QualType Sema::CheckShiftOperands(ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS, 9803 SourceLocation Loc, BinaryOperatorKind Opc, 9804 bool IsCompAssign) { 9805 checkArithmeticNull(*this, LHS, RHS, Loc, /*IsCompare=*/false); 9806 9807 // Vector shifts promote their scalar inputs to vector type. 9808 if (LHS.get()->getType()->isVectorType() || 9809 RHS.get()->getType()->isVectorType()) { 9810 if (LangOpts.ZVector) { 9811 // The shift operators for the z vector extensions work basically 9812 // like general shifts, except that neither the LHS nor the RHS is 9813 // allowed to be a "vector bool". 9814 if (auto LHSVecType = LHS.get()->getType()->getAs<VectorType>()) 9815 if (LHSVecType->getVectorKind() == VectorType::AltiVecBool) 9816 return InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS); 9817 if (auto RHSVecType = RHS.get()->getType()->getAs<VectorType>()) 9818 if (RHSVecType->getVectorKind() == VectorType::AltiVecBool) 9819 return InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS); 9820 } 9821 return checkVectorShift(*this, LHS, RHS, Loc, IsCompAssign); 9822 } 9823 9824 // Shifts don't perform usual arithmetic conversions, they just do integer 9825 // promotions on each operand. C99 6.5.7p3 9826 9827 // For the LHS, do usual unary conversions, but then reset them away 9828 // if this is a compound assignment. 9829 ExprResult OldLHS = LHS; 9830 LHS = UsualUnaryConversions(LHS.get()); 9831 if (LHS.isInvalid()) 9832 return QualType(); 9833 QualType LHSType = LHS.get()->getType(); 9834 if (IsCompAssign) LHS = OldLHS; 9835 9836 // The RHS is simpler. 9837 RHS = UsualUnaryConversions(RHS.get()); 9838 if (RHS.isInvalid()) 9839 return QualType(); 9840 QualType RHSType = RHS.get()->getType(); 9841 9842 // C99 6.5.7p2: Each of the operands shall have integer type. 9843 if (!LHSType->hasIntegerRepresentation() || 9844 !RHSType->hasIntegerRepresentation()) 9845 return InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS); 9846 9847 // C++0x: Don't allow scoped enums. FIXME: Use something better than 9848 // hasIntegerRepresentation() above instead of this. 9849 if (isScopedEnumerationType(LHSType) || 9850 isScopedEnumerationType(RHSType)) { 9851 return InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS); 9852 } 9853 // Sanity-check shift operands 9854 DiagnoseBadShiftValues(*this, LHS, RHS, Loc, Opc, LHSType); 9855 9856 // "The type of the result is that of the promoted left operand." 9857 return LHSType; 9858 } 9859 9860 /// If two different enums are compared, raise a warning. 9861 static void checkEnumComparison(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, Expr *LHS, 9862 Expr *RHS) { 9863 QualType LHSStrippedType = LHS->IgnoreParenImpCasts()->getType(); 9864 QualType RHSStrippedType = RHS->IgnoreParenImpCasts()->getType(); 9865 9866 const EnumType *LHSEnumType = LHSStrippedType->getAs<EnumType>(); 9867 if (!LHSEnumType) 9868 return; 9869 const EnumType *RHSEnumType = RHSStrippedType->getAs<EnumType>(); 9870 if (!RHSEnumType) 9871 return; 9872 9873 // Ignore anonymous enums. 9874 if (!LHSEnumType->getDecl()->getIdentifier() && 9875 !LHSEnumType->getDecl()->getTypedefNameForAnonDecl()) 9876 return; 9877 if (!RHSEnumType->getDecl()->getIdentifier() && 9878 !RHSEnumType->getDecl()->getTypedefNameForAnonDecl()) 9879 return; 9880 9881 if (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(LHSStrippedType, RHSStrippedType)) 9882 return; 9883 9884 S.Diag(Loc, diag::warn_comparison_of_mixed_enum_types) 9885 << LHSStrippedType << RHSStrippedType 9886 << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange(); 9887 } 9888 9889 /// Diagnose bad pointer comparisons. 9890 static void diagnoseDistinctPointerComparison(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, 9891 ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS, 9892 bool IsError) { 9893 S.Diag(Loc, IsError ? diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers 9894 : diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers) 9895 << LHS.get()->getType() << RHS.get()->getType() 9896 << LHS.get()->getSourceRange() << RHS.get()->getSourceRange(); 9897 } 9898 9899 /// Returns false if the pointers are converted to a composite type, 9900 /// true otherwise. 9901 static bool convertPointersToCompositeType(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, 9902 ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS) { 9903 // C++ [expr.rel]p2: 9904 // [...] Pointer conversions (4.10) and qualification 9905 // conversions (4.4) are performed on pointer operands (or on 9906 // a pointer operand and a null pointer constant) to bring 9907 // them to their composite pointer type. [...] 9908 // 9909 // C++ [expr.eq]p1 uses the same notion for (in)equality 9910 // comparisons of pointers. 9911 9912 QualType LHSType = LHS.get()->getType(); 9913 QualType RHSType = RHS.get()->getType(); 9914 assert(LHSType->isPointerType() || RHSType->isPointerType() || 9915 LHSType->isMemberPointerType() || RHSType->isMemberPointerType()); 9916 9917 QualType T = S.FindCompositePointerType(Loc, LHS, RHS); 9918 if (T.isNull()) { 9919 if ((LHSType->isPointerType() || LHSType->isMemberPointerType()) && 9920 (RHSType->isPointerType() || RHSType->isMemberPointerType())) 9921 diagnoseDistinctPointerComparison(S, Loc, LHS, RHS, /*isError*/true); 9922 else 9923 S.InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS); 9924 return true; 9925 } 9926 9927 LHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), T, CK_BitCast); 9928 RHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), T, CK_BitCast); 9929 return false; 9930 } 9931 9932 static void diagnoseFunctionPointerToVoidComparison(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, 9933 ExprResult &LHS, 9934 ExprResult &RHS, 9935 bool IsError) { 9936 S.Diag(Loc, IsError ? diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_fptr_to_void 9937 : diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_fptr_to_void) 9938 << LHS.get()->getType() << RHS.get()->getType() 9939 << LHS.get()->getSourceRange() << RHS.get()->getSourceRange(); 9940 } 9941 9942 static bool isObjCObjectLiteral(ExprResult &E) { 9943 switch (E.get()->IgnoreParenImpCasts()->getStmtClass()) { 9944 case Stmt::ObjCArrayLiteralClass: 9945 case Stmt::ObjCDictionaryLiteralClass: 9946 case Stmt::ObjCStringLiteralClass: 9947 case Stmt::ObjCBoxedExprClass: 9948 return true; 9949 default: 9950 // Note that ObjCBoolLiteral is NOT an object literal! 9951 return false; 9952 } 9953 } 9954 9955 static bool hasIsEqualMethod(Sema &S, const Expr *LHS, const Expr *RHS) { 9956 const ObjCObjectPointerType *Type = 9957 LHS->getType()->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(); 9958 9959 // If this is not actually an Objective-C object, bail out. 9960 if (!Type) 9961 return false; 9962 9963 // Get the LHS object's interface type. 9964 QualType InterfaceType = Type->getPointeeType(); 9965 9966 // If the RHS isn't an Objective-C object, bail out. 9967 if (!RHS->getType()->isObjCObjectPointerType()) 9968 return false; 9969 9970 // Try to find the -isEqual: method. 9971 Selector IsEqualSel = S.NSAPIObj->getIsEqualSelector(); 9972 ObjCMethodDecl *Method = S.LookupMethodInObjectType(IsEqualSel, 9973 InterfaceType, 9974 /*IsInstance=*/true); 9975 if (!Method) { 9976 if (Type->isObjCIdType()) { 9977 // For 'id', just check the global pool. 9978 Method = S.LookupInstanceMethodInGlobalPool(IsEqualSel, SourceRange(), 9979 /*receiverId=*/true); 9980 } else { 9981 // Check protocols. 9982 Method = S.LookupMethodInQualifiedType(IsEqualSel, Type, 9983 /*IsInstance=*/true); 9984 } 9985 } 9986 9987 if (!Method) 9988 return false; 9989 9990 QualType T = Method->parameters()[0]->getType(); 9991 if (!T->isObjCObjectPointerType()) 9992 return false; 9993 9994 QualType R = Method->getReturnType(); 9995 if (!R->isScalarType()) 9996 return false; 9997 9998 return true; 9999 } 10000 10001 Sema::ObjCLiteralKind Sema::CheckLiteralKind(Expr *FromE) { 10002 FromE = FromE->IgnoreParenImpCasts(); 10003 switch (FromE->getStmtClass()) { 10004 default: 10005 break; 10006 case Stmt::ObjCStringLiteralClass: 10007 // "string literal" 10008 return LK_String; 10009 case Stmt::ObjCArrayLiteralClass: 10010 // "array literal" 10011 return LK_Array; 10012 case Stmt::ObjCDictionaryLiteralClass: 10013 // "dictionary literal" 10014 return LK_Dictionary; 10015 case Stmt::BlockExprClass: 10016 return LK_Block; 10017 case Stmt::ObjCBoxedExprClass: { 10018 Expr *Inner = cast<ObjCBoxedExpr>(FromE)->getSubExpr()->IgnoreParens(); 10019 switch (Inner->getStmtClass()) { 10020 case Stmt::IntegerLiteralClass: 10021 case Stmt::FloatingLiteralClass: 10022 case Stmt::CharacterLiteralClass: 10023 case Stmt::ObjCBoolLiteralExprClass: 10024 case Stmt::CXXBoolLiteralExprClass: 10025 // "numeric literal" 10026 return LK_Numeric; 10027 case Stmt::ImplicitCastExprClass: { 10028 CastKind CK = cast<CastExpr>(Inner)->getCastKind(); 10029 // Boolean literals can be represented by implicit casts. 10030 if (CK == CK_IntegralToBoolean || CK == CK_IntegralCast) 10031 return LK_Numeric; 10032 break; 10033 } 10034 default: 10035 break; 10036 } 10037 return LK_Boxed; 10038 } 10039 } 10040 return LK_None; 10041 } 10042 10043 static void diagnoseObjCLiteralComparison(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, 10044 ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS, 10045 BinaryOperator::Opcode Opc){ 10046 Expr *Literal; 10047 Expr *Other; 10048 if (isObjCObjectLiteral(LHS)) { 10049 Literal = LHS.get(); 10050 Other = RHS.get(); 10051 } else { 10052 Literal = RHS.get(); 10053 Other = LHS.get(); 10054 } 10055 10056 // Don't warn on comparisons against nil. 10057 Other = Other->IgnoreParenCasts(); 10058 if (Other->isNullPointerConstant(S.getASTContext(), 10059 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull)) 10060 return; 10061 10062 // This should be kept in sync with warn_objc_literal_comparison. 10063 // LK_String should always be after the other literals, since it has its own 10064 // warning flag. 10065 Sema::ObjCLiteralKind LiteralKind = S.CheckLiteralKind(Literal); 10066 assert(LiteralKind != Sema::LK_Block); 10067 if (LiteralKind == Sema::LK_None) { 10068 llvm_unreachable("Unknown Objective-C object literal kind"); 10069 } 10070 10071 if (LiteralKind == Sema::LK_String) 10072 S.Diag(Loc, diag::warn_objc_string_literal_comparison) 10073 << Literal->getSourceRange(); 10074 else 10075 S.Diag(Loc, diag::warn_objc_literal_comparison) 10076 << LiteralKind << Literal->getSourceRange(); 10077 10078 if (BinaryOperator::isEqualityOp(Opc) && 10079 hasIsEqualMethod(S, LHS.get(), RHS.get())) { 10080 SourceLocation Start = LHS.get()->getBeginLoc(); 10081 SourceLocation End = S.getLocForEndOfToken(RHS.get()->getEndLoc()); 10082 CharSourceRange OpRange = 10083 CharSourceRange::getCharRange(Loc, S.getLocForEndOfToken(Loc)); 10084 10085 S.Diag(Loc, diag::note_objc_literal_comparison_isequal) 10086 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(Start, Opc == BO_EQ ? "[" : "![") 10087 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(OpRange, " isEqual:") 10088 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(End, "]"); 10089 } 10090 } 10091 10092 /// Warns on !x < y, !x & y where !(x < y), !(x & y) was probably intended. 10093 static void diagnoseLogicalNotOnLHSofCheck(Sema &S, ExprResult &LHS, 10094 ExprResult &RHS, SourceLocation Loc, 10095 BinaryOperatorKind Opc) { 10096 // Check that left hand side is !something. 10097 UnaryOperator *UO = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(LHS.get()->IgnoreImpCasts()); 10098 if (!UO || UO->getOpcode() != UO_LNot) return; 10099 10100 // Only check if the right hand side is non-bool arithmetic type. 10101 if (RHS.get()->isKnownToHaveBooleanValue()) return; 10102 10103 // Make sure that the something in !something is not bool. 10104 Expr *SubExpr = UO->getSubExpr()->IgnoreImpCasts(); 10105 if (SubExpr->isKnownToHaveBooleanValue()) return; 10106 10107 // Emit warning. 10108 bool IsBitwiseOp = Opc == BO_And || Opc == BO_Or || Opc == BO_Xor; 10109 S.Diag(UO->getOperatorLoc(), diag::warn_logical_not_on_lhs_of_check) 10110 << Loc << IsBitwiseOp; 10111 10112 // First note suggest !(x < y) 10113 SourceLocation FirstOpen = SubExpr->getBeginLoc(); 10114 SourceLocation FirstClose = RHS.get()->getEndLoc(); 10115 FirstClose = S.getLocForEndOfToken(FirstClose); 10116 if (FirstClose.isInvalid()) 10117 FirstOpen = SourceLocation(); 10118 S.Diag(UO->getOperatorLoc(), diag::note_logical_not_fix) 10119 << IsBitwiseOp 10120 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(FirstOpen, "(") 10121 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(FirstClose, ")"); 10122 10123 // Second note suggests (!x) < y 10124 SourceLocation SecondOpen = LHS.get()->getBeginLoc(); 10125 SourceLocation SecondClose = LHS.get()->getEndLoc(); 10126 SecondClose = S.getLocForEndOfToken(SecondClose); 10127 if (SecondClose.isInvalid()) 10128 SecondOpen = SourceLocation(); 10129 S.Diag(UO->getOperatorLoc(), diag::note_logical_not_silence_with_parens) 10130 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(SecondOpen, "(") 10131 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(SecondClose, ")"); 10132 } 10133 10134 // Get the decl for a simple expression: a reference to a variable, 10135 // an implicit C++ field reference, or an implicit ObjC ivar reference. 10136 static ValueDecl *getCompareDecl(Expr *E) { 10137 if (DeclRefExpr *DR = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(E)) 10138 return DR->getDecl(); 10139 if (ObjCIvarRefExpr *Ivar = dyn_cast<ObjCIvarRefExpr>(E)) { 10140 if (Ivar->isFreeIvar()) 10141 return Ivar->getDecl(); 10142 } 10143 if (MemberExpr *Mem = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(E)) { 10144 if (Mem->isImplicitAccess()) 10145 return Mem->getMemberDecl(); 10146 } 10147 return nullptr; 10148 } 10149 10150 /// Diagnose some forms of syntactically-obvious tautological comparison. 10151 static void diagnoseTautologicalComparison(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, 10152 Expr *LHS, Expr *RHS, 10153 BinaryOperatorKind Opc) { 10154 Expr *LHSStripped = LHS->IgnoreParenImpCasts(); 10155 Expr *RHSStripped = RHS->IgnoreParenImpCasts(); 10156 10157 QualType LHSType = LHS->getType(); 10158 QualType RHSType = RHS->getType(); 10159 if (LHSType->hasFloatingRepresentation() || 10160 (LHSType->isBlockPointerType() && !BinaryOperator::isEqualityOp(Opc)) || 10161 LHS->getBeginLoc().isMacroID() || RHS->getBeginLoc().isMacroID() || 10162 S.inTemplateInstantiation()) 10163 return; 10164 10165 // Comparisons between two array types are ill-formed for operator<=>, so 10166 // we shouldn't emit any additional warnings about it. 10167 if (Opc == BO_Cmp && LHSType->isArrayType() && RHSType->isArrayType()) 10168 return; 10169 10170 // For non-floating point types, check for self-comparisons of the form 10171 // x == x, x != x, x < x, etc. These always evaluate to a constant, and 10172 // often indicate logic errors in the program. 10173 // 10174 // NOTE: Don't warn about comparison expressions resulting from macro 10175 // expansion. Also don't warn about comparisons which are only self 10176 // comparisons within a template instantiation. The warnings should catch 10177 // obvious cases in the definition of the template anyways. The idea is to 10178 // warn when the typed comparison operator will always evaluate to the same 10179 // result. 10180 ValueDecl *DL = getCompareDecl(LHSStripped); 10181 ValueDecl *DR = getCompareDecl(RHSStripped); 10182 10183 // Used for indexing into %select in warn_comparison_always 10184 enum { 10185 AlwaysConstant, 10186 AlwaysTrue, 10187 AlwaysFalse, 10188 AlwaysEqual, // std::strong_ordering::equal from operator<=> 10189 }; 10190 if (DL && DR && declaresSameEntity(DL, DR)) { 10191 unsigned Result; 10192 switch (Opc) { 10193 case BO_EQ: case BO_LE: case BO_GE: 10194 Result = AlwaysTrue; 10195 break; 10196 case BO_NE: case BO_LT: case BO_GT: 10197 Result = AlwaysFalse; 10198 break; 10199 case BO_Cmp: 10200 Result = AlwaysEqual; 10201 break; 10202 default: 10203 Result = AlwaysConstant; 10204 break; 10205 } 10206 S.DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, nullptr, 10207 S.PDiag(diag::warn_comparison_always) 10208 << 0 /*self-comparison*/ 10209 << Result); 10210 } else if (DL && DR && 10211 DL->getType()->isArrayType() && DR->getType()->isArrayType() && 10212 !DL->isWeak() && !DR->isWeak()) { 10213 // What is it always going to evaluate to? 10214 unsigned Result; 10215 switch(Opc) { 10216 case BO_EQ: // e.g. array1 == array2 10217 Result = AlwaysFalse; 10218 break; 10219 case BO_NE: // e.g. array1 != array2 10220 Result = AlwaysTrue; 10221 break; 10222 default: // e.g. array1 <= array2 10223 // The best we can say is 'a constant' 10224 Result = AlwaysConstant; 10225 break; 10226 } 10227 S.DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, nullptr, 10228 S.PDiag(diag::warn_comparison_always) 10229 << 1 /*array comparison*/ 10230 << Result); 10231 } 10232 10233 if (isa<CastExpr>(LHSStripped)) 10234 LHSStripped = LHSStripped->IgnoreParenCasts(); 10235 if (isa<CastExpr>(RHSStripped)) 10236 RHSStripped = RHSStripped->IgnoreParenCasts(); 10237 10238 // Warn about comparisons against a string constant (unless the other 10239 // operand is null); the user probably wants strcmp. 10240 Expr *LiteralString = nullptr; 10241 Expr *LiteralStringStripped = nullptr; 10242 if ((isa<StringLiteral>(LHSStripped) || isa<ObjCEncodeExpr>(LHSStripped)) && 10243 !RHSStripped->isNullPointerConstant(S.Context, 10244 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) { 10245 LiteralString = LHS; 10246 LiteralStringStripped = LHSStripped; 10247 } else if ((isa<StringLiteral>(RHSStripped) || 10248 isa<ObjCEncodeExpr>(RHSStripped)) && 10249 !LHSStripped->isNullPointerConstant(S.Context, 10250 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) { 10251 LiteralString = RHS; 10252 LiteralStringStripped = RHSStripped; 10253 } 10254 10255 if (LiteralString) { 10256 S.DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, nullptr, 10257 S.PDiag(diag::warn_stringcompare) 10258 << isa<ObjCEncodeExpr>(LiteralStringStripped) 10259 << LiteralString->getSourceRange()); 10260 } 10261 } 10262 10263 static ImplicitConversionKind castKindToImplicitConversionKind(CastKind CK) { 10264 switch (CK) { 10265 default: { 10266 #ifndef NDEBUG 10267 llvm::errs() << "unhandled cast kind: " << CastExpr::getCastKindName(CK) 10268 << "\n"; 10269 #endif 10270 llvm_unreachable("unhandled cast kind"); 10271 } 10272 case CK_UserDefinedConversion: 10273 return ICK_Identity; 10274 case CK_LValueToRValue: 10275 return ICK_Lvalue_To_Rvalue; 10276 case CK_ArrayToPointerDecay: 10277 return ICK_Array_To_Pointer; 10278 case CK_FunctionToPointerDecay: 10279 return ICK_Function_To_Pointer; 10280 case CK_IntegralCast: 10281 return ICK_Integral_Conversion; 10282 case CK_FloatingCast: 10283 return ICK_Floating_Conversion; 10284 case CK_IntegralToFloating: 10285 case CK_FloatingToIntegral: 10286 return ICK_Floating_Integral; 10287 case CK_IntegralComplexCast: 10288 case CK_FloatingComplexCast: 10289 case CK_FloatingComplexToIntegralComplex: 10290 case CK_IntegralComplexToFloatingComplex: 10291 return ICK_Complex_Conversion; 10292 case CK_FloatingComplexToReal: 10293 case CK_FloatingRealToComplex: 10294 case CK_IntegralComplexToReal: 10295 case CK_IntegralRealToComplex: 10296 return ICK_Complex_Real; 10297 } 10298 } 10299 10300 static bool checkThreeWayNarrowingConversion(Sema &S, QualType ToType, Expr *E, 10301 QualType FromType, 10302 SourceLocation Loc) { 10303 // Check for a narrowing implicit conversion. 10304 StandardConversionSequence SCS; 10305 SCS.setAsIdentityConversion(); 10306 SCS.setToType(0, FromType); 10307 SCS.setToType(1, ToType); 10308 if (const auto *ICE = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(E)) 10309 SCS.Second = castKindToImplicitConversionKind(ICE->getCastKind()); 10310 10311 APValue PreNarrowingValue; 10312 QualType PreNarrowingType; 10313 switch (SCS.getNarrowingKind(S.Context, E, PreNarrowingValue, 10314 PreNarrowingType, 10315 /*IgnoreFloatToIntegralConversion*/ true)) { 10316 case NK_Dependent_Narrowing: 10317 // Implicit conversion to a narrower type, but the expression is 10318 // value-dependent so we can't tell whether it's actually narrowing. 10319 case NK_Not_Narrowing: 10320 return false; 10321 10322 case NK_Constant_Narrowing: 10323 // Implicit conversion to a narrower type, and the value is not a constant 10324 // expression. 10325 S.Diag(E->getBeginLoc(), diag::err_spaceship_argument_narrowing) 10326 << /*Constant*/ 1 10327 << PreNarrowingValue.getAsString(S.Context, PreNarrowingType) << ToType; 10328 return true; 10329 10330 case NK_Variable_Narrowing: 10331 // Implicit conversion to a narrower type, and the value is not a constant 10332 // expression. 10333 case NK_Type_Narrowing: 10334 S.Diag(E->getBeginLoc(), diag::err_spaceship_argument_narrowing) 10335 << /*Constant*/ 0 << FromType << ToType; 10336 // TODO: It's not a constant expression, but what if the user intended it 10337 // to be? Can we produce notes to help them figure out why it isn't? 10338 return true; 10339 } 10340 llvm_unreachable("unhandled case in switch"); 10341 } 10342 10343 static QualType checkArithmeticOrEnumeralThreeWayCompare(Sema &S, 10344 ExprResult &LHS, 10345 ExprResult &RHS, 10346 SourceLocation Loc) { 10347 using CCT = ComparisonCategoryType; 10348 10349 QualType LHSType = LHS.get()->getType(); 10350 QualType RHSType = RHS.get()->getType(); 10351 // Dig out the original argument type and expression before implicit casts 10352 // were applied. These are the types/expressions we need to check the 10353 // [expr.spaceship] requirements against. 10354 ExprResult LHSStripped = LHS.get()->IgnoreParenImpCasts(); 10355 ExprResult RHSStripped = RHS.get()->IgnoreParenImpCasts(); 10356 QualType LHSStrippedType = LHSStripped.get()->getType(); 10357 QualType RHSStrippedType = RHSStripped.get()->getType(); 10358 10359 // C++2a [expr.spaceship]p3: If one of the operands is of type bool and the 10360 // other is not, the program is ill-formed. 10361 if (LHSStrippedType->isBooleanType() != RHSStrippedType->isBooleanType()) { 10362 S.InvalidOperands(Loc, LHSStripped, RHSStripped); 10363 return QualType(); 10364 } 10365 10366 int NumEnumArgs = (int)LHSStrippedType->isEnumeralType() + 10367 RHSStrippedType->isEnumeralType(); 10368 if (NumEnumArgs == 1) { 10369 bool LHSIsEnum = LHSStrippedType->isEnumeralType(); 10370 QualType OtherTy = LHSIsEnum ? RHSStrippedType : LHSStrippedType; 10371 if (OtherTy->hasFloatingRepresentation()) { 10372 S.InvalidOperands(Loc, LHSStripped, RHSStripped); 10373 return QualType(); 10374 } 10375 } 10376 if (NumEnumArgs == 2) { 10377 // C++2a [expr.spaceship]p5: If both operands have the same enumeration 10378 // type E, the operator yields the result of converting the operands 10379 // to the underlying type of E and applying <=> to the converted operands. 10380 if (!S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(LHSStrippedType, RHSStrippedType)) { 10381 S.InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS); 10382 return QualType(); 10383 } 10384 QualType IntType = 10385 LHSStrippedType->getAs<EnumType>()->getDecl()->getIntegerType(); 10386 assert(IntType->isArithmeticType()); 10387 10388 // We can't use `CK_IntegralCast` when the underlying type is 'bool', so we 10389 // promote the boolean type, and all other promotable integer types, to 10390 // avoid this. 10391 if (IntType->isPromotableIntegerType()) 10392 IntType = S.Context.getPromotedIntegerType(IntType); 10393 10394 LHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), IntType, CK_IntegralCast); 10395 RHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), IntType, CK_IntegralCast); 10396 LHSType = RHSType = IntType; 10397 } 10398 10399 // C++2a [expr.spaceship]p4: If both operands have arithmetic types, the 10400 // usual arithmetic conversions are applied to the operands. 10401 QualType Type = S.UsualArithmeticConversions(LHS, RHS); 10402 if (LHS.isInvalid() || RHS.isInvalid()) 10403 return QualType(); 10404 if (Type.isNull()) 10405 return S.InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS); 10406 assert(Type->isArithmeticType() || Type->isEnumeralType()); 10407 10408 bool HasNarrowing = checkThreeWayNarrowingConversion( 10409 S, Type, LHS.get(), LHSType, LHS.get()->getBeginLoc()); 10410 HasNarrowing |= checkThreeWayNarrowingConversion(S, Type, RHS.get(), RHSType, 10411 RHS.get()->getBeginLoc()); 10412 if (HasNarrowing) 10413 return QualType(); 10414 10415 assert(!Type.isNull() && "composite type for <=> has not been set"); 10416 10417 auto TypeKind = [&]() { 10418 if (const ComplexType *CT = Type->getAs<ComplexType>()) { 10419 if (CT->getElementType()->hasFloatingRepresentation()) 10420 return CCT::WeakEquality; 10421 return CCT::StrongEquality; 10422 } 10423 if (Type->isIntegralOrEnumerationType()) 10424 return CCT::StrongOrdering; 10425 if (Type->hasFloatingRepresentation()) 10426 return CCT::PartialOrdering; 10427 llvm_unreachable("other types are unimplemented"); 10428 }(); 10429 10430 return S.CheckComparisonCategoryType(TypeKind, Loc); 10431 } 10432 10433 static QualType checkArithmeticOrEnumeralCompare(Sema &S, ExprResult &LHS, 10434 ExprResult &RHS, 10435 SourceLocation Loc, 10436 BinaryOperatorKind Opc) { 10437 if (Opc == BO_Cmp) 10438 return checkArithmeticOrEnumeralThreeWayCompare(S, LHS, RHS, Loc); 10439 10440 // C99 6.5.8p3 / C99 6.5.9p4 10441 QualType Type = S.UsualArithmeticConversions(LHS, RHS); 10442 if (LHS.isInvalid() || RHS.isInvalid()) 10443 return QualType(); 10444 if (Type.isNull()) 10445 return S.InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS); 10446 assert(Type->isArithmeticType() || Type->isEnumeralType()); 10447 10448 checkEnumComparison(S, Loc, LHS.get(), RHS.get()); 10449 10450 if (Type->isAnyComplexType() && BinaryOperator::isRelationalOp(Opc)) 10451 return S.InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS); 10452 10453 // Check for comparisons of floating point operands using != and ==. 10454 if (Type->hasFloatingRepresentation() && BinaryOperator::isEqualityOp(Opc)) 10455 S.CheckFloatComparison(Loc, LHS.get(), RHS.get()); 10456 10457 // The result of comparisons is 'bool' in C++, 'int' in C. 10458 return S.Context.getLogicalOperationType(); 10459 } 10460 10461 void Sema::CheckPtrComparisonWithNullChar(ExprResult &E, ExprResult &NullE) { 10462 if (!NullE.get()->getType()->isAnyPointerType()) 10463 return; 10464 int NullValue = PP.isMacroDefined("NULL") ? 0 : 1; 10465 if (!E.get()->getType()->isAnyPointerType() && 10466 E.get()->isNullPointerConstant(Context, 10467 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull) == 10468 Expr::NPCK_ZeroExpression) { 10469 if (const auto *CL = dyn_cast<CharacterLiteral>(E.get())) { 10470 if (CL->getValue() == 0) 10471 Diag(E.get()->getExprLoc(), diag::warn_pointer_compare) 10472 << NullValue 10473 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(E.get()->getExprLoc(), 10474 NullValue ? "NULL" : "(void *)0"); 10475 } else if (const auto *CE = dyn_cast<CStyleCastExpr>(E.get())) { 10476 TypeSourceInfo *TI = CE->getTypeInfoAsWritten(); 10477 QualType T = Context.getCanonicalType(TI->getType()).getUnqualifiedType(); 10478 if (T == Context.CharTy) 10479 Diag(E.get()->getExprLoc(), diag::warn_pointer_compare) 10480 << NullValue 10481 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(E.get()->getExprLoc(), 10482 NullValue ? "NULL" : "(void *)0"); 10483 } 10484 } 10485 } 10486 10487 // C99 6.5.8, C++ [expr.rel] 10488 QualType Sema::CheckCompareOperands(ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS, 10489 SourceLocation Loc, 10490 BinaryOperatorKind Opc) { 10491 bool IsRelational = BinaryOperator::isRelationalOp(Opc); 10492 bool IsThreeWay = Opc == BO_Cmp; 10493 auto IsAnyPointerType = [](ExprResult E) { 10494 QualType Ty = E.get()->getType(); 10495 return Ty->isPointerType() || Ty->isMemberPointerType(); 10496 }; 10497 10498 // C++2a [expr.spaceship]p6: If at least one of the operands is of pointer 10499 // type, array-to-pointer, ..., conversions are performed on both operands to 10500 // bring them to their composite type. 10501 // Otherwise, all comparisons expect an rvalue, so convert to rvalue before 10502 // any type-related checks. 10503 if (!IsThreeWay || IsAnyPointerType(LHS) || IsAnyPointerType(RHS)) { 10504 LHS = DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(LHS.get()); 10505 if (LHS.isInvalid()) 10506 return QualType(); 10507 RHS = DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(RHS.get()); 10508 if (RHS.isInvalid()) 10509 return QualType(); 10510 } else { 10511 LHS = DefaultLvalueConversion(LHS.get()); 10512 if (LHS.isInvalid()) 10513 return QualType(); 10514 RHS = DefaultLvalueConversion(RHS.get()); 10515 if (RHS.isInvalid()) 10516 return QualType(); 10517 } 10518 10519 checkArithmeticNull(*this, LHS, RHS, Loc, /*IsCompare=*/true); 10520 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && BinaryOperator::isEqualityOp(Opc)) { 10521 CheckPtrComparisonWithNullChar(LHS, RHS); 10522 CheckPtrComparisonWithNullChar(RHS, LHS); 10523 } 10524 10525 // Handle vector comparisons separately. 10526 if (LHS.get()->getType()->isVectorType() || 10527 RHS.get()->getType()->isVectorType()) 10528 return CheckVectorCompareOperands(LHS, RHS, Loc, Opc); 10529 10530 diagnoseLogicalNotOnLHSofCheck(*this, LHS, RHS, Loc, Opc); 10531 diagnoseTautologicalComparison(*this, Loc, LHS.get(), RHS.get(), Opc); 10532 10533 QualType LHSType = LHS.get()->getType(); 10534 QualType RHSType = RHS.get()->getType(); 10535 if ((LHSType->isArithmeticType() || LHSType->isEnumeralType()) && 10536 (RHSType->isArithmeticType() || RHSType->isEnumeralType())) 10537 return checkArithmeticOrEnumeralCompare(*this, LHS, RHS, Loc, Opc); 10538 10539 const Expr::NullPointerConstantKind LHSNullKind = 10540 LHS.get()->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull); 10541 const Expr::NullPointerConstantKind RHSNullKind = 10542 RHS.get()->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull); 10543 bool LHSIsNull = LHSNullKind != Expr::NPCK_NotNull; 10544 bool RHSIsNull = RHSNullKind != Expr::NPCK_NotNull; 10545 10546 auto computeResultTy = [&]() { 10547 if (Opc != BO_Cmp) 10548 return Context.getLogicalOperationType(); 10549 assert(getLangOpts().CPlusPlus); 10550 assert(Context.hasSameType(LHS.get()->getType(), RHS.get()->getType())); 10551 10552 QualType CompositeTy = LHS.get()->getType(); 10553 assert(!CompositeTy->isReferenceType()); 10554 10555 auto buildResultTy = [&](ComparisonCategoryType Kind) { 10556 return CheckComparisonCategoryType(Kind, Loc); 10557 }; 10558 10559 // C++2a [expr.spaceship]p7: If the composite pointer type is a function 10560 // pointer type, a pointer-to-member type, or std::nullptr_t, the 10561 // result is of type std::strong_equality 10562 if (CompositeTy->isFunctionPointerType() || 10563 CompositeTy->isMemberPointerType() || CompositeTy->isNullPtrType()) 10564 // FIXME: consider making the function pointer case produce 10565 // strong_ordering not strong_equality, per P0946R0-Jax18 discussion 10566 // and direction polls 10567 return buildResultTy(ComparisonCategoryType::StrongEquality); 10568 10569 // C++2a [expr.spaceship]p8: If the composite pointer type is an object 10570 // pointer type, p <=> q is of type std::strong_ordering. 10571 if (CompositeTy->isPointerType()) { 10572 // P0946R0: Comparisons between a null pointer constant and an object 10573 // pointer result in std::strong_equality 10574 if (LHSIsNull != RHSIsNull) 10575 return buildResultTy(ComparisonCategoryType::StrongEquality); 10576 return buildResultTy(ComparisonCategoryType::StrongOrdering); 10577 } 10578 // C++2a [expr.spaceship]p9: Otherwise, the program is ill-formed. 10579 // TODO: Extend support for operator<=> to ObjC types. 10580 return InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS); 10581 }; 10582 10583 10584 if (!IsRelational && LHSIsNull != RHSIsNull) { 10585 bool IsEquality = Opc == BO_EQ; 10586 if (RHSIsNull) 10587 DiagnoseAlwaysNonNullPointer(LHS.get(), RHSNullKind, IsEquality, 10588 RHS.get()->getSourceRange()); 10589 else 10590 DiagnoseAlwaysNonNullPointer(RHS.get(), LHSNullKind, IsEquality, 10591 LHS.get()->getSourceRange()); 10592 } 10593 10594 if ((LHSType->isIntegerType() && !LHSIsNull) || 10595 (RHSType->isIntegerType() && !RHSIsNull)) { 10596 // Skip normal pointer conversion checks in this case; we have better 10597 // diagnostics for this below. 10598 } else if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 10599 // Equality comparison of a function pointer to a void pointer is invalid, 10600 // but we allow it as an extension. 10601 // FIXME: If we really want to allow this, should it be part of composite 10602 // pointer type computation so it works in conditionals too? 10603 if (!IsRelational && 10604 ((LHSType->isFunctionPointerType() && RHSType->isVoidPointerType()) || 10605 (RHSType->isFunctionPointerType() && LHSType->isVoidPointerType()))) { 10606 // This is a gcc extension compatibility comparison. 10607 // In a SFINAE context, we treat this as a hard error to maintain 10608 // conformance with the C++ standard. 10609 diagnoseFunctionPointerToVoidComparison( 10610 *this, Loc, LHS, RHS, /*isError*/ (bool)isSFINAEContext()); 10611 10612 if (isSFINAEContext()) 10613 return QualType(); 10614 10615 RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), LHSType, CK_BitCast); 10616 return computeResultTy(); 10617 } 10618 10619 // C++ [expr.eq]p2: 10620 // If at least one operand is a pointer [...] bring them to their 10621 // composite pointer type. 10622 // C++ [expr.spaceship]p6 10623 // If at least one of the operands is of pointer type, [...] bring them 10624 // to their composite pointer type. 10625 // C++ [expr.rel]p2: 10626 // If both operands are pointers, [...] bring them to their composite 10627 // pointer type. 10628 if ((int)LHSType->isPointerType() + (int)RHSType->isPointerType() >= 10629 (IsRelational ? 2 : 1) && 10630 (!LangOpts.ObjCAutoRefCount || !(LHSType->isObjCObjectPointerType() || 10631 RHSType->isObjCObjectPointerType()))) { 10632 if (convertPointersToCompositeType(*this, Loc, LHS, RHS)) 10633 return QualType(); 10634 return computeResultTy(); 10635 } 10636 } else if (LHSType->isPointerType() && 10637 RHSType->isPointerType()) { // C99 6.5.8p2 10638 // All of the following pointer-related warnings are GCC extensions, except 10639 // when handling null pointer constants. 10640 QualType LCanPointeeTy = 10641 LHSType->castAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType().getCanonicalType(); 10642 QualType RCanPointeeTy = 10643 RHSType->castAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType().getCanonicalType(); 10644 10645 // C99 6.5.9p2 and C99 6.5.8p2 10646 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(LCanPointeeTy.getUnqualifiedType(), 10647 RCanPointeeTy.getUnqualifiedType())) { 10648 // Valid unless a relational comparison of function pointers 10649 if (IsRelational && LCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType()) { 10650 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_ordered_comparison_of_function_pointers) 10651 << LHSType << RHSType << LHS.get()->getSourceRange() 10652 << RHS.get()->getSourceRange(); 10653 } 10654 } else if (!IsRelational && 10655 (LCanPointeeTy->isVoidType() || RCanPointeeTy->isVoidType())) { 10656 // Valid unless comparison between non-null pointer and function pointer 10657 if ((LCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType() || RCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType()) 10658 && !LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull) 10659 diagnoseFunctionPointerToVoidComparison(*this, Loc, LHS, RHS, 10660 /*isError*/false); 10661 } else { 10662 // Invalid 10663 diagnoseDistinctPointerComparison(*this, Loc, LHS, RHS, /*isError*/false); 10664 } 10665 if (LCanPointeeTy != RCanPointeeTy) { 10666 // Treat NULL constant as a special case in OpenCL. 10667 if (getLangOpts().OpenCL && !LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull) { 10668 const PointerType *LHSPtr = LHSType->getAs<PointerType>(); 10669 if (!LHSPtr->isAddressSpaceOverlapping(*RHSType->getAs<PointerType>())) { 10670 Diag(Loc, 10671 diag::err_typecheck_op_on_nonoverlapping_address_space_pointers) 10672 << LHSType << RHSType << 0 /* comparison */ 10673 << LHS.get()->getSourceRange() << RHS.get()->getSourceRange(); 10674 } 10675 } 10676 LangAS AddrSpaceL = LCanPointeeTy.getAddressSpace(); 10677 LangAS AddrSpaceR = RCanPointeeTy.getAddressSpace(); 10678 CastKind Kind = AddrSpaceL != AddrSpaceR ? CK_AddressSpaceConversion 10679 : CK_BitCast; 10680 if (LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull) 10681 LHS = ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), RHSType, Kind); 10682 else 10683 RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), LHSType, Kind); 10684 } 10685 return computeResultTy(); 10686 } 10687 10688 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 10689 // C++ [expr.eq]p4: 10690 // Two operands of type std::nullptr_t or one operand of type 10691 // std::nullptr_t and the other a null pointer constant compare equal. 10692 if (!IsRelational && LHSIsNull && RHSIsNull) { 10693 if (LHSType->isNullPtrType()) { 10694 RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), LHSType, CK_NullToPointer); 10695 return computeResultTy(); 10696 } 10697 if (RHSType->isNullPtrType()) { 10698 LHS = ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), RHSType, CK_NullToPointer); 10699 return computeResultTy(); 10700 } 10701 } 10702 10703 // Comparison of Objective-C pointers and block pointers against nullptr_t. 10704 // These aren't covered by the composite pointer type rules. 10705 if (!IsRelational && RHSType->isNullPtrType() && 10706 (LHSType->isObjCObjectPointerType() || LHSType->isBlockPointerType())) { 10707 RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), LHSType, CK_NullToPointer); 10708 return computeResultTy(); 10709 } 10710 if (!IsRelational && LHSType->isNullPtrType() && 10711 (RHSType->isObjCObjectPointerType() || RHSType->isBlockPointerType())) { 10712 LHS = ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), RHSType, CK_NullToPointer); 10713 return computeResultTy(); 10714 } 10715 10716 if (IsRelational && 10717 ((LHSType->isNullPtrType() && RHSType->isPointerType()) || 10718 (RHSType->isNullPtrType() && LHSType->isPointerType()))) { 10719 // HACK: Relational comparison of nullptr_t against a pointer type is 10720 // invalid per DR583, but we allow it within std::less<> and friends, 10721 // since otherwise common uses of it break. 10722 // FIXME: Consider removing this hack once LWG fixes std::less<> and 10723 // friends to have std::nullptr_t overload candidates. 10724 DeclContext *DC = CurContext; 10725 if (isa<FunctionDecl>(DC)) 10726 DC = DC->getParent(); 10727 if (auto *CTSD = dyn_cast<ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl>(DC)) { 10728 if (CTSD->isInStdNamespace() && 10729 llvm::StringSwitch<bool>(CTSD->getName()) 10730 .Cases("less", "less_equal", "greater", "greater_equal", true) 10731 .Default(false)) { 10732 if (RHSType->isNullPtrType()) 10733 RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), LHSType, CK_NullToPointer); 10734 else 10735 LHS = ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), RHSType, CK_NullToPointer); 10736 return computeResultTy(); 10737 } 10738 } 10739 } 10740 10741 // C++ [expr.eq]p2: 10742 // If at least one operand is a pointer to member, [...] bring them to 10743 // their composite pointer type. 10744 if (!IsRelational && 10745 (LHSType->isMemberPointerType() || RHSType->isMemberPointerType())) { 10746 if (convertPointersToCompositeType(*this, Loc, LHS, RHS)) 10747 return QualType(); 10748 else 10749 return computeResultTy(); 10750 } 10751 } 10752 10753 // Handle block pointer types. 10754 if (!IsRelational && LHSType->isBlockPointerType() && 10755 RHSType->isBlockPointerType()) { 10756 QualType lpointee = LHSType->castAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType(); 10757 QualType rpointee = RHSType->castAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType(); 10758 10759 if (!LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull && 10760 !Context.typesAreCompatible(lpointee, rpointee)) { 10761 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_blocks) 10762 << LHSType << RHSType << LHS.get()->getSourceRange() 10763 << RHS.get()->getSourceRange(); 10764 } 10765 RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), LHSType, CK_BitCast); 10766 return computeResultTy(); 10767 } 10768 10769 // Allow block pointers to be compared with null pointer constants. 10770 if (!IsRelational 10771 && ((LHSType->isBlockPointerType() && RHSType->isPointerType()) 10772 || (LHSType->isPointerType() && RHSType->isBlockPointerType()))) { 10773 if (!LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull) { 10774 if (!((RHSType->isPointerType() && RHSType->castAs<PointerType>() 10775 ->getPointeeType()->isVoidType()) 10776 || (LHSType->isPointerType() && LHSType->castAs<PointerType>() 10777 ->getPointeeType()->isVoidType()))) 10778 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_blocks) 10779 << LHSType << RHSType << LHS.get()->getSourceRange() 10780 << RHS.get()->getSourceRange(); 10781 } 10782 if (LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull) 10783 LHS = ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), RHSType, 10784 RHSType->isPointerType() ? CK_BitCast 10785 : CK_AnyPointerToBlockPointerCast); 10786 else 10787 RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), LHSType, 10788 LHSType->isPointerType() ? CK_BitCast 10789 : CK_AnyPointerToBlockPointerCast); 10790 return computeResultTy(); 10791 } 10792 10793 if (LHSType->isObjCObjectPointerType() || 10794 RHSType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) { 10795 const PointerType *LPT = LHSType->getAs<PointerType>(); 10796 const PointerType *RPT = RHSType->getAs<PointerType>(); 10797 if (LPT || RPT) { 10798 bool LPtrToVoid = LPT ? LPT->getPointeeType()->isVoidType() : false; 10799 bool RPtrToVoid = RPT ? RPT->getPointeeType()->isVoidType() : false; 10800 10801 if (!LPtrToVoid && !RPtrToVoid && 10802 !Context.typesAreCompatible(LHSType, RHSType)) { 10803 diagnoseDistinctPointerComparison(*this, Loc, LHS, RHS, 10804 /*isError*/false); 10805 } 10806 if (LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull) { 10807 Expr *E = LHS.get(); 10808 if (getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount) 10809 CheckObjCConversion(SourceRange(), RHSType, E, 10810 CCK_ImplicitConversion); 10811 LHS = ImpCastExprToType(E, RHSType, 10812 RPT ? CK_BitCast :CK_CPointerToObjCPointerCast); 10813 } 10814 else { 10815 Expr *E = RHS.get(); 10816 if (getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount) 10817 CheckObjCConversion(SourceRange(), LHSType, E, CCK_ImplicitConversion, 10818 /*Diagnose=*/true, 10819 /*DiagnoseCFAudited=*/false, Opc); 10820 RHS = ImpCastExprToType(E, LHSType, 10821 LPT ? CK_BitCast :CK_CPointerToObjCPointerCast); 10822 } 10823 return computeResultTy(); 10824 } 10825 if (LHSType->isObjCObjectPointerType() && 10826 RHSType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) { 10827 if (!Context.areComparableObjCPointerTypes(LHSType, RHSType)) 10828 diagnoseDistinctPointerComparison(*this, Loc, LHS, RHS, 10829 /*isError*/false); 10830 if (isObjCObjectLiteral(LHS) || isObjCObjectLiteral(RHS)) 10831 diagnoseObjCLiteralComparison(*this, Loc, LHS, RHS, Opc); 10832 10833 if (LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull) 10834 LHS = ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), RHSType, CK_BitCast); 10835 else 10836 RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), LHSType, CK_BitCast); 10837 return computeResultTy(); 10838 } 10839 10840 if (!IsRelational && LHSType->isBlockPointerType() && 10841 RHSType->isBlockCompatibleObjCPointerType(Context)) { 10842 LHS = ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), RHSType, 10843 CK_BlockPointerToObjCPointerCast); 10844 return computeResultTy(); 10845 } else if (!IsRelational && 10846 LHSType->isBlockCompatibleObjCPointerType(Context) && 10847 RHSType->isBlockPointerType()) { 10848 RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), LHSType, 10849 CK_BlockPointerToObjCPointerCast); 10850 return computeResultTy(); 10851 } 10852 } 10853 if ((LHSType->isAnyPointerType() && RHSType->isIntegerType()) || 10854 (LHSType->isIntegerType() && RHSType->isAnyPointerType())) { 10855 unsigned DiagID = 0; 10856 bool isError = false; 10857 if (LangOpts.DebuggerSupport) { 10858 // Under a debugger, allow the comparison of pointers to integers, 10859 // since users tend to want to compare addresses. 10860 } else if ((LHSIsNull && LHSType->isIntegerType()) || 10861 (RHSIsNull && RHSType->isIntegerType())) { 10862 if (IsRelational) { 10863 isError = getLangOpts().CPlusPlus; 10864 DiagID = 10865 isError ? diag::err_typecheck_ordered_comparison_of_pointer_and_zero 10866 : diag::ext_typecheck_ordered_comparison_of_pointer_and_zero; 10867 } 10868 } else if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 10869 DiagID = diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_pointer_integer; 10870 isError = true; 10871 } else if (IsRelational) 10872 DiagID = diag::ext_typecheck_ordered_comparison_of_pointer_integer; 10873 else 10874 DiagID = diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_pointer_integer; 10875 10876 if (DiagID) { 10877 Diag(Loc, DiagID) 10878 << LHSType << RHSType << LHS.get()->getSourceRange() 10879 << RHS.get()->getSourceRange(); 10880 if (isError) 10881 return QualType(); 10882 } 10883 10884 if (LHSType->isIntegerType()) 10885 LHS = ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), RHSType, 10886 LHSIsNull ? CK_NullToPointer : CK_IntegralToPointer); 10887 else 10888 RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), LHSType, 10889 RHSIsNull ? CK_NullToPointer : CK_IntegralToPointer); 10890 return computeResultTy(); 10891 } 10892 10893 // Handle block pointers. 10894 if (!IsRelational && RHSIsNull 10895 && LHSType->isBlockPointerType() && RHSType->isIntegerType()) { 10896 RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), LHSType, CK_NullToPointer); 10897 return computeResultTy(); 10898 } 10899 if (!IsRelational && LHSIsNull 10900 && LHSType->isIntegerType() && RHSType->isBlockPointerType()) { 10901 LHS = ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), RHSType, CK_NullToPointer); 10902 return computeResultTy(); 10903 } 10904 10905 if (getLangOpts().OpenCLVersion >= 200 || getLangOpts().OpenCLCPlusPlus) { 10906 if (LHSType->isClkEventT() && RHSType->isClkEventT()) { 10907 return computeResultTy(); 10908 } 10909 10910 if (LHSType->isQueueT() && RHSType->isQueueT()) { 10911 return computeResultTy(); 10912 } 10913 10914 if (LHSIsNull && RHSType->isQueueT()) { 10915 LHS = ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), RHSType, CK_NullToPointer); 10916 return computeResultTy(); 10917 } 10918 10919 if (LHSType->isQueueT() && RHSIsNull) { 10920 RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), LHSType, CK_NullToPointer); 10921 return computeResultTy(); 10922 } 10923 } 10924 10925 return InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS); 10926 } 10927 10928 // Return a signed ext_vector_type that is of identical size and number of 10929 // elements. For floating point vectors, return an integer type of identical 10930 // size and number of elements. In the non ext_vector_type case, search from 10931 // the largest type to the smallest type to avoid cases where long long == long, 10932 // where long gets picked over long long. 10933 QualType Sema::GetSignedVectorType(QualType V) { 10934 const VectorType *VTy = V->getAs<VectorType>(); 10935 unsigned TypeSize = Context.getTypeSize(VTy->getElementType()); 10936 10937 if (isa<ExtVectorType>(VTy)) { 10938 if (TypeSize == Context.getTypeSize(Context.CharTy)) 10939 return Context.getExtVectorType(Context.CharTy, VTy->getNumElements()); 10940 else if (TypeSize == Context.getTypeSize(Context.ShortTy)) 10941 return Context.getExtVectorType(Context.ShortTy, VTy->getNumElements()); 10942 else if (TypeSize == Context.getTypeSize(Context.IntTy)) 10943 return Context.getExtVectorType(Context.IntTy, VTy->getNumElements()); 10944 else if (TypeSize == Context.getTypeSize(Context.LongTy)) 10945 return Context.getExtVectorType(Context.LongTy, VTy->getNumElements()); 10946 assert(TypeSize == Context.getTypeSize(Context.LongLongTy) && 10947 "Unhandled vector element size in vector compare"); 10948 return Context.getExtVectorType(Context.LongLongTy, VTy->getNumElements()); 10949 } 10950 10951 if (TypeSize == Context.getTypeSize(Context.LongLongTy)) 10952 return Context.getVectorType(Context.LongLongTy, VTy->getNumElements(), 10953 VectorType::GenericVector); 10954 else if (TypeSize == Context.getTypeSize(Context.LongTy)) 10955 return Context.getVectorType(Context.LongTy, VTy->getNumElements(), 10956 VectorType::GenericVector); 10957 else if (TypeSize == Context.getTypeSize(Context.IntTy)) 10958 return Context.getVectorType(Context.IntTy, VTy->getNumElements(), 10959 VectorType::GenericVector); 10960 else if (TypeSize == Context.getTypeSize(Context.ShortTy)) 10961 return Context.getVectorType(Context.ShortTy, VTy->getNumElements(), 10962 VectorType::GenericVector); 10963 assert(TypeSize == Context.getTypeSize(Context.CharTy) && 10964 "Unhandled vector element size in vector compare"); 10965 return Context.getVectorType(Context.CharTy, VTy->getNumElements(), 10966 VectorType::GenericVector); 10967 } 10968 10969 /// CheckVectorCompareOperands - vector comparisons are a clang extension that 10970 /// operates on extended vector types. Instead of producing an IntTy result, 10971 /// like a scalar comparison, a vector comparison produces a vector of integer 10972 /// types. 10973 QualType Sema::CheckVectorCompareOperands(ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS, 10974 SourceLocation Loc, 10975 BinaryOperatorKind Opc) { 10976 // Check to make sure we're operating on vectors of the same type and width, 10977 // Allowing one side to be a scalar of element type. 10978 QualType vType = CheckVectorOperands(LHS, RHS, Loc, /*isCompAssign*/false, 10979 /*AllowBothBool*/true, 10980 /*AllowBoolConversions*/getLangOpts().ZVector); 10981 if (vType.isNull()) 10982 return vType; 10983 10984 QualType LHSType = LHS.get()->getType(); 10985 10986 // If AltiVec, the comparison results in a numeric type, i.e. 10987 // bool for C++, int for C 10988 if (getLangOpts().AltiVec && 10989 vType->getAs<VectorType>()->getVectorKind() == VectorType::AltiVecVector) 10990 return Context.getLogicalOperationType(); 10991 10992 // For non-floating point types, check for self-comparisons of the form 10993 // x == x, x != x, x < x, etc. These always evaluate to a constant, and 10994 // often indicate logic errors in the program. 10995 diagnoseTautologicalComparison(*this, Loc, LHS.get(), RHS.get(), Opc); 10996 10997 // Check for comparisons of floating point operands using != and ==. 10998 if (BinaryOperator::isEqualityOp(Opc) && 10999 LHSType->hasFloatingRepresentation()) { 11000 assert(RHS.get()->getType()->hasFloatingRepresentation()); 11001 CheckFloatComparison(Loc, LHS.get(), RHS.get()); 11002 } 11003 11004 // Return a signed type for the vector. 11005 return GetSignedVectorType(vType); 11006 } 11007 11008 QualType Sema::CheckVectorLogicalOperands(ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS, 11009 SourceLocation Loc) { 11010 // Ensure that either both operands are of the same vector type, or 11011 // one operand is of a vector type and the other is of its element type. 11012 QualType vType = CheckVectorOperands(LHS, RHS, Loc, false, 11013 /*AllowBothBool*/true, 11014 /*AllowBoolConversions*/false); 11015 if (vType.isNull()) 11016 return InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS); 11017 if (getLangOpts().OpenCL && getLangOpts().OpenCLVersion < 120 && 11018 !getLangOpts().OpenCLCPlusPlus && vType->hasFloatingRepresentation()) 11019 return InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS); 11020 // FIXME: The check for C++ here is for GCC compatibility. GCC rejects the 11021 // usage of the logical operators && and || with vectors in C. This 11022 // check could be notionally dropped. 11023 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && 11024 !(isa<ExtVectorType>(vType->getAs<VectorType>()))) 11025 return InvalidLogicalVectorOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS); 11026 11027 return GetSignedVectorType(LHS.get()->getType()); 11028 } 11029 11030 inline QualType Sema::CheckBitwiseOperands(ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS, 11031 SourceLocation Loc, 11032 BinaryOperatorKind Opc) { 11033 checkArithmeticNull(*this, LHS, RHS, Loc, /*IsCompare=*/false); 11034 11035 bool IsCompAssign = 11036 Opc == BO_AndAssign || Opc == BO_OrAssign || Opc == BO_XorAssign; 11037 11038 if (LHS.get()->getType()->isVectorType() || 11039 RHS.get()->getType()->isVectorType()) { 11040 if (LHS.get()->getType()->hasIntegerRepresentation() && 11041 RHS.get()->getType()->hasIntegerRepresentation()) 11042 return CheckVectorOperands(LHS, RHS, Loc, IsCompAssign, 11043 /*AllowBothBool*/true, 11044 /*AllowBoolConversions*/getLangOpts().ZVector); 11045 return InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS); 11046 } 11047 11048 if (Opc == BO_And) 11049 diagnoseLogicalNotOnLHSofCheck(*this, LHS, RHS, Loc, Opc); 11050 11051 ExprResult LHSResult = LHS, RHSResult = RHS; 11052 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(LHSResult, RHSResult, 11053 IsCompAssign); 11054 if (LHSResult.isInvalid() || RHSResult.isInvalid()) 11055 return QualType(); 11056 LHS = LHSResult.get(); 11057 RHS = RHSResult.get(); 11058 11059 if (!compType.isNull() && compType->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType()) 11060 return compType; 11061 return InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS); 11062 } 11063 11064 // C99 6.5.[13,14] 11065 inline QualType Sema::CheckLogicalOperands(ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS, 11066 SourceLocation Loc, 11067 BinaryOperatorKind Opc) { 11068 // Check vector operands differently. 11069 if (LHS.get()->getType()->isVectorType() || RHS.get()->getType()->isVectorType()) 11070 return CheckVectorLogicalOperands(LHS, RHS, Loc); 11071 11072 // Diagnose cases where the user write a logical and/or but probably meant a 11073 // bitwise one. We do this when the LHS is a non-bool integer and the RHS 11074 // is a constant. 11075 if (LHS.get()->getType()->isIntegerType() && 11076 !LHS.get()->getType()->isBooleanType() && 11077 RHS.get()->getType()->isIntegerType() && !RHS.get()->isValueDependent() && 11078 // Don't warn in macros or template instantiations. 11079 !Loc.isMacroID() && !inTemplateInstantiation()) { 11080 // If the RHS can be constant folded, and if it constant folds to something 11081 // that isn't 0 or 1 (which indicate a potential logical operation that 11082 // happened to fold to true/false) then warn. 11083 // Parens on the RHS are ignored. 11084 Expr::EvalResult EVResult; 11085 if (RHS.get()->EvaluateAsInt(EVResult, Context)) { 11086 llvm::APSInt Result = EVResult.Val.getInt(); 11087 if ((getLangOpts().Bool && !RHS.get()->getType()->isBooleanType() && 11088 !RHS.get()->getExprLoc().isMacroID()) || 11089 (Result != 0 && Result != 1)) { 11090 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_logical_instead_of_bitwise) 11091 << RHS.get()->getSourceRange() 11092 << (Opc == BO_LAnd ? "&&" : "||"); 11093 // Suggest replacing the logical operator with the bitwise version 11094 Diag(Loc, diag::note_logical_instead_of_bitwise_change_operator) 11095 << (Opc == BO_LAnd ? "&" : "|") 11096 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(SourceRange( 11097 Loc, getLocForEndOfToken(Loc)), 11098 Opc == BO_LAnd ? "&" : "|"); 11099 if (Opc == BO_LAnd) 11100 // Suggest replacing "Foo() && kNonZero" with "Foo()" 11101 Diag(Loc, diag::note_logical_instead_of_bitwise_remove_constant) 11102 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval( 11103 SourceRange(getLocForEndOfToken(LHS.get()->getEndLoc()), 11104 RHS.get()->getEndLoc())); 11105 } 11106 } 11107 } 11108 11109 if (!Context.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 11110 // OpenCL v1.1 s6.3.g: The logical operators and (&&), or (||) do 11111 // not operate on the built-in scalar and vector float types. 11112 if (Context.getLangOpts().OpenCL && 11113 Context.getLangOpts().OpenCLVersion < 120) { 11114 if (LHS.get()->getType()->isFloatingType() || 11115 RHS.get()->getType()->isFloatingType()) 11116 return InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS); 11117 } 11118 11119 LHS = UsualUnaryConversions(LHS.get()); 11120 if (LHS.isInvalid()) 11121 return QualType(); 11122 11123 RHS = UsualUnaryConversions(RHS.get()); 11124 if (RHS.isInvalid()) 11125 return QualType(); 11126 11127 if (!LHS.get()->getType()->isScalarType() || 11128 !RHS.get()->getType()->isScalarType()) 11129 return InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS); 11130 11131 return Context.IntTy; 11132 } 11133 11134 // The following is safe because we only use this method for 11135 // non-overloadable operands. 11136 11137 // C++ [expr.log.and]p1 11138 // C++ [expr.log.or]p1 11139 // The operands are both contextually converted to type bool. 11140 ExprResult LHSRes = PerformContextuallyConvertToBool(LHS.get()); 11141 if (LHSRes.isInvalid()) 11142 return InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS); 11143 LHS = LHSRes; 11144 11145 ExprResult RHSRes = PerformContextuallyConvertToBool(RHS.get()); 11146 if (RHSRes.isInvalid()) 11147 return InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS); 11148 RHS = RHSRes; 11149 11150 // C++ [expr.log.and]p2 11151 // C++ [expr.log.or]p2 11152 // The result is a bool. 11153 return Context.BoolTy; 11154 } 11155 11156 static bool IsReadonlyMessage(Expr *E, Sema &S) { 11157 const MemberExpr *ME = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(E); 11158 if (!ME) return false; 11159 if (!isa<FieldDecl>(ME->getMemberDecl())) return false; 11160 ObjCMessageExpr *Base = dyn_cast<ObjCMessageExpr>( 11161 ME->getBase()->IgnoreImplicit()->IgnoreParenImpCasts()); 11162 if (!Base) return false; 11163 return Base->getMethodDecl() != nullptr; 11164 } 11165 11166 /// Is the given expression (which must be 'const') a reference to a 11167 /// variable which was originally non-const, but which has become 11168 /// 'const' due to being captured within a block? 11169 enum NonConstCaptureKind { NCCK_None, NCCK_Block, NCCK_Lambda }; 11170 static NonConstCaptureKind isReferenceToNonConstCapture(Sema &S, Expr *E) { 11171 assert(E->isLValue() && E->getType().isConstQualified()); 11172 E = E->IgnoreParens(); 11173 11174 // Must be a reference to a declaration from an enclosing scope. 11175 DeclRefExpr *DRE = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(E); 11176 if (!DRE) return NCCK_None; 11177 if (!DRE->refersToEnclosingVariableOrCapture()) return NCCK_None; 11178 11179 // The declaration must be a variable which is not declared 'const'. 11180 VarDecl *var = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(DRE->getDecl()); 11181 if (!var) return NCCK_None; 11182 if (var->getType().isConstQualified()) return NCCK_None; 11183 assert(var->hasLocalStorage() && "capture added 'const' to non-local?"); 11184 11185 // Decide whether the first capture was for a block or a lambda. 11186 DeclContext *DC = S.CurContext, *Prev = nullptr; 11187 // Decide whether the first capture was for a block or a lambda. 11188 while (DC) { 11189 // For init-capture, it is possible that the variable belongs to the 11190 // template pattern of the current context. 11191 if (auto *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(DC)) 11192 if (var->isInitCapture() && 11193 FD->getTemplateInstantiationPattern() == var->getDeclContext()) 11194 break; 11195 if (DC == var->getDeclContext()) 11196 break; 11197 Prev = DC; 11198 DC = DC->getParent(); 11199 } 11200 // Unless we have an init-capture, we've gone one step too far. 11201 if (!var->isInitCapture()) 11202 DC = Prev; 11203 return (isa<BlockDecl>(DC) ? NCCK_Block : NCCK_Lambda); 11204 } 11205 11206 static bool IsTypeModifiable(QualType Ty, bool IsDereference) { 11207 Ty = Ty.getNonReferenceType(); 11208 if (IsDereference && Ty->isPointerType()) 11209 Ty = Ty->getPointeeType(); 11210 return !Ty.isConstQualified(); 11211 } 11212 11213 // Update err_typecheck_assign_const and note_typecheck_assign_const 11214 // when this enum is changed. 11215 enum { 11216 ConstFunction, 11217 ConstVariable, 11218 ConstMember, 11219 ConstMethod, 11220 NestedConstMember, 11221 ConstUnknown, // Keep as last element 11222 }; 11223 11224 /// Emit the "read-only variable not assignable" error and print notes to give 11225 /// more information about why the variable is not assignable, such as pointing 11226 /// to the declaration of a const variable, showing that a method is const, or 11227 /// that the function is returning a const reference. 11228 static void DiagnoseConstAssignment(Sema &S, const Expr *E, 11229 SourceLocation Loc) { 11230 SourceRange ExprRange = E->getSourceRange(); 11231 11232 // Only emit one error on the first const found. All other consts will emit 11233 // a note to the error. 11234 bool DiagnosticEmitted = false; 11235 11236 // Track if the current expression is the result of a dereference, and if the 11237 // next checked expression is the result of a dereference. 11238 bool IsDereference = false; 11239 bool NextIsDereference = false; 11240 11241 // Loop to process MemberExpr chains. 11242 while (true) { 11243 IsDereference = NextIsDereference; 11244 11245 E = E->IgnoreImplicit()->IgnoreParenImpCasts(); 11246 if (const MemberExpr *ME = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(E)) { 11247 NextIsDereference = ME->isArrow(); 11248 const ValueDecl *VD = ME->getMemberDecl(); 11249 if (const FieldDecl *Field = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(VD)) { 11250 // Mutable fields can be modified even if the class is const. 11251 if (Field->isMutable()) { 11252 assert(DiagnosticEmitted && "Expected diagnostic not emitted."); 11253 break; 11254 } 11255 11256 if (!IsTypeModifiable(Field->getType(), IsDereference)) { 11257 if (!DiagnosticEmitted) { 11258 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_assign_const) 11259 << ExprRange << ConstMember << false /*static*/ << Field 11260 << Field->getType(); 11261 DiagnosticEmitted = true; 11262 } 11263 S.Diag(VD->getLocation(), diag::note_typecheck_assign_const) 11264 << ConstMember << false /*static*/ << Field << Field->getType() 11265 << Field->getSourceRange(); 11266 } 11267 E = ME->getBase(); 11268 continue; 11269 } else if (const VarDecl *VDecl = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(VD)) { 11270 if (VDecl->getType().isConstQualified()) { 11271 if (!DiagnosticEmitted) { 11272 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_assign_const) 11273 << ExprRange << ConstMember << true /*static*/ << VDecl 11274 << VDecl->getType(); 11275 DiagnosticEmitted = true; 11276 } 11277 S.Diag(VD->getLocation(), diag::note_typecheck_assign_const) 11278 << ConstMember << true /*static*/ << VDecl << VDecl->getType() 11279 << VDecl->getSourceRange(); 11280 } 11281 // Static fields do not inherit constness from parents. 11282 break; 11283 } 11284 break; // End MemberExpr 11285 } else if (const ArraySubscriptExpr *ASE = 11286 dyn_cast<ArraySubscriptExpr>(E)) { 11287 E = ASE->getBase()->IgnoreParenImpCasts(); 11288 continue; 11289 } else if (const ExtVectorElementExpr *EVE = 11290 dyn_cast<ExtVectorElementExpr>(E)) { 11291 E = EVE->getBase()->IgnoreParenImpCasts(); 11292 continue; 11293 } 11294 break; 11295 } 11296 11297 if (const CallExpr *CE = dyn_cast<CallExpr>(E)) { 11298 // Function calls 11299 const FunctionDecl *FD = CE->getDirectCallee(); 11300 if (FD && !IsTypeModifiable(FD->getReturnType(), IsDereference)) { 11301 if (!DiagnosticEmitted) { 11302 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_assign_const) << ExprRange 11303 << ConstFunction << FD; 11304 DiagnosticEmitted = true; 11305 } 11306 S.Diag(FD->getReturnTypeSourceRange().getBegin(), 11307 diag::note_typecheck_assign_const) 11308 << ConstFunction << FD << FD->getReturnType() 11309 << FD->getReturnTypeSourceRange(); 11310 } 11311 } else if (const DeclRefExpr *DRE = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(E)) { 11312 // Point to variable declaration. 11313 if (const ValueDecl *VD = DRE->getDecl()) { 11314 if (!IsTypeModifiable(VD->getType(), IsDereference)) { 11315 if (!DiagnosticEmitted) { 11316 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_assign_const) 11317 << ExprRange << ConstVariable << VD << VD->getType(); 11318 DiagnosticEmitted = true; 11319 } 11320 S.Diag(VD->getLocation(), diag::note_typecheck_assign_const) 11321 << ConstVariable << VD << VD->getType() << VD->getSourceRange(); 11322 } 11323 } 11324 } else if (isa<CXXThisExpr>(E)) { 11325 if (const DeclContext *DC = S.getFunctionLevelDeclContext()) { 11326 if (const CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(DC)) { 11327 if (MD->isConst()) { 11328 if (!DiagnosticEmitted) { 11329 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_assign_const) << ExprRange 11330 << ConstMethod << MD; 11331 DiagnosticEmitted = true; 11332 } 11333 S.Diag(MD->getLocation(), diag::note_typecheck_assign_const) 11334 << ConstMethod << MD << MD->getSourceRange(); 11335 } 11336 } 11337 } 11338 } 11339 11340 if (DiagnosticEmitted) 11341 return; 11342 11343 // Can't determine a more specific message, so display the generic error. 11344 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_assign_const) << ExprRange << ConstUnknown; 11345 } 11346 11347 enum OriginalExprKind { 11348 OEK_Variable, 11349 OEK_Member, 11350 OEK_LValue 11351 }; 11352 11353 static void DiagnoseRecursiveConstFields(Sema &S, const ValueDecl *VD, 11354 const RecordType *Ty, 11355 SourceLocation Loc, SourceRange Range, 11356 OriginalExprKind OEK, 11357 bool &DiagnosticEmitted) { 11358 std::vector<const RecordType *> RecordTypeList; 11359 RecordTypeList.push_back(Ty); 11360 unsigned NextToCheckIndex = 0; 11361 // We walk the record hierarchy breadth-first to ensure that we print 11362 // diagnostics in field nesting order. 11363 while (RecordTypeList.size() > NextToCheckIndex) { 11364 bool IsNested = NextToCheckIndex > 0; 11365 for (const FieldDecl *Field : 11366 RecordTypeList[NextToCheckIndex]->getDecl()->fields()) { 11367 // First, check every field for constness. 11368 QualType FieldTy = Field->getType(); 11369 if (FieldTy.isConstQualified()) { 11370 if (!DiagnosticEmitted) { 11371 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_assign_const) 11372 << Range << NestedConstMember << OEK << VD 11373 << IsNested << Field; 11374 DiagnosticEmitted = true; 11375 } 11376 S.Diag(Field->getLocation(), diag::note_typecheck_assign_const) 11377 << NestedConstMember << IsNested << Field 11378 << FieldTy << Field->getSourceRange(); 11379 } 11380 11381 // Then we append it to the list to check next in order. 11382 FieldTy = FieldTy.getCanonicalType(); 11383 if (const auto *FieldRecTy = FieldTy->getAs<RecordType>()) { 11384 if (llvm::find(RecordTypeList, FieldRecTy) == RecordTypeList.end()) 11385 RecordTypeList.push_back(FieldRecTy); 11386 } 11387 } 11388 ++NextToCheckIndex; 11389 } 11390 } 11391 11392 /// Emit an error for the case where a record we are trying to assign to has a 11393 /// const-qualified field somewhere in its hierarchy. 11394 static void DiagnoseRecursiveConstFields(Sema &S, const Expr *E, 11395 SourceLocation Loc) { 11396 QualType Ty = E->getType(); 11397 assert(Ty->isRecordType() && "lvalue was not record?"); 11398 SourceRange Range = E->getSourceRange(); 11399 const RecordType *RTy = Ty.getCanonicalType()->getAs<RecordType>(); 11400 bool DiagEmitted = false; 11401 11402 if (const MemberExpr *ME = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(E)) 11403 DiagnoseRecursiveConstFields(S, ME->getMemberDecl(), RTy, Loc, 11404 Range, OEK_Member, DiagEmitted); 11405 else if (const DeclRefExpr *DRE = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(E)) 11406 DiagnoseRecursiveConstFields(S, DRE->getDecl(), RTy, Loc, 11407 Range, OEK_Variable, DiagEmitted); 11408 else 11409 DiagnoseRecursiveConstFields(S, nullptr, RTy, Loc, 11410 Range, OEK_LValue, DiagEmitted); 11411 if (!DiagEmitted) 11412 DiagnoseConstAssignment(S, E, Loc); 11413 } 11414 11415 /// CheckForModifiableLvalue - Verify that E is a modifiable lvalue. If not, 11416 /// emit an error and return true. If so, return false. 11417 static bool CheckForModifiableLvalue(Expr *E, SourceLocation Loc, Sema &S) { 11418 assert(!E->hasPlaceholderType(BuiltinType::PseudoObject)); 11419 11420 S.CheckShadowingDeclModification(E, Loc); 11421 11422 SourceLocation OrigLoc = Loc; 11423 Expr::isModifiableLvalueResult IsLV = E->isModifiableLvalue(S.Context, 11424 &Loc); 11425 if (IsLV == Expr::MLV_ClassTemporary && IsReadonlyMessage(E, S)) 11426 IsLV = Expr::MLV_InvalidMessageExpression; 11427 if (IsLV == Expr::MLV_Valid) 11428 return false; 11429 11430 unsigned DiagID = 0; 11431 bool NeedType = false; 11432 switch (IsLV) { // C99 6.5.16p2 11433 case Expr::MLV_ConstQualified: 11434 // Use a specialized diagnostic when we're assigning to an object 11435 // from an enclosing function or block. 11436 if (NonConstCaptureKind NCCK = isReferenceToNonConstCapture(S, E)) { 11437 if (NCCK == NCCK_Block) 11438 DiagID = diag::err_block_decl_ref_not_modifiable_lvalue; 11439 else 11440 DiagID = diag::err_lambda_decl_ref_not_modifiable_lvalue; 11441 break; 11442 } 11443 11444 // In ARC, use some specialized diagnostics for occasions where we 11445 // infer 'const'. These are always pseudo-strong variables. 11446 if (S.getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount) { 11447 DeclRefExpr *declRef = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(E->IgnoreParenCasts()); 11448 if (declRef && isa<VarDecl>(declRef->getDecl())) { 11449 VarDecl *var = cast<VarDecl>(declRef->getDecl()); 11450 11451 // Use the normal diagnostic if it's pseudo-__strong but the 11452 // user actually wrote 'const'. 11453 if (var->isARCPseudoStrong() && 11454 (!var->getTypeSourceInfo() || 11455 !var->getTypeSourceInfo()->getType().isConstQualified())) { 11456 // There are three pseudo-strong cases: 11457 // - self 11458 ObjCMethodDecl *method = S.getCurMethodDecl(); 11459 if (method && var == method->getSelfDecl()) { 11460 DiagID = method->isClassMethod() 11461 ? diag::err_typecheck_arc_assign_self_class_method 11462 : diag::err_typecheck_arc_assign_self; 11463 11464 // - Objective-C externally_retained attribute. 11465 } else if (var->hasAttr<ObjCExternallyRetainedAttr>() || 11466 isa<ParmVarDecl>(var)) { 11467 DiagID = diag::err_typecheck_arc_assign_externally_retained; 11468 11469 // - fast enumeration variables 11470 } else { 11471 DiagID = diag::err_typecheck_arr_assign_enumeration; 11472 } 11473 11474 SourceRange Assign; 11475 if (Loc != OrigLoc) 11476 Assign = SourceRange(OrigLoc, OrigLoc); 11477 S.Diag(Loc, DiagID) << E->getSourceRange() << Assign; 11478 // We need to preserve the AST regardless, so migration tool 11479 // can do its job. 11480 return false; 11481 } 11482 } 11483 } 11484 11485 // If none of the special cases above are triggered, then this is a 11486 // simple const assignment. 11487 if (DiagID == 0) { 11488 DiagnoseConstAssignment(S, E, Loc); 11489 return true; 11490 } 11491 11492 break; 11493 case Expr::MLV_ConstAddrSpace: 11494 DiagnoseConstAssignment(S, E, Loc); 11495 return true; 11496 case Expr::MLV_ConstQualifiedField: 11497 DiagnoseRecursiveConstFields(S, E, Loc); 11498 return true; 11499 case Expr::MLV_ArrayType: 11500 case Expr::MLV_ArrayTemporary: 11501 DiagID = diag::err_typecheck_array_not_modifiable_lvalue; 11502 NeedType = true; 11503 break; 11504 case Expr::MLV_NotObjectType: 11505 DiagID = diag::err_typecheck_non_object_not_modifiable_lvalue; 11506 NeedType = true; 11507 break; 11508 case Expr::MLV_LValueCast: 11509 DiagID = diag::err_typecheck_lvalue_casts_not_supported; 11510 break; 11511 case Expr::MLV_Valid: 11512 llvm_unreachable("did not take early return for MLV_Valid"); 11513 case Expr::MLV_InvalidExpression: 11514 case Expr::MLV_MemberFunction: 11515 case Expr::MLV_ClassTemporary: 11516 DiagID = diag::err_typecheck_expression_not_modifiable_lvalue; 11517 break; 11518 case Expr::MLV_IncompleteType: 11519 case Expr::MLV_IncompleteVoidType: 11520 return S.RequireCompleteType(Loc, E->getType(), 11521 diag::err_typecheck_incomplete_type_not_modifiable_lvalue, E); 11522 case Expr::MLV_DuplicateVectorComponents: 11523 DiagID = diag::err_typecheck_duplicate_vector_components_not_mlvalue; 11524 break; 11525 case Expr::MLV_NoSetterProperty: 11526 llvm_unreachable("readonly properties should be processed differently"); 11527 case Expr::MLV_InvalidMessageExpression: 11528 DiagID = diag::err_readonly_message_assignment; 11529 break; 11530 case Expr::MLV_SubObjCPropertySetting: 11531 DiagID = diag::err_no_subobject_property_setting; 11532 break; 11533 } 11534 11535 SourceRange Assign; 11536 if (Loc != OrigLoc) 11537 Assign = SourceRange(OrigLoc, OrigLoc); 11538 if (NeedType) 11539 S.Diag(Loc, DiagID) << E->getType() << E->getSourceRange() << Assign; 11540 else 11541 S.Diag(Loc, DiagID) << E->getSourceRange() << Assign; 11542 return true; 11543 } 11544 11545 static void CheckIdentityFieldAssignment(Expr *LHSExpr, Expr *RHSExpr, 11546 SourceLocation Loc, 11547 Sema &Sema) { 11548 if (Sema.inTemplateInstantiation()) 11549 return; 11550 if (Sema.isUnevaluatedContext()) 11551 return; 11552 if (Loc.isInvalid() || Loc.isMacroID()) 11553 return; 11554 if (LHSExpr->getExprLoc().isMacroID() || RHSExpr->getExprLoc().isMacroID()) 11555 return; 11556 11557 // C / C++ fields 11558 MemberExpr *ML = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(LHSExpr); 11559 MemberExpr *MR = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(RHSExpr); 11560 if (ML && MR) { 11561 if (!(isa<CXXThisExpr>(ML->getBase()) && isa<CXXThisExpr>(MR->getBase()))) 11562 return; 11563 const ValueDecl *LHSDecl = 11564 cast<ValueDecl>(ML->getMemberDecl()->getCanonicalDecl()); 11565 const ValueDecl *RHSDecl = 11566 cast<ValueDecl>(MR->getMemberDecl()->getCanonicalDecl()); 11567 if (LHSDecl != RHSDecl) 11568 return; 11569 if (LHSDecl->getType().isVolatileQualified()) 11570 return; 11571 if (const ReferenceType *RefTy = LHSDecl->getType()->getAs<ReferenceType>()) 11572 if (RefTy->getPointeeType().isVolatileQualified()) 11573 return; 11574 11575 Sema.Diag(Loc, diag::warn_identity_field_assign) << 0; 11576 } 11577 11578 // Objective-C instance variables 11579 ObjCIvarRefExpr *OL = dyn_cast<ObjCIvarRefExpr>(LHSExpr); 11580 ObjCIvarRefExpr *OR = dyn_cast<ObjCIvarRefExpr>(RHSExpr); 11581 if (OL && OR && OL->getDecl() == OR->getDecl()) { 11582 DeclRefExpr *RL = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(OL->getBase()->IgnoreImpCasts()); 11583 DeclRefExpr *RR = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(OR->getBase()->IgnoreImpCasts()); 11584 if (RL && RR && RL->getDecl() == RR->getDecl()) 11585 Sema.Diag(Loc, diag::warn_identity_field_assign) << 1; 11586 } 11587 } 11588 11589 // C99 6.5.16.1 11590 QualType Sema::CheckAssignmentOperands(Expr *LHSExpr, ExprResult &RHS, 11591 SourceLocation Loc, 11592 QualType CompoundType) { 11593 assert(!LHSExpr->hasPlaceholderType(BuiltinType::PseudoObject)); 11594 11595 // Verify that LHS is a modifiable lvalue, and emit error if not. 11596 if (CheckForModifiableLvalue(LHSExpr, Loc, *this)) 11597 return QualType(); 11598 11599 QualType LHSType = LHSExpr->getType(); 11600 QualType RHSType = CompoundType.isNull() ? RHS.get()->getType() : 11601 CompoundType; 11602 // OpenCL v1.2 s6.1.1.1 p2: 11603 // The half data type can only be used to declare a pointer to a buffer that 11604 // contains half values 11605 if (getLangOpts().OpenCL && !getOpenCLOptions().isEnabled("cl_khr_fp16") && 11606 LHSType->isHalfType()) { 11607 Diag(Loc, diag::err_opencl_half_load_store) << 1 11608 << LHSType.getUnqualifiedType(); 11609 return QualType(); 11610 } 11611 11612 AssignConvertType ConvTy; 11613 if (CompoundType.isNull()) { 11614 Expr *RHSCheck = RHS.get(); 11615 11616 CheckIdentityFieldAssignment(LHSExpr, RHSCheck, Loc, *this); 11617 11618 QualType LHSTy(LHSType); 11619 ConvTy = CheckSingleAssignmentConstraints(LHSTy, RHS); 11620 if (RHS.isInvalid()) 11621 return QualType(); 11622 // Special case of NSObject attributes on c-style pointer types. 11623 if (ConvTy == IncompatiblePointer && 11624 ((Context.isObjCNSObjectType(LHSType) && 11625 RHSType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) || 11626 (Context.isObjCNSObjectType(RHSType) && 11627 LHSType->isObjCObjectPointerType()))) 11628 ConvTy = Compatible; 11629 11630 if (ConvTy == Compatible && 11631 LHSType->isObjCObjectType()) 11632 Diag(Loc, diag::err_objc_object_assignment) 11633 << LHSType; 11634 11635 // If the RHS is a unary plus or minus, check to see if they = and + are 11636 // right next to each other. If so, the user may have typo'd "x =+ 4" 11637 // instead of "x += 4". 11638 if (ImplicitCastExpr *ICE = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(RHSCheck)) 11639 RHSCheck = ICE->getSubExpr(); 11640 if (UnaryOperator *UO = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(RHSCheck)) { 11641 if ((UO->getOpcode() == UO_Plus || UO->getOpcode() == UO_Minus) && 11642 Loc.isFileID() && UO->getOperatorLoc().isFileID() && 11643 // Only if the two operators are exactly adjacent. 11644 Loc.getLocWithOffset(1) == UO->getOperatorLoc() && 11645 // And there is a space or other character before the subexpr of the 11646 // unary +/-. We don't want to warn on "x=-1". 11647 Loc.getLocWithOffset(2) != UO->getSubExpr()->getBeginLoc() && 11648 UO->getSubExpr()->getBeginLoc().isFileID()) { 11649 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_not_compound_assign) 11650 << (UO->getOpcode() == UO_Plus ? "+" : "-") 11651 << SourceRange(UO->getOperatorLoc(), UO->getOperatorLoc()); 11652 } 11653 } 11654 11655 if (ConvTy == Compatible) { 11656 if (LHSType.getObjCLifetime() == Qualifiers::OCL_Strong) { 11657 // Warn about retain cycles where a block captures the LHS, but 11658 // not if the LHS is a simple variable into which the block is 11659 // being stored...unless that variable can be captured by reference! 11660 const Expr *InnerLHS = LHSExpr->IgnoreParenCasts(); 11661 const DeclRefExpr *DRE = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(InnerLHS); 11662 if (!DRE || DRE->getDecl()->hasAttr<BlocksAttr>()) 11663 checkRetainCycles(LHSExpr, RHS.get()); 11664 } 11665 11666 if (LHSType.getObjCLifetime() == Qualifiers::OCL_Strong || 11667 LHSType.isNonWeakInMRRWithObjCWeak(Context)) { 11668 // It is safe to assign a weak reference into a strong variable. 11669 // Although this code can still have problems: 11670 // id x = self.weakProp; 11671 // id y = self.weakProp; 11672 // we do not warn to warn spuriously when 'x' and 'y' are on separate 11673 // paths through the function. This should be revisited if 11674 // -Wrepeated-use-of-weak is made flow-sensitive. 11675 // For ObjCWeak only, we do not warn if the assign is to a non-weak 11676 // variable, which will be valid for the current autorelease scope. 11677 if (!Diags.isIgnored(diag::warn_arc_repeated_use_of_weak, 11678 RHS.get()->getBeginLoc())) 11679 getCurFunction()->markSafeWeakUse(RHS.get()); 11680 11681 } else if (getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount || getLangOpts().ObjCWeak) { 11682 checkUnsafeExprAssigns(Loc, LHSExpr, RHS.get()); 11683 } 11684 } 11685 } else { 11686 // Compound assignment "x += y" 11687 ConvTy = CheckAssignmentConstraints(Loc, LHSType, RHSType); 11688 } 11689 11690 if (DiagnoseAssignmentResult(ConvTy, Loc, LHSType, RHSType, 11691 RHS.get(), AA_Assigning)) 11692 return QualType(); 11693 11694 CheckForNullPointerDereference(*this, LHSExpr); 11695 11696 // C99 6.5.16p3: The type of an assignment expression is the type of the 11697 // left operand unless the left operand has qualified type, in which case 11698 // it is the unqualified version of the type of the left operand. 11699 // C99 6.5.16.1p2: In simple assignment, the value of the right operand 11700 // is converted to the type of the assignment expression (above). 11701 // C++ 5.17p1: the type of the assignment expression is that of its left 11702 // operand. 11703 return (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus 11704 ? LHSType : LHSType.getUnqualifiedType()); 11705 } 11706 11707 // Only ignore explicit casts to void. 11708 static bool IgnoreCommaOperand(const Expr *E) { 11709 E = E->IgnoreParens(); 11710 11711 if (const CastExpr *CE = dyn_cast<CastExpr>(E)) { 11712 if (CE->getCastKind() == CK_ToVoid) { 11713 return true; 11714 } 11715 11716 // static_cast<void> on a dependent type will not show up as CK_ToVoid. 11717 if (CE->getCastKind() == CK_Dependent && E->getType()->isVoidType() && 11718 CE->getSubExpr()->getType()->isDependentType()) { 11719 return true; 11720 } 11721 } 11722 11723 return false; 11724 } 11725 11726 // Look for instances where it is likely the comma operator is confused with 11727 // another operator. There is a whitelist of acceptable expressions for the 11728 // left hand side of the comma operator, otherwise emit a warning. 11729 void Sema::DiagnoseCommaOperator(const Expr *LHS, SourceLocation Loc) { 11730 // No warnings in macros 11731 if (Loc.isMacroID()) 11732 return; 11733 11734 // Don't warn in template instantiations. 11735 if (inTemplateInstantiation()) 11736 return; 11737 11738 // Scope isn't fine-grained enough to whitelist the specific cases, so 11739 // instead, skip more than needed, then call back into here with the 11740 // CommaVisitor in SemaStmt.cpp. 11741 // The whitelisted locations are the initialization and increment portions 11742 // of a for loop. The additional checks are on the condition of 11743 // if statements, do/while loops, and for loops. 11744 // Differences in scope flags for C89 mode requires the extra logic. 11745 const unsigned ForIncrementFlags = 11746 getLangOpts().C99 || getLangOpts().CPlusPlus 11747 ? Scope::ControlScope | Scope::ContinueScope | Scope::BreakScope 11748 : Scope::ContinueScope | Scope::BreakScope; 11749 const unsigned ForInitFlags = Scope::ControlScope | Scope::DeclScope; 11750 const unsigned ScopeFlags = getCurScope()->getFlags(); 11751 if ((ScopeFlags & ForIncrementFlags) == ForIncrementFlags || 11752 (ScopeFlags & ForInitFlags) == ForInitFlags) 11753 return; 11754 11755 // If there are multiple comma operators used together, get the RHS of the 11756 // of the comma operator as the LHS. 11757 while (const BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(LHS)) { 11758 if (BO->getOpcode() != BO_Comma) 11759 break; 11760 LHS = BO->getRHS(); 11761 } 11762 11763 // Only allow some expressions on LHS to not warn. 11764 if (IgnoreCommaOperand(LHS)) 11765 return; 11766 11767 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_comma_operator); 11768 Diag(LHS->getBeginLoc(), diag::note_cast_to_void) 11769 << LHS->getSourceRange() 11770 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(LHS->getBeginLoc(), 11771 LangOpts.CPlusPlus ? "static_cast<void>(" 11772 : "(void)(") 11773 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(PP.getLocForEndOfToken(LHS->getEndLoc()), 11774 ")"); 11775 } 11776 11777 // C99 6.5.17 11778 static QualType CheckCommaOperands(Sema &S, ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS, 11779 SourceLocation Loc) { 11780 LHS = S.CheckPlaceholderExpr(LHS.get()); 11781 RHS = S.CheckPlaceholderExpr(RHS.get()); 11782 if (LHS.isInvalid() || RHS.isInvalid()) 11783 return QualType(); 11784 11785 // C's comma performs lvalue conversion (C99 6.3.2.1) on both its 11786 // operands, but not unary promotions. 11787 // C++'s comma does not do any conversions at all (C++ [expr.comma]p1). 11788 11789 // So we treat the LHS as a ignored value, and in C++ we allow the 11790 // containing site to determine what should be done with the RHS. 11791 LHS = S.IgnoredValueConversions(LHS.get()); 11792 if (LHS.isInvalid()) 11793 return QualType(); 11794 11795 S.DiagnoseUnusedExprResult(LHS.get()); 11796 11797 if (!S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 11798 RHS = S.DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(RHS.get()); 11799 if (RHS.isInvalid()) 11800 return QualType(); 11801 if (!RHS.get()->getType()->isVoidType()) 11802 S.RequireCompleteType(Loc, RHS.get()->getType(), 11803 diag::err_incomplete_type); 11804 } 11805 11806 if (!S.getDiagnostics().isIgnored(diag::warn_comma_operator, Loc)) 11807 S.DiagnoseCommaOperator(LHS.get(), Loc); 11808 11809 return RHS.get()->getType(); 11810 } 11811 11812 /// CheckIncrementDecrementOperand - unlike most "Check" methods, this routine 11813 /// doesn't need to call UsualUnaryConversions or UsualArithmeticConversions. 11814 static QualType CheckIncrementDecrementOperand(Sema &S, Expr *Op, 11815 ExprValueKind &VK, 11816 ExprObjectKind &OK, 11817 SourceLocation OpLoc, 11818 bool IsInc, bool IsPrefix) { 11819 if (Op->isTypeDependent()) 11820 return S.Context.DependentTy; 11821 11822 QualType ResType = Op->getType(); 11823 // Atomic types can be used for increment / decrement where the non-atomic 11824 // versions can, so ignore the _Atomic() specifier for the purpose of 11825 // checking. 11826 if (const AtomicType *ResAtomicType = ResType->getAs<AtomicType>()) 11827 ResType = ResAtomicType->getValueType(); 11828 11829 assert(!ResType.isNull() && "no type for increment/decrement expression"); 11830 11831 if (S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && ResType->isBooleanType()) { 11832 // Decrement of bool is not allowed. 11833 if (!IsInc) { 11834 S.Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_decrement_bool) << Op->getSourceRange(); 11835 return QualType(); 11836 } 11837 // Increment of bool sets it to true, but is deprecated. 11838 S.Diag(OpLoc, S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus17 ? diag::ext_increment_bool 11839 : diag::warn_increment_bool) 11840 << Op->getSourceRange(); 11841 } else if (S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && ResType->isEnumeralType()) { 11842 // Error on enum increments and decrements in C++ mode 11843 S.Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_increment_decrement_enum) << IsInc << ResType; 11844 return QualType(); 11845 } else if (ResType->isRealType()) { 11846 // OK! 11847 } else if (ResType->isPointerType()) { 11848 // C99 6.5.2.4p2, 6.5.6p2 11849 if (!checkArithmeticOpPointerOperand(S, OpLoc, Op)) 11850 return QualType(); 11851 } else if (ResType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) { 11852 // On modern runtimes, ObjC pointer arithmetic is forbidden. 11853 // Otherwise, we just need a complete type. 11854 if (checkArithmeticIncompletePointerType(S, OpLoc, Op) || 11855 checkArithmeticOnObjCPointer(S, OpLoc, Op)) 11856 return QualType(); 11857 } else if (ResType->isAnyComplexType()) { 11858 // C99 does not support ++/-- on complex types, we allow as an extension. 11859 S.Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_integer_increment_complex) 11860 << ResType << Op->getSourceRange(); 11861 } else if (ResType->isPlaceholderType()) { 11862 ExprResult PR = S.CheckPlaceholderExpr(Op); 11863 if (PR.isInvalid()) return QualType(); 11864 return CheckIncrementDecrementOperand(S, PR.get(), VK, OK, OpLoc, 11865 IsInc, IsPrefix); 11866 } else if (S.getLangOpts().AltiVec && ResType->isVectorType()) { 11867 // OK! ( C/C++ Language Extensions for CBEA(Version 2.6) 10.3 ) 11868 } else if (S.getLangOpts().ZVector && ResType->isVectorType() && 11869 (ResType->getAs<VectorType>()->getVectorKind() != 11870 VectorType::AltiVecBool)) { 11871 // The z vector extensions allow ++ and -- for non-bool vectors. 11872 } else if(S.getLangOpts().OpenCL && ResType->isVectorType() && 11873 ResType->getAs<VectorType>()->getElementType()->isIntegerType()) { 11874 // OpenCL V1.2 6.3 says dec/inc ops operate on integer vector types. 11875 } else { 11876 S.Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_illegal_increment_decrement) 11877 << ResType << int(IsInc) << Op->getSourceRange(); 11878 return QualType(); 11879 } 11880 // At this point, we know we have a real, complex or pointer type. 11881 // Now make sure the operand is a modifiable lvalue. 11882 if (CheckForModifiableLvalue(Op, OpLoc, S)) 11883 return QualType(); 11884 // In C++, a prefix increment is the same type as the operand. Otherwise 11885 // (in C or with postfix), the increment is the unqualified type of the 11886 // operand. 11887 if (IsPrefix && S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 11888 VK = VK_LValue; 11889 OK = Op->getObjectKind(); 11890 return ResType; 11891 } else { 11892 VK = VK_RValue; 11893 return ResType.getUnqualifiedType(); 11894 } 11895 } 11896 11897 11898 /// getPrimaryDecl - Helper function for CheckAddressOfOperand(). 11899 /// This routine allows us to typecheck complex/recursive expressions 11900 /// where the declaration is needed for type checking. We only need to 11901 /// handle cases when the expression references a function designator 11902 /// or is an lvalue. Here are some examples: 11903 /// - &(x) => x 11904 /// - &*****f => f for f a function designator. 11905 /// - &s.xx => s 11906 /// - &s.zz[1].yy -> s, if zz is an array 11907 /// - *(x + 1) -> x, if x is an array 11908 /// - &"123"[2] -> 0 11909 /// - & __real__ x -> x 11910 static ValueDecl *getPrimaryDecl(Expr *E) { 11911 switch (E->getStmtClass()) { 11912 case Stmt::DeclRefExprClass: 11913 return cast<DeclRefExpr>(E)->getDecl(); 11914 case Stmt::MemberExprClass: 11915 // If this is an arrow operator, the address is an offset from 11916 // the base's value, so the object the base refers to is 11917 // irrelevant. 11918 if (cast<MemberExpr>(E)->isArrow()) 11919 return nullptr; 11920 // Otherwise, the expression refers to a part of the base 11921 return getPrimaryDecl(cast<MemberExpr>(E)->getBase()); 11922 case Stmt::ArraySubscriptExprClass: { 11923 // FIXME: This code shouldn't be necessary! We should catch the implicit 11924 // promotion of register arrays earlier. 11925 Expr* Base = cast<ArraySubscriptExpr>(E)->getBase(); 11926 if (ImplicitCastExpr* ICE = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(Base)) { 11927 if (ICE->getSubExpr()->getType()->isArrayType()) 11928 return getPrimaryDecl(ICE->getSubExpr()); 11929 } 11930 return nullptr; 11931 } 11932 case Stmt::UnaryOperatorClass: { 11933 UnaryOperator *UO = cast<UnaryOperator>(E); 11934 11935 switch(UO->getOpcode()) { 11936 case UO_Real: 11937 case UO_Imag: 11938 case UO_Extension: 11939 return getPrimaryDecl(UO->getSubExpr()); 11940 default: 11941 return nullptr; 11942 } 11943 } 11944 case Stmt::ParenExprClass: 11945 return getPrimaryDecl(cast<ParenExpr>(E)->getSubExpr()); 11946 case Stmt::ImplicitCastExprClass: 11947 // If the result of an implicit cast is an l-value, we care about 11948 // the sub-expression; otherwise, the result here doesn't matter. 11949 return getPrimaryDecl(cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(E)->getSubExpr()); 11950 default: 11951 return nullptr; 11952 } 11953 } 11954 11955 namespace { 11956 enum { 11957 AO_Bit_Field = 0, 11958 AO_Vector_Element = 1, 11959 AO_Property_Expansion = 2, 11960 AO_Register_Variable = 3, 11961 AO_No_Error = 4 11962 }; 11963 } 11964 /// Diagnose invalid operand for address of operations. 11965 /// 11966 /// \param Type The type of operand which cannot have its address taken. 11967 static void diagnoseAddressOfInvalidType(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, 11968 Expr *E, unsigned Type) { 11969 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_address_of) << Type << E->getSourceRange(); 11970 } 11971 11972 /// CheckAddressOfOperand - The operand of & must be either a function 11973 /// designator or an lvalue designating an object. If it is an lvalue, the 11974 /// object cannot be declared with storage class register or be a bit field. 11975 /// Note: The usual conversions are *not* applied to the operand of the & 11976 /// operator (C99 6.3.2.1p[2-4]), and its result is never an lvalue. 11977 /// In C++, the operand might be an overloaded function name, in which case 11978 /// we allow the '&' but retain the overloaded-function type. 11979 QualType Sema::CheckAddressOfOperand(ExprResult &OrigOp, SourceLocation OpLoc) { 11980 if (const BuiltinType *PTy = OrigOp.get()->getType()->getAsPlaceholderType()){ 11981 if (PTy->getKind() == BuiltinType::Overload) { 11982 Expr *E = OrigOp.get()->IgnoreParens(); 11983 if (!isa<OverloadExpr>(E)) { 11984 assert(cast<UnaryOperator>(E)->getOpcode() == UO_AddrOf); 11985 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_invalid_lvalue_addrof_addrof_function) 11986 << OrigOp.get()->getSourceRange(); 11987 return QualType(); 11988 } 11989 11990 OverloadExpr *Ovl = cast<OverloadExpr>(E); 11991 if (isa<UnresolvedMemberExpr>(Ovl)) 11992 if (!ResolveSingleFunctionTemplateSpecialization(Ovl)) { 11993 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_invalid_form_pointer_member_function) 11994 << OrigOp.get()->getSourceRange(); 11995 return QualType(); 11996 } 11997 11998 return Context.OverloadTy; 11999 } 12000 12001 if (PTy->getKind() == BuiltinType::UnknownAny) 12002 return Context.UnknownAnyTy; 12003 12004 if (PTy->getKind() == BuiltinType::BoundMember) { 12005 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_invalid_form_pointer_member_function) 12006 << OrigOp.get()->getSourceRange(); 12007 return QualType(); 12008 } 12009 12010 OrigOp = CheckPlaceholderExpr(OrigOp.get()); 12011 if (OrigOp.isInvalid()) return QualType(); 12012 } 12013 12014 if (OrigOp.get()->isTypeDependent()) 12015 return Context.DependentTy; 12016 12017 assert(!OrigOp.get()->getType()->isPlaceholderType()); 12018 12019 // Make sure to ignore parentheses in subsequent checks 12020 Expr *op = OrigOp.get()->IgnoreParens(); 12021 12022 // In OpenCL captures for blocks called as lambda functions 12023 // are located in the private address space. Blocks used in 12024 // enqueue_kernel can be located in a different address space 12025 // depending on a vendor implementation. Thus preventing 12026 // taking an address of the capture to avoid invalid AS casts. 12027 if (LangOpts.OpenCL) { 12028 auto* VarRef = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(op); 12029 if (VarRef && VarRef->refersToEnclosingVariableOrCapture()) { 12030 Diag(op->getExprLoc(), diag::err_opencl_taking_address_capture); 12031 return QualType(); 12032 } 12033 } 12034 12035 if (getLangOpts().C99) { 12036 // Implement C99-only parts of addressof rules. 12037 if (UnaryOperator* uOp = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(op)) { 12038 if (uOp->getOpcode() == UO_Deref) 12039 // Per C99 6.5.3.2, the address of a deref always returns a valid result 12040 // (assuming the deref expression is valid). 12041 return uOp->getSubExpr()->getType(); 12042 } 12043 // Technically, there should be a check for array subscript 12044 // expressions here, but the result of one is always an lvalue anyway. 12045 } 12046 ValueDecl *dcl = getPrimaryDecl(op); 12047 12048 if (auto *FD = dyn_cast_or_null<FunctionDecl>(dcl)) 12049 if (!checkAddressOfFunctionIsAvailable(FD, /*Complain=*/true, 12050 op->getBeginLoc())) 12051 return QualType(); 12052 12053 Expr::LValueClassification lval = op->ClassifyLValue(Context); 12054 unsigned AddressOfError = AO_No_Error; 12055 12056 if (lval == Expr::LV_ClassTemporary || lval == Expr::LV_ArrayTemporary) { 12057 bool sfinae = (bool)isSFINAEContext(); 12058 Diag(OpLoc, isSFINAEContext() ? diag::err_typecheck_addrof_temporary 12059 : diag::ext_typecheck_addrof_temporary) 12060 << op->getType() << op->getSourceRange(); 12061 if (sfinae) 12062 return QualType(); 12063 // Materialize the temporary as an lvalue so that we can take its address. 12064 OrigOp = op = 12065 CreateMaterializeTemporaryExpr(op->getType(), OrigOp.get(), true); 12066 } else if (isa<ObjCSelectorExpr>(op)) { 12067 return Context.getPointerType(op->getType()); 12068 } else if (lval == Expr::LV_MemberFunction) { 12069 // If it's an instance method, make a member pointer. 12070 // The expression must have exactly the form &A::foo. 12071 12072 // If the underlying expression isn't a decl ref, give up. 12073 if (!isa<DeclRefExpr>(op)) { 12074 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_invalid_form_pointer_member_function) 12075 << OrigOp.get()->getSourceRange(); 12076 return QualType(); 12077 } 12078 DeclRefExpr *DRE = cast<DeclRefExpr>(op); 12079 CXXMethodDecl *MD = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(DRE->getDecl()); 12080 12081 // The id-expression was parenthesized. 12082 if (OrigOp.get() != DRE) { 12083 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_parens_pointer_member_function) 12084 << OrigOp.get()->getSourceRange(); 12085 12086 // The method was named without a qualifier. 12087 } else if (!DRE->getQualifier()) { 12088 if (MD->getParent()->getName().empty()) 12089 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_unqualified_pointer_member_function) 12090 << op->getSourceRange(); 12091 else { 12092 SmallString<32> Str; 12093 StringRef Qual = (MD->getParent()->getName() + "::").toStringRef(Str); 12094 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_unqualified_pointer_member_function) 12095 << op->getSourceRange() 12096 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(op->getSourceRange().getBegin(), Qual); 12097 } 12098 } 12099 12100 // Taking the address of a dtor is illegal per C++ [class.dtor]p2. 12101 if (isa<CXXDestructorDecl>(MD)) 12102 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_addrof_dtor) << op->getSourceRange(); 12103 12104 QualType MPTy = Context.getMemberPointerType( 12105 op->getType(), Context.getTypeDeclType(MD->getParent()).getTypePtr()); 12106 // Under the MS ABI, lock down the inheritance model now. 12107 if (Context.getTargetInfo().getCXXABI().isMicrosoft()) 12108 (void)isCompleteType(OpLoc, MPTy); 12109 return MPTy; 12110 } else if (lval != Expr::LV_Valid && lval != Expr::LV_IncompleteVoidType) { 12111 // C99 6.5.3.2p1 12112 // The operand must be either an l-value or a function designator 12113 if (!op->getType()->isFunctionType()) { 12114 // Use a special diagnostic for loads from property references. 12115 if (isa<PseudoObjectExpr>(op)) { 12116 AddressOfError = AO_Property_Expansion; 12117 } else { 12118 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_invalid_lvalue_addrof) 12119 << op->getType() << op->getSourceRange(); 12120 return QualType(); 12121 } 12122 } 12123 } else if (op->getObjectKind() == OK_BitField) { // C99 6.5.3.2p1 12124 // The operand cannot be a bit-field 12125 AddressOfError = AO_Bit_Field; 12126 } else if (op->getObjectKind() == OK_VectorComponent) { 12127 // The operand cannot be an element of a vector 12128 AddressOfError = AO_Vector_Element; 12129 } else if (dcl) { // C99 6.5.3.2p1 12130 // We have an lvalue with a decl. Make sure the decl is not declared 12131 // with the register storage-class specifier. 12132 if (const VarDecl *vd = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(dcl)) { 12133 // in C++ it is not error to take address of a register 12134 // variable (c++03 7.1.1P3) 12135 if (vd->getStorageClass() == SC_Register && 12136 !getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 12137 AddressOfError = AO_Register_Variable; 12138 } 12139 } else if (isa<MSPropertyDecl>(dcl)) { 12140 AddressOfError = AO_Property_Expansion; 12141 } else if (isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(dcl)) { 12142 return Context.OverloadTy; 12143 } else if (isa<FieldDecl>(dcl) || isa<IndirectFieldDecl>(dcl)) { 12144 // Okay: we can take the address of a field. 12145 // Could be a pointer to member, though, if there is an explicit 12146 // scope qualifier for the class. 12147 if (isa<DeclRefExpr>(op) && cast<DeclRefExpr>(op)->getQualifier()) { 12148 DeclContext *Ctx = dcl->getDeclContext(); 12149 if (Ctx && Ctx->isRecord()) { 12150 if (dcl->getType()->isReferenceType()) { 12151 Diag(OpLoc, 12152 diag::err_cannot_form_pointer_to_member_of_reference_type) 12153 << dcl->getDeclName() << dcl->getType(); 12154 return QualType(); 12155 } 12156 12157 while (cast<RecordDecl>(Ctx)->isAnonymousStructOrUnion()) 12158 Ctx = Ctx->getParent(); 12159 12160 QualType MPTy = Context.getMemberPointerType( 12161 op->getType(), 12162 Context.getTypeDeclType(cast<RecordDecl>(Ctx)).getTypePtr()); 12163 // Under the MS ABI, lock down the inheritance model now. 12164 if (Context.getTargetInfo().getCXXABI().isMicrosoft()) 12165 (void)isCompleteType(OpLoc, MPTy); 12166 return MPTy; 12167 } 12168 } 12169 } else if (!isa<FunctionDecl>(dcl) && !isa<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl>(dcl) && 12170 !isa<BindingDecl>(dcl)) 12171 llvm_unreachable("Unknown/unexpected decl type"); 12172 } 12173 12174 if (AddressOfError != AO_No_Error) { 12175 diagnoseAddressOfInvalidType(*this, OpLoc, op, AddressOfError); 12176 return QualType(); 12177 } 12178 12179 if (lval == Expr::LV_IncompleteVoidType) { 12180 // Taking the address of a void variable is technically illegal, but we 12181 // allow it in cases which are otherwise valid. 12182 // Example: "extern void x; void* y = &x;". 12183 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_typecheck_addrof_void) << op->getSourceRange(); 12184 } 12185 12186 // If the operand has type "type", the result has type "pointer to type". 12187 if (op->getType()->isObjCObjectType()) 12188 return Context.getObjCObjectPointerType(op->getType()); 12189 12190 CheckAddressOfPackedMember(op); 12191 12192 return Context.getPointerType(op->getType()); 12193 } 12194 12195 static void RecordModifiableNonNullParam(Sema &S, const Expr *Exp) { 12196 const DeclRefExpr *DRE = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(Exp); 12197 if (!DRE) 12198 return; 12199 const Decl *D = DRE->getDecl(); 12200 if (!D) 12201 return; 12202 const ParmVarDecl *Param = dyn_cast<ParmVarDecl>(D); 12203 if (!Param) 12204 return; 12205 if (const FunctionDecl* FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(Param->getDeclContext())) 12206 if (!FD->hasAttr<NonNullAttr>() && !Param->hasAttr<NonNullAttr>()) 12207 return; 12208 if (FunctionScopeInfo *FD = S.getCurFunction()) 12209 if (!FD->ModifiedNonNullParams.count(Param)) 12210 FD->ModifiedNonNullParams.insert(Param); 12211 } 12212 12213 /// CheckIndirectionOperand - Type check unary indirection (prefix '*'). 12214 static QualType CheckIndirectionOperand(Sema &S, Expr *Op, ExprValueKind &VK, 12215 SourceLocation OpLoc) { 12216 if (Op->isTypeDependent()) 12217 return S.Context.DependentTy; 12218 12219 ExprResult ConvResult = S.UsualUnaryConversions(Op); 12220 if (ConvResult.isInvalid()) 12221 return QualType(); 12222 Op = ConvResult.get(); 12223 QualType OpTy = Op->getType(); 12224 QualType Result; 12225 12226 if (isa<CXXReinterpretCastExpr>(Op)) { 12227 QualType OpOrigType = Op->IgnoreParenCasts()->getType(); 12228 S.CheckCompatibleReinterpretCast(OpOrigType, OpTy, /*IsDereference*/true, 12229 Op->getSourceRange()); 12230 } 12231 12232 if (const PointerType *PT = OpTy->getAs<PointerType>()) 12233 { 12234 Result = PT->getPointeeType(); 12235 } 12236 else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT = 12237 OpTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) 12238 Result = OPT->getPointeeType(); 12239 else { 12240 ExprResult PR = S.CheckPlaceholderExpr(Op); 12241 if (PR.isInvalid()) return QualType(); 12242 if (PR.get() != Op) 12243 return CheckIndirectionOperand(S, PR.get(), VK, OpLoc); 12244 } 12245 12246 if (Result.isNull()) { 12247 S.Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_indirection_requires_pointer) 12248 << OpTy << Op->getSourceRange(); 12249 return QualType(); 12250 } 12251 12252 // Note that per both C89 and C99, indirection is always legal, even if Result 12253 // is an incomplete type or void. It would be possible to warn about 12254 // dereferencing a void pointer, but it's completely well-defined, and such a 12255 // warning is unlikely to catch any mistakes. In C++, indirection is not valid 12256 // for pointers to 'void' but is fine for any other pointer type: 12257 // 12258 // C++ [expr.unary.op]p1: 12259 // [...] the expression to which [the unary * operator] is applied shall 12260 // be a pointer to an object type, or a pointer to a function type 12261 if (S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && Result->isVoidType()) 12262 S.Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_typecheck_indirection_through_void_pointer) 12263 << OpTy << Op->getSourceRange(); 12264 12265 // Dereferences are usually l-values... 12266 VK = VK_LValue; 12267 12268 // ...except that certain expressions are never l-values in C. 12269 if (!S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && Result.isCForbiddenLValueType()) 12270 VK = VK_RValue; 12271 12272 return Result; 12273 } 12274 12275 BinaryOperatorKind Sema::ConvertTokenKindToBinaryOpcode(tok::TokenKind Kind) { 12276 BinaryOperatorKind Opc; 12277 switch (Kind) { 12278 default: llvm_unreachable("Unknown binop!"); 12279 case tok::periodstar: Opc = BO_PtrMemD; break; 12280 case tok::arrowstar: Opc = BO_PtrMemI; break; 12281 case tok::star: Opc = BO_Mul; break; 12282 case tok::slash: Opc = BO_Div; break; 12283 case tok::percent: Opc = BO_Rem; break; 12284 case tok::plus: Opc = BO_Add; break; 12285 case tok::minus: Opc = BO_Sub; break; 12286 case tok::lessless: Opc = BO_Shl; break; 12287 case tok::greatergreater: Opc = BO_Shr; break; 12288 case tok::lessequal: Opc = BO_LE; break; 12289 case tok::less: Opc = BO_LT; break; 12290 case tok::greaterequal: Opc = BO_GE; break; 12291 case tok::greater: Opc = BO_GT; break; 12292 case tok::exclaimequal: Opc = BO_NE; break; 12293 case tok::equalequal: Opc = BO_EQ; break; 12294 case tok::spaceship: Opc = BO_Cmp; break; 12295 case tok::amp: Opc = BO_And; break; 12296 case tok::caret: Opc = BO_Xor; break; 12297 case tok::pipe: Opc = BO_Or; break; 12298 case tok::ampamp: Opc = BO_LAnd; break; 12299 case tok::pipepipe: Opc = BO_LOr; break; 12300 case tok::equal: Opc = BO_Assign; break; 12301 case tok::starequal: Opc = BO_MulAssign; break; 12302 case tok::slashequal: Opc = BO_DivAssign; break; 12303 case tok::percentequal: Opc = BO_RemAssign; break; 12304 case tok::plusequal: Opc = BO_AddAssign; break; 12305 case tok::minusequal: Opc = BO_SubAssign; break; 12306 case tok::lesslessequal: Opc = BO_ShlAssign; break; 12307 case tok::greatergreaterequal: Opc = BO_ShrAssign; break; 12308 case tok::ampequal: Opc = BO_AndAssign; break; 12309 case tok::caretequal: Opc = BO_XorAssign; break; 12310 case tok::pipeequal: Opc = BO_OrAssign; break; 12311 case tok::comma: Opc = BO_Comma; break; 12312 } 12313 return Opc; 12314 } 12315 12316 static inline UnaryOperatorKind ConvertTokenKindToUnaryOpcode( 12317 tok::TokenKind Kind) { 12318 UnaryOperatorKind Opc; 12319 switch (Kind) { 12320 default: llvm_unreachable("Unknown unary op!"); 12321 case tok::plusplus: Opc = UO_PreInc; break; 12322 case tok::minusminus: Opc = UO_PreDec; break; 12323 case tok::amp: Opc = UO_AddrOf; break; 12324 case tok::star: Opc = UO_Deref; break; 12325 case tok::plus: Opc = UO_Plus; break; 12326 case tok::minus: Opc = UO_Minus; break; 12327 case tok::tilde: Opc = UO_Not; break; 12328 case tok::exclaim: Opc = UO_LNot; break; 12329 case tok::kw___real: Opc = UO_Real; break; 12330 case tok::kw___imag: Opc = UO_Imag; break; 12331 case tok::kw___extension__: Opc = UO_Extension; break; 12332 } 12333 return Opc; 12334 } 12335 12336 /// DiagnoseSelfAssignment - Emits a warning if a value is assigned to itself. 12337 /// This warning suppressed in the event of macro expansions. 12338 static void DiagnoseSelfAssignment(Sema &S, Expr *LHSExpr, Expr *RHSExpr, 12339 SourceLocation OpLoc, bool IsBuiltin) { 12340 if (S.inTemplateInstantiation()) 12341 return; 12342 if (S.isUnevaluatedContext()) 12343 return; 12344 if (OpLoc.isInvalid() || OpLoc.isMacroID()) 12345 return; 12346 LHSExpr = LHSExpr->IgnoreParenImpCasts(); 12347 RHSExpr = RHSExpr->IgnoreParenImpCasts(); 12348 const DeclRefExpr *LHSDeclRef = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(LHSExpr); 12349 const DeclRefExpr *RHSDeclRef = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(RHSExpr); 12350 if (!LHSDeclRef || !RHSDeclRef || 12351 LHSDeclRef->getLocation().isMacroID() || 12352 RHSDeclRef->getLocation().isMacroID()) 12353 return; 12354 const ValueDecl *LHSDecl = 12355 cast<ValueDecl>(LHSDeclRef->getDecl()->getCanonicalDecl()); 12356 const ValueDecl *RHSDecl = 12357 cast<ValueDecl>(RHSDeclRef->getDecl()->getCanonicalDecl()); 12358 if (LHSDecl != RHSDecl) 12359 return; 12360 if (LHSDecl->getType().isVolatileQualified()) 12361 return; 12362 if (const ReferenceType *RefTy = LHSDecl->getType()->getAs<ReferenceType>()) 12363 if (RefTy->getPointeeType().isVolatileQualified()) 12364 return; 12365 12366 S.Diag(OpLoc, IsBuiltin ? diag::warn_self_assignment_builtin 12367 : diag::warn_self_assignment_overloaded) 12368 << LHSDeclRef->getType() << LHSExpr->getSourceRange() 12369 << RHSExpr->getSourceRange(); 12370 } 12371 12372 /// Check if a bitwise-& is performed on an Objective-C pointer. This 12373 /// is usually indicative of introspection within the Objective-C pointer. 12374 static void checkObjCPointerIntrospection(Sema &S, ExprResult &L, ExprResult &R, 12375 SourceLocation OpLoc) { 12376 if (!S.getLangOpts().ObjC) 12377 return; 12378 12379 const Expr *ObjCPointerExpr = nullptr, *OtherExpr = nullptr; 12380 const Expr *LHS = L.get(); 12381 const Expr *RHS = R.get(); 12382 12383 if (LHS->IgnoreParenCasts()->getType()->isObjCObjectPointerType()) { 12384 ObjCPointerExpr = LHS; 12385 OtherExpr = RHS; 12386 } 12387 else if (RHS->IgnoreParenCasts()->getType()->isObjCObjectPointerType()) { 12388 ObjCPointerExpr = RHS; 12389 OtherExpr = LHS; 12390 } 12391 12392 // This warning is deliberately made very specific to reduce false 12393 // positives with logic that uses '&' for hashing. This logic mainly 12394 // looks for code trying to introspect into tagged pointers, which 12395 // code should generally never do. 12396 if (ObjCPointerExpr && isa<IntegerLiteral>(OtherExpr->IgnoreParenCasts())) { 12397 unsigned Diag = diag::warn_objc_pointer_masking; 12398 // Determine if we are introspecting the result of performSelectorXXX. 12399 const Expr *Ex = ObjCPointerExpr->IgnoreParenCasts(); 12400 // Special case messages to -performSelector and friends, which 12401 // can return non-pointer values boxed in a pointer value. 12402 // Some clients may wish to silence warnings in this subcase. 12403 if (const ObjCMessageExpr *ME = dyn_cast<ObjCMessageExpr>(Ex)) { 12404 Selector S = ME->getSelector(); 12405 StringRef SelArg0 = S.getNameForSlot(0); 12406 if (SelArg0.startswith("performSelector")) 12407 Diag = diag::warn_objc_pointer_masking_performSelector; 12408 } 12409 12410 S.Diag(OpLoc, Diag) 12411 << ObjCPointerExpr->getSourceRange(); 12412 } 12413 } 12414 12415 static NamedDecl *getDeclFromExpr(Expr *E) { 12416 if (!E) 12417 return nullptr; 12418 if (auto *DRE = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(E)) 12419 return DRE->getDecl(); 12420 if (auto *ME = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(E)) 12421 return ME->getMemberDecl(); 12422 if (auto *IRE = dyn_cast<ObjCIvarRefExpr>(E)) 12423 return IRE->getDecl(); 12424 return nullptr; 12425 } 12426 12427 // This helper function promotes a binary operator's operands (which are of a 12428 // half vector type) to a vector of floats and then truncates the result to 12429 // a vector of either half or short. 12430 static ExprResult convertHalfVecBinOp(Sema &S, ExprResult LHS, ExprResult RHS, 12431 BinaryOperatorKind Opc, QualType ResultTy, 12432 ExprValueKind VK, ExprObjectKind OK, 12433 bool IsCompAssign, SourceLocation OpLoc, 12434 FPOptions FPFeatures) { 12435 auto &Context = S.getASTContext(); 12436 assert((isVector(ResultTy, Context.HalfTy) || 12437 isVector(ResultTy, Context.ShortTy)) && 12438 "Result must be a vector of half or short"); 12439 assert(isVector(LHS.get()->getType(), Context.HalfTy) && 12440 isVector(RHS.get()->getType(), Context.HalfTy) && 12441 "both operands expected to be a half vector"); 12442 12443 RHS = convertVector(RHS.get(), Context.FloatTy, S); 12444 QualType BinOpResTy = RHS.get()->getType(); 12445 12446 // If Opc is a comparison, ResultType is a vector of shorts. In that case, 12447 // change BinOpResTy to a vector of ints. 12448 if (isVector(ResultTy, Context.ShortTy)) 12449 BinOpResTy = S.GetSignedVectorType(BinOpResTy); 12450 12451 if (IsCompAssign) 12452 return new (Context) CompoundAssignOperator( 12453 LHS.get(), RHS.get(), Opc, ResultTy, VK, OK, BinOpResTy, BinOpResTy, 12454 OpLoc, FPFeatures); 12455 12456 LHS = convertVector(LHS.get(), Context.FloatTy, S); 12457 auto *BO = new (Context) BinaryOperator(LHS.get(), RHS.get(), Opc, BinOpResTy, 12458 VK, OK, OpLoc, FPFeatures); 12459 return convertVector(BO, ResultTy->getAs<VectorType>()->getElementType(), S); 12460 } 12461 12462 static std::pair<ExprResult, ExprResult> 12463 CorrectDelayedTyposInBinOp(Sema &S, BinaryOperatorKind Opc, Expr *LHSExpr, 12464 Expr *RHSExpr) { 12465 ExprResult LHS = LHSExpr, RHS = RHSExpr; 12466 if (!S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 12467 // C cannot handle TypoExpr nodes on either side of a binop because it 12468 // doesn't handle dependent types properly, so make sure any TypoExprs have 12469 // been dealt with before checking the operands. 12470 LHS = S.CorrectDelayedTyposInExpr(LHS); 12471 RHS = S.CorrectDelayedTyposInExpr(RHS, [Opc, LHS](Expr *E) { 12472 if (Opc != BO_Assign) 12473 return ExprResult(E); 12474 // Avoid correcting the RHS to the same Expr as the LHS. 12475 Decl *D = getDeclFromExpr(E); 12476 return (D && D == getDeclFromExpr(LHS.get())) ? ExprError() : E; 12477 }); 12478 } 12479 return std::make_pair(LHS, RHS); 12480 } 12481 12482 /// Returns true if conversion between vectors of halfs and vectors of floats 12483 /// is needed. 12484 static bool needsConversionOfHalfVec(bool OpRequiresConversion, ASTContext &Ctx, 12485 QualType SrcType) { 12486 return OpRequiresConversion && !Ctx.getLangOpts().NativeHalfType && 12487 !Ctx.getTargetInfo().useFP16ConversionIntrinsics() && 12488 isVector(SrcType, Ctx.HalfTy); 12489 } 12490 12491 /// CreateBuiltinBinOp - Creates a new built-in binary operation with 12492 /// operator @p Opc at location @c TokLoc. This routine only supports 12493 /// built-in operations; ActOnBinOp handles overloaded operators. 12494 ExprResult Sema::CreateBuiltinBinOp(SourceLocation OpLoc, 12495 BinaryOperatorKind Opc, 12496 Expr *LHSExpr, Expr *RHSExpr) { 12497 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11 && isa<InitListExpr>(RHSExpr)) { 12498 // The syntax only allows initializer lists on the RHS of assignment, 12499 // so we don't need to worry about accepting invalid code for 12500 // non-assignment operators. 12501 // C++11 5.17p9: 12502 // The meaning of x = {v} [...] is that of x = T(v) [...]. The meaning 12503 // of x = {} is x = T(). 12504 InitializationKind Kind = InitializationKind::CreateDirectList( 12505 RHSExpr->getBeginLoc(), RHSExpr->getBeginLoc(), RHSExpr->getEndLoc()); 12506 InitializedEntity Entity = 12507 InitializedEntity::InitializeTemporary(LHSExpr->getType()); 12508 InitializationSequence InitSeq(*this, Entity, Kind, RHSExpr); 12509 ExprResult Init = InitSeq.Perform(*this, Entity, Kind, RHSExpr); 12510 if (Init.isInvalid()) 12511 return Init; 12512 RHSExpr = Init.get(); 12513 } 12514 12515 ExprResult LHS = LHSExpr, RHS = RHSExpr; 12516 QualType ResultTy; // Result type of the binary operator. 12517 // The following two variables are used for compound assignment operators 12518 QualType CompLHSTy; // Type of LHS after promotions for computation 12519 QualType CompResultTy; // Type of computation result 12520 ExprValueKind VK = VK_RValue; 12521 ExprObjectKind OK = OK_Ordinary; 12522 bool ConvertHalfVec = false; 12523 12524 std::tie(LHS, RHS) = CorrectDelayedTyposInBinOp(*this, Opc, LHSExpr, RHSExpr); 12525 if (!LHS.isUsable() || !RHS.isUsable()) 12526 return ExprError(); 12527 12528 if (getLangOpts().OpenCL) { 12529 QualType LHSTy = LHSExpr->getType(); 12530 QualType RHSTy = RHSExpr->getType(); 12531 // OpenCLC v2.0 s6.13.11.1 allows atomic variables to be initialized by 12532 // the ATOMIC_VAR_INIT macro. 12533 if (LHSTy->isAtomicType() || RHSTy->isAtomicType()) { 12534 SourceRange SR(LHSExpr->getBeginLoc(), RHSExpr->getEndLoc()); 12535 if (BO_Assign == Opc) 12536 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_opencl_atomic_init) << 0 << SR; 12537 else 12538 ResultTy = InvalidOperands(OpLoc, LHS, RHS); 12539 return ExprError(); 12540 } 12541 12542 // OpenCL special types - image, sampler, pipe, and blocks are to be used 12543 // only with a builtin functions and therefore should be disallowed here. 12544 if (LHSTy->isImageType() || RHSTy->isImageType() || 12545 LHSTy->isSamplerT() || RHSTy->isSamplerT() || 12546 LHSTy->isPipeType() || RHSTy->isPipeType() || 12547 LHSTy->isBlockPointerType() || RHSTy->isBlockPointerType()) { 12548 ResultTy = InvalidOperands(OpLoc, LHS, RHS); 12549 return ExprError(); 12550 } 12551 } 12552 12553 // Diagnose operations on the unsupported types for OpenMP device compilation. 12554 if (getLangOpts().OpenMP && getLangOpts().OpenMPIsDevice) { 12555 if (Opc != BO_Assign && Opc != BO_Comma) { 12556 checkOpenMPDeviceExpr(LHSExpr); 12557 checkOpenMPDeviceExpr(RHSExpr); 12558 } 12559 } 12560 12561 switch (Opc) { 12562 case BO_Assign: 12563 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(LHS.get(), RHS, OpLoc, QualType()); 12564 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && 12565 LHS.get()->getObjectKind() != OK_ObjCProperty) { 12566 VK = LHS.get()->getValueKind(); 12567 OK = LHS.get()->getObjectKind(); 12568 } 12569 if (!ResultTy.isNull()) { 12570 DiagnoseSelfAssignment(*this, LHS.get(), RHS.get(), OpLoc, true); 12571 DiagnoseSelfMove(LHS.get(), RHS.get(), OpLoc); 12572 12573 // Avoid copying a block to the heap if the block is assigned to a local 12574 // auto variable that is declared in the same scope as the block. This 12575 // optimization is unsafe if the local variable is declared in an outer 12576 // scope. For example: 12577 // 12578 // BlockTy b; 12579 // { 12580 // b = ^{...}; 12581 // } 12582 // // It is unsafe to invoke the block here if it wasn't copied to the 12583 // // heap. 12584 // b(); 12585 12586 if (auto *BE = dyn_cast<BlockExpr>(RHS.get()->IgnoreParens())) 12587 if (auto *DRE = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(LHS.get()->IgnoreParens())) 12588 if (auto *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(DRE->getDecl())) 12589 if (VD->hasLocalStorage() && getCurScope()->isDeclScope(VD)) 12590 BE->getBlockDecl()->setCanAvoidCopyToHeap(); 12591 } 12592 RecordModifiableNonNullParam(*this, LHS.get()); 12593 break; 12594 case BO_PtrMemD: 12595 case BO_PtrMemI: 12596 ResultTy = CheckPointerToMemberOperands(LHS, RHS, VK, OpLoc, 12597 Opc == BO_PtrMemI); 12598 break; 12599 case BO_Mul: 12600 case BO_Div: 12601 ConvertHalfVec = true; 12602 ResultTy = CheckMultiplyDivideOperands(LHS, RHS, OpLoc, false, 12603 Opc == BO_Div); 12604 break; 12605 case BO_Rem: 12606 ResultTy = CheckRemainderOperands(LHS, RHS, OpLoc); 12607 break; 12608 case BO_Add: 12609 ConvertHalfVec = true; 12610 ResultTy = CheckAdditionOperands(LHS, RHS, OpLoc, Opc); 12611 break; 12612 case BO_Sub: 12613 ConvertHalfVec = true; 12614 ResultTy = CheckSubtractionOperands(LHS, RHS, OpLoc); 12615 break; 12616 case BO_Shl: 12617 case BO_Shr: 12618 ResultTy = CheckShiftOperands(LHS, RHS, OpLoc, Opc); 12619 break; 12620 case BO_LE: 12621 case BO_LT: 12622 case BO_GE: 12623 case BO_GT: 12624 ConvertHalfVec = true; 12625 ResultTy = CheckCompareOperands(LHS, RHS, OpLoc, Opc); 12626 break; 12627 case BO_EQ: 12628 case BO_NE: 12629 ConvertHalfVec = true; 12630 ResultTy = CheckCompareOperands(LHS, RHS, OpLoc, Opc); 12631 break; 12632 case BO_Cmp: 12633 ConvertHalfVec = true; 12634 ResultTy = CheckCompareOperands(LHS, RHS, OpLoc, Opc); 12635 assert(ResultTy.isNull() || ResultTy->getAsCXXRecordDecl()); 12636 break; 12637 case BO_And: 12638 checkObjCPointerIntrospection(*this, LHS, RHS, OpLoc); 12639 LLVM_FALLTHROUGH; 12640 case BO_Xor: 12641 case BO_Or: 12642 ResultTy = CheckBitwiseOperands(LHS, RHS, OpLoc, Opc); 12643 break; 12644 case BO_LAnd: 12645 case BO_LOr: 12646 ConvertHalfVec = true; 12647 ResultTy = CheckLogicalOperands(LHS, RHS, OpLoc, Opc); 12648 break; 12649 case BO_MulAssign: 12650 case BO_DivAssign: 12651 ConvertHalfVec = true; 12652 CompResultTy = CheckMultiplyDivideOperands(LHS, RHS, OpLoc, true, 12653 Opc == BO_DivAssign); 12654 CompLHSTy = CompResultTy; 12655 if (!CompResultTy.isNull() && !LHS.isInvalid() && !RHS.isInvalid()) 12656 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(LHS.get(), RHS, OpLoc, CompResultTy); 12657 break; 12658 case BO_RemAssign: 12659 CompResultTy = CheckRemainderOperands(LHS, RHS, OpLoc, true); 12660 CompLHSTy = CompResultTy; 12661 if (!CompResultTy.isNull() && !LHS.isInvalid() && !RHS.isInvalid()) 12662 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(LHS.get(), RHS, OpLoc, CompResultTy); 12663 break; 12664 case BO_AddAssign: 12665 ConvertHalfVec = true; 12666 CompResultTy = CheckAdditionOperands(LHS, RHS, OpLoc, Opc, &CompLHSTy); 12667 if (!CompResultTy.isNull() && !LHS.isInvalid() && !RHS.isInvalid()) 12668 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(LHS.get(), RHS, OpLoc, CompResultTy); 12669 break; 12670 case BO_SubAssign: 12671 ConvertHalfVec = true; 12672 CompResultTy = CheckSubtractionOperands(LHS, RHS, OpLoc, &CompLHSTy); 12673 if (!CompResultTy.isNull() && !LHS.isInvalid() && !RHS.isInvalid()) 12674 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(LHS.get(), RHS, OpLoc, CompResultTy); 12675 break; 12676 case BO_ShlAssign: 12677 case BO_ShrAssign: 12678 CompResultTy = CheckShiftOperands(LHS, RHS, OpLoc, Opc, true); 12679 CompLHSTy = CompResultTy; 12680 if (!CompResultTy.isNull() && !LHS.isInvalid() && !RHS.isInvalid()) 12681 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(LHS.get(), RHS, OpLoc, CompResultTy); 12682 break; 12683 case BO_AndAssign: 12684 case BO_OrAssign: // fallthrough 12685 DiagnoseSelfAssignment(*this, LHS.get(), RHS.get(), OpLoc, true); 12686 LLVM_FALLTHROUGH; 12687 case BO_XorAssign: 12688 CompResultTy = CheckBitwiseOperands(LHS, RHS, OpLoc, Opc); 12689 CompLHSTy = CompResultTy; 12690 if (!CompResultTy.isNull() && !LHS.isInvalid() && !RHS.isInvalid()) 12691 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(LHS.get(), RHS, OpLoc, CompResultTy); 12692 break; 12693 case BO_Comma: 12694 ResultTy = CheckCommaOperands(*this, LHS, RHS, OpLoc); 12695 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && !RHS.isInvalid()) { 12696 VK = RHS.get()->getValueKind(); 12697 OK = RHS.get()->getObjectKind(); 12698 } 12699 break; 12700 } 12701 if (ResultTy.isNull() || LHS.isInvalid() || RHS.isInvalid()) 12702 return ExprError(); 12703 12704 // Some of the binary operations require promoting operands of half vector to 12705 // float vectors and truncating the result back to half vector. For now, we do 12706 // this only when HalfArgsAndReturn is set (that is, when the target is arm or 12707 // arm64). 12708 assert(isVector(RHS.get()->getType(), Context.HalfTy) == 12709 isVector(LHS.get()->getType(), Context.HalfTy) && 12710 "both sides are half vectors or neither sides are"); 12711 ConvertHalfVec = needsConversionOfHalfVec(ConvertHalfVec, Context, 12712 LHS.get()->getType()); 12713 12714 // Check for array bounds violations for both sides of the BinaryOperator 12715 CheckArrayAccess(LHS.get()); 12716 CheckArrayAccess(RHS.get()); 12717 12718 if (const ObjCIsaExpr *OISA = dyn_cast<ObjCIsaExpr>(LHS.get()->IgnoreParenCasts())) { 12719 NamedDecl *ObjectSetClass = LookupSingleName(TUScope, 12720 &Context.Idents.get("object_setClass"), 12721 SourceLocation(), LookupOrdinaryName); 12722 if (ObjectSetClass && isa<ObjCIsaExpr>(LHS.get())) { 12723 SourceLocation RHSLocEnd = getLocForEndOfToken(RHS.get()->getEndLoc()); 12724 Diag(LHS.get()->getExprLoc(), diag::warn_objc_isa_assign) 12725 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(LHS.get()->getBeginLoc(), 12726 "object_setClass(") 12727 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(SourceRange(OISA->getOpLoc(), OpLoc), 12728 ",") 12729 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(RHSLocEnd, ")"); 12730 } 12731 else 12732 Diag(LHS.get()->getExprLoc(), diag::warn_objc_isa_assign); 12733 } 12734 else if (const ObjCIvarRefExpr *OIRE = 12735 dyn_cast<ObjCIvarRefExpr>(LHS.get()->IgnoreParenCasts())) 12736 DiagnoseDirectIsaAccess(*this, OIRE, OpLoc, RHS.get()); 12737 12738 // Opc is not a compound assignment if CompResultTy is null. 12739 if (CompResultTy.isNull()) { 12740 if (ConvertHalfVec) 12741 return convertHalfVecBinOp(*this, LHS, RHS, Opc, ResultTy, VK, OK, false, 12742 OpLoc, FPFeatures); 12743 return new (Context) BinaryOperator(LHS.get(), RHS.get(), Opc, ResultTy, VK, 12744 OK, OpLoc, FPFeatures); 12745 } 12746 12747 // Handle compound assignments. 12748 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && LHS.get()->getObjectKind() != 12749 OK_ObjCProperty) { 12750 VK = VK_LValue; 12751 OK = LHS.get()->getObjectKind(); 12752 } 12753 12754 if (ConvertHalfVec) 12755 return convertHalfVecBinOp(*this, LHS, RHS, Opc, ResultTy, VK, OK, true, 12756 OpLoc, FPFeatures); 12757 12758 return new (Context) CompoundAssignOperator( 12759 LHS.get(), RHS.get(), Opc, ResultTy, VK, OK, CompLHSTy, CompResultTy, 12760 OpLoc, FPFeatures); 12761 } 12762 12763 /// DiagnoseBitwisePrecedence - Emit a warning when bitwise and comparison 12764 /// operators are mixed in a way that suggests that the programmer forgot that 12765 /// comparison operators have higher precedence. The most typical example of 12766 /// such code is "flags & 0x0020 != 0", which is equivalent to "flags & 1". 12767 static void DiagnoseBitwisePrecedence(Sema &Self, BinaryOperatorKind Opc, 12768 SourceLocation OpLoc, Expr *LHSExpr, 12769 Expr *RHSExpr) { 12770 BinaryOperator *LHSBO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(LHSExpr); 12771 BinaryOperator *RHSBO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(RHSExpr); 12772 12773 // Check that one of the sides is a comparison operator and the other isn't. 12774 bool isLeftComp = LHSBO && LHSBO->isComparisonOp(); 12775 bool isRightComp = RHSBO && RHSBO->isComparisonOp(); 12776 if (isLeftComp == isRightComp) 12777 return; 12778 12779 // Bitwise operations are sometimes used as eager logical ops. 12780 // Don't diagnose this. 12781 bool isLeftBitwise = LHSBO && LHSBO->isBitwiseOp(); 12782 bool isRightBitwise = RHSBO && RHSBO->isBitwiseOp(); 12783 if (isLeftBitwise || isRightBitwise) 12784 return; 12785 12786 SourceRange DiagRange = isLeftComp 12787 ? SourceRange(LHSExpr->getBeginLoc(), OpLoc) 12788 : SourceRange(OpLoc, RHSExpr->getEndLoc()); 12789 StringRef OpStr = isLeftComp ? LHSBO->getOpcodeStr() : RHSBO->getOpcodeStr(); 12790 SourceRange ParensRange = 12791 isLeftComp 12792 ? SourceRange(LHSBO->getRHS()->getBeginLoc(), RHSExpr->getEndLoc()) 12793 : SourceRange(LHSExpr->getBeginLoc(), RHSBO->getLHS()->getEndLoc()); 12794 12795 Self.Diag(OpLoc, diag::warn_precedence_bitwise_rel) 12796 << DiagRange << BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc) << OpStr; 12797 SuggestParentheses(Self, OpLoc, 12798 Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_silence) << OpStr, 12799 (isLeftComp ? LHSExpr : RHSExpr)->getSourceRange()); 12800 SuggestParentheses(Self, OpLoc, 12801 Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_bitwise_first) 12802 << BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc), 12803 ParensRange); 12804 } 12805 12806 /// It accepts a '&&' expr that is inside a '||' one. 12807 /// Emit a diagnostic together with a fixit hint that wraps the '&&' expression 12808 /// in parentheses. 12809 static void 12810 EmitDiagnosticForLogicalAndInLogicalOr(Sema &Self, SourceLocation OpLoc, 12811 BinaryOperator *Bop) { 12812 assert(Bop->getOpcode() == BO_LAnd); 12813 Self.Diag(Bop->getOperatorLoc(), diag::warn_logical_and_in_logical_or) 12814 << Bop->getSourceRange() << OpLoc; 12815 SuggestParentheses(Self, Bop->getOperatorLoc(), 12816 Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_silence) 12817 << Bop->getOpcodeStr(), 12818 Bop->getSourceRange()); 12819 } 12820 12821 /// Returns true if the given expression can be evaluated as a constant 12822 /// 'true'. 12823 static bool EvaluatesAsTrue(Sema &S, Expr *E) { 12824 bool Res; 12825 return !E->isValueDependent() && 12826 E->EvaluateAsBooleanCondition(Res, S.getASTContext()) && Res; 12827 } 12828 12829 /// Returns true if the given expression can be evaluated as a constant 12830 /// 'false'. 12831 static bool EvaluatesAsFalse(Sema &S, Expr *E) { 12832 bool Res; 12833 return !E->isValueDependent() && 12834 E->EvaluateAsBooleanCondition(Res, S.getASTContext()) && !Res; 12835 } 12836 12837 /// Look for '&&' in the left hand of a '||' expr. 12838 static void DiagnoseLogicalAndInLogicalOrLHS(Sema &S, SourceLocation OpLoc, 12839 Expr *LHSExpr, Expr *RHSExpr) { 12840 if (BinaryOperator *Bop = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(LHSExpr)) { 12841 if (Bop->getOpcode() == BO_LAnd) { 12842 // If it's "a && b || 0" don't warn since the precedence doesn't matter. 12843 if (EvaluatesAsFalse(S, RHSExpr)) 12844 return; 12845 // If it's "1 && a || b" don't warn since the precedence doesn't matter. 12846 if (!EvaluatesAsTrue(S, Bop->getLHS())) 12847 return EmitDiagnosticForLogicalAndInLogicalOr(S, OpLoc, Bop); 12848 } else if (Bop->getOpcode() == BO_LOr) { 12849 if (BinaryOperator *RBop = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Bop->getRHS())) { 12850 // If it's "a || b && 1 || c" we didn't warn earlier for 12851 // "a || b && 1", but warn now. 12852 if (RBop->getOpcode() == BO_LAnd && EvaluatesAsTrue(S, RBop->getRHS())) 12853 return EmitDiagnosticForLogicalAndInLogicalOr(S, OpLoc, RBop); 12854 } 12855 } 12856 } 12857 } 12858 12859 /// Look for '&&' in the right hand of a '||' expr. 12860 static void DiagnoseLogicalAndInLogicalOrRHS(Sema &S, SourceLocation OpLoc, 12861 Expr *LHSExpr, Expr *RHSExpr) { 12862 if (BinaryOperator *Bop = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(RHSExpr)) { 12863 if (Bop->getOpcode() == BO_LAnd) { 12864 // If it's "0 || a && b" don't warn since the precedence doesn't matter. 12865 if (EvaluatesAsFalse(S, LHSExpr)) 12866 return; 12867 // If it's "a || b && 1" don't warn since the precedence doesn't matter. 12868 if (!EvaluatesAsTrue(S, Bop->getRHS())) 12869 return EmitDiagnosticForLogicalAndInLogicalOr(S, OpLoc, Bop); 12870 } 12871 } 12872 } 12873 12874 /// Look for bitwise op in the left or right hand of a bitwise op with 12875 /// lower precedence and emit a diagnostic together with a fixit hint that wraps 12876 /// the '&' expression in parentheses. 12877 static void DiagnoseBitwiseOpInBitwiseOp(Sema &S, BinaryOperatorKind Opc, 12878 SourceLocation OpLoc, Expr *SubExpr) { 12879 if (BinaryOperator *Bop = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(SubExpr)) { 12880 if (Bop->isBitwiseOp() && Bop->getOpcode() < Opc) { 12881 S.Diag(Bop->getOperatorLoc(), diag::warn_bitwise_op_in_bitwise_op) 12882 << Bop->getOpcodeStr() << BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc) 12883 << Bop->getSourceRange() << OpLoc; 12884 SuggestParentheses(S, Bop->getOperatorLoc(), 12885 S.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_silence) 12886 << Bop->getOpcodeStr(), 12887 Bop->getSourceRange()); 12888 } 12889 } 12890 } 12891 12892 static void DiagnoseAdditionInShift(Sema &S, SourceLocation OpLoc, 12893 Expr *SubExpr, StringRef Shift) { 12894 if (BinaryOperator *Bop = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(SubExpr)) { 12895 if (Bop->getOpcode() == BO_Add || Bop->getOpcode() == BO_Sub) { 12896 StringRef Op = Bop->getOpcodeStr(); 12897 S.Diag(Bop->getOperatorLoc(), diag::warn_addition_in_bitshift) 12898 << Bop->getSourceRange() << OpLoc << Shift << Op; 12899 SuggestParentheses(S, Bop->getOperatorLoc(), 12900 S.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_silence) << Op, 12901 Bop->getSourceRange()); 12902 } 12903 } 12904 } 12905 12906 static void DiagnoseShiftCompare(Sema &S, SourceLocation OpLoc, 12907 Expr *LHSExpr, Expr *RHSExpr) { 12908 CXXOperatorCallExpr *OCE = dyn_cast<CXXOperatorCallExpr>(LHSExpr); 12909 if (!OCE) 12910 return; 12911 12912 FunctionDecl *FD = OCE->getDirectCallee(); 12913 if (!FD || !FD->isOverloadedOperator()) 12914 return; 12915 12916 OverloadedOperatorKind Kind = FD->getOverloadedOperator(); 12917 if (Kind != OO_LessLess && Kind != OO_GreaterGreater) 12918 return; 12919 12920 S.Diag(OpLoc, diag::warn_overloaded_shift_in_comparison) 12921 << LHSExpr->getSourceRange() << RHSExpr->getSourceRange() 12922 << (Kind == OO_LessLess); 12923 SuggestParentheses(S, OCE->getOperatorLoc(), 12924 S.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_silence) 12925 << (Kind == OO_LessLess ? "<<" : ">>"), 12926 OCE->getSourceRange()); 12927 SuggestParentheses( 12928 S, OpLoc, S.PDiag(diag::note_evaluate_comparison_first), 12929 SourceRange(OCE->getArg(1)->getBeginLoc(), RHSExpr->getEndLoc())); 12930 } 12931 12932 /// DiagnoseBinOpPrecedence - Emit warnings for expressions with tricky 12933 /// precedence. 12934 static void DiagnoseBinOpPrecedence(Sema &Self, BinaryOperatorKind Opc, 12935 SourceLocation OpLoc, Expr *LHSExpr, 12936 Expr *RHSExpr){ 12937 // Diagnose "arg1 'bitwise' arg2 'eq' arg3". 12938 if (BinaryOperator::isBitwiseOp(Opc)) 12939 DiagnoseBitwisePrecedence(Self, Opc, OpLoc, LHSExpr, RHSExpr); 12940 12941 // Diagnose "arg1 & arg2 | arg3" 12942 if ((Opc == BO_Or || Opc == BO_Xor) && 12943 !OpLoc.isMacroID()/* Don't warn in macros. */) { 12944 DiagnoseBitwiseOpInBitwiseOp(Self, Opc, OpLoc, LHSExpr); 12945 DiagnoseBitwiseOpInBitwiseOp(Self, Opc, OpLoc, RHSExpr); 12946 } 12947 12948 // Warn about arg1 || arg2 && arg3, as GCC 4.3+ does. 12949 // We don't warn for 'assert(a || b && "bad")' since this is safe. 12950 if (Opc == BO_LOr && !OpLoc.isMacroID()/* Don't warn in macros. */) { 12951 DiagnoseLogicalAndInLogicalOrLHS(Self, OpLoc, LHSExpr, RHSExpr); 12952 DiagnoseLogicalAndInLogicalOrRHS(Self, OpLoc, LHSExpr, RHSExpr); 12953 } 12954 12955 if ((Opc == BO_Shl && LHSExpr->getType()->isIntegralType(Self.getASTContext())) 12956 || Opc == BO_Shr) { 12957 StringRef Shift = BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc); 12958 DiagnoseAdditionInShift(Self, OpLoc, LHSExpr, Shift); 12959 DiagnoseAdditionInShift(Self, OpLoc, RHSExpr, Shift); 12960 } 12961 12962 // Warn on overloaded shift operators and comparisons, such as: 12963 // cout << 5 == 4; 12964 if (BinaryOperator::isComparisonOp(Opc)) 12965 DiagnoseShiftCompare(Self, OpLoc, LHSExpr, RHSExpr); 12966 } 12967 12968 // Binary Operators. 'Tok' is the token for the operator. 12969 ExprResult Sema::ActOnBinOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation TokLoc, 12970 tok::TokenKind Kind, 12971 Expr *LHSExpr, Expr *RHSExpr) { 12972 BinaryOperatorKind Opc = ConvertTokenKindToBinaryOpcode(Kind); 12973 assert(LHSExpr && "ActOnBinOp(): missing left expression"); 12974 assert(RHSExpr && "ActOnBinOp(): missing right expression"); 12975 12976 // Emit warnings for tricky precedence issues, e.g. "bitfield & 0x4 == 0" 12977 DiagnoseBinOpPrecedence(*this, Opc, TokLoc, LHSExpr, RHSExpr); 12978 12979 return BuildBinOp(S, TokLoc, Opc, LHSExpr, RHSExpr); 12980 } 12981 12982 /// Build an overloaded binary operator expression in the given scope. 12983 static ExprResult BuildOverloadedBinOp(Sema &S, Scope *Sc, SourceLocation OpLoc, 12984 BinaryOperatorKind Opc, 12985 Expr *LHS, Expr *RHS) { 12986 switch (Opc) { 12987 case BO_Assign: 12988 case BO_DivAssign: 12989 case BO_RemAssign: 12990 case BO_SubAssign: 12991 case BO_AndAssign: 12992 case BO_OrAssign: 12993 case BO_XorAssign: 12994 DiagnoseSelfAssignment(S, LHS, RHS, OpLoc, false); 12995 CheckIdentityFieldAssignment(LHS, RHS, OpLoc, S); 12996 break; 12997 default: 12998 break; 12999 } 13000 13001 // Find all of the overloaded operators visible from this 13002 // point. We perform both an operator-name lookup from the local 13003 // scope and an argument-dependent lookup based on the types of 13004 // the arguments. 13005 UnresolvedSet<16> Functions; 13006 OverloadedOperatorKind OverOp 13007 = BinaryOperator::getOverloadedOperator(Opc); 13008 if (Sc && OverOp != OO_None && OverOp != OO_Equal) 13009 S.LookupOverloadedOperatorName(OverOp, Sc, LHS->getType(), 13010 RHS->getType(), Functions); 13011 13012 // Build the (potentially-overloaded, potentially-dependent) 13013 // binary operation. 13014 return S.CreateOverloadedBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, Functions, LHS, RHS); 13015 } 13016 13017 ExprResult Sema::BuildBinOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation OpLoc, 13018 BinaryOperatorKind Opc, 13019 Expr *LHSExpr, Expr *RHSExpr) { 13020 ExprResult LHS, RHS; 13021 std::tie(LHS, RHS) = CorrectDelayedTyposInBinOp(*this, Opc, LHSExpr, RHSExpr); 13022 if (!LHS.isUsable() || !RHS.isUsable()) 13023 return ExprError(); 13024 LHSExpr = LHS.get(); 13025 RHSExpr = RHS.get(); 13026 13027 // We want to end up calling one of checkPseudoObjectAssignment 13028 // (if the LHS is a pseudo-object), BuildOverloadedBinOp (if 13029 // both expressions are overloadable or either is type-dependent), 13030 // or CreateBuiltinBinOp (in any other case). We also want to get 13031 // any placeholder types out of the way. 13032 13033 // Handle pseudo-objects in the LHS. 13034 if (const BuiltinType *pty = LHSExpr->getType()->getAsPlaceholderType()) { 13035 // Assignments with a pseudo-object l-value need special analysis. 13036 if (pty->getKind() == BuiltinType::PseudoObject && 13037 BinaryOperator::isAssignmentOp(Opc)) 13038 return checkPseudoObjectAssignment(S, OpLoc, Opc, LHSExpr, RHSExpr); 13039 13040 // Don't resolve overloads if the other type is overloadable. 13041 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && pty->getKind() == BuiltinType::Overload) { 13042 // We can't actually test that if we still have a placeholder, 13043 // though. Fortunately, none of the exceptions we see in that 13044 // code below are valid when the LHS is an overload set. Note 13045 // that an overload set can be dependently-typed, but it never 13046 // instantiates to having an overloadable type. 13047 ExprResult resolvedRHS = CheckPlaceholderExpr(RHSExpr); 13048 if (resolvedRHS.isInvalid()) return ExprError(); 13049 RHSExpr = resolvedRHS.get(); 13050 13051 if (RHSExpr->isTypeDependent() || 13052 RHSExpr->getType()->isOverloadableType()) 13053 return BuildOverloadedBinOp(*this, S, OpLoc, Opc, LHSExpr, RHSExpr); 13054 } 13055 13056 // If we're instantiating "a.x < b" or "A::x < b" and 'x' names a function 13057 // template, diagnose the missing 'template' keyword instead of diagnosing 13058 // an invalid use of a bound member function. 13059 // 13060 // Note that "A::x < b" might be valid if 'b' has an overloadable type due 13061 // to C++1z [over.over]/1.4, but we already checked for that case above. 13062 if (Opc == BO_LT && inTemplateInstantiation() && 13063 (pty->getKind() == BuiltinType::BoundMember || 13064 pty->getKind() == BuiltinType::Overload)) { 13065 auto *OE = dyn_cast<OverloadExpr>(LHSExpr); 13066 if (OE && !OE->hasTemplateKeyword() && !OE->hasExplicitTemplateArgs() && 13067 std::any_of(OE->decls_begin(), OE->decls_end(), [](NamedDecl *ND) { 13068 return isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(ND); 13069 })) { 13070 Diag(OE->getQualifier() ? OE->getQualifierLoc().getBeginLoc() 13071 : OE->getNameLoc(), 13072 diag::err_template_kw_missing) 13073 << OE->getName().getAsString() << ""; 13074 return ExprError(); 13075 } 13076 } 13077 13078 ExprResult LHS = CheckPlaceholderExpr(LHSExpr); 13079 if (LHS.isInvalid()) return ExprError(); 13080 LHSExpr = LHS.get(); 13081 } 13082 13083 // Handle pseudo-objects in the RHS. 13084 if (const BuiltinType *pty = RHSExpr->getType()->getAsPlaceholderType()) { 13085 // An overload in the RHS can potentially be resolved by the type 13086 // being assigned to. 13087 if (Opc == BO_Assign && pty->getKind() == BuiltinType::Overload) { 13088 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && 13089 (LHSExpr->isTypeDependent() || RHSExpr->isTypeDependent() || 13090 LHSExpr->getType()->isOverloadableType())) 13091 return BuildOverloadedBinOp(*this, S, OpLoc, Opc, LHSExpr, RHSExpr); 13092 13093 return CreateBuiltinBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, LHSExpr, RHSExpr); 13094 } 13095 13096 // Don't resolve overloads if the other type is overloadable. 13097 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && pty->getKind() == BuiltinType::Overload && 13098 LHSExpr->getType()->isOverloadableType()) 13099 return BuildOverloadedBinOp(*this, S, OpLoc, Opc, LHSExpr, RHSExpr); 13100 13101 ExprResult resolvedRHS = CheckPlaceholderExpr(RHSExpr); 13102 if (!resolvedRHS.isUsable()) return ExprError(); 13103 RHSExpr = resolvedRHS.get(); 13104 } 13105 13106 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 13107 // If either expression is type-dependent, always build an 13108 // overloaded op. 13109 if (LHSExpr->isTypeDependent() || RHSExpr->isTypeDependent()) 13110 return BuildOverloadedBinOp(*this, S, OpLoc, Opc, LHSExpr, RHSExpr); 13111 13112 // Otherwise, build an overloaded op if either expression has an 13113 // overloadable type. 13114 if (LHSExpr->getType()->isOverloadableType() || 13115 RHSExpr->getType()->isOverloadableType()) 13116 return BuildOverloadedBinOp(*this, S, OpLoc, Opc, LHSExpr, RHSExpr); 13117 } 13118 13119 // Build a built-in binary operation. 13120 return CreateBuiltinBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, LHSExpr, RHSExpr); 13121 } 13122 13123 static bool isOverflowingIntegerType(ASTContext &Ctx, QualType T) { 13124 if (T.isNull() || T->isDependentType()) 13125 return false; 13126 13127 if (!T->isPromotableIntegerType()) 13128 return true; 13129 13130 return Ctx.getIntWidth(T) >= Ctx.getIntWidth(Ctx.IntTy); 13131 } 13132 13133 ExprResult Sema::CreateBuiltinUnaryOp(SourceLocation OpLoc, 13134 UnaryOperatorKind Opc, 13135 Expr *InputExpr) { 13136 ExprResult Input = InputExpr; 13137 ExprValueKind VK = VK_RValue; 13138 ExprObjectKind OK = OK_Ordinary; 13139 QualType resultType; 13140 bool CanOverflow = false; 13141 13142 bool ConvertHalfVec = false; 13143 if (getLangOpts().OpenCL) { 13144 QualType Ty = InputExpr->getType(); 13145 // The only legal unary operation for atomics is '&'. 13146 if ((Opc != UO_AddrOf && Ty->isAtomicType()) || 13147 // OpenCL special types - image, sampler, pipe, and blocks are to be used 13148 // only with a builtin functions and therefore should be disallowed here. 13149 (Ty->isImageType() || Ty->isSamplerT() || Ty->isPipeType() 13150 || Ty->isBlockPointerType())) { 13151 return ExprError(Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_unary_expr) 13152 << InputExpr->getType() 13153 << Input.get()->getSourceRange()); 13154 } 13155 } 13156 // Diagnose operations on the unsupported types for OpenMP device compilation. 13157 if (getLangOpts().OpenMP && getLangOpts().OpenMPIsDevice) { 13158 if (UnaryOperator::isIncrementDecrementOp(Opc) || 13159 UnaryOperator::isArithmeticOp(Opc)) 13160 checkOpenMPDeviceExpr(InputExpr); 13161 } 13162 13163 switch (Opc) { 13164 case UO_PreInc: 13165 case UO_PreDec: 13166 case UO_PostInc: 13167 case UO_PostDec: 13168 resultType = CheckIncrementDecrementOperand(*this, Input.get(), VK, OK, 13169 OpLoc, 13170 Opc == UO_PreInc || 13171 Opc == UO_PostInc, 13172 Opc == UO_PreInc || 13173 Opc == UO_PreDec); 13174 CanOverflow = isOverflowingIntegerType(Context, resultType); 13175 break; 13176 case UO_AddrOf: 13177 resultType = CheckAddressOfOperand(Input, OpLoc); 13178 CheckAddressOfNoDeref(InputExpr); 13179 RecordModifiableNonNullParam(*this, InputExpr); 13180 break; 13181 case UO_Deref: { 13182 Input = DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Input.get()); 13183 if (Input.isInvalid()) return ExprError(); 13184 resultType = CheckIndirectionOperand(*this, Input.get(), VK, OpLoc); 13185 break; 13186 } 13187 case UO_Plus: 13188 case UO_Minus: 13189 CanOverflow = Opc == UO_Minus && 13190 isOverflowingIntegerType(Context, Input.get()->getType()); 13191 Input = UsualUnaryConversions(Input.get()); 13192 if (Input.isInvalid()) return ExprError(); 13193 // Unary plus and minus require promoting an operand of half vector to a 13194 // float vector and truncating the result back to a half vector. For now, we 13195 // do this only when HalfArgsAndReturns is set (that is, when the target is 13196 // arm or arm64). 13197 ConvertHalfVec = 13198 needsConversionOfHalfVec(true, Context, Input.get()->getType()); 13199 13200 // If the operand is a half vector, promote it to a float vector. 13201 if (ConvertHalfVec) 13202 Input = convertVector(Input.get(), Context.FloatTy, *this); 13203 resultType = Input.get()->getType(); 13204 if (resultType->isDependentType()) 13205 break; 13206 if (resultType->isArithmeticType()) // C99 6.5.3.3p1 13207 break; 13208 else if (resultType->isVectorType() && 13209 // The z vector extensions don't allow + or - with bool vectors. 13210 (!Context.getLangOpts().ZVector || 13211 resultType->getAs<VectorType>()->getVectorKind() != 13212 VectorType::AltiVecBool)) 13213 break; 13214 else if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && // C++ [expr.unary.op]p6 13215 Opc == UO_Plus && 13216 resultType->isPointerType()) 13217 break; 13218 13219 return ExprError(Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_unary_expr) 13220 << resultType << Input.get()->getSourceRange()); 13221 13222 case UO_Not: // bitwise complement 13223 Input = UsualUnaryConversions(Input.get()); 13224 if (Input.isInvalid()) 13225 return ExprError(); 13226 resultType = Input.get()->getType(); 13227 13228 if (resultType->isDependentType()) 13229 break; 13230 // C99 6.5.3.3p1. We allow complex int and float as a GCC extension. 13231 if (resultType->isComplexType() || resultType->isComplexIntegerType()) 13232 // C99 does not support '~' for complex conjugation. 13233 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_integer_complement_complex) 13234 << resultType << Input.get()->getSourceRange(); 13235 else if (resultType->hasIntegerRepresentation()) 13236 break; 13237 else if (resultType->isExtVectorType() && Context.getLangOpts().OpenCL) { 13238 // OpenCL v1.1 s6.3.f: The bitwise operator not (~) does not operate 13239 // on vector float types. 13240 QualType T = resultType->getAs<ExtVectorType>()->getElementType(); 13241 if (!T->isIntegerType()) 13242 return ExprError(Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_unary_expr) 13243 << resultType << Input.get()->getSourceRange()); 13244 } else { 13245 return ExprError(Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_unary_expr) 13246 << resultType << Input.get()->getSourceRange()); 13247 } 13248 break; 13249 13250 case UO_LNot: // logical negation 13251 // Unlike +/-/~, integer promotions aren't done here (C99 6.5.3.3p5). 13252 Input = DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Input.get()); 13253 if (Input.isInvalid()) return ExprError(); 13254 resultType = Input.get()->getType(); 13255 13256 // Though we still have to promote half FP to float... 13257 if (resultType->isHalfType() && !Context.getLangOpts().NativeHalfType) { 13258 Input = ImpCastExprToType(Input.get(), Context.FloatTy, CK_FloatingCast).get(); 13259 resultType = Context.FloatTy; 13260 } 13261 13262 if (resultType->isDependentType()) 13263 break; 13264 if (resultType->isScalarType() && !isScopedEnumerationType(resultType)) { 13265 // C99 6.5.3.3p1: ok, fallthrough; 13266 if (Context.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 13267 // C++03 [expr.unary.op]p8, C++0x [expr.unary.op]p9: 13268 // operand contextually converted to bool. 13269 Input = ImpCastExprToType(Input.get(), Context.BoolTy, 13270 ScalarTypeToBooleanCastKind(resultType)); 13271 } else if (Context.getLangOpts().OpenCL && 13272 Context.getLangOpts().OpenCLVersion < 120) { 13273 // OpenCL v1.1 6.3.h: The logical operator not (!) does not 13274 // operate on scalar float types. 13275 if (!resultType->isIntegerType() && !resultType->isPointerType()) 13276 return ExprError(Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_unary_expr) 13277 << resultType << Input.get()->getSourceRange()); 13278 } 13279 } else if (resultType->isExtVectorType()) { 13280 if (Context.getLangOpts().OpenCL && 13281 Context.getLangOpts().OpenCLVersion < 120 && 13282 !Context.getLangOpts().OpenCLCPlusPlus) { 13283 // OpenCL v1.1 6.3.h: The logical operator not (!) does not 13284 // operate on vector float types. 13285 QualType T = resultType->getAs<ExtVectorType>()->getElementType(); 13286 if (!T->isIntegerType()) 13287 return ExprError(Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_unary_expr) 13288 << resultType << Input.get()->getSourceRange()); 13289 } 13290 // Vector logical not returns the signed variant of the operand type. 13291 resultType = GetSignedVectorType(resultType); 13292 break; 13293 } else { 13294 // FIXME: GCC's vector extension permits the usage of '!' with a vector 13295 // type in C++. We should allow that here too. 13296 return ExprError(Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_unary_expr) 13297 << resultType << Input.get()->getSourceRange()); 13298 } 13299 13300 // LNot always has type int. C99 6.5.3.3p5. 13301 // In C++, it's bool. C++ 5.3.1p8 13302 resultType = Context.getLogicalOperationType(); 13303 break; 13304 case UO_Real: 13305 case UO_Imag: 13306 resultType = CheckRealImagOperand(*this, Input, OpLoc, Opc == UO_Real); 13307 // _Real maps ordinary l-values into ordinary l-values. _Imag maps ordinary 13308 // complex l-values to ordinary l-values and all other values to r-values. 13309 if (Input.isInvalid()) return ExprError(); 13310 if (Opc == UO_Real || Input.get()->getType()->isAnyComplexType()) { 13311 if (Input.get()->getValueKind() != VK_RValue && 13312 Input.get()->getObjectKind() == OK_Ordinary) 13313 VK = Input.get()->getValueKind(); 13314 } else if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 13315 // In C, a volatile scalar is read by __imag. In C++, it is not. 13316 Input = DefaultLvalueConversion(Input.get()); 13317 } 13318 break; 13319 case UO_Extension: 13320 resultType = Input.get()->getType(); 13321 VK = Input.get()->getValueKind(); 13322 OK = Input.get()->getObjectKind(); 13323 break; 13324 case UO_Coawait: 13325 // It's unnecessary to represent the pass-through operator co_await in the 13326 // AST; just return the input expression instead. 13327 assert(!Input.get()->getType()->isDependentType() && 13328 "the co_await expression must be non-dependant before " 13329 "building operator co_await"); 13330 return Input; 13331 } 13332 if (resultType.isNull() || Input.isInvalid()) 13333 return ExprError(); 13334 13335 // Check for array bounds violations in the operand of the UnaryOperator, 13336 // except for the '*' and '&' operators that have to be handled specially 13337 // by CheckArrayAccess (as there are special cases like &array[arraysize] 13338 // that are explicitly defined as valid by the standard). 13339 if (Opc != UO_AddrOf && Opc != UO_Deref) 13340 CheckArrayAccess(Input.get()); 13341 13342 auto *UO = new (Context) 13343 UnaryOperator(Input.get(), Opc, resultType, VK, OK, OpLoc, CanOverflow); 13344 13345 if (Opc == UO_Deref && UO->getType()->hasAttr(attr::NoDeref) && 13346 !isa<ArrayType>(UO->getType().getDesugaredType(Context))) 13347 ExprEvalContexts.back().PossibleDerefs.insert(UO); 13348 13349 // Convert the result back to a half vector. 13350 if (ConvertHalfVec) 13351 return convertVector(UO, Context.HalfTy, *this); 13352 return UO; 13353 } 13354 13355 /// Determine whether the given expression is a qualified member 13356 /// access expression, of a form that could be turned into a pointer to member 13357 /// with the address-of operator. 13358 bool Sema::isQualifiedMemberAccess(Expr *E) { 13359 if (DeclRefExpr *DRE = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(E)) { 13360 if (!DRE->getQualifier()) 13361 return false; 13362 13363 ValueDecl *VD = DRE->getDecl(); 13364 if (!VD->isCXXClassMember()) 13365 return false; 13366 13367 if (isa<FieldDecl>(VD) || isa<IndirectFieldDecl>(VD)) 13368 return true; 13369 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(VD)) 13370 return Method->isInstance(); 13371 13372 return false; 13373 } 13374 13375 if (UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE = dyn_cast<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(E)) { 13376 if (!ULE->getQualifier()) 13377 return false; 13378 13379 for (NamedDecl *D : ULE->decls()) { 13380 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(D)) { 13381 if (Method->isInstance()) 13382 return true; 13383 } else { 13384 // Overload set does not contain methods. 13385 break; 13386 } 13387 } 13388 13389 return false; 13390 } 13391 13392 return false; 13393 } 13394 13395 ExprResult Sema::BuildUnaryOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation OpLoc, 13396 UnaryOperatorKind Opc, Expr *Input) { 13397 // First things first: handle placeholders so that the 13398 // overloaded-operator check considers the right type. 13399 if (const BuiltinType *pty = Input->getType()->getAsPlaceholderType()) { 13400 // Increment and decrement of pseudo-object references. 13401 if (pty->getKind() == BuiltinType::PseudoObject && 13402 UnaryOperator::isIncrementDecrementOp(Opc)) 13403 return checkPseudoObjectIncDec(S, OpLoc, Opc, Input); 13404 13405 // extension is always a builtin operator. 13406 if (Opc == UO_Extension) 13407 return CreateBuiltinUnaryOp(OpLoc, Opc, Input); 13408 13409 // & gets special logic for several kinds of placeholder. 13410 // The builtin code knows what to do. 13411 if (Opc == UO_AddrOf && 13412 (pty->getKind() == BuiltinType::Overload || 13413 pty->getKind() == BuiltinType::UnknownAny || 13414 pty->getKind() == BuiltinType::BoundMember)) 13415 return CreateBuiltinUnaryOp(OpLoc, Opc, Input); 13416 13417 // Anything else needs to be handled now. 13418 ExprResult Result = CheckPlaceholderExpr(Input); 13419 if (Result.isInvalid()) return ExprError(); 13420 Input = Result.get(); 13421 } 13422 13423 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && Input->getType()->isOverloadableType() && 13424 UnaryOperator::getOverloadedOperator(Opc) != OO_None && 13425 !(Opc == UO_AddrOf && isQualifiedMemberAccess(Input))) { 13426 // Find all of the overloaded operators visible from this 13427 // point. We perform both an operator-name lookup from the local 13428 // scope and an argument-dependent lookup based on the types of 13429 // the arguments. 13430 UnresolvedSet<16> Functions; 13431 OverloadedOperatorKind OverOp = UnaryOperator::getOverloadedOperator(Opc); 13432 if (S && OverOp != OO_None) 13433 LookupOverloadedOperatorName(OverOp, S, Input->getType(), QualType(), 13434 Functions); 13435 13436 return CreateOverloadedUnaryOp(OpLoc, Opc, Functions, Input); 13437 } 13438 13439 return CreateBuiltinUnaryOp(OpLoc, Opc, Input); 13440 } 13441 13442 // Unary Operators. 'Tok' is the token for the operator. 13443 ExprResult Sema::ActOnUnaryOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation OpLoc, 13444 tok::TokenKind Op, Expr *Input) { 13445 return BuildUnaryOp(S, OpLoc, ConvertTokenKindToUnaryOpcode(Op), Input); 13446 } 13447 13448 /// ActOnAddrLabel - Parse the GNU address of label extension: "&&foo". 13449 ExprResult Sema::ActOnAddrLabel(SourceLocation OpLoc, SourceLocation LabLoc, 13450 LabelDecl *TheDecl) { 13451 TheDecl->markUsed(Context); 13452 // Create the AST node. The address of a label always has type 'void*'. 13453 return new (Context) AddrLabelExpr(OpLoc, LabLoc, TheDecl, 13454 Context.getPointerType(Context.VoidTy)); 13455 } 13456 13457 void Sema::ActOnStartStmtExpr() { 13458 PushExpressionEvaluationContext(ExprEvalContexts.back().Context); 13459 } 13460 13461 void Sema::ActOnStmtExprError() { 13462 // Note that function is also called by TreeTransform when leaving a 13463 // StmtExpr scope without rebuilding anything. 13464 13465 DiscardCleanupsInEvaluationContext(); 13466 PopExpressionEvaluationContext(); 13467 } 13468 13469 ExprResult 13470 Sema::ActOnStmtExpr(SourceLocation LPLoc, Stmt *SubStmt, 13471 SourceLocation RPLoc) { // "({..})" 13472 assert(SubStmt && isa<CompoundStmt>(SubStmt) && "Invalid action invocation!"); 13473 CompoundStmt *Compound = cast<CompoundStmt>(SubStmt); 13474 13475 if (hasAnyUnrecoverableErrorsInThisFunction()) 13476 DiscardCleanupsInEvaluationContext(); 13477 assert(!Cleanup.exprNeedsCleanups() && 13478 "cleanups within StmtExpr not correctly bound!"); 13479 PopExpressionEvaluationContext(); 13480 13481 // FIXME: there are a variety of strange constraints to enforce here, for 13482 // example, it is not possible to goto into a stmt expression apparently. 13483 // More semantic analysis is needed. 13484 13485 // If there are sub-stmts in the compound stmt, take the type of the last one 13486 // as the type of the stmtexpr. 13487 QualType Ty = Context.VoidTy; 13488 bool StmtExprMayBindToTemp = false; 13489 if (!Compound->body_empty()) { 13490 // For GCC compatibility we get the last Stmt excluding trailing NullStmts. 13491 if (const auto *LastStmt = 13492 dyn_cast<ValueStmt>(Compound->getStmtExprResult())) { 13493 if (const Expr *Value = LastStmt->getExprStmt()) { 13494 StmtExprMayBindToTemp = true; 13495 Ty = Value->getType(); 13496 } 13497 } 13498 } 13499 13500 // FIXME: Check that expression type is complete/non-abstract; statement 13501 // expressions are not lvalues. 13502 Expr *ResStmtExpr = new (Context) StmtExpr(Compound, Ty, LPLoc, RPLoc); 13503 if (StmtExprMayBindToTemp) 13504 return MaybeBindToTemporary(ResStmtExpr); 13505 return ResStmtExpr; 13506 } 13507 13508 ExprResult Sema::ActOnStmtExprResult(ExprResult ER) { 13509 if (ER.isInvalid()) 13510 return ExprError(); 13511 13512 // Do function/array conversion on the last expression, but not 13513 // lvalue-to-rvalue. However, initialize an unqualified type. 13514 ER = DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(ER.get()); 13515 if (ER.isInvalid()) 13516 return ExprError(); 13517 Expr *E = ER.get(); 13518 13519 if (E->isTypeDependent()) 13520 return E; 13521 13522 // In ARC, if the final expression ends in a consume, splice 13523 // the consume out and bind it later. In the alternate case 13524 // (when dealing with a retainable type), the result 13525 // initialization will create a produce. In both cases the 13526 // result will be +1, and we'll need to balance that out with 13527 // a bind. 13528 auto *Cast = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(E); 13529 if (Cast && Cast->getCastKind() == CK_ARCConsumeObject) 13530 return Cast->getSubExpr(); 13531 13532 // FIXME: Provide a better location for the initialization. 13533 return PerformCopyInitialization( 13534 InitializedEntity::InitializeStmtExprResult( 13535 E->getBeginLoc(), E->getType().getUnqualifiedType()), 13536 SourceLocation(), E); 13537 } 13538 13539 ExprResult Sema::BuildBuiltinOffsetOf(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc, 13540 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo, 13541 ArrayRef<OffsetOfComponent> Components, 13542 SourceLocation RParenLoc) { 13543 QualType ArgTy = TInfo->getType(); 13544 bool Dependent = ArgTy->isDependentType(); 13545 SourceRange TypeRange = TInfo->getTypeLoc().getLocalSourceRange(); 13546 13547 // We must have at least one component that refers to the type, and the first 13548 // one is known to be a field designator. Verify that the ArgTy represents 13549 // a struct/union/class. 13550 if (!Dependent && !ArgTy->isRecordType()) 13551 return ExprError(Diag(BuiltinLoc, diag::err_offsetof_record_type) 13552 << ArgTy << TypeRange); 13553 13554 // Type must be complete per C99 7.17p3 because a declaring a variable 13555 // with an incomplete type would be ill-formed. 13556 if (!Dependent 13557 && RequireCompleteType(BuiltinLoc, ArgTy, 13558 diag::err_offsetof_incomplete_type, TypeRange)) 13559 return ExprError(); 13560 13561 bool DidWarnAboutNonPOD = false; 13562 QualType CurrentType = ArgTy; 13563 SmallVector<OffsetOfNode, 4> Comps; 13564 SmallVector<Expr*, 4> Exprs; 13565 for (const OffsetOfComponent &OC : Components) { 13566 if (OC.isBrackets) { 13567 // Offset of an array sub-field. TODO: Should we allow vector elements? 13568 if (!CurrentType->isDependentType()) { 13569 const ArrayType *AT = Context.getAsArrayType(CurrentType); 13570 if(!AT) 13571 return ExprError(Diag(OC.LocEnd, diag::err_offsetof_array_type) 13572 << CurrentType); 13573 CurrentType = AT->getElementType(); 13574 } else 13575 CurrentType = Context.DependentTy; 13576 13577 ExprResult IdxRval = DefaultLvalueConversion(static_cast<Expr*>(OC.U.E)); 13578 if (IdxRval.isInvalid()) 13579 return ExprError(); 13580 Expr *Idx = IdxRval.get(); 13581 13582 // The expression must be an integral expression. 13583 // FIXME: An integral constant expression? 13584 if (!Idx->isTypeDependent() && !Idx->isValueDependent() && 13585 !Idx->getType()->isIntegerType()) 13586 return ExprError( 13587 Diag(Idx->getBeginLoc(), diag::err_typecheck_subscript_not_integer) 13588 << Idx->getSourceRange()); 13589 13590 // Record this array index. 13591 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(OC.LocStart, Exprs.size(), OC.LocEnd)); 13592 Exprs.push_back(Idx); 13593 continue; 13594 } 13595 13596 // Offset of a field. 13597 if (CurrentType->isDependentType()) { 13598 // We have the offset of a field, but we can't look into the dependent 13599 // type. Just record the identifier of the field. 13600 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(OC.LocStart, OC.U.IdentInfo, OC.LocEnd)); 13601 CurrentType = Context.DependentTy; 13602 continue; 13603 } 13604 13605 // We need to have a complete type to look into. 13606 if (RequireCompleteType(OC.LocStart, CurrentType, 13607 diag::err_offsetof_incomplete_type)) 13608 return ExprError(); 13609 13610 // Look for the designated field. 13611 const RecordType *RC = CurrentType->getAs<RecordType>(); 13612 if (!RC) 13613 return ExprError(Diag(OC.LocEnd, diag::err_offsetof_record_type) 13614 << CurrentType); 13615 RecordDecl *RD = RC->getDecl(); 13616 13617 // C++ [lib.support.types]p5: 13618 // The macro offsetof accepts a restricted set of type arguments in this 13619 // International Standard. type shall be a POD structure or a POD union 13620 // (clause 9). 13621 // C++11 [support.types]p4: 13622 // If type is not a standard-layout class (Clause 9), the results are 13623 // undefined. 13624 if (CXXRecordDecl *CRD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RD)) { 13625 bool IsSafe = LangOpts.CPlusPlus11? CRD->isStandardLayout() : CRD->isPOD(); 13626 unsigned DiagID = 13627 LangOpts.CPlusPlus11? diag::ext_offsetof_non_standardlayout_type 13628 : diag::ext_offsetof_non_pod_type; 13629 13630 if (!IsSafe && !DidWarnAboutNonPOD && 13631 DiagRuntimeBehavior(BuiltinLoc, nullptr, 13632 PDiag(DiagID) 13633 << SourceRange(Components[0].LocStart, OC.LocEnd) 13634 << CurrentType)) 13635 DidWarnAboutNonPOD = true; 13636 } 13637 13638 // Look for the field. 13639 LookupResult R(*this, OC.U.IdentInfo, OC.LocStart, LookupMemberName); 13640 LookupQualifiedName(R, RD); 13641 FieldDecl *MemberDecl = R.getAsSingle<FieldDecl>(); 13642 IndirectFieldDecl *IndirectMemberDecl = nullptr; 13643 if (!MemberDecl) { 13644 if ((IndirectMemberDecl = R.getAsSingle<IndirectFieldDecl>())) 13645 MemberDecl = IndirectMemberDecl->getAnonField(); 13646 } 13647 13648 if (!MemberDecl) 13649 return ExprError(Diag(BuiltinLoc, diag::err_no_member) 13650 << OC.U.IdentInfo << RD << SourceRange(OC.LocStart, 13651 OC.LocEnd)); 13652 13653 // C99 7.17p3: 13654 // (If the specified member is a bit-field, the behavior is undefined.) 13655 // 13656 // We diagnose this as an error. 13657 if (MemberDecl->isBitField()) { 13658 Diag(OC.LocEnd, diag::err_offsetof_bitfield) 13659 << MemberDecl->getDeclName() 13660 << SourceRange(BuiltinLoc, RParenLoc); 13661 Diag(MemberDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_bitfield_decl); 13662 return ExprError(); 13663 } 13664 13665 RecordDecl *Parent = MemberDecl->getParent(); 13666 if (IndirectMemberDecl) 13667 Parent = cast<RecordDecl>(IndirectMemberDecl->getDeclContext()); 13668 13669 // If the member was found in a base class, introduce OffsetOfNodes for 13670 // the base class indirections. 13671 CXXBasePaths Paths; 13672 if (IsDerivedFrom(OC.LocStart, CurrentType, Context.getTypeDeclType(Parent), 13673 Paths)) { 13674 if (Paths.getDetectedVirtual()) { 13675 Diag(OC.LocEnd, diag::err_offsetof_field_of_virtual_base) 13676 << MemberDecl->getDeclName() 13677 << SourceRange(BuiltinLoc, RParenLoc); 13678 return ExprError(); 13679 } 13680 13681 CXXBasePath &Path = Paths.front(); 13682 for (const CXXBasePathElement &B : Path) 13683 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(B.Base)); 13684 } 13685 13686 if (IndirectMemberDecl) { 13687 for (auto *FI : IndirectMemberDecl->chain()) { 13688 assert(isa<FieldDecl>(FI)); 13689 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(OC.LocStart, 13690 cast<FieldDecl>(FI), OC.LocEnd)); 13691 } 13692 } else 13693 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(OC.LocStart, MemberDecl, OC.LocEnd)); 13694 13695 CurrentType = MemberDecl->getType().getNonReferenceType(); 13696 } 13697 13698 return OffsetOfExpr::Create(Context, Context.getSizeType(), BuiltinLoc, TInfo, 13699 Comps, Exprs, RParenLoc); 13700 } 13701 13702 ExprResult Sema::ActOnBuiltinOffsetOf(Scope *S, 13703 SourceLocation BuiltinLoc, 13704 SourceLocation TypeLoc, 13705 ParsedType ParsedArgTy, 13706 ArrayRef<OffsetOfComponent> Components, 13707 SourceLocation RParenLoc) { 13708 13709 TypeSourceInfo *ArgTInfo; 13710 QualType ArgTy = GetTypeFromParser(ParsedArgTy, &ArgTInfo); 13711 if (ArgTy.isNull()) 13712 return ExprError(); 13713 13714 if (!ArgTInfo) 13715 ArgTInfo = Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(ArgTy, TypeLoc); 13716 13717 return BuildBuiltinOffsetOf(BuiltinLoc, ArgTInfo, Components, RParenLoc); 13718 } 13719 13720 13721 ExprResult Sema::ActOnChooseExpr(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc, 13722 Expr *CondExpr, 13723 Expr *LHSExpr, Expr *RHSExpr, 13724 SourceLocation RPLoc) { 13725 assert((CondExpr && LHSExpr && RHSExpr) && "Missing type argument(s)"); 13726 13727 ExprValueKind VK = VK_RValue; 13728 ExprObjectKind OK = OK_Ordinary; 13729 QualType resType; 13730 bool ValueDependent = false; 13731 bool CondIsTrue = false; 13732 if (CondExpr->isTypeDependent() || CondExpr->isValueDependent()) { 13733 resType = Context.DependentTy; 13734 ValueDependent = true; 13735 } else { 13736 // The conditional expression is required to be a constant expression. 13737 llvm::APSInt condEval(32); 13738 ExprResult CondICE 13739 = VerifyIntegerConstantExpression(CondExpr, &condEval, 13740 diag::err_typecheck_choose_expr_requires_constant, false); 13741 if (CondICE.isInvalid()) 13742 return ExprError(); 13743 CondExpr = CondICE.get(); 13744 CondIsTrue = condEval.getZExtValue(); 13745 13746 // If the condition is > zero, then the AST type is the same as the LHSExpr. 13747 Expr *ActiveExpr = CondIsTrue ? LHSExpr : RHSExpr; 13748 13749 resType = ActiveExpr->getType(); 13750 ValueDependent = ActiveExpr->isValueDependent(); 13751 VK = ActiveExpr->getValueKind(); 13752 OK = ActiveExpr->getObjectKind(); 13753 } 13754 13755 return new (Context) 13756 ChooseExpr(BuiltinLoc, CondExpr, LHSExpr, RHSExpr, resType, VK, OK, RPLoc, 13757 CondIsTrue, resType->isDependentType(), ValueDependent); 13758 } 13759 13760 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 13761 // Clang Extensions. 13762 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 13763 13764 /// ActOnBlockStart - This callback is invoked when a block literal is started. 13765 void Sema::ActOnBlockStart(SourceLocation CaretLoc, Scope *CurScope) { 13766 BlockDecl *Block = BlockDecl::Create(Context, CurContext, CaretLoc); 13767 13768 if (LangOpts.CPlusPlus) { 13769 Decl *ManglingContextDecl; 13770 if (MangleNumberingContext *MCtx = 13771 getCurrentMangleNumberContext(Block->getDeclContext(), 13772 ManglingContextDecl)) { 13773 unsigned ManglingNumber = MCtx->getManglingNumber(Block); 13774 Block->setBlockMangling(ManglingNumber, ManglingContextDecl); 13775 } 13776 } 13777 13778 PushBlockScope(CurScope, Block); 13779 CurContext->addDecl(Block); 13780 if (CurScope) 13781 PushDeclContext(CurScope, Block); 13782 else 13783 CurContext = Block; 13784 13785 getCurBlock()->HasImplicitReturnType = true; 13786 13787 // Enter a new evaluation context to insulate the block from any 13788 // cleanups from the enclosing full-expression. 13789 PushExpressionEvaluationContext( 13790 ExpressionEvaluationContext::PotentiallyEvaluated); 13791 } 13792 13793 void Sema::ActOnBlockArguments(SourceLocation CaretLoc, Declarator &ParamInfo, 13794 Scope *CurScope) { 13795 assert(ParamInfo.getIdentifier() == nullptr && 13796 "block-id should have no identifier!"); 13797 assert(ParamInfo.getContext() == DeclaratorContext::BlockLiteralContext); 13798 BlockScopeInfo *CurBlock = getCurBlock(); 13799 13800 TypeSourceInfo *Sig = GetTypeForDeclarator(ParamInfo, CurScope); 13801 QualType T = Sig->getType(); 13802 13803 // FIXME: We should allow unexpanded parameter packs here, but that would, 13804 // in turn, make the block expression contain unexpanded parameter packs. 13805 if (DiagnoseUnexpandedParameterPack(CaretLoc, Sig, UPPC_Block)) { 13806 // Drop the parameters. 13807 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo EPI; 13808 EPI.HasTrailingReturn = false; 13809 EPI.TypeQuals.addConst(); 13810 T = Context.getFunctionType(Context.DependentTy, None, EPI); 13811 Sig = Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(T); 13812 } 13813 13814 // GetTypeForDeclarator always produces a function type for a block 13815 // literal signature. Furthermore, it is always a FunctionProtoType 13816 // unless the function was written with a typedef. 13817 assert(T->isFunctionType() && 13818 "GetTypeForDeclarator made a non-function block signature"); 13819 13820 // Look for an explicit signature in that function type. 13821 FunctionProtoTypeLoc ExplicitSignature; 13822 13823 if ((ExplicitSignature = Sig->getTypeLoc() 13824 .getAsAdjusted<FunctionProtoTypeLoc>())) { 13825 13826 // Check whether that explicit signature was synthesized by 13827 // GetTypeForDeclarator. If so, don't save that as part of the 13828 // written signature. 13829 if (ExplicitSignature.getLocalRangeBegin() == 13830 ExplicitSignature.getLocalRangeEnd()) { 13831 // This would be much cheaper if we stored TypeLocs instead of 13832 // TypeSourceInfos. 13833 TypeLoc Result = ExplicitSignature.getReturnLoc(); 13834 unsigned Size = Result.getFullDataSize(); 13835 Sig = Context.CreateTypeSourceInfo(Result.getType(), Size); 13836 Sig->getTypeLoc().initializeFullCopy(Result, Size); 13837 13838 ExplicitSignature = FunctionProtoTypeLoc(); 13839 } 13840 } 13841 13842 CurBlock->TheDecl->setSignatureAsWritten(Sig); 13843 CurBlock->FunctionType = T; 13844 13845 const FunctionType *Fn = T->getAs<FunctionType>(); 13846 QualType RetTy = Fn->getReturnType(); 13847 bool isVariadic = 13848 (isa<FunctionProtoType>(Fn) && cast<FunctionProtoType>(Fn)->isVariadic()); 13849 13850 CurBlock->TheDecl->setIsVariadic(isVariadic); 13851 13852 // Context.DependentTy is used as a placeholder for a missing block 13853 // return type. TODO: what should we do with declarators like: 13854 // ^ * { ... } 13855 // If the answer is "apply template argument deduction".... 13856 if (RetTy != Context.DependentTy) { 13857 CurBlock->ReturnType = RetTy; 13858 CurBlock->TheDecl->setBlockMissingReturnType(false); 13859 CurBlock->HasImplicitReturnType = false; 13860 } 13861 13862 // Push block parameters from the declarator if we had them. 13863 SmallVector<ParmVarDecl*, 8> Params; 13864 if (ExplicitSignature) { 13865 for (unsigned I = 0, E = ExplicitSignature.getNumParams(); I != E; ++I) { 13866 ParmVarDecl *Param = ExplicitSignature.getParam(I); 13867 if (Param->getIdentifier() == nullptr && 13868 !Param->isImplicit() && 13869 !Param->isInvalidDecl() && 13870 !getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) 13871 Diag(Param->getLocation(), diag::err_parameter_name_omitted); 13872 Params.push_back(Param); 13873 } 13874 13875 // Fake up parameter variables if we have a typedef, like 13876 // ^ fntype { ... } 13877 } else if (const FunctionProtoType *Fn = T->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) { 13878 for (const auto &I : Fn->param_types()) { 13879 ParmVarDecl *Param = BuildParmVarDeclForTypedef( 13880 CurBlock->TheDecl, ParamInfo.getBeginLoc(), I); 13881 Params.push_back(Param); 13882 } 13883 } 13884 13885 // Set the parameters on the block decl. 13886 if (!Params.empty()) { 13887 CurBlock->TheDecl->setParams(Params); 13888 CheckParmsForFunctionDef(CurBlock->TheDecl->parameters(), 13889 /*CheckParameterNames=*/false); 13890 } 13891 13892 // Finally we can process decl attributes. 13893 ProcessDeclAttributes(CurScope, CurBlock->TheDecl, ParamInfo); 13894 13895 // Put the parameter variables in scope. 13896 for (auto AI : CurBlock->TheDecl->parameters()) { 13897 AI->setOwningFunction(CurBlock->TheDecl); 13898 13899 // If this has an identifier, add it to the scope stack. 13900 if (AI->getIdentifier()) { 13901 CheckShadow(CurBlock->TheScope, AI); 13902 13903 PushOnScopeChains(AI, CurBlock->TheScope); 13904 } 13905 } 13906 } 13907 13908 /// ActOnBlockError - If there is an error parsing a block, this callback 13909 /// is invoked to pop the information about the block from the action impl. 13910 void Sema::ActOnBlockError(SourceLocation CaretLoc, Scope *CurScope) { 13911 // Leave the expression-evaluation context. 13912 DiscardCleanupsInEvaluationContext(); 13913 PopExpressionEvaluationContext(); 13914 13915 // Pop off CurBlock, handle nested blocks. 13916 PopDeclContext(); 13917 PopFunctionScopeInfo(); 13918 } 13919 13920 /// ActOnBlockStmtExpr - This is called when the body of a block statement 13921 /// literal was successfully completed. ^(int x){...} 13922 ExprResult Sema::ActOnBlockStmtExpr(SourceLocation CaretLoc, 13923 Stmt *Body, Scope *CurScope) { 13924 // If blocks are disabled, emit an error. 13925 if (!LangOpts.Blocks) 13926 Diag(CaretLoc, diag::err_blocks_disable) << LangOpts.OpenCL; 13927 13928 // Leave the expression-evaluation context. 13929 if (hasAnyUnrecoverableErrorsInThisFunction()) 13930 DiscardCleanupsInEvaluationContext(); 13931 assert(!Cleanup.exprNeedsCleanups() && 13932 "cleanups within block not correctly bound!"); 13933 PopExpressionEvaluationContext(); 13934 13935 BlockScopeInfo *BSI = cast<BlockScopeInfo>(FunctionScopes.back()); 13936 BlockDecl *BD = BSI->TheDecl; 13937 13938 if (BSI->HasImplicitReturnType) 13939 deduceClosureReturnType(*BSI); 13940 13941 QualType RetTy = Context.VoidTy; 13942 if (!BSI->ReturnType.isNull()) 13943 RetTy = BSI->ReturnType; 13944 13945 bool NoReturn = BD->hasAttr<NoReturnAttr>(); 13946 QualType BlockTy; 13947 13948 // If the user wrote a function type in some form, try to use that. 13949 if (!BSI->FunctionType.isNull()) { 13950 const FunctionType *FTy = BSI->FunctionType->getAs<FunctionType>(); 13951 13952 FunctionType::ExtInfo Ext = FTy->getExtInfo(); 13953 if (NoReturn && !Ext.getNoReturn()) Ext = Ext.withNoReturn(true); 13954 13955 // Turn protoless block types into nullary block types. 13956 if (isa<FunctionNoProtoType>(FTy)) { 13957 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo EPI; 13958 EPI.ExtInfo = Ext; 13959 BlockTy = Context.getFunctionType(RetTy, None, EPI); 13960 13961 // Otherwise, if we don't need to change anything about the function type, 13962 // preserve its sugar structure. 13963 } else if (FTy->getReturnType() == RetTy && 13964 (!NoReturn || FTy->getNoReturnAttr())) { 13965 BlockTy = BSI->FunctionType; 13966 13967 // Otherwise, make the minimal modifications to the function type. 13968 } else { 13969 const FunctionProtoType *FPT = cast<FunctionProtoType>(FTy); 13970 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo EPI = FPT->getExtProtoInfo(); 13971 EPI.TypeQuals = Qualifiers(); 13972 EPI.ExtInfo = Ext; 13973 BlockTy = Context.getFunctionType(RetTy, FPT->getParamTypes(), EPI); 13974 } 13975 13976 // If we don't have a function type, just build one from nothing. 13977 } else { 13978 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo EPI; 13979 EPI.ExtInfo = FunctionType::ExtInfo().withNoReturn(NoReturn); 13980 BlockTy = Context.getFunctionType(RetTy, None, EPI); 13981 } 13982 13983 DiagnoseUnusedParameters(BD->parameters()); 13984 BlockTy = Context.getBlockPointerType(BlockTy); 13985 13986 // If needed, diagnose invalid gotos and switches in the block. 13987 if (getCurFunction()->NeedsScopeChecking() && 13988 !PP.isCodeCompletionEnabled()) 13989 DiagnoseInvalidJumps(cast<CompoundStmt>(Body)); 13990 13991 BD->setBody(cast<CompoundStmt>(Body)); 13992 13993 if (Body && getCurFunction()->HasPotentialAvailabilityViolations) 13994 DiagnoseUnguardedAvailabilityViolations(BD); 13995 13996 // Try to apply the named return value optimization. We have to check again 13997 // if we can do this, though, because blocks keep return statements around 13998 // to deduce an implicit return type. 13999 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && RetTy->isRecordType() && 14000 !BD->isDependentContext()) 14001 computeNRVO(Body, BSI); 14002 14003 PopDeclContext(); 14004 14005 // Pop the block scope now but keep it alive to the end of this function. 14006 AnalysisBasedWarnings::Policy WP = AnalysisWarnings.getDefaultPolicy(); 14007 PoppedFunctionScopePtr ScopeRAII = PopFunctionScopeInfo(&WP, BD, BlockTy); 14008 14009 // Set the captured variables on the block. 14010 SmallVector<BlockDecl::Capture, 4> Captures; 14011 for (Capture &Cap : BSI->Captures) { 14012 if (Cap.isInvalid() || Cap.isThisCapture()) 14013 continue; 14014 14015 VarDecl *Var = Cap.getVariable(); 14016 Expr *CopyExpr = nullptr; 14017 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && Cap.isCopyCapture()) { 14018 if (const RecordType *Record = 14019 Cap.getCaptureType()->getAs<RecordType>()) { 14020 // The capture logic needs the destructor, so make sure we mark it. 14021 // Usually this is unnecessary because most local variables have 14022 // their destructors marked at declaration time, but parameters are 14023 // an exception because it's technically only the call site that 14024 // actually requires the destructor. 14025 if (isa<ParmVarDecl>(Var)) 14026 FinalizeVarWithDestructor(Var, Record); 14027 14028 // Enter a separate potentially-evaluated context while building block 14029 // initializers to isolate their cleanups from those of the block 14030 // itself. 14031 // FIXME: Is this appropriate even when the block itself occurs in an 14032 // unevaluated operand? 14033 EnterExpressionEvaluationContext EvalContext( 14034 *this, ExpressionEvaluationContext::PotentiallyEvaluated); 14035 14036 SourceLocation Loc = Cap.getLocation(); 14037 14038 ExprResult Result = BuildDeclarationNameExpr( 14039 CXXScopeSpec(), DeclarationNameInfo(Var->getDeclName(), Loc), Var); 14040 14041 // According to the blocks spec, the capture of a variable from 14042 // the stack requires a const copy constructor. This is not true 14043 // of the copy/move done to move a __block variable to the heap. 14044 if (!Result.isInvalid() && 14045 !Result.get()->getType().isConstQualified()) { 14046 Result = ImpCastExprToType(Result.get(), 14047 Result.get()->getType().withConst(), 14048 CK_NoOp, VK_LValue); 14049 } 14050 14051 if (!Result.isInvalid()) { 14052 Result = PerformCopyInitialization( 14053 InitializedEntity::InitializeBlock(Var->getLocation(), 14054 Cap.getCaptureType(), false), 14055 Loc, Result.get()); 14056 } 14057 14058 // Build a full-expression copy expression if initialization 14059 // succeeded and used a non-trivial constructor. Recover from 14060 // errors by pretending that the copy isn't necessary. 14061 if (!Result.isInvalid() && 14062 !cast<CXXConstructExpr>(Result.get())->getConstructor() 14063 ->isTrivial()) { 14064 Result = MaybeCreateExprWithCleanups(Result); 14065 CopyExpr = Result.get(); 14066 } 14067 } 14068 } 14069 14070 BlockDecl::Capture NewCap(Var, Cap.isBlockCapture(), Cap.isNested(), 14071 CopyExpr); 14072 Captures.push_back(NewCap); 14073 } 14074 BD->setCaptures(Context, Captures, BSI->CXXThisCaptureIndex != 0); 14075 14076 BlockExpr *Result = new (Context) BlockExpr(BD, BlockTy); 14077 14078 // If the block isn't obviously global, i.e. it captures anything at 14079 // all, then we need to do a few things in the surrounding context: 14080 if (Result->getBlockDecl()->hasCaptures()) { 14081 // First, this expression has a new cleanup object. 14082 ExprCleanupObjects.push_back(Result->getBlockDecl()); 14083 Cleanup.setExprNeedsCleanups(true); 14084 14085 // It also gets a branch-protected scope if any of the captured 14086 // variables needs destruction. 14087 for (const auto &CI : Result->getBlockDecl()->captures()) { 14088 const VarDecl *var = CI.getVariable(); 14089 if (var->getType().isDestructedType() != QualType::DK_none) { 14090 setFunctionHasBranchProtectedScope(); 14091 break; 14092 } 14093 } 14094 } 14095 14096 if (getCurFunction()) 14097 getCurFunction()->addBlock(BD); 14098 14099 return Result; 14100 } 14101 14102 ExprResult Sema::ActOnVAArg(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc, Expr *E, ParsedType Ty, 14103 SourceLocation RPLoc) { 14104 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo; 14105 GetTypeFromParser(Ty, &TInfo); 14106 return BuildVAArgExpr(BuiltinLoc, E, TInfo, RPLoc); 14107 } 14108 14109 ExprResult Sema::BuildVAArgExpr(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc, 14110 Expr *E, TypeSourceInfo *TInfo, 14111 SourceLocation RPLoc) { 14112 Expr *OrigExpr = E; 14113 bool IsMS = false; 14114 14115 // CUDA device code does not support varargs. 14116 if (getLangOpts().CUDA && getLangOpts().CUDAIsDevice) { 14117 if (const FunctionDecl *F = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(CurContext)) { 14118 CUDAFunctionTarget T = IdentifyCUDATarget(F); 14119 if (T == CFT_Global || T == CFT_Device || T == CFT_HostDevice) 14120 return ExprError(Diag(E->getBeginLoc(), diag::err_va_arg_in_device)); 14121 } 14122 } 14123 14124 // NVPTX does not support va_arg expression. 14125 if (getLangOpts().OpenMP && getLangOpts().OpenMPIsDevice && 14126 Context.getTargetInfo().getTriple().isNVPTX()) 14127 targetDiag(E->getBeginLoc(), diag::err_va_arg_in_device); 14128 14129 // It might be a __builtin_ms_va_list. (But don't ever mark a va_arg() 14130 // as Microsoft ABI on an actual Microsoft platform, where 14131 // __builtin_ms_va_list and __builtin_va_list are the same.) 14132 if (!E->isTypeDependent() && Context.getTargetInfo().hasBuiltinMSVaList() && 14133 Context.getTargetInfo().getBuiltinVaListKind() != TargetInfo::CharPtrBuiltinVaList) { 14134 QualType MSVaListType = Context.getBuiltinMSVaListType(); 14135 if (Context.hasSameType(MSVaListType, E->getType())) { 14136 if (CheckForModifiableLvalue(E, BuiltinLoc, *this)) 14137 return ExprError(); 14138 IsMS = true; 14139 } 14140 } 14141 14142 // Get the va_list type 14143 QualType VaListType = Context.getBuiltinVaListType(); 14144 if (!IsMS) { 14145 if (VaListType->isArrayType()) { 14146 // Deal with implicit array decay; for example, on x86-64, 14147 // va_list is an array, but it's supposed to decay to 14148 // a pointer for va_arg. 14149 VaListType = Context.getArrayDecayedType(VaListType); 14150 // Make sure the input expression also decays appropriately. 14151 ExprResult Result = UsualUnaryConversions(E); 14152 if (Result.isInvalid()) 14153 return ExprError(); 14154 E = Result.get(); 14155 } else if (VaListType->isRecordType() && getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 14156 // If va_list is a record type and we are compiling in C++ mode, 14157 // check the argument using reference binding. 14158 InitializedEntity Entity = InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter( 14159 Context, Context.getLValueReferenceType(VaListType), false); 14160 ExprResult Init = PerformCopyInitialization(Entity, SourceLocation(), E); 14161 if (Init.isInvalid()) 14162 return ExprError(); 14163 E = Init.getAs<Expr>(); 14164 } else { 14165 // Otherwise, the va_list argument must be an l-value because 14166 // it is modified by va_arg. 14167 if (!E->isTypeDependent() && 14168 CheckForModifiableLvalue(E, BuiltinLoc, *this)) 14169 return ExprError(); 14170 } 14171 } 14172 14173 if (!IsMS && !E->isTypeDependent() && 14174 !Context.hasSameType(VaListType, E->getType())) 14175 return ExprError( 14176 Diag(E->getBeginLoc(), 14177 diag::err_first_argument_to_va_arg_not_of_type_va_list) 14178 << OrigExpr->getType() << E->getSourceRange()); 14179 14180 if (!TInfo->getType()->isDependentType()) { 14181 if (RequireCompleteType(TInfo->getTypeLoc().getBeginLoc(), TInfo->getType(), 14182 diag::err_second_parameter_to_va_arg_incomplete, 14183 TInfo->getTypeLoc())) 14184 return ExprError(); 14185 14186 if (RequireNonAbstractType(TInfo->getTypeLoc().getBeginLoc(), 14187 TInfo->getType(), 14188 diag::err_second_parameter_to_va_arg_abstract, 14189 TInfo->getTypeLoc())) 14190 return ExprError(); 14191 14192 if (!TInfo->getType().isPODType(Context)) { 14193 Diag(TInfo->getTypeLoc().getBeginLoc(), 14194 TInfo->getType()->isObjCLifetimeType() 14195 ? diag::warn_second_parameter_to_va_arg_ownership_qualified 14196 : diag::warn_second_parameter_to_va_arg_not_pod) 14197 << TInfo->getType() 14198 << TInfo->getTypeLoc().getSourceRange(); 14199 } 14200 14201 // Check for va_arg where arguments of the given type will be promoted 14202 // (i.e. this va_arg is guaranteed to have undefined behavior). 14203 QualType PromoteType; 14204 if (TInfo->getType()->isPromotableIntegerType()) { 14205 PromoteType = Context.getPromotedIntegerType(TInfo->getType()); 14206 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(PromoteType, TInfo->getType())) 14207 PromoteType = QualType(); 14208 } 14209 if (TInfo->getType()->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Float)) 14210 PromoteType = Context.DoubleTy; 14211 if (!PromoteType.isNull()) 14212 DiagRuntimeBehavior(TInfo->getTypeLoc().getBeginLoc(), E, 14213 PDiag(diag::warn_second_parameter_to_va_arg_never_compatible) 14214 << TInfo->getType() 14215 << PromoteType 14216 << TInfo->getTypeLoc().getSourceRange()); 14217 } 14218 14219 QualType T = TInfo->getType().getNonLValueExprType(Context); 14220 return new (Context) VAArgExpr(BuiltinLoc, E, TInfo, RPLoc, T, IsMS); 14221 } 14222 14223 ExprResult Sema::ActOnGNUNullExpr(SourceLocation TokenLoc) { 14224 // The type of __null will be int or long, depending on the size of 14225 // pointers on the target. 14226 QualType Ty; 14227 unsigned pw = Context.getTargetInfo().getPointerWidth(0); 14228 if (pw == Context.getTargetInfo().getIntWidth()) 14229 Ty = Context.IntTy; 14230 else if (pw == Context.getTargetInfo().getLongWidth()) 14231 Ty = Context.LongTy; 14232 else if (pw == Context.getTargetInfo().getLongLongWidth()) 14233 Ty = Context.LongLongTy; 14234 else { 14235 llvm_unreachable("I don't know size of pointer!"); 14236 } 14237 14238 return new (Context) GNUNullExpr(Ty, TokenLoc); 14239 } 14240 14241 ExprResult Sema::ActOnSourceLocExpr(SourceLocExpr::IdentKind Kind, 14242 SourceLocation BuiltinLoc, 14243 SourceLocation RPLoc) { 14244 return BuildSourceLocExpr(Kind, BuiltinLoc, RPLoc, CurContext); 14245 } 14246 14247 ExprResult Sema::BuildSourceLocExpr(SourceLocExpr::IdentKind Kind, 14248 SourceLocation BuiltinLoc, 14249 SourceLocation RPLoc, 14250 DeclContext *ParentContext) { 14251 return new (Context) 14252 SourceLocExpr(Context, Kind, BuiltinLoc, RPLoc, ParentContext); 14253 } 14254 14255 bool Sema::ConversionToObjCStringLiteralCheck(QualType DstType, Expr *&Exp, 14256 bool Diagnose) { 14257 if (!getLangOpts().ObjC) 14258 return false; 14259 14260 const ObjCObjectPointerType *PT = DstType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(); 14261 if (!PT) 14262 return false; 14263 14264 if (!PT->isObjCIdType()) { 14265 // Check if the destination is the 'NSString' interface. 14266 const ObjCInterfaceDecl *ID = PT->getInterfaceDecl(); 14267 if (!ID || !ID->getIdentifier()->isStr("NSString")) 14268 return false; 14269 } 14270 14271 // Ignore any parens, implicit casts (should only be 14272 // array-to-pointer decays), and not-so-opaque values. The last is 14273 // important for making this trigger for property assignments. 14274 Expr *SrcExpr = Exp->IgnoreParenImpCasts(); 14275 if (OpaqueValueExpr *OV = dyn_cast<OpaqueValueExpr>(SrcExpr)) 14276 if (OV->getSourceExpr()) 14277 SrcExpr = OV->getSourceExpr()->IgnoreParenImpCasts(); 14278 14279 StringLiteral *SL = dyn_cast<StringLiteral>(SrcExpr); 14280 if (!SL || !SL->isAscii()) 14281 return false; 14282 if (Diagnose) { 14283 Diag(SL->getBeginLoc(), diag::err_missing_atsign_prefix) 14284 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(SL->getBeginLoc(), "@"); 14285 Exp = BuildObjCStringLiteral(SL->getBeginLoc(), SL).get(); 14286 } 14287 return true; 14288 } 14289 14290 static bool maybeDiagnoseAssignmentToFunction(Sema &S, QualType DstType, 14291 const Expr *SrcExpr) { 14292 if (!DstType->isFunctionPointerType() || 14293 !SrcExpr->getType()->isFunctionType()) 14294 return false; 14295 14296 auto *DRE = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(SrcExpr->IgnoreParenImpCasts()); 14297 if (!DRE) 14298 return false; 14299 14300 auto *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(DRE->getDecl()); 14301 if (!FD) 14302 return false; 14303 14304 return !S.checkAddressOfFunctionIsAvailable(FD, 14305 /*Complain=*/true, 14306 SrcExpr->getBeginLoc()); 14307 } 14308 14309 bool Sema::DiagnoseAssignmentResult(AssignConvertType ConvTy, 14310 SourceLocation Loc, 14311 QualType DstType, QualType SrcType, 14312 Expr *SrcExpr, AssignmentAction Action, 14313 bool *Complained) { 14314 if (Complained) 14315 *Complained = false; 14316 14317 // Decode the result (notice that AST's are still created for extensions). 14318 bool CheckInferredResultType = false; 14319 bool isInvalid = false; 14320 unsigned DiagKind = 0; 14321 FixItHint Hint; 14322 ConversionFixItGenerator ConvHints; 14323 bool MayHaveConvFixit = false; 14324 bool MayHaveFunctionDiff = false; 14325 const ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFace = nullptr; 14326 const ObjCProtocolDecl *PDecl = nullptr; 14327 14328 switch (ConvTy) { 14329 case Compatible: 14330 DiagnoseAssignmentEnum(DstType, SrcType, SrcExpr); 14331 return false; 14332 14333 case PointerToInt: 14334 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_pointer_int; 14335 ConvHints.tryToFixConversion(SrcExpr, SrcType, DstType, *this); 14336 MayHaveConvFixit = true; 14337 break; 14338 case IntToPointer: 14339 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_int_pointer; 14340 ConvHints.tryToFixConversion(SrcExpr, SrcType, DstType, *this); 14341 MayHaveConvFixit = true; 14342 break; 14343 case IncompatiblePointer: 14344 if (Action == AA_Passing_CFAudited) 14345 DiagKind = diag::err_arc_typecheck_convert_incompatible_pointer; 14346 else if (SrcType->isFunctionPointerType() && 14347 DstType->isFunctionPointerType()) 14348 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_incompatible_function_pointer; 14349 else 14350 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_incompatible_pointer; 14351 14352 CheckInferredResultType = DstType->isObjCObjectPointerType() && 14353 SrcType->isObjCObjectPointerType(); 14354 if (Hint.isNull() && !CheckInferredResultType) { 14355 ConvHints.tryToFixConversion(SrcExpr, SrcType, DstType, *this); 14356 } 14357 else if (CheckInferredResultType) { 14358 SrcType = SrcType.getUnqualifiedType(); 14359 DstType = DstType.getUnqualifiedType(); 14360 } 14361 MayHaveConvFixit = true; 14362 break; 14363 case IncompatiblePointerSign: 14364 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_incompatible_pointer_sign; 14365 break; 14366 case FunctionVoidPointer: 14367 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_pointer_void_func; 14368 break; 14369 case IncompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers: { 14370 // Perform array-to-pointer decay if necessary. 14371 if (SrcType->isArrayType()) SrcType = Context.getArrayDecayedType(SrcType); 14372 14373 Qualifiers lhq = SrcType->getPointeeType().getQualifiers(); 14374 Qualifiers rhq = DstType->getPointeeType().getQualifiers(); 14375 if (lhq.getAddressSpace() != rhq.getAddressSpace()) { 14376 DiagKind = diag::err_typecheck_incompatible_address_space; 14377 break; 14378 14379 } else if (lhq.getObjCLifetime() != rhq.getObjCLifetime()) { 14380 DiagKind = diag::err_typecheck_incompatible_ownership; 14381 break; 14382 } 14383 14384 llvm_unreachable("unknown error case for discarding qualifiers!"); 14385 // fallthrough 14386 } 14387 case CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers: 14388 // If the qualifiers lost were because we were applying the 14389 // (deprecated) C++ conversion from a string literal to a char* 14390 // (or wchar_t*), then there was no error (C++ 4.2p2). FIXME: 14391 // Ideally, this check would be performed in 14392 // checkPointerTypesForAssignment. However, that would require a 14393 // bit of refactoring (so that the second argument is an 14394 // expression, rather than a type), which should be done as part 14395 // of a larger effort to fix checkPointerTypesForAssignment for 14396 // C++ semantics. 14397 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && 14398 IsStringLiteralToNonConstPointerConversion(SrcExpr, DstType)) 14399 return false; 14400 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_discards_qualifiers; 14401 break; 14402 case IncompatibleNestedPointerQualifiers: 14403 DiagKind = diag::ext_nested_pointer_qualifier_mismatch; 14404 break; 14405 case IncompatibleNestedPointerAddressSpaceMismatch: 14406 DiagKind = diag::err_typecheck_incompatible_nested_address_space; 14407 break; 14408 case IntToBlockPointer: 14409 DiagKind = diag::err_int_to_block_pointer; 14410 break; 14411 case IncompatibleBlockPointer: 14412 DiagKind = diag::err_typecheck_convert_incompatible_block_pointer; 14413 break; 14414 case IncompatibleObjCQualifiedId: { 14415 if (SrcType->isObjCQualifiedIdType()) { 14416 const ObjCObjectPointerType *srcOPT = 14417 SrcType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(); 14418 for (auto *srcProto : srcOPT->quals()) { 14419 PDecl = srcProto; 14420 break; 14421 } 14422 if (const ObjCInterfaceType *IFaceT = 14423 DstType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getInterfaceType()) 14424 IFace = IFaceT->getDecl(); 14425 } 14426 else if (DstType->isObjCQualifiedIdType()) { 14427 const ObjCObjectPointerType *dstOPT = 14428 DstType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(); 14429 for (auto *dstProto : dstOPT->quals()) { 14430 PDecl = dstProto; 14431 break; 14432 } 14433 if (const ObjCInterfaceType *IFaceT = 14434 SrcType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getInterfaceType()) 14435 IFace = IFaceT->getDecl(); 14436 } 14437 DiagKind = diag::warn_incompatible_qualified_id; 14438 break; 14439 } 14440 case IncompatibleVectors: 14441 DiagKind = diag::warn_incompatible_vectors; 14442 break; 14443 case IncompatibleObjCWeakRef: 14444 DiagKind = diag::err_arc_weak_unavailable_assign; 14445 break; 14446 case Incompatible: 14447 if (maybeDiagnoseAssignmentToFunction(*this, DstType, SrcExpr)) { 14448 if (Complained) 14449 *Complained = true; 14450 return true; 14451 } 14452 14453 DiagKind = diag::err_typecheck_convert_incompatible; 14454 ConvHints.tryToFixConversion(SrcExpr, SrcType, DstType, *this); 14455 MayHaveConvFixit = true; 14456 isInvalid = true; 14457 MayHaveFunctionDiff = true; 14458 break; 14459 } 14460 14461 QualType FirstType, SecondType; 14462 switch (Action) { 14463 case AA_Assigning: 14464 case AA_Initializing: 14465 // The destination type comes first. 14466 FirstType = DstType; 14467 SecondType = SrcType; 14468 break; 14469 14470 case AA_Returning: 14471 case AA_Passing: 14472 case AA_Passing_CFAudited: 14473 case AA_Converting: 14474 case AA_Sending: 14475 case AA_Casting: 14476 // The source type comes first. 14477 FirstType = SrcType; 14478 SecondType = DstType; 14479 break; 14480 } 14481 14482 PartialDiagnostic FDiag = PDiag(DiagKind); 14483 if (Action == AA_Passing_CFAudited) 14484 FDiag << FirstType << SecondType << AA_Passing << SrcExpr->getSourceRange(); 14485 else 14486 FDiag << FirstType << SecondType << Action << SrcExpr->getSourceRange(); 14487 14488 // If we can fix the conversion, suggest the FixIts. 14489 assert(ConvHints.isNull() || Hint.isNull()); 14490 if (!ConvHints.isNull()) { 14491 for (FixItHint &H : ConvHints.Hints) 14492 FDiag << H; 14493 } else { 14494 FDiag << Hint; 14495 } 14496 if (MayHaveConvFixit) { FDiag << (unsigned) (ConvHints.Kind); } 14497 14498 if (MayHaveFunctionDiff) 14499 HandleFunctionTypeMismatch(FDiag, SecondType, FirstType); 14500 14501 Diag(Loc, FDiag); 14502 if (DiagKind == diag::warn_incompatible_qualified_id && 14503 PDecl && IFace && !IFace->hasDefinition()) 14504 Diag(IFace->getLocation(), diag::note_incomplete_class_and_qualified_id) 14505 << IFace << PDecl; 14506 14507 if (SecondType == Context.OverloadTy) 14508 NoteAllOverloadCandidates(OverloadExpr::find(SrcExpr).Expression, 14509 FirstType, /*TakingAddress=*/true); 14510 14511 if (CheckInferredResultType) 14512 EmitRelatedResultTypeNote(SrcExpr); 14513 14514 if (Action == AA_Returning && ConvTy == IncompatiblePointer) 14515 EmitRelatedResultTypeNoteForReturn(DstType); 14516 14517 if (Complained) 14518 *Complained = true; 14519 return isInvalid; 14520 } 14521 14522 ExprResult Sema::VerifyIntegerConstantExpression(Expr *E, 14523 llvm::APSInt *Result) { 14524 class SimpleICEDiagnoser : public VerifyICEDiagnoser { 14525 public: 14526 void diagnoseNotICE(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, SourceRange SR) override { 14527 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_expr_not_ice) << S.LangOpts.CPlusPlus << SR; 14528 } 14529 } Diagnoser; 14530 14531 return VerifyIntegerConstantExpression(E, Result, Diagnoser); 14532 } 14533 14534 ExprResult Sema::VerifyIntegerConstantExpression(Expr *E, 14535 llvm::APSInt *Result, 14536 unsigned DiagID, 14537 bool AllowFold) { 14538 class IDDiagnoser : public VerifyICEDiagnoser { 14539 unsigned DiagID; 14540 14541 public: 14542 IDDiagnoser(unsigned DiagID) 14543 : VerifyICEDiagnoser(DiagID == 0), DiagID(DiagID) { } 14544 14545 void diagnoseNotICE(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, SourceRange SR) override { 14546 S.Diag(Loc, DiagID) << SR; 14547 } 14548 } Diagnoser(DiagID); 14549 14550 return VerifyIntegerConstantExpression(E, Result, Diagnoser, AllowFold); 14551 } 14552 14553 void Sema::VerifyICEDiagnoser::diagnoseFold(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, 14554 SourceRange SR) { 14555 S.Diag(Loc, diag::ext_expr_not_ice) << SR << S.LangOpts.CPlusPlus; 14556 } 14557 14558 ExprResult 14559 Sema::VerifyIntegerConstantExpression(Expr *E, llvm::APSInt *Result, 14560 VerifyICEDiagnoser &Diagnoser, 14561 bool AllowFold) { 14562 SourceLocation DiagLoc = E->getBeginLoc(); 14563 14564 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11) { 14565 // C++11 [expr.const]p5: 14566 // If an expression of literal class type is used in a context where an 14567 // integral constant expression is required, then that class type shall 14568 // have a single non-explicit conversion function to an integral or 14569 // unscoped enumeration type 14570 ExprResult Converted; 14571 class CXX11ConvertDiagnoser : public ICEConvertDiagnoser { 14572 public: 14573 CXX11ConvertDiagnoser(bool Silent) 14574 : ICEConvertDiagnoser(/*AllowScopedEnumerations*/false, 14575 Silent, true) {} 14576 14577 SemaDiagnosticBuilder diagnoseNotInt(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, 14578 QualType T) override { 14579 return S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_ice_not_integral) << T; 14580 } 14581 14582 SemaDiagnosticBuilder diagnoseIncomplete( 14583 Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, QualType T) override { 14584 return S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_ice_incomplete_type) << T; 14585 } 14586 14587 SemaDiagnosticBuilder diagnoseExplicitConv( 14588 Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, QualType T, QualType ConvTy) override { 14589 return S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_ice_explicit_conversion) << T << ConvTy; 14590 } 14591 14592 SemaDiagnosticBuilder noteExplicitConv( 14593 Sema &S, CXXConversionDecl *Conv, QualType ConvTy) override { 14594 return S.Diag(Conv->getLocation(), diag::note_ice_conversion_here) 14595 << ConvTy->isEnumeralType() << ConvTy; 14596 } 14597 14598 SemaDiagnosticBuilder diagnoseAmbiguous( 14599 Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, QualType T) override { 14600 return S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_ice_ambiguous_conversion) << T; 14601 } 14602 14603 SemaDiagnosticBuilder noteAmbiguous( 14604 Sema &S, CXXConversionDecl *Conv, QualType ConvTy) override { 14605 return S.Diag(Conv->getLocation(), diag::note_ice_conversion_here) 14606 << ConvTy->isEnumeralType() << ConvTy; 14607 } 14608 14609 SemaDiagnosticBuilder diagnoseConversion( 14610 Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, QualType T, QualType ConvTy) override { 14611 llvm_unreachable("conversion functions are permitted"); 14612 } 14613 } ConvertDiagnoser(Diagnoser.Suppress); 14614 14615 Converted = PerformContextualImplicitConversion(DiagLoc, E, 14616 ConvertDiagnoser); 14617 if (Converted.isInvalid()) 14618 return Converted; 14619 E = Converted.get(); 14620 if (!E->getType()->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType()) 14621 return ExprError(); 14622 } else if (!E->getType()->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType()) { 14623 // An ICE must be of integral or unscoped enumeration type. 14624 if (!Diagnoser.Suppress) 14625 Diagnoser.diagnoseNotICE(*this, DiagLoc, E->getSourceRange()); 14626 return ExprError(); 14627 } 14628 14629 // Circumvent ICE checking in C++11 to avoid evaluating the expression twice 14630 // in the non-ICE case. 14631 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11 && E->isIntegerConstantExpr(Context)) { 14632 if (Result) 14633 *Result = E->EvaluateKnownConstIntCheckOverflow(Context); 14634 if (!isa<ConstantExpr>(E)) 14635 E = ConstantExpr::Create(Context, E); 14636 return E; 14637 } 14638 14639 Expr::EvalResult EvalResult; 14640 SmallVector<PartialDiagnosticAt, 8> Notes; 14641 EvalResult.Diag = &Notes; 14642 14643 // Try to evaluate the expression, and produce diagnostics explaining why it's 14644 // not a constant expression as a side-effect. 14645 bool Folded = 14646 E->EvaluateAsRValue(EvalResult, Context, /*isConstantContext*/ true) && 14647 EvalResult.Val.isInt() && !EvalResult.HasSideEffects; 14648 14649 if (!isa<ConstantExpr>(E)) 14650 E = ConstantExpr::Create(Context, E, EvalResult.Val); 14651 14652 // In C++11, we can rely on diagnostics being produced for any expression 14653 // which is not a constant expression. If no diagnostics were produced, then 14654 // this is a constant expression. 14655 if (Folded && getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11 && Notes.empty()) { 14656 if (Result) 14657 *Result = EvalResult.Val.getInt(); 14658 return E; 14659 } 14660 14661 // If our only note is the usual "invalid subexpression" note, just point 14662 // the caret at its location rather than producing an essentially 14663 // redundant note. 14664 if (Notes.size() == 1 && Notes[0].second.getDiagID() == 14665 diag::note_invalid_subexpr_in_const_expr) { 14666 DiagLoc = Notes[0].first; 14667 Notes.clear(); 14668 } 14669 14670 if (!Folded || !AllowFold) { 14671 if (!Diagnoser.Suppress) { 14672 Diagnoser.diagnoseNotICE(*this, DiagLoc, E->getSourceRange()); 14673 for (const PartialDiagnosticAt &Note : Notes) 14674 Diag(Note.first, Note.second); 14675 } 14676 14677 return ExprError(); 14678 } 14679 14680 Diagnoser.diagnoseFold(*this, DiagLoc, E->getSourceRange()); 14681 for (const PartialDiagnosticAt &Note : Notes) 14682 Diag(Note.first, Note.second); 14683 14684 if (Result) 14685 *Result = EvalResult.Val.getInt(); 14686 return E; 14687 } 14688 14689 namespace { 14690 // Handle the case where we conclude a expression which we speculatively 14691 // considered to be unevaluated is actually evaluated. 14692 class TransformToPE : public TreeTransform<TransformToPE> { 14693 typedef TreeTransform<TransformToPE> BaseTransform; 14694 14695 public: 14696 TransformToPE(Sema &SemaRef) : BaseTransform(SemaRef) { } 14697 14698 // Make sure we redo semantic analysis 14699 bool AlwaysRebuild() { return true; } 14700 bool ReplacingOriginal() { return true; } 14701 14702 // We need to special-case DeclRefExprs referring to FieldDecls which 14703 // are not part of a member pointer formation; normal TreeTransforming 14704 // doesn't catch this case because of the way we represent them in the AST. 14705 // FIXME: This is a bit ugly; is it really the best way to handle this 14706 // case? 14707 // 14708 // Error on DeclRefExprs referring to FieldDecls. 14709 ExprResult TransformDeclRefExpr(DeclRefExpr *E) { 14710 if (isa<FieldDecl>(E->getDecl()) && 14711 !SemaRef.isUnevaluatedContext()) 14712 return SemaRef.Diag(E->getLocation(), 14713 diag::err_invalid_non_static_member_use) 14714 << E->getDecl() << E->getSourceRange(); 14715 14716 return BaseTransform::TransformDeclRefExpr(E); 14717 } 14718 14719 // Exception: filter out member pointer formation 14720 ExprResult TransformUnaryOperator(UnaryOperator *E) { 14721 if (E->getOpcode() == UO_AddrOf && E->getType()->isMemberPointerType()) 14722 return E; 14723 14724 return BaseTransform::TransformUnaryOperator(E); 14725 } 14726 14727 // The body of a lambda-expression is in a separate expression evaluation 14728 // context so never needs to be transformed. 14729 // FIXME: Ideally we wouldn't transform the closure type either, and would 14730 // just recreate the capture expressions and lambda expression. 14731 StmtResult TransformLambdaBody(LambdaExpr *E, Stmt *Body) { 14732 return SkipLambdaBody(E, Body); 14733 } 14734 }; 14735 } 14736 14737 ExprResult Sema::TransformToPotentiallyEvaluated(Expr *E) { 14738 assert(isUnevaluatedContext() && 14739 "Should only transform unevaluated expressions"); 14740 ExprEvalContexts.back().Context = 14741 ExprEvalContexts[ExprEvalContexts.size()-2].Context; 14742 if (isUnevaluatedContext()) 14743 return E; 14744 return TransformToPE(*this).TransformExpr(E); 14745 } 14746 14747 void 14748 Sema::PushExpressionEvaluationContext( 14749 ExpressionEvaluationContext NewContext, Decl *LambdaContextDecl, 14750 ExpressionEvaluationContextRecord::ExpressionKind ExprContext) { 14751 ExprEvalContexts.emplace_back(NewContext, ExprCleanupObjects.size(), Cleanup, 14752 LambdaContextDecl, ExprContext); 14753 Cleanup.reset(); 14754 if (!MaybeODRUseExprs.empty()) 14755 std::swap(MaybeODRUseExprs, ExprEvalContexts.back().SavedMaybeODRUseExprs); 14756 } 14757 14758 void 14759 Sema::PushExpressionEvaluationContext( 14760 ExpressionEvaluationContext NewContext, ReuseLambdaContextDecl_t, 14761 ExpressionEvaluationContextRecord::ExpressionKind ExprContext) { 14762 Decl *ClosureContextDecl = ExprEvalContexts.back().ManglingContextDecl; 14763 PushExpressionEvaluationContext(NewContext, ClosureContextDecl, ExprContext); 14764 } 14765 14766 namespace { 14767 14768 const DeclRefExpr *CheckPossibleDeref(Sema &S, const Expr *PossibleDeref) { 14769 PossibleDeref = PossibleDeref->IgnoreParenImpCasts(); 14770 if (const auto *E = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(PossibleDeref)) { 14771 if (E->getOpcode() == UO_Deref) 14772 return CheckPossibleDeref(S, E->getSubExpr()); 14773 } else if (const auto *E = dyn_cast<ArraySubscriptExpr>(PossibleDeref)) { 14774 return CheckPossibleDeref(S, E->getBase()); 14775 } else if (const auto *E = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(PossibleDeref)) { 14776 return CheckPossibleDeref(S, E->getBase()); 14777 } else if (const auto E = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(PossibleDeref)) { 14778 QualType Inner; 14779 QualType Ty = E->getType(); 14780 if (const auto *Ptr = Ty->getAs<PointerType>()) 14781 Inner = Ptr->getPointeeType(); 14782 else if (const auto *Arr = S.Context.getAsArrayType(Ty)) 14783 Inner = Arr->getElementType(); 14784 else 14785 return nullptr; 14786 14787 if (Inner->hasAttr(attr::NoDeref)) 14788 return E; 14789 } 14790 return nullptr; 14791 } 14792 14793 } // namespace 14794 14795 void Sema::WarnOnPendingNoDerefs(ExpressionEvaluationContextRecord &Rec) { 14796 for (const Expr *E : Rec.PossibleDerefs) { 14797 const DeclRefExpr *DeclRef = CheckPossibleDeref(*this, E); 14798 if (DeclRef) { 14799 const ValueDecl *Decl = DeclRef->getDecl(); 14800 Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::warn_dereference_of_noderef_type) 14801 << Decl->getName() << E->getSourceRange(); 14802 Diag(Decl->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl) << Decl->getName(); 14803 } else { 14804 Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::warn_dereference_of_noderef_type_no_decl) 14805 << E->getSourceRange(); 14806 } 14807 } 14808 Rec.PossibleDerefs.clear(); 14809 } 14810 14811 void Sema::PopExpressionEvaluationContext() { 14812 ExpressionEvaluationContextRecord& Rec = ExprEvalContexts.back(); 14813 unsigned NumTypos = Rec.NumTypos; 14814 14815 if (!Rec.Lambdas.empty()) { 14816 using ExpressionKind = ExpressionEvaluationContextRecord::ExpressionKind; 14817 if (Rec.ExprContext == ExpressionKind::EK_TemplateArgument || Rec.isUnevaluated() || 14818 (Rec.isConstantEvaluated() && !getLangOpts().CPlusPlus17)) { 14819 unsigned D; 14820 if (Rec.isUnevaluated()) { 14821 // C++11 [expr.prim.lambda]p2: 14822 // A lambda-expression shall not appear in an unevaluated operand 14823 // (Clause 5). 14824 D = diag::err_lambda_unevaluated_operand; 14825 } else if (Rec.isConstantEvaluated() && !getLangOpts().CPlusPlus17) { 14826 // C++1y [expr.const]p2: 14827 // A conditional-expression e is a core constant expression unless the 14828 // evaluation of e, following the rules of the abstract machine, would 14829 // evaluate [...] a lambda-expression. 14830 D = diag::err_lambda_in_constant_expression; 14831 } else if (Rec.ExprContext == ExpressionKind::EK_TemplateArgument) { 14832 // C++17 [expr.prim.lamda]p2: 14833 // A lambda-expression shall not appear [...] in a template-argument. 14834 D = diag::err_lambda_in_invalid_context; 14835 } else 14836 llvm_unreachable("Couldn't infer lambda error message."); 14837 14838 for (const auto *L : Rec.Lambdas) 14839 Diag(L->getBeginLoc(), D); 14840 } 14841 } 14842 14843 WarnOnPendingNoDerefs(Rec); 14844 14845 // When are coming out of an unevaluated context, clear out any 14846 // temporaries that we may have created as part of the evaluation of 14847 // the expression in that context: they aren't relevant because they 14848 // will never be constructed. 14849 if (Rec.isUnevaluated() || Rec.isConstantEvaluated()) { 14850 ExprCleanupObjects.erase(ExprCleanupObjects.begin() + Rec.NumCleanupObjects, 14851 ExprCleanupObjects.end()); 14852 Cleanup = Rec.ParentCleanup; 14853 CleanupVarDeclMarking(); 14854 std::swap(MaybeODRUseExprs, Rec.SavedMaybeODRUseExprs); 14855 // Otherwise, merge the contexts together. 14856 } else { 14857 Cleanup.mergeFrom(Rec.ParentCleanup); 14858 MaybeODRUseExprs.insert(Rec.SavedMaybeODRUseExprs.begin(), 14859 Rec.SavedMaybeODRUseExprs.end()); 14860 } 14861 14862 // Pop the current expression evaluation context off the stack. 14863 ExprEvalContexts.pop_back(); 14864 14865 // The global expression evaluation context record is never popped. 14866 ExprEvalContexts.back().NumTypos += NumTypos; 14867 } 14868 14869 void Sema::DiscardCleanupsInEvaluationContext() { 14870 ExprCleanupObjects.erase( 14871 ExprCleanupObjects.begin() + ExprEvalContexts.back().NumCleanupObjects, 14872 ExprCleanupObjects.end()); 14873 Cleanup.reset(); 14874 MaybeODRUseExprs.clear(); 14875 } 14876 14877 ExprResult Sema::HandleExprEvaluationContextForTypeof(Expr *E) { 14878 ExprResult Result = CheckPlaceholderExpr(E); 14879 if (Result.isInvalid()) 14880 return ExprError(); 14881 E = Result.get(); 14882 if (!E->getType()->isVariablyModifiedType()) 14883 return E; 14884 return TransformToPotentiallyEvaluated(E); 14885 } 14886 14887 /// Are we in a context that is potentially constant evaluated per C++20 14888 /// [expr.const]p12? 14889 static bool isPotentiallyConstantEvaluatedContext(Sema &SemaRef) { 14890 /// C++2a [expr.const]p12: 14891 // An expression or conversion is potentially constant evaluated if it is 14892 switch (SemaRef.ExprEvalContexts.back().Context) { 14893 case Sema::ExpressionEvaluationContext::ConstantEvaluated: 14894 // -- a manifestly constant-evaluated expression, 14895 case Sema::ExpressionEvaluationContext::PotentiallyEvaluated: 14896 case Sema::ExpressionEvaluationContext::PotentiallyEvaluatedIfUsed: 14897 case Sema::ExpressionEvaluationContext::DiscardedStatement: 14898 // -- a potentially-evaluated expression, 14899 case Sema::ExpressionEvaluationContext::UnevaluatedList: 14900 // -- an immediate subexpression of a braced-init-list, 14901 14902 // -- [FIXME] an expression of the form & cast-expression that occurs 14903 // within a templated entity 14904 // -- a subexpression of one of the above that is not a subexpression of 14905 // a nested unevaluated operand. 14906 return true; 14907 14908 case Sema::ExpressionEvaluationContext::Unevaluated: 14909 case Sema::ExpressionEvaluationContext::UnevaluatedAbstract: 14910 // Expressions in this context are never evaluated. 14911 return false; 14912 } 14913 llvm_unreachable("Invalid context"); 14914 } 14915 14916 /// Return true if this function has a calling convention that requires mangling 14917 /// in the size of the parameter pack. 14918 static bool funcHasParameterSizeMangling(Sema &S, FunctionDecl *FD) { 14919 // These manglings don't do anything on non-Windows or non-x86 platforms, so 14920 // we don't need parameter type sizes. 14921 const llvm::Triple &TT = S.Context.getTargetInfo().getTriple(); 14922 if (!TT.isOSWindows() || (TT.getArch() != llvm::Triple::x86 && 14923 TT.getArch() != llvm::Triple::x86_64)) 14924 return false; 14925 14926 // If this is C++ and this isn't an extern "C" function, parameters do not 14927 // need to be complete. In this case, C++ mangling will apply, which doesn't 14928 // use the size of the parameters. 14929 if (S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && !FD->isExternC()) 14930 return false; 14931 14932 // Stdcall, fastcall, and vectorcall need this special treatment. 14933 CallingConv CC = FD->getType()->castAs<FunctionType>()->getCallConv(); 14934 switch (CC) { 14935 case CC_X86StdCall: 14936 case CC_X86FastCall: 14937 case CC_X86VectorCall: 14938 return true; 14939 default: 14940 break; 14941 } 14942 return false; 14943 } 14944 14945 /// Require that all of the parameter types of function be complete. Normally, 14946 /// parameter types are only required to be complete when a function is called 14947 /// or defined, but to mangle functions with certain calling conventions, the 14948 /// mangler needs to know the size of the parameter list. In this situation, 14949 /// MSVC doesn't emit an error or instantiate templates. Instead, MSVC mangles 14950 /// the function as _foo@0, i.e. zero bytes of parameters, which will usually 14951 /// result in a linker error. Clang doesn't implement this behavior, and instead 14952 /// attempts to error at compile time. 14953 static void CheckCompleteParameterTypesForMangler(Sema &S, FunctionDecl *FD, 14954 SourceLocation Loc) { 14955 class ParamIncompleteTypeDiagnoser : public Sema::TypeDiagnoser { 14956 FunctionDecl *FD; 14957 ParmVarDecl *Param; 14958 14959 public: 14960 ParamIncompleteTypeDiagnoser(FunctionDecl *FD, ParmVarDecl *Param) 14961 : FD(FD), Param(Param) {} 14962 14963 void diagnose(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, QualType T) override { 14964 CallingConv CC = FD->getType()->castAs<FunctionType>()->getCallConv(); 14965 StringRef CCName; 14966 switch (CC) { 14967 case CC_X86StdCall: 14968 CCName = "stdcall"; 14969 break; 14970 case CC_X86FastCall: 14971 CCName = "fastcall"; 14972 break; 14973 case CC_X86VectorCall: 14974 CCName = "vectorcall"; 14975 break; 14976 default: 14977 llvm_unreachable("CC does not need mangling"); 14978 } 14979 14980 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_cconv_incomplete_param_type) 14981 << Param->getDeclName() << FD->getDeclName() << CCName; 14982 } 14983 }; 14984 14985 for (ParmVarDecl *Param : FD->parameters()) { 14986 ParamIncompleteTypeDiagnoser Diagnoser(FD, Param); 14987 S.RequireCompleteType(Loc, Param->getType(), Diagnoser); 14988 } 14989 } 14990 14991 namespace { 14992 enum class OdrUseContext { 14993 /// Declarations in this context are not odr-used. 14994 None, 14995 /// Declarations in this context are formally odr-used, but this is a 14996 /// dependent context. 14997 Dependent, 14998 /// Declarations in this context are odr-used but not actually used (yet). 14999 FormallyOdrUsed, 15000 /// Declarations in this context are used. 15001 Used 15002 }; 15003 } 15004 15005 /// Are we within a context in which references to resolved functions or to 15006 /// variables result in odr-use? 15007 static OdrUseContext isOdrUseContext(Sema &SemaRef) { 15008 OdrUseContext Result; 15009 15010 switch (SemaRef.ExprEvalContexts.back().Context) { 15011 case Sema::ExpressionEvaluationContext::Unevaluated: 15012 case Sema::ExpressionEvaluationContext::UnevaluatedList: 15013 case Sema::ExpressionEvaluationContext::UnevaluatedAbstract: 15014 return OdrUseContext::None; 15015 15016 case Sema::ExpressionEvaluationContext::ConstantEvaluated: 15017 case Sema::ExpressionEvaluationContext::PotentiallyEvaluated: 15018 Result = OdrUseContext::Used; 15019 break; 15020 15021 case Sema::ExpressionEvaluationContext::DiscardedStatement: 15022 Result = OdrUseContext::FormallyOdrUsed; 15023 break; 15024 15025 case Sema::ExpressionEvaluationContext::PotentiallyEvaluatedIfUsed: 15026 // A default argument formally results in odr-use, but doesn't actually 15027 // result in a use in any real sense until it itself is used. 15028 Result = OdrUseContext::FormallyOdrUsed; 15029 break; 15030 } 15031 15032 if (SemaRef.CurContext->isDependentContext()) 15033 return OdrUseContext::Dependent; 15034 15035 return Result; 15036 } 15037 15038 static bool isImplicitlyDefinableConstexprFunction(FunctionDecl *Func) { 15039 CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Func); 15040 return Func->isConstexpr() && 15041 (Func->isImplicitlyInstantiable() || (MD && !MD->isUserProvided())); 15042 } 15043 15044 /// Mark a function referenced, and check whether it is odr-used 15045 /// (C++ [basic.def.odr]p2, C99 6.9p3) 15046 void Sema::MarkFunctionReferenced(SourceLocation Loc, FunctionDecl *Func, 15047 bool MightBeOdrUse) { 15048 assert(Func && "No function?"); 15049 15050 Func->setReferenced(); 15051 15052 // Recursive functions aren't really used until they're used from some other 15053 // context. 15054 bool IsRecursiveCall = CurContext == Func; 15055 15056 // C++11 [basic.def.odr]p3: 15057 // A function whose name appears as a potentially-evaluated expression is 15058 // odr-used if it is the unique lookup result or the selected member of a 15059 // set of overloaded functions [...]. 15060 // 15061 // We (incorrectly) mark overload resolution as an unevaluated context, so we 15062 // can just check that here. 15063 OdrUseContext OdrUse = 15064 MightBeOdrUse ? isOdrUseContext(*this) : OdrUseContext::None; 15065 if (IsRecursiveCall && OdrUse == OdrUseContext::Used) 15066 OdrUse = OdrUseContext::FormallyOdrUsed; 15067 15068 // C++20 [expr.const]p12: 15069 // A function [...] is needed for constant evaluation if it is [...] a 15070 // constexpr function that is named by an expression that is potentially 15071 // constant evaluated 15072 bool NeededForConstantEvaluation = 15073 isPotentiallyConstantEvaluatedContext(*this) && 15074 isImplicitlyDefinableConstexprFunction(Func); 15075 15076 // Determine whether we require a function definition to exist, per 15077 // C++11 [temp.inst]p3: 15078 // Unless a function template specialization has been explicitly 15079 // instantiated or explicitly specialized, the function template 15080 // specialization is implicitly instantiated when the specialization is 15081 // referenced in a context that requires a function definition to exist. 15082 // C++20 [temp.inst]p7: 15083 // The existence of a definition of a [...] function is considered to 15084 // affect the semantics of the program if the [...] function is needed for 15085 // constant evaluation by an expression 15086 // C++20 [basic.def.odr]p10: 15087 // Every program shall contain exactly one definition of every non-inline 15088 // function or variable that is odr-used in that program outside of a 15089 // discarded statement 15090 // C++20 [special]p1: 15091 // The implementation will implicitly define [defaulted special members] 15092 // if they are odr-used or needed for constant evaluation. 15093 // 15094 // Note that we skip the implicit instantiation of templates that are only 15095 // used in unused default arguments or by recursive calls to themselves. 15096 // This is formally non-conforming, but seems reasonable in practice. 15097 bool NeedDefinition = !IsRecursiveCall && (OdrUse == OdrUseContext::Used || 15098 NeededForConstantEvaluation); 15099 15100 // C++14 [temp.expl.spec]p6: 15101 // If a template [...] is explicitly specialized then that specialization 15102 // shall be declared before the first use of that specialization that would 15103 // cause an implicit instantiation to take place, in every translation unit 15104 // in which such a use occurs 15105 if (NeedDefinition && 15106 (Func->getTemplateSpecializationKind() != TSK_Undeclared || 15107 Func->getMemberSpecializationInfo())) 15108 checkSpecializationVisibility(Loc, Func); 15109 15110 // C++14 [except.spec]p17: 15111 // An exception-specification is considered to be needed when: 15112 // - the function is odr-used or, if it appears in an unevaluated operand, 15113 // would be odr-used if the expression were potentially-evaluated; 15114 // 15115 // Note, we do this even if MightBeOdrUse is false. That indicates that the 15116 // function is a pure virtual function we're calling, and in that case the 15117 // function was selected by overload resolution and we need to resolve its 15118 // exception specification for a different reason. 15119 const FunctionProtoType *FPT = Func->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>(); 15120 if (FPT && isUnresolvedExceptionSpec(FPT->getExceptionSpecType())) 15121 ResolveExceptionSpec(Loc, FPT); 15122 15123 if (getLangOpts().CUDA) 15124 CheckCUDACall(Loc, Func); 15125 15126 // If we need a definition, try to create one. 15127 if (NeedDefinition && !Func->getBody()) { 15128 if (CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Func)) { 15129 Constructor = cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Constructor->getFirstDecl()); 15130 if (Constructor->isDefaulted() && !Constructor->isDeleted()) { 15131 if (Constructor->isDefaultConstructor()) { 15132 if (Constructor->isTrivial() && 15133 !Constructor->hasAttr<DLLExportAttr>()) 15134 return; 15135 DefineImplicitDefaultConstructor(Loc, Constructor); 15136 } else if (Constructor->isCopyConstructor()) { 15137 DefineImplicitCopyConstructor(Loc, Constructor); 15138 } else if (Constructor->isMoveConstructor()) { 15139 DefineImplicitMoveConstructor(Loc, Constructor); 15140 } 15141 } else if (Constructor->getInheritedConstructor()) { 15142 DefineInheritingConstructor(Loc, Constructor); 15143 } 15144 } else if (CXXDestructorDecl *Destructor = 15145 dyn_cast<CXXDestructorDecl>(Func)) { 15146 Destructor = cast<CXXDestructorDecl>(Destructor->getFirstDecl()); 15147 if (Destructor->isDefaulted() && !Destructor->isDeleted()) { 15148 if (Destructor->isTrivial() && !Destructor->hasAttr<DLLExportAttr>()) 15149 return; 15150 DefineImplicitDestructor(Loc, Destructor); 15151 } 15152 if (Destructor->isVirtual() && getLangOpts().AppleKext) 15153 MarkVTableUsed(Loc, Destructor->getParent()); 15154 } else if (CXXMethodDecl *MethodDecl = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Func)) { 15155 if (MethodDecl->isOverloadedOperator() && 15156 MethodDecl->getOverloadedOperator() == OO_Equal) { 15157 MethodDecl = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(MethodDecl->getFirstDecl()); 15158 if (MethodDecl->isDefaulted() && !MethodDecl->isDeleted()) { 15159 if (MethodDecl->isCopyAssignmentOperator()) 15160 DefineImplicitCopyAssignment(Loc, MethodDecl); 15161 else if (MethodDecl->isMoveAssignmentOperator()) 15162 DefineImplicitMoveAssignment(Loc, MethodDecl); 15163 } 15164 } else if (isa<CXXConversionDecl>(MethodDecl) && 15165 MethodDecl->getParent()->isLambda()) { 15166 CXXConversionDecl *Conversion = 15167 cast<CXXConversionDecl>(MethodDecl->getFirstDecl()); 15168 if (Conversion->isLambdaToBlockPointerConversion()) 15169 DefineImplicitLambdaToBlockPointerConversion(Loc, Conversion); 15170 else 15171 DefineImplicitLambdaToFunctionPointerConversion(Loc, Conversion); 15172 } else if (MethodDecl->isVirtual() && getLangOpts().AppleKext) 15173 MarkVTableUsed(Loc, MethodDecl->getParent()); 15174 } 15175 15176 // Implicit instantiation of function templates and member functions of 15177 // class templates. 15178 if (Func->isImplicitlyInstantiable()) { 15179 TemplateSpecializationKind TSK = 15180 Func->getTemplateSpecializationKindForInstantiation(); 15181 SourceLocation PointOfInstantiation = Func->getPointOfInstantiation(); 15182 bool FirstInstantiation = PointOfInstantiation.isInvalid(); 15183 if (FirstInstantiation) { 15184 PointOfInstantiation = Loc; 15185 Func->setTemplateSpecializationKind(TSK, PointOfInstantiation); 15186 } else if (TSK != TSK_ImplicitInstantiation) { 15187 // Use the point of use as the point of instantiation, instead of the 15188 // point of explicit instantiation (which we track as the actual point 15189 // of instantiation). This gives better backtraces in diagnostics. 15190 PointOfInstantiation = Loc; 15191 } 15192 15193 if (FirstInstantiation || TSK != TSK_ImplicitInstantiation || 15194 Func->isConstexpr()) { 15195 if (isa<CXXRecordDecl>(Func->getDeclContext()) && 15196 cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Func->getDeclContext())->isLocalClass() && 15197 CodeSynthesisContexts.size()) 15198 PendingLocalImplicitInstantiations.push_back( 15199 std::make_pair(Func, PointOfInstantiation)); 15200 else if (Func->isConstexpr()) 15201 // Do not defer instantiations of constexpr functions, to avoid the 15202 // expression evaluator needing to call back into Sema if it sees a 15203 // call to such a function. 15204 InstantiateFunctionDefinition(PointOfInstantiation, Func); 15205 else { 15206 Func->setInstantiationIsPending(true); 15207 PendingInstantiations.push_back( 15208 std::make_pair(Func, PointOfInstantiation)); 15209 // Notify the consumer that a function was implicitly instantiated. 15210 Consumer.HandleCXXImplicitFunctionInstantiation(Func); 15211 } 15212 } 15213 } else { 15214 // Walk redefinitions, as some of them may be instantiable. 15215 for (auto i : Func->redecls()) { 15216 if (!i->isUsed(false) && i->isImplicitlyInstantiable()) 15217 MarkFunctionReferenced(Loc, i, MightBeOdrUse); 15218 } 15219 } 15220 } 15221 15222 // If this is the first "real" use, act on that. 15223 if (OdrUse == OdrUseContext::Used && !Func->isUsed(/*CheckUsedAttr=*/false)) { 15224 // Keep track of used but undefined functions. 15225 if (!Func->isDefined()) { 15226 if (mightHaveNonExternalLinkage(Func)) 15227 UndefinedButUsed.insert(std::make_pair(Func->getCanonicalDecl(), Loc)); 15228 else if (Func->getMostRecentDecl()->isInlined() && 15229 !LangOpts.GNUInline && 15230 !Func->getMostRecentDecl()->hasAttr<GNUInlineAttr>()) 15231 UndefinedButUsed.insert(std::make_pair(Func->getCanonicalDecl(), Loc)); 15232 else if (isExternalWithNoLinkageType(Func)) 15233 UndefinedButUsed.insert(std::make_pair(Func->getCanonicalDecl(), Loc)); 15234 } 15235 15236 // Some x86 Windows calling conventions mangle the size of the parameter 15237 // pack into the name. Computing the size of the parameters requires the 15238 // parameter types to be complete. Check that now. 15239 if (funcHasParameterSizeMangling(*this, Func)) 15240 CheckCompleteParameterTypesForMangler(*this, Func, Loc); 15241 15242 Func->markUsed(Context); 15243 15244 if (LangOpts.OpenMP && LangOpts.OpenMPIsDevice) 15245 checkOpenMPDeviceFunction(Loc, Func); 15246 } 15247 } 15248 15249 /// Directly mark a variable odr-used. Given a choice, prefer to use 15250 /// MarkVariableReferenced since it does additional checks and then 15251 /// calls MarkVarDeclODRUsed. 15252 /// If the variable must be captured: 15253 /// - if FunctionScopeIndexToStopAt is null, capture it in the CurContext 15254 /// - else capture it in the DeclContext that maps to the 15255 /// *FunctionScopeIndexToStopAt on the FunctionScopeInfo stack. 15256 static void 15257 MarkVarDeclODRUsed(VarDecl *Var, SourceLocation Loc, Sema &SemaRef, 15258 const unsigned *const FunctionScopeIndexToStopAt = nullptr) { 15259 // Keep track of used but undefined variables. 15260 // FIXME: We shouldn't suppress this warning for static data members. 15261 if (Var->hasDefinition(SemaRef.Context) == VarDecl::DeclarationOnly && 15262 (!Var->isExternallyVisible() || Var->isInline() || 15263 SemaRef.isExternalWithNoLinkageType(Var)) && 15264 !(Var->isStaticDataMember() && Var->hasInit())) { 15265 SourceLocation &old = SemaRef.UndefinedButUsed[Var->getCanonicalDecl()]; 15266 if (old.isInvalid()) 15267 old = Loc; 15268 } 15269 QualType CaptureType, DeclRefType; 15270 if (SemaRef.LangOpts.OpenMP) 15271 SemaRef.tryCaptureOpenMPLambdas(Var); 15272 SemaRef.tryCaptureVariable(Var, Loc, Sema::TryCapture_Implicit, 15273 /*EllipsisLoc*/ SourceLocation(), 15274 /*BuildAndDiagnose*/ true, 15275 CaptureType, DeclRefType, 15276 FunctionScopeIndexToStopAt); 15277 15278 Var->markUsed(SemaRef.Context); 15279 } 15280 15281 void Sema::MarkCaptureUsedInEnclosingContext(VarDecl *Capture, 15282 SourceLocation Loc, 15283 unsigned CapturingScopeIndex) { 15284 MarkVarDeclODRUsed(Capture, Loc, *this, &CapturingScopeIndex); 15285 } 15286 15287 static void 15288 diagnoseUncapturableValueReference(Sema &S, SourceLocation loc, 15289 ValueDecl *var, DeclContext *DC) { 15290 DeclContext *VarDC = var->getDeclContext(); 15291 15292 // If the parameter still belongs to the translation unit, then 15293 // we're actually just using one parameter in the declaration of 15294 // the next. 15295 if (isa<ParmVarDecl>(var) && 15296 isa<TranslationUnitDecl>(VarDC)) 15297 return; 15298 15299 // For C code, don't diagnose about capture if we're not actually in code 15300 // right now; it's impossible to write a non-constant expression outside of 15301 // function context, so we'll get other (more useful) diagnostics later. 15302 // 15303 // For C++, things get a bit more nasty... it would be nice to suppress this 15304 // diagnostic for certain cases like using a local variable in an array bound 15305 // for a member of a local class, but the correct predicate is not obvious. 15306 if (!S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && !S.CurContext->isFunctionOrMethod()) 15307 return; 15308 15309 unsigned ValueKind = isa<BindingDecl>(var) ? 1 : 0; 15310 unsigned ContextKind = 3; // unknown 15311 if (isa<CXXMethodDecl>(VarDC) && 15312 cast<CXXRecordDecl>(VarDC->getParent())->isLambda()) { 15313 ContextKind = 2; 15314 } else if (isa<FunctionDecl>(VarDC)) { 15315 ContextKind = 0; 15316 } else if (isa<BlockDecl>(VarDC)) { 15317 ContextKind = 1; 15318 } 15319 15320 S.Diag(loc, diag::err_reference_to_local_in_enclosing_context) 15321 << var << ValueKind << ContextKind << VarDC; 15322 S.Diag(var->getLocation(), diag::note_entity_declared_at) 15323 << var; 15324 15325 // FIXME: Add additional diagnostic info about class etc. which prevents 15326 // capture. 15327 } 15328 15329 15330 static bool isVariableAlreadyCapturedInScopeInfo(CapturingScopeInfo *CSI, VarDecl *Var, 15331 bool &SubCapturesAreNested, 15332 QualType &CaptureType, 15333 QualType &DeclRefType) { 15334 // Check whether we've already captured it. 15335 if (CSI->CaptureMap.count(Var)) { 15336 // If we found a capture, any subcaptures are nested. 15337 SubCapturesAreNested = true; 15338 15339 // Retrieve the capture type for this variable. 15340 CaptureType = CSI->getCapture(Var).getCaptureType(); 15341 15342 // Compute the type of an expression that refers to this variable. 15343 DeclRefType = CaptureType.getNonReferenceType(); 15344 15345 // Similarly to mutable captures in lambda, all the OpenMP captures by copy 15346 // are mutable in the sense that user can change their value - they are 15347 // private instances of the captured declarations. 15348 const Capture &Cap = CSI->getCapture(Var); 15349 if (Cap.isCopyCapture() && 15350 !(isa<LambdaScopeInfo>(CSI) && cast<LambdaScopeInfo>(CSI)->Mutable) && 15351 !(isa<CapturedRegionScopeInfo>(CSI) && 15352 cast<CapturedRegionScopeInfo>(CSI)->CapRegionKind == CR_OpenMP)) 15353 DeclRefType.addConst(); 15354 return true; 15355 } 15356 return false; 15357 } 15358 15359 // Only block literals, captured statements, and lambda expressions can 15360 // capture; other scopes don't work. 15361 static DeclContext *getParentOfCapturingContextOrNull(DeclContext *DC, VarDecl *Var, 15362 SourceLocation Loc, 15363 const bool Diagnose, Sema &S) { 15364 if (isa<BlockDecl>(DC) || isa<CapturedDecl>(DC) || isLambdaCallOperator(DC)) 15365 return getLambdaAwareParentOfDeclContext(DC); 15366 else if (Var->hasLocalStorage()) { 15367 if (Diagnose) 15368 diagnoseUncapturableValueReference(S, Loc, Var, DC); 15369 } 15370 return nullptr; 15371 } 15372 15373 // Certain capturing entities (lambdas, blocks etc.) are not allowed to capture 15374 // certain types of variables (unnamed, variably modified types etc.) 15375 // so check for eligibility. 15376 static bool isVariableCapturable(CapturingScopeInfo *CSI, VarDecl *Var, 15377 SourceLocation Loc, 15378 const bool Diagnose, Sema &S) { 15379 15380 bool IsBlock = isa<BlockScopeInfo>(CSI); 15381 bool IsLambda = isa<LambdaScopeInfo>(CSI); 15382 15383 // Lambdas are not allowed to capture unnamed variables 15384 // (e.g. anonymous unions). 15385 // FIXME: The C++11 rule don't actually state this explicitly, but I'm 15386 // assuming that's the intent. 15387 if (IsLambda && !Var->getDeclName()) { 15388 if (Diagnose) { 15389 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_lambda_capture_anonymous_var); 15390 S.Diag(Var->getLocation(), diag::note_declared_at); 15391 } 15392 return false; 15393 } 15394 15395 // Prohibit variably-modified types in blocks; they're difficult to deal with. 15396 if (Var->getType()->isVariablyModifiedType() && IsBlock) { 15397 if (Diagnose) { 15398 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_ref_vm_type); 15399 S.Diag(Var->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl) 15400 << Var->getDeclName(); 15401 } 15402 return false; 15403 } 15404 // Prohibit structs with flexible array members too. 15405 // We cannot capture what is in the tail end of the struct. 15406 if (const RecordType *VTTy = Var->getType()->getAs<RecordType>()) { 15407 if (VTTy->getDecl()->hasFlexibleArrayMember()) { 15408 if (Diagnose) { 15409 if (IsBlock) 15410 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_ref_flexarray_type); 15411 else 15412 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_lambda_capture_flexarray_type) 15413 << Var->getDeclName(); 15414 S.Diag(Var->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl) 15415 << Var->getDeclName(); 15416 } 15417 return false; 15418 } 15419 } 15420 const bool HasBlocksAttr = Var->hasAttr<BlocksAttr>(); 15421 // Lambdas and captured statements are not allowed to capture __block 15422 // variables; they don't support the expected semantics. 15423 if (HasBlocksAttr && (IsLambda || isa<CapturedRegionScopeInfo>(CSI))) { 15424 if (Diagnose) { 15425 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_capture_block_variable) 15426 << Var->getDeclName() << !IsLambda; 15427 S.Diag(Var->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl) 15428 << Var->getDeclName(); 15429 } 15430 return false; 15431 } 15432 // OpenCL v2.0 s6.12.5: Blocks cannot reference/capture other blocks 15433 if (S.getLangOpts().OpenCL && IsBlock && 15434 Var->getType()->isBlockPointerType()) { 15435 if (Diagnose) 15436 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_opencl_block_ref_block); 15437 return false; 15438 } 15439 15440 return true; 15441 } 15442 15443 // Returns true if the capture by block was successful. 15444 static bool captureInBlock(BlockScopeInfo *BSI, VarDecl *Var, 15445 SourceLocation Loc, 15446 const bool BuildAndDiagnose, 15447 QualType &CaptureType, 15448 QualType &DeclRefType, 15449 const bool Nested, 15450 Sema &S, bool Invalid) { 15451 bool ByRef = false; 15452 15453 // Blocks are not allowed to capture arrays, excepting OpenCL. 15454 // OpenCL v2.0 s1.12.5 (revision 40): arrays are captured by reference 15455 // (decayed to pointers). 15456 if (!Invalid && !S.getLangOpts().OpenCL && CaptureType->isArrayType()) { 15457 if (BuildAndDiagnose) { 15458 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_ref_array_type); 15459 S.Diag(Var->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl) 15460 << Var->getDeclName(); 15461 Invalid = true; 15462 } else { 15463 return false; 15464 } 15465 } 15466 15467 // Forbid the block-capture of autoreleasing variables. 15468 if (!Invalid && 15469 CaptureType.getObjCLifetime() == Qualifiers::OCL_Autoreleasing) { 15470 if (BuildAndDiagnose) { 15471 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_arc_autoreleasing_capture) 15472 << /*block*/ 0; 15473 S.Diag(Var->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl) 15474 << Var->getDeclName(); 15475 Invalid = true; 15476 } else { 15477 return false; 15478 } 15479 } 15480 15481 // Warn about implicitly autoreleasing indirect parameters captured by blocks. 15482 if (const auto *PT = CaptureType->getAs<PointerType>()) { 15483 // This function finds out whether there is an AttributedType of kind 15484 // attr::ObjCOwnership in Ty. The existence of AttributedType of kind 15485 // attr::ObjCOwnership implies __autoreleasing was explicitly specified 15486 // rather than being added implicitly by the compiler. 15487 auto IsObjCOwnershipAttributedType = [](QualType Ty) { 15488 while (const auto *AttrTy = Ty->getAs<AttributedType>()) { 15489 if (AttrTy->getAttrKind() == attr::ObjCOwnership) 15490 return true; 15491 15492 // Peel off AttributedTypes that are not of kind ObjCOwnership. 15493 Ty = AttrTy->getModifiedType(); 15494 } 15495 15496 return false; 15497 }; 15498 15499 QualType PointeeTy = PT->getPointeeType(); 15500 15501 if (!Invalid && PointeeTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>() && 15502 PointeeTy.getObjCLifetime() == Qualifiers::OCL_Autoreleasing && 15503 !IsObjCOwnershipAttributedType(PointeeTy)) { 15504 if (BuildAndDiagnose) { 15505 SourceLocation VarLoc = Var->getLocation(); 15506 S.Diag(Loc, diag::warn_block_capture_autoreleasing); 15507 S.Diag(VarLoc, diag::note_declare_parameter_strong); 15508 } 15509 } 15510 } 15511 15512 const bool HasBlocksAttr = Var->hasAttr<BlocksAttr>(); 15513 if (HasBlocksAttr || CaptureType->isReferenceType() || 15514 (S.getLangOpts().OpenMP && S.isOpenMPCapturedDecl(Var))) { 15515 // Block capture by reference does not change the capture or 15516 // declaration reference types. 15517 ByRef = true; 15518 } else { 15519 // Block capture by copy introduces 'const'. 15520 CaptureType = CaptureType.getNonReferenceType().withConst(); 15521 DeclRefType = CaptureType; 15522 } 15523 15524 // Actually capture the variable. 15525 if (BuildAndDiagnose) 15526 BSI->addCapture(Var, HasBlocksAttr, ByRef, Nested, Loc, SourceLocation(), 15527 CaptureType, Invalid); 15528 15529 return !Invalid; 15530 } 15531 15532 15533 /// Capture the given variable in the captured region. 15534 static bool captureInCapturedRegion(CapturedRegionScopeInfo *RSI, 15535 VarDecl *Var, 15536 SourceLocation Loc, 15537 const bool BuildAndDiagnose, 15538 QualType &CaptureType, 15539 QualType &DeclRefType, 15540 const bool RefersToCapturedVariable, 15541 Sema &S, bool Invalid) { 15542 // By default, capture variables by reference. 15543 bool ByRef = true; 15544 // Using an LValue reference type is consistent with Lambdas (see below). 15545 if (S.getLangOpts().OpenMP && RSI->CapRegionKind == CR_OpenMP) { 15546 if (S.isOpenMPCapturedDecl(Var)) { 15547 bool HasConst = DeclRefType.isConstQualified(); 15548 DeclRefType = DeclRefType.getUnqualifiedType(); 15549 // Don't lose diagnostics about assignments to const. 15550 if (HasConst) 15551 DeclRefType.addConst(); 15552 } 15553 ByRef = S.isOpenMPCapturedByRef(Var, RSI->OpenMPLevel); 15554 } 15555 15556 if (ByRef) 15557 CaptureType = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(DeclRefType); 15558 else 15559 CaptureType = DeclRefType; 15560 15561 // Actually capture the variable. 15562 if (BuildAndDiagnose) 15563 RSI->addCapture(Var, /*isBlock*/ false, ByRef, RefersToCapturedVariable, 15564 Loc, SourceLocation(), CaptureType, Invalid); 15565 15566 return !Invalid; 15567 } 15568 15569 /// Capture the given variable in the lambda. 15570 static bool captureInLambda(LambdaScopeInfo *LSI, 15571 VarDecl *Var, 15572 SourceLocation Loc, 15573 const bool BuildAndDiagnose, 15574 QualType &CaptureType, 15575 QualType &DeclRefType, 15576 const bool RefersToCapturedVariable, 15577 const Sema::TryCaptureKind Kind, 15578 SourceLocation EllipsisLoc, 15579 const bool IsTopScope, 15580 Sema &S, bool Invalid) { 15581 // Determine whether we are capturing by reference or by value. 15582 bool ByRef = false; 15583 if (IsTopScope && Kind != Sema::TryCapture_Implicit) { 15584 ByRef = (Kind == Sema::TryCapture_ExplicitByRef); 15585 } else { 15586 ByRef = (LSI->ImpCaptureStyle == LambdaScopeInfo::ImpCap_LambdaByref); 15587 } 15588 15589 // Compute the type of the field that will capture this variable. 15590 if (ByRef) { 15591 // C++11 [expr.prim.lambda]p15: 15592 // An entity is captured by reference if it is implicitly or 15593 // explicitly captured but not captured by copy. It is 15594 // unspecified whether additional unnamed non-static data 15595 // members are declared in the closure type for entities 15596 // captured by reference. 15597 // 15598 // FIXME: It is not clear whether we want to build an lvalue reference 15599 // to the DeclRefType or to CaptureType.getNonReferenceType(). GCC appears 15600 // to do the former, while EDG does the latter. Core issue 1249 will 15601 // clarify, but for now we follow GCC because it's a more permissive and 15602 // easily defensible position. 15603 CaptureType = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(DeclRefType); 15604 } else { 15605 // C++11 [expr.prim.lambda]p14: 15606 // For each entity captured by copy, an unnamed non-static 15607 // data member is declared in the closure type. The 15608 // declaration order of these members is unspecified. The type 15609 // of such a data member is the type of the corresponding 15610 // captured entity if the entity is not a reference to an 15611 // object, or the referenced type otherwise. [Note: If the 15612 // captured entity is a reference to a function, the 15613 // corresponding data member is also a reference to a 15614 // function. - end note ] 15615 if (const ReferenceType *RefType = CaptureType->getAs<ReferenceType>()){ 15616 if (!RefType->getPointeeType()->isFunctionType()) 15617 CaptureType = RefType->getPointeeType(); 15618 } 15619 15620 // Forbid the lambda copy-capture of autoreleasing variables. 15621 if (!Invalid && 15622 CaptureType.getObjCLifetime() == Qualifiers::OCL_Autoreleasing) { 15623 if (BuildAndDiagnose) { 15624 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_arc_autoreleasing_capture) << /*lambda*/ 1; 15625 S.Diag(Var->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl) 15626 << Var->getDeclName(); 15627 Invalid = true; 15628 } else { 15629 return false; 15630 } 15631 } 15632 15633 // Make sure that by-copy captures are of a complete and non-abstract type. 15634 if (!Invalid && BuildAndDiagnose) { 15635 if (!CaptureType->isDependentType() && 15636 S.RequireCompleteType(Loc, CaptureType, 15637 diag::err_capture_of_incomplete_type, 15638 Var->getDeclName())) 15639 Invalid = true; 15640 else if (S.RequireNonAbstractType(Loc, CaptureType, 15641 diag::err_capture_of_abstract_type)) 15642 Invalid = true; 15643 } 15644 } 15645 15646 // Compute the type of a reference to this captured variable. 15647 if (ByRef) 15648 DeclRefType = CaptureType.getNonReferenceType(); 15649 else { 15650 // C++ [expr.prim.lambda]p5: 15651 // The closure type for a lambda-expression has a public inline 15652 // function call operator [...]. This function call operator is 15653 // declared const (9.3.1) if and only if the lambda-expression's 15654 // parameter-declaration-clause is not followed by mutable. 15655 DeclRefType = CaptureType.getNonReferenceType(); 15656 if (!LSI->Mutable && !CaptureType->isReferenceType()) 15657 DeclRefType.addConst(); 15658 } 15659 15660 // Add the capture. 15661 if (BuildAndDiagnose) 15662 LSI->addCapture(Var, /*isBlock=*/false, ByRef, RefersToCapturedVariable, 15663 Loc, EllipsisLoc, CaptureType, Invalid); 15664 15665 return !Invalid; 15666 } 15667 15668 bool Sema::tryCaptureVariable( 15669 VarDecl *Var, SourceLocation ExprLoc, TryCaptureKind Kind, 15670 SourceLocation EllipsisLoc, bool BuildAndDiagnose, QualType &CaptureType, 15671 QualType &DeclRefType, const unsigned *const FunctionScopeIndexToStopAt) { 15672 // An init-capture is notionally from the context surrounding its 15673 // declaration, but its parent DC is the lambda class. 15674 DeclContext *VarDC = Var->getDeclContext(); 15675 if (Var->isInitCapture()) 15676 VarDC = VarDC->getParent(); 15677 15678 DeclContext *DC = CurContext; 15679 const unsigned MaxFunctionScopesIndex = FunctionScopeIndexToStopAt 15680 ? *FunctionScopeIndexToStopAt : FunctionScopes.size() - 1; 15681 // We need to sync up the Declaration Context with the 15682 // FunctionScopeIndexToStopAt 15683 if (FunctionScopeIndexToStopAt) { 15684 unsigned FSIndex = FunctionScopes.size() - 1; 15685 while (FSIndex != MaxFunctionScopesIndex) { 15686 DC = getLambdaAwareParentOfDeclContext(DC); 15687 --FSIndex; 15688 } 15689 } 15690 15691 15692 // If the variable is declared in the current context, there is no need to 15693 // capture it. 15694 if (VarDC == DC) return true; 15695 15696 // Capture global variables if it is required to use private copy of this 15697 // variable. 15698 bool IsGlobal = !Var->hasLocalStorage(); 15699 if (IsGlobal && 15700 !(LangOpts.OpenMP && isOpenMPCapturedDecl(Var, /*CheckScopeInfo=*/true, 15701 MaxFunctionScopesIndex))) 15702 return true; 15703 Var = Var->getCanonicalDecl(); 15704 15705 // Walk up the stack to determine whether we can capture the variable, 15706 // performing the "simple" checks that don't depend on type. We stop when 15707 // we've either hit the declared scope of the variable or find an existing 15708 // capture of that variable. We start from the innermost capturing-entity 15709 // (the DC) and ensure that all intervening capturing-entities 15710 // (blocks/lambdas etc.) between the innermost capturer and the variable`s 15711 // declcontext can either capture the variable or have already captured 15712 // the variable. 15713 CaptureType = Var->getType(); 15714 DeclRefType = CaptureType.getNonReferenceType(); 15715 bool Nested = false; 15716 bool Explicit = (Kind != TryCapture_Implicit); 15717 unsigned FunctionScopesIndex = MaxFunctionScopesIndex; 15718 do { 15719 // Only block literals, captured statements, and lambda expressions can 15720 // capture; other scopes don't work. 15721 DeclContext *ParentDC = getParentOfCapturingContextOrNull(DC, Var, 15722 ExprLoc, 15723 BuildAndDiagnose, 15724 *this); 15725 // We need to check for the parent *first* because, if we *have* 15726 // private-captured a global variable, we need to recursively capture it in 15727 // intermediate blocks, lambdas, etc. 15728 if (!ParentDC) { 15729 if (IsGlobal) { 15730 FunctionScopesIndex = MaxFunctionScopesIndex - 1; 15731 break; 15732 } 15733 return true; 15734 } 15735 15736 FunctionScopeInfo *FSI = FunctionScopes[FunctionScopesIndex]; 15737 CapturingScopeInfo *CSI = cast<CapturingScopeInfo>(FSI); 15738 15739 15740 // Check whether we've already captured it. 15741 if (isVariableAlreadyCapturedInScopeInfo(CSI, Var, Nested, CaptureType, 15742 DeclRefType)) { 15743 CSI->getCapture(Var).markUsed(BuildAndDiagnose); 15744 break; 15745 } 15746 // If we are instantiating a generic lambda call operator body, 15747 // we do not want to capture new variables. What was captured 15748 // during either a lambdas transformation or initial parsing 15749 // should be used. 15750 if (isGenericLambdaCallOperatorSpecialization(DC)) { 15751 if (BuildAndDiagnose) { 15752 LambdaScopeInfo *LSI = cast<LambdaScopeInfo>(CSI); 15753 if (LSI->ImpCaptureStyle == CapturingScopeInfo::ImpCap_None) { 15754 Diag(ExprLoc, diag::err_lambda_impcap) << Var->getDeclName(); 15755 Diag(Var->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl) 15756 << Var->getDeclName(); 15757 Diag(LSI->Lambda->getBeginLoc(), diag::note_lambda_decl); 15758 } else 15759 diagnoseUncapturableValueReference(*this, ExprLoc, Var, DC); 15760 } 15761 return true; 15762 } 15763 15764 // Try to capture variable-length arrays types. 15765 if (Var->getType()->isVariablyModifiedType()) { 15766 // We're going to walk down into the type and look for VLA 15767 // expressions. 15768 QualType QTy = Var->getType(); 15769 if (ParmVarDecl *PVD = dyn_cast_or_null<ParmVarDecl>(Var)) 15770 QTy = PVD->getOriginalType(); 15771 captureVariablyModifiedType(Context, QTy, CSI); 15772 } 15773 15774 if (getLangOpts().OpenMP) { 15775 if (auto *RSI = dyn_cast<CapturedRegionScopeInfo>(CSI)) { 15776 // OpenMP private variables should not be captured in outer scope, so 15777 // just break here. Similarly, global variables that are captured in a 15778 // target region should not be captured outside the scope of the region. 15779 if (RSI->CapRegionKind == CR_OpenMP) { 15780 bool IsOpenMPPrivateDecl = isOpenMPPrivateDecl(Var, RSI->OpenMPLevel); 15781 auto IsTargetCap = !IsOpenMPPrivateDecl && 15782 isOpenMPTargetCapturedDecl(Var, RSI->OpenMPLevel); 15783 // When we detect target captures we are looking from inside the 15784 // target region, therefore we need to propagate the capture from the 15785 // enclosing region. Therefore, the capture is not initially nested. 15786 if (IsTargetCap) 15787 adjustOpenMPTargetScopeIndex(FunctionScopesIndex, RSI->OpenMPLevel); 15788 15789 if (IsTargetCap || IsOpenMPPrivateDecl) { 15790 Nested = !IsTargetCap; 15791 DeclRefType = DeclRefType.getUnqualifiedType(); 15792 CaptureType = Context.getLValueReferenceType(DeclRefType); 15793 break; 15794 } 15795 } 15796 } 15797 } 15798 if (CSI->ImpCaptureStyle == CapturingScopeInfo::ImpCap_None && !Explicit) { 15799 // No capture-default, and this is not an explicit capture 15800 // so cannot capture this variable. 15801 if (BuildAndDiagnose) { 15802 Diag(ExprLoc, diag::err_lambda_impcap) << Var->getDeclName(); 15803 Diag(Var->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl) 15804 << Var->getDeclName(); 15805 if (cast<LambdaScopeInfo>(CSI)->Lambda) 15806 Diag(cast<LambdaScopeInfo>(CSI)->Lambda->getBeginLoc(), 15807 diag::note_lambda_decl); 15808 // FIXME: If we error out because an outer lambda can not implicitly 15809 // capture a variable that an inner lambda explicitly captures, we 15810 // should have the inner lambda do the explicit capture - because 15811 // it makes for cleaner diagnostics later. This would purely be done 15812 // so that the diagnostic does not misleadingly claim that a variable 15813 // can not be captured by a lambda implicitly even though it is captured 15814 // explicitly. Suggestion: 15815 // - create const bool VariableCaptureWasInitiallyExplicit = Explicit 15816 // at the function head 15817 // - cache the StartingDeclContext - this must be a lambda 15818 // - captureInLambda in the innermost lambda the variable. 15819 } 15820 return true; 15821 } 15822 15823 FunctionScopesIndex--; 15824 DC = ParentDC; 15825 Explicit = false; 15826 } while (!VarDC->Equals(DC)); 15827 15828 // Walk back down the scope stack, (e.g. from outer lambda to inner lambda) 15829 // computing the type of the capture at each step, checking type-specific 15830 // requirements, and adding captures if requested. 15831 // If the variable had already been captured previously, we start capturing 15832 // at the lambda nested within that one. 15833 bool Invalid = false; 15834 for (unsigned I = ++FunctionScopesIndex, N = MaxFunctionScopesIndex + 1; I != N; 15835 ++I) { 15836 CapturingScopeInfo *CSI = cast<CapturingScopeInfo>(FunctionScopes[I]); 15837 15838 // Certain capturing entities (lambdas, blocks etc.) are not allowed to capture 15839 // certain types of variables (unnamed, variably modified types etc.) 15840 // so check for eligibility. 15841 if (!Invalid) 15842 Invalid = 15843 !isVariableCapturable(CSI, Var, ExprLoc, BuildAndDiagnose, *this); 15844 15845 // After encountering an error, if we're actually supposed to capture, keep 15846 // capturing in nested contexts to suppress any follow-on diagnostics. 15847 if (Invalid && !BuildAndDiagnose) 15848 return true; 15849 15850 if (BlockScopeInfo *BSI = dyn_cast<BlockScopeInfo>(CSI)) { 15851 Invalid = !captureInBlock(BSI, Var, ExprLoc, BuildAndDiagnose, CaptureType, 15852 DeclRefType, Nested, *this, Invalid); 15853 Nested = true; 15854 } else if (CapturedRegionScopeInfo *RSI = dyn_cast<CapturedRegionScopeInfo>(CSI)) { 15855 Invalid = !captureInCapturedRegion(RSI, Var, ExprLoc, BuildAndDiagnose, 15856 CaptureType, DeclRefType, Nested, 15857 *this, Invalid); 15858 Nested = true; 15859 } else { 15860 LambdaScopeInfo *LSI = cast<LambdaScopeInfo>(CSI); 15861 Invalid = 15862 !captureInLambda(LSI, Var, ExprLoc, BuildAndDiagnose, CaptureType, 15863 DeclRefType, Nested, Kind, EllipsisLoc, 15864 /*IsTopScope*/ I == N - 1, *this, Invalid); 15865 Nested = true; 15866 } 15867 15868 if (Invalid && !BuildAndDiagnose) 15869 return true; 15870 } 15871 return Invalid; 15872 } 15873 15874 bool Sema::tryCaptureVariable(VarDecl *Var, SourceLocation Loc, 15875 TryCaptureKind Kind, SourceLocation EllipsisLoc) { 15876 QualType CaptureType; 15877 QualType DeclRefType; 15878 return tryCaptureVariable(Var, Loc, Kind, EllipsisLoc, 15879 /*BuildAndDiagnose=*/true, CaptureType, 15880 DeclRefType, nullptr); 15881 } 15882 15883 bool Sema::NeedToCaptureVariable(VarDecl *Var, SourceLocation Loc) { 15884 QualType CaptureType; 15885 QualType DeclRefType; 15886 return !tryCaptureVariable(Var, Loc, TryCapture_Implicit, SourceLocation(), 15887 /*BuildAndDiagnose=*/false, CaptureType, 15888 DeclRefType, nullptr); 15889 } 15890 15891 QualType Sema::getCapturedDeclRefType(VarDecl *Var, SourceLocation Loc) { 15892 QualType CaptureType; 15893 QualType DeclRefType; 15894 15895 // Determine whether we can capture this variable. 15896 if (tryCaptureVariable(Var, Loc, TryCapture_Implicit, SourceLocation(), 15897 /*BuildAndDiagnose=*/false, CaptureType, 15898 DeclRefType, nullptr)) 15899 return QualType(); 15900 15901 return DeclRefType; 15902 } 15903 15904 namespace { 15905 // Helper to copy the template arguments from a DeclRefExpr or MemberExpr. 15906 // The produced TemplateArgumentListInfo* points to data stored within this 15907 // object, so should only be used in contexts where the pointer will not be 15908 // used after the CopiedTemplateArgs object is destroyed. 15909 class CopiedTemplateArgs { 15910 bool HasArgs; 15911 TemplateArgumentListInfo TemplateArgStorage; 15912 public: 15913 template<typename RefExpr> 15914 CopiedTemplateArgs(RefExpr *E) : HasArgs(E->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) { 15915 if (HasArgs) 15916 E->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(TemplateArgStorage); 15917 } 15918 operator TemplateArgumentListInfo*() 15919 #ifdef __has_cpp_attribute 15920 #if __has_cpp_attribute(clang::lifetimebound) 15921 [[clang::lifetimebound]] 15922 #endif 15923 #endif 15924 { 15925 return HasArgs ? &TemplateArgStorage : nullptr; 15926 } 15927 }; 15928 } 15929 15930 /// Walk the set of potential results of an expression and mark them all as 15931 /// non-odr-uses if they satisfy the side-conditions of the NonOdrUseReason. 15932 /// 15933 /// \return A new expression if we found any potential results, ExprEmpty() if 15934 /// not, and ExprError() if we diagnosed an error. 15935 static ExprResult rebuildPotentialResultsAsNonOdrUsed(Sema &S, Expr *E, 15936 NonOdrUseReason NOUR) { 15937 // Per C++11 [basic.def.odr], a variable is odr-used "unless it is 15938 // an object that satisfies the requirements for appearing in a 15939 // constant expression (5.19) and the lvalue-to-rvalue conversion (4.1) 15940 // is immediately applied." This function handles the lvalue-to-rvalue 15941 // conversion part. 15942 // 15943 // If we encounter a node that claims to be an odr-use but shouldn't be, we 15944 // transform it into the relevant kind of non-odr-use node and rebuild the 15945 // tree of nodes leading to it. 15946 // 15947 // This is a mini-TreeTransform that only transforms a restricted subset of 15948 // nodes (and only certain operands of them). 15949 15950 // Rebuild a subexpression. 15951 auto Rebuild = [&](Expr *Sub) { 15952 return rebuildPotentialResultsAsNonOdrUsed(S, Sub, NOUR); 15953 }; 15954 15955 // Check whether a potential result satisfies the requirements of NOUR. 15956 auto IsPotentialResultOdrUsed = [&](NamedDecl *D) { 15957 // Any entity other than a VarDecl is always odr-used whenever it's named 15958 // in a potentially-evaluated expression. 15959 auto *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D); 15960 if (!VD) 15961 return true; 15962 15963 // C++2a [basic.def.odr]p4: 15964 // A variable x whose name appears as a potentially-evalauted expression 15965 // e is odr-used by e unless 15966 // -- x is a reference that is usable in constant expressions, or 15967 // -- x is a variable of non-reference type that is usable in constant 15968 // expressions and has no mutable subobjects, and e is an element of 15969 // the set of potential results of an expression of 15970 // non-volatile-qualified non-class type to which the lvalue-to-rvalue 15971 // conversion is applied, or 15972 // -- x is a variable of non-reference type, and e is an element of the 15973 // set of potential results of a discarded-value expression to which 15974 // the lvalue-to-rvalue conversion is not applied 15975 // 15976 // We check the first bullet and the "potentially-evaluated" condition in 15977 // BuildDeclRefExpr. We check the type requirements in the second bullet 15978 // in CheckLValueToRValueConversionOperand below. 15979 switch (NOUR) { 15980 case NOUR_None: 15981 case NOUR_Unevaluated: 15982 llvm_unreachable("unexpected non-odr-use-reason"); 15983 15984 case NOUR_Constant: 15985 // Constant references were handled when they were built. 15986 if (VD->getType()->isReferenceType()) 15987 return true; 15988 if (auto *RD = VD->getType()->getAsCXXRecordDecl()) 15989 if (RD->hasMutableFields()) 15990 return true; 15991 if (!VD->isUsableInConstantExpressions(S.Context)) 15992 return true; 15993 break; 15994 15995 case NOUR_Discarded: 15996 if (VD->getType()->isReferenceType()) 15997 return true; 15998 break; 15999 } 16000 return false; 16001 }; 16002 16003 // Mark that this expression does not constitute an odr-use. 16004 auto MarkNotOdrUsed = [&] { 16005 S.MaybeODRUseExprs.erase(E); 16006 if (LambdaScopeInfo *LSI = S.getCurLambda()) 16007 LSI->markVariableExprAsNonODRUsed(E); 16008 }; 16009 16010 // C++2a [basic.def.odr]p2: 16011 // The set of potential results of an expression e is defined as follows: 16012 switch (E->getStmtClass()) { 16013 // -- If e is an id-expression, ... 16014 case Expr::DeclRefExprClass: { 16015 auto *DRE = cast<DeclRefExpr>(E); 16016 if (DRE->isNonOdrUse() || IsPotentialResultOdrUsed(DRE->getDecl())) 16017 break; 16018 16019 // Rebuild as a non-odr-use DeclRefExpr. 16020 MarkNotOdrUsed(); 16021 return DeclRefExpr::Create( 16022 S.Context, DRE->getQualifierLoc(), DRE->getTemplateKeywordLoc(), 16023 DRE->getDecl(), DRE->refersToEnclosingVariableOrCapture(), 16024 DRE->getNameInfo(), DRE->getType(), DRE->getValueKind(), 16025 DRE->getFoundDecl(), CopiedTemplateArgs(DRE), NOUR); 16026 } 16027 16028 case Expr::FunctionParmPackExprClass: { 16029 auto *FPPE = cast<FunctionParmPackExpr>(E); 16030 // If any of the declarations in the pack is odr-used, then the expression 16031 // as a whole constitutes an odr-use. 16032 for (VarDecl *D : *FPPE) 16033 if (IsPotentialResultOdrUsed(D)) 16034 return ExprEmpty(); 16035 16036 // FIXME: Rebuild as a non-odr-use FunctionParmPackExpr? In practice, 16037 // nothing cares about whether we marked this as an odr-use, but it might 16038 // be useful for non-compiler tools. 16039 MarkNotOdrUsed(); 16040 break; 16041 } 16042 16043 // -- If e is a subscripting operation with an array operand... 16044 case Expr::ArraySubscriptExprClass: { 16045 auto *ASE = cast<ArraySubscriptExpr>(E); 16046 Expr *OldBase = ASE->getBase()->IgnoreImplicit(); 16047 if (!OldBase->getType()->isArrayType()) 16048 break; 16049 ExprResult Base = Rebuild(OldBase); 16050 if (!Base.isUsable()) 16051 return Base; 16052 Expr *LHS = ASE->getBase() == ASE->getLHS() ? Base.get() : ASE->getLHS(); 16053 Expr *RHS = ASE->getBase() == ASE->getRHS() ? Base.get() : ASE->getRHS(); 16054 SourceLocation LBracketLoc = ASE->getBeginLoc(); // FIXME: Not stored. 16055 return S.ActOnArraySubscriptExpr(nullptr, LHS, LBracketLoc, RHS, 16056 ASE->getRBracketLoc()); 16057 } 16058 16059 case Expr::MemberExprClass: { 16060 auto *ME = cast<MemberExpr>(E); 16061 // -- If e is a class member access expression [...] naming a non-static 16062 // data member... 16063 if (isa<FieldDecl>(ME->getMemberDecl())) { 16064 ExprResult Base = Rebuild(ME->getBase()); 16065 if (!Base.isUsable()) 16066 return Base; 16067 return MemberExpr::Create( 16068 S.Context, Base.get(), ME->isArrow(), ME->getOperatorLoc(), 16069 ME->getQualifierLoc(), ME->getTemplateKeywordLoc(), 16070 ME->getMemberDecl(), ME->getFoundDecl(), ME->getMemberNameInfo(), 16071 CopiedTemplateArgs(ME), ME->getType(), ME->getValueKind(), 16072 ME->getObjectKind(), ME->isNonOdrUse()); 16073 } 16074 16075 if (ME->getMemberDecl()->isCXXInstanceMember()) 16076 break; 16077 16078 // -- If e is a class member access expression naming a static data member, 16079 // ... 16080 if (ME->isNonOdrUse() || IsPotentialResultOdrUsed(ME->getMemberDecl())) 16081 break; 16082 16083 // Rebuild as a non-odr-use MemberExpr. 16084 MarkNotOdrUsed(); 16085 return MemberExpr::Create( 16086 S.Context, ME->getBase(), ME->isArrow(), ME->getOperatorLoc(), 16087 ME->getQualifierLoc(), ME->getTemplateKeywordLoc(), ME->getMemberDecl(), 16088 ME->getFoundDecl(), ME->getMemberNameInfo(), CopiedTemplateArgs(ME), 16089 ME->getType(), ME->getValueKind(), ME->getObjectKind(), NOUR); 16090 return ExprEmpty(); 16091 } 16092 16093 case Expr::BinaryOperatorClass: { 16094 auto *BO = cast<BinaryOperator>(E); 16095 Expr *LHS = BO->getLHS(); 16096 Expr *RHS = BO->getRHS(); 16097 // -- If e is a pointer-to-member expression of the form e1 .* e2 ... 16098 if (BO->getOpcode() == BO_PtrMemD) { 16099 ExprResult Sub = Rebuild(LHS); 16100 if (!Sub.isUsable()) 16101 return Sub; 16102 LHS = Sub.get(); 16103 // -- If e is a comma expression, ... 16104 } else if (BO->getOpcode() == BO_Comma) { 16105 ExprResult Sub = Rebuild(RHS); 16106 if (!Sub.isUsable()) 16107 return Sub; 16108 RHS = Sub.get(); 16109 } else { 16110 break; 16111 } 16112 return S.BuildBinOp(nullptr, BO->getOperatorLoc(), BO->getOpcode(), 16113 LHS, RHS); 16114 } 16115 16116 // -- If e has the form (e1)... 16117 case Expr::ParenExprClass: { 16118 auto *PE = cast<ParenExpr>(E); 16119 ExprResult Sub = Rebuild(PE->getSubExpr()); 16120 if (!Sub.isUsable()) 16121 return Sub; 16122 return S.ActOnParenExpr(PE->getLParen(), PE->getRParen(), Sub.get()); 16123 } 16124 16125 // -- If e is a glvalue conditional expression, ... 16126 // We don't apply this to a binary conditional operator. FIXME: Should we? 16127 case Expr::ConditionalOperatorClass: { 16128 auto *CO = cast<ConditionalOperator>(E); 16129 ExprResult LHS = Rebuild(CO->getLHS()); 16130 if (LHS.isInvalid()) 16131 return ExprError(); 16132 ExprResult RHS = Rebuild(CO->getRHS()); 16133 if (RHS.isInvalid()) 16134 return ExprError(); 16135 if (!LHS.isUsable() && !RHS.isUsable()) 16136 return ExprEmpty(); 16137 if (!LHS.isUsable()) 16138 LHS = CO->getLHS(); 16139 if (!RHS.isUsable()) 16140 RHS = CO->getRHS(); 16141 return S.ActOnConditionalOp(CO->getQuestionLoc(), CO->getColonLoc(), 16142 CO->getCond(), LHS.get(), RHS.get()); 16143 } 16144 16145 // [Clang extension] 16146 // -- If e has the form __extension__ e1... 16147 case Expr::UnaryOperatorClass: { 16148 auto *UO = cast<UnaryOperator>(E); 16149 if (UO->getOpcode() != UO_Extension) 16150 break; 16151 ExprResult Sub = Rebuild(UO->getSubExpr()); 16152 if (!Sub.isUsable()) 16153 return Sub; 16154 return S.BuildUnaryOp(nullptr, UO->getOperatorLoc(), UO_Extension, 16155 Sub.get()); 16156 } 16157 16158 // [Clang extension] 16159 // -- If e has the form _Generic(...), the set of potential results is the 16160 // union of the sets of potential results of the associated expressions. 16161 case Expr::GenericSelectionExprClass: { 16162 auto *GSE = cast<GenericSelectionExpr>(E); 16163 16164 SmallVector<Expr *, 4> AssocExprs; 16165 bool AnyChanged = false; 16166 for (Expr *OrigAssocExpr : GSE->getAssocExprs()) { 16167 ExprResult AssocExpr = Rebuild(OrigAssocExpr); 16168 if (AssocExpr.isInvalid()) 16169 return ExprError(); 16170 if (AssocExpr.isUsable()) { 16171 AssocExprs.push_back(AssocExpr.get()); 16172 AnyChanged = true; 16173 } else { 16174 AssocExprs.push_back(OrigAssocExpr); 16175 } 16176 } 16177 16178 return AnyChanged ? S.CreateGenericSelectionExpr( 16179 GSE->getGenericLoc(), GSE->getDefaultLoc(), 16180 GSE->getRParenLoc(), GSE->getControllingExpr(), 16181 GSE->getAssocTypeSourceInfos(), AssocExprs) 16182 : ExprEmpty(); 16183 } 16184 16185 // [Clang extension] 16186 // -- If e has the form __builtin_choose_expr(...), the set of potential 16187 // results is the union of the sets of potential results of the 16188 // second and third subexpressions. 16189 case Expr::ChooseExprClass: { 16190 auto *CE = cast<ChooseExpr>(E); 16191 16192 ExprResult LHS = Rebuild(CE->getLHS()); 16193 if (LHS.isInvalid()) 16194 return ExprError(); 16195 16196 ExprResult RHS = Rebuild(CE->getLHS()); 16197 if (RHS.isInvalid()) 16198 return ExprError(); 16199 16200 if (!LHS.get() && !RHS.get()) 16201 return ExprEmpty(); 16202 if (!LHS.isUsable()) 16203 LHS = CE->getLHS(); 16204 if (!RHS.isUsable()) 16205 RHS = CE->getRHS(); 16206 16207 return S.ActOnChooseExpr(CE->getBuiltinLoc(), CE->getCond(), LHS.get(), 16208 RHS.get(), CE->getRParenLoc()); 16209 } 16210 16211 // Step through non-syntactic nodes. 16212 case Expr::ConstantExprClass: { 16213 auto *CE = cast<ConstantExpr>(E); 16214 ExprResult Sub = Rebuild(CE->getSubExpr()); 16215 if (!Sub.isUsable()) 16216 return Sub; 16217 return ConstantExpr::Create(S.Context, Sub.get()); 16218 } 16219 16220 // We could mostly rely on the recursive rebuilding to rebuild implicit 16221 // casts, but not at the top level, so rebuild them here. 16222 case Expr::ImplicitCastExprClass: { 16223 auto *ICE = cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(E); 16224 // Only step through the narrow set of cast kinds we expect to encounter. 16225 // Anything else suggests we've left the region in which potential results 16226 // can be found. 16227 switch (ICE->getCastKind()) { 16228 case CK_NoOp: 16229 case CK_DerivedToBase: 16230 case CK_UncheckedDerivedToBase: { 16231 ExprResult Sub = Rebuild(ICE->getSubExpr()); 16232 if (!Sub.isUsable()) 16233 return Sub; 16234 CXXCastPath Path(ICE->path()); 16235 return S.ImpCastExprToType(Sub.get(), ICE->getType(), ICE->getCastKind(), 16236 ICE->getValueKind(), &Path); 16237 } 16238 16239 default: 16240 break; 16241 } 16242 break; 16243 } 16244 16245 default: 16246 break; 16247 } 16248 16249 // Can't traverse through this node. Nothing to do. 16250 return ExprEmpty(); 16251 } 16252 16253 ExprResult Sema::CheckLValueToRValueConversionOperand(Expr *E) { 16254 // C++2a [basic.def.odr]p4: 16255 // [...] an expression of non-volatile-qualified non-class type to which 16256 // the lvalue-to-rvalue conversion is applied [...] 16257 if (E->getType().isVolatileQualified() || E->getType()->getAs<RecordType>()) 16258 return E; 16259 16260 ExprResult Result = 16261 rebuildPotentialResultsAsNonOdrUsed(*this, E, NOUR_Constant); 16262 if (Result.isInvalid()) 16263 return ExprError(); 16264 return Result.get() ? Result : E; 16265 } 16266 16267 ExprResult Sema::ActOnConstantExpression(ExprResult Res) { 16268 Res = CorrectDelayedTyposInExpr(Res); 16269 16270 if (!Res.isUsable()) 16271 return Res; 16272 16273 // If a constant-expression is a reference to a variable where we delay 16274 // deciding whether it is an odr-use, just assume we will apply the 16275 // lvalue-to-rvalue conversion. In the one case where this doesn't happen 16276 // (a non-type template argument), we have special handling anyway. 16277 return CheckLValueToRValueConversionOperand(Res.get()); 16278 } 16279 16280 void Sema::CleanupVarDeclMarking() { 16281 // Iterate through a local copy in case MarkVarDeclODRUsed makes a recursive 16282 // call. 16283 MaybeODRUseExprSet LocalMaybeODRUseExprs; 16284 std::swap(LocalMaybeODRUseExprs, MaybeODRUseExprs); 16285 16286 for (Expr *E : LocalMaybeODRUseExprs) { 16287 if (auto *DRE = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(E)) { 16288 MarkVarDeclODRUsed(cast<VarDecl>(DRE->getDecl()), 16289 DRE->getLocation(), *this); 16290 } else if (auto *ME = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(E)) { 16291 MarkVarDeclODRUsed(cast<VarDecl>(ME->getMemberDecl()), ME->getMemberLoc(), 16292 *this); 16293 } else if (auto *FP = dyn_cast<FunctionParmPackExpr>(E)) { 16294 for (VarDecl *VD : *FP) 16295 MarkVarDeclODRUsed(VD, FP->getParameterPackLocation(), *this); 16296 } else { 16297 llvm_unreachable("Unexpected expression"); 16298 } 16299 } 16300 16301 assert(MaybeODRUseExprs.empty() && 16302 "MarkVarDeclODRUsed failed to cleanup MaybeODRUseExprs?"); 16303 } 16304 16305 static void DoMarkVarDeclReferenced(Sema &SemaRef, SourceLocation Loc, 16306 VarDecl *Var, Expr *E) { 16307 assert((!E || isa<DeclRefExpr>(E) || isa<MemberExpr>(E) || 16308 isa<FunctionParmPackExpr>(E)) && 16309 "Invalid Expr argument to DoMarkVarDeclReferenced"); 16310 Var->setReferenced(); 16311 16312 if (Var->isInvalidDecl()) 16313 return; 16314 16315 auto *MSI = Var->getMemberSpecializationInfo(); 16316 TemplateSpecializationKind TSK = MSI ? MSI->getTemplateSpecializationKind() 16317 : Var->getTemplateSpecializationKind(); 16318 16319 OdrUseContext OdrUse = isOdrUseContext(SemaRef); 16320 bool UsableInConstantExpr = 16321 Var->mightBeUsableInConstantExpressions(SemaRef.Context); 16322 16323 // C++20 [expr.const]p12: 16324 // A variable [...] is needed for constant evaluation if it is [...] a 16325 // variable whose name appears as a potentially constant evaluated 16326 // expression that is either a contexpr variable or is of non-volatile 16327 // const-qualified integral type or of reference type 16328 bool NeededForConstantEvaluation = 16329 isPotentiallyConstantEvaluatedContext(SemaRef) && UsableInConstantExpr; 16330 16331 bool NeedDefinition = 16332 OdrUse == OdrUseContext::Used || NeededForConstantEvaluation; 16333 16334 VarTemplateSpecializationDecl *VarSpec = 16335 dyn_cast<VarTemplateSpecializationDecl>(Var); 16336 assert(!isa<VarTemplatePartialSpecializationDecl>(Var) && 16337 "Can't instantiate a partial template specialization."); 16338 16339 // If this might be a member specialization of a static data member, check 16340 // the specialization is visible. We already did the checks for variable 16341 // template specializations when we created them. 16342 if (NeedDefinition && TSK != TSK_Undeclared && 16343 !isa<VarTemplateSpecializationDecl>(Var)) 16344 SemaRef.checkSpecializationVisibility(Loc, Var); 16345 16346 // Perform implicit instantiation of static data members, static data member 16347 // templates of class templates, and variable template specializations. Delay 16348 // instantiations of variable templates, except for those that could be used 16349 // in a constant expression. 16350 if (NeedDefinition && isTemplateInstantiation(TSK)) { 16351 // Per C++17 [temp.explicit]p10, we may instantiate despite an explicit 16352 // instantiation declaration if a variable is usable in a constant 16353 // expression (among other cases). 16354 bool TryInstantiating = 16355 TSK == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation || 16356 (TSK == TSK_ExplicitInstantiationDeclaration && UsableInConstantExpr); 16357 16358 if (TryInstantiating) { 16359 SourceLocation PointOfInstantiation = 16360 MSI ? MSI->getPointOfInstantiation() : Var->getPointOfInstantiation(); 16361 bool FirstInstantiation = PointOfInstantiation.isInvalid(); 16362 if (FirstInstantiation) { 16363 PointOfInstantiation = Loc; 16364 if (MSI) 16365 MSI->setPointOfInstantiation(PointOfInstantiation); 16366 else 16367 Var->setTemplateSpecializationKind(TSK, PointOfInstantiation); 16368 } 16369 16370 bool InstantiationDependent = false; 16371 bool IsNonDependent = 16372 VarSpec ? !TemplateSpecializationType::anyDependentTemplateArguments( 16373 VarSpec->getTemplateArgsInfo(), InstantiationDependent) 16374 : true; 16375 16376 // Do not instantiate specializations that are still type-dependent. 16377 if (IsNonDependent) { 16378 if (UsableInConstantExpr) { 16379 // Do not defer instantiations of variables that could be used in a 16380 // constant expression. 16381 SemaRef.InstantiateVariableDefinition(PointOfInstantiation, Var); 16382 } else if (FirstInstantiation || 16383 isa<VarTemplateSpecializationDecl>(Var)) { 16384 // FIXME: For a specialization of a variable template, we don't 16385 // distinguish between "declaration and type implicitly instantiated" 16386 // and "implicit instantiation of definition requested", so we have 16387 // no direct way to avoid enqueueing the pending instantiation 16388 // multiple times. 16389 SemaRef.PendingInstantiations 16390 .push_back(std::make_pair(Var, PointOfInstantiation)); 16391 } 16392 } 16393 } 16394 } 16395 16396 // C++2a [basic.def.odr]p4: 16397 // A variable x whose name appears as a potentially-evaluated expression e 16398 // is odr-used by e unless 16399 // -- x is a reference that is usable in constant expressions 16400 // -- x is a variable of non-reference type that is usable in constant 16401 // expressions and has no mutable subobjects [FIXME], and e is an 16402 // element of the set of potential results of an expression of 16403 // non-volatile-qualified non-class type to which the lvalue-to-rvalue 16404 // conversion is applied 16405 // -- x is a variable of non-reference type, and e is an element of the set 16406 // of potential results of a discarded-value expression to which the 16407 // lvalue-to-rvalue conversion is not applied [FIXME] 16408 // 16409 // We check the first part of the second bullet here, and 16410 // Sema::CheckLValueToRValueConversionOperand deals with the second part. 16411 // FIXME: To get the third bullet right, we need to delay this even for 16412 // variables that are not usable in constant expressions. 16413 16414 // If we already know this isn't an odr-use, there's nothing more to do. 16415 if (DeclRefExpr *DRE = dyn_cast_or_null<DeclRefExpr>(E)) 16416 if (DRE->isNonOdrUse()) 16417 return; 16418 if (MemberExpr *ME = dyn_cast_or_null<MemberExpr>(E)) 16419 if (ME->isNonOdrUse()) 16420 return; 16421 16422 switch (OdrUse) { 16423 case OdrUseContext::None: 16424 assert((!E || isa<FunctionParmPackExpr>(E)) && 16425 "missing non-odr-use marking for unevaluated decl ref"); 16426 break; 16427 16428 case OdrUseContext::FormallyOdrUsed: 16429 // FIXME: Ignoring formal odr-uses results in incorrect lambda capture 16430 // behavior. 16431 break; 16432 16433 case OdrUseContext::Used: 16434 // If we might later find that this expression isn't actually an odr-use, 16435 // delay the marking. 16436 if (E && Var->isUsableInConstantExpressions(SemaRef.Context)) 16437 SemaRef.MaybeODRUseExprs.insert(E); 16438 else 16439 MarkVarDeclODRUsed(Var, Loc, SemaRef); 16440 break; 16441 16442 case OdrUseContext::Dependent: 16443 // If this is a dependent context, we don't need to mark variables as 16444 // odr-used, but we may still need to track them for lambda capture. 16445 // FIXME: Do we also need to do this inside dependent typeid expressions 16446 // (which are modeled as unevaluated at this point)? 16447 const bool RefersToEnclosingScope = 16448 (SemaRef.CurContext != Var->getDeclContext() && 16449 Var->getDeclContext()->isFunctionOrMethod() && Var->hasLocalStorage()); 16450 if (RefersToEnclosingScope) { 16451 LambdaScopeInfo *const LSI = 16452 SemaRef.getCurLambda(/*IgnoreNonLambdaCapturingScope=*/true); 16453 if (LSI && (!LSI->CallOperator || 16454 !LSI->CallOperator->Encloses(Var->getDeclContext()))) { 16455 // If a variable could potentially be odr-used, defer marking it so 16456 // until we finish analyzing the full expression for any 16457 // lvalue-to-rvalue 16458 // or discarded value conversions that would obviate odr-use. 16459 // Add it to the list of potential captures that will be analyzed 16460 // later (ActOnFinishFullExpr) for eventual capture and odr-use marking 16461 // unless the variable is a reference that was initialized by a constant 16462 // expression (this will never need to be captured or odr-used). 16463 // 16464 // FIXME: We can simplify this a lot after implementing P0588R1. 16465 assert(E && "Capture variable should be used in an expression."); 16466 if (!Var->getType()->isReferenceType() || 16467 !Var->isUsableInConstantExpressions(SemaRef.Context)) 16468 LSI->addPotentialCapture(E->IgnoreParens()); 16469 } 16470 } 16471 break; 16472 } 16473 } 16474 16475 /// Mark a variable referenced, and check whether it is odr-used 16476 /// (C++ [basic.def.odr]p2, C99 6.9p3). Note that this should not be 16477 /// used directly for normal expressions referring to VarDecl. 16478 void Sema::MarkVariableReferenced(SourceLocation Loc, VarDecl *Var) { 16479 DoMarkVarDeclReferenced(*this, Loc, Var, nullptr); 16480 } 16481 16482 static void MarkExprReferenced(Sema &SemaRef, SourceLocation Loc, 16483 Decl *D, Expr *E, bool MightBeOdrUse) { 16484 if (SemaRef.isInOpenMPDeclareTargetContext()) 16485 SemaRef.checkDeclIsAllowedInOpenMPTarget(E, D); 16486 16487 if (VarDecl *Var = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) { 16488 DoMarkVarDeclReferenced(SemaRef, Loc, Var, E); 16489 return; 16490 } 16491 16492 SemaRef.MarkAnyDeclReferenced(Loc, D, MightBeOdrUse); 16493 16494 // If this is a call to a method via a cast, also mark the method in the 16495 // derived class used in case codegen can devirtualize the call. 16496 const MemberExpr *ME = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(E); 16497 if (!ME) 16498 return; 16499 CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(ME->getMemberDecl()); 16500 if (!MD) 16501 return; 16502 // Only attempt to devirtualize if this is truly a virtual call. 16503 bool IsVirtualCall = MD->isVirtual() && 16504 ME->performsVirtualDispatch(SemaRef.getLangOpts()); 16505 if (!IsVirtualCall) 16506 return; 16507 16508 // If it's possible to devirtualize the call, mark the called function 16509 // referenced. 16510 CXXMethodDecl *DM = MD->getDevirtualizedMethod( 16511 ME->getBase(), SemaRef.getLangOpts().AppleKext); 16512 if (DM) 16513 SemaRef.MarkAnyDeclReferenced(Loc, DM, MightBeOdrUse); 16514 } 16515 16516 /// Perform reference-marking and odr-use handling for a DeclRefExpr. 16517 void Sema::MarkDeclRefReferenced(DeclRefExpr *E, const Expr *Base) { 16518 // TODO: update this with DR# once a defect report is filed. 16519 // C++11 defect. The address of a pure member should not be an ODR use, even 16520 // if it's a qualified reference. 16521 bool OdrUse = true; 16522 if (const CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(E->getDecl())) 16523 if (Method->isVirtual() && 16524 !Method->getDevirtualizedMethod(Base, getLangOpts().AppleKext)) 16525 OdrUse = false; 16526 MarkExprReferenced(*this, E->getLocation(), E->getDecl(), E, OdrUse); 16527 } 16528 16529 /// Perform reference-marking and odr-use handling for a MemberExpr. 16530 void Sema::MarkMemberReferenced(MemberExpr *E) { 16531 // C++11 [basic.def.odr]p2: 16532 // A non-overloaded function whose name appears as a potentially-evaluated 16533 // expression or a member of a set of candidate functions, if selected by 16534 // overload resolution when referred to from a potentially-evaluated 16535 // expression, is odr-used, unless it is a pure virtual function and its 16536 // name is not explicitly qualified. 16537 bool MightBeOdrUse = true; 16538 if (E->performsVirtualDispatch(getLangOpts())) { 16539 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(E->getMemberDecl())) 16540 if (Method->isPure()) 16541 MightBeOdrUse = false; 16542 } 16543 SourceLocation Loc = 16544 E->getMemberLoc().isValid() ? E->getMemberLoc() : E->getBeginLoc(); 16545 MarkExprReferenced(*this, Loc, E->getMemberDecl(), E, MightBeOdrUse); 16546 } 16547 16548 /// Perform reference-marking and odr-use handling for a FunctionParmPackExpr. 16549 void Sema::MarkFunctionParmPackReferenced(FunctionParmPackExpr *E) { 16550 for (VarDecl *VD : *E) 16551 MarkExprReferenced(*this, E->getParameterPackLocation(), VD, E, true); 16552 } 16553 16554 /// Perform marking for a reference to an arbitrary declaration. It 16555 /// marks the declaration referenced, and performs odr-use checking for 16556 /// functions and variables. This method should not be used when building a 16557 /// normal expression which refers to a variable. 16558 void Sema::MarkAnyDeclReferenced(SourceLocation Loc, Decl *D, 16559 bool MightBeOdrUse) { 16560 if (MightBeOdrUse) { 16561 if (auto *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) { 16562 MarkVariableReferenced(Loc, VD); 16563 return; 16564 } 16565 } 16566 if (auto *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) { 16567 MarkFunctionReferenced(Loc, FD, MightBeOdrUse); 16568 return; 16569 } 16570 D->setReferenced(); 16571 } 16572 16573 namespace { 16574 // Mark all of the declarations used by a type as referenced. 16575 // FIXME: Not fully implemented yet! We need to have a better understanding 16576 // of when we're entering a context we should not recurse into. 16577 // FIXME: This is and EvaluatedExprMarker are more-or-less equivalent to 16578 // TreeTransforms rebuilding the type in a new context. Rather than 16579 // duplicating the TreeTransform logic, we should consider reusing it here. 16580 // Currently that causes problems when rebuilding LambdaExprs. 16581 class MarkReferencedDecls : public RecursiveASTVisitor<MarkReferencedDecls> { 16582 Sema &S; 16583 SourceLocation Loc; 16584 16585 public: 16586 typedef RecursiveASTVisitor<MarkReferencedDecls> Inherited; 16587 16588 MarkReferencedDecls(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc) : S(S), Loc(Loc) { } 16589 16590 bool TraverseTemplateArgument(const TemplateArgument &Arg); 16591 }; 16592 } 16593 16594 bool MarkReferencedDecls::TraverseTemplateArgument( 16595 const TemplateArgument &Arg) { 16596 { 16597 // A non-type template argument is a constant-evaluated context. 16598 EnterExpressionEvaluationContext Evaluated( 16599 S, Sema::ExpressionEvaluationContext::ConstantEvaluated); 16600 if (Arg.getKind() == TemplateArgument::Declaration) { 16601 if (Decl *D = Arg.getAsDecl()) 16602 S.MarkAnyDeclReferenced(Loc, D, true); 16603 } else if (Arg.getKind() == TemplateArgument::Expression) { 16604 S.MarkDeclarationsReferencedInExpr(Arg.getAsExpr(), false); 16605 } 16606 } 16607 16608 return Inherited::TraverseTemplateArgument(Arg); 16609 } 16610 16611 void Sema::MarkDeclarationsReferencedInType(SourceLocation Loc, QualType T) { 16612 MarkReferencedDecls Marker(*this, Loc); 16613 Marker.TraverseType(T); 16614 } 16615 16616 namespace { 16617 /// Helper class that marks all of the declarations referenced by 16618 /// potentially-evaluated subexpressions as "referenced". 16619 class EvaluatedExprMarker : public EvaluatedExprVisitor<EvaluatedExprMarker> { 16620 Sema &S; 16621 bool SkipLocalVariables; 16622 16623 public: 16624 typedef EvaluatedExprVisitor<EvaluatedExprMarker> Inherited; 16625 16626 EvaluatedExprMarker(Sema &S, bool SkipLocalVariables) 16627 : Inherited(S.Context), S(S), SkipLocalVariables(SkipLocalVariables) { } 16628 16629 void VisitDeclRefExpr(DeclRefExpr *E) { 16630 // If we were asked not to visit local variables, don't. 16631 if (SkipLocalVariables) { 16632 if (VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(E->getDecl())) 16633 if (VD->hasLocalStorage()) 16634 return; 16635 } 16636 16637 S.MarkDeclRefReferenced(E); 16638 } 16639 16640 void VisitMemberExpr(MemberExpr *E) { 16641 S.MarkMemberReferenced(E); 16642 Inherited::VisitMemberExpr(E); 16643 } 16644 16645 void VisitCXXBindTemporaryExpr(CXXBindTemporaryExpr *E) { 16646 S.MarkFunctionReferenced( 16647 E->getBeginLoc(), 16648 const_cast<CXXDestructorDecl *>(E->getTemporary()->getDestructor())); 16649 Visit(E->getSubExpr()); 16650 } 16651 16652 void VisitCXXNewExpr(CXXNewExpr *E) { 16653 if (E->getOperatorNew()) 16654 S.MarkFunctionReferenced(E->getBeginLoc(), E->getOperatorNew()); 16655 if (E->getOperatorDelete()) 16656 S.MarkFunctionReferenced(E->getBeginLoc(), E->getOperatorDelete()); 16657 Inherited::VisitCXXNewExpr(E); 16658 } 16659 16660 void VisitCXXDeleteExpr(CXXDeleteExpr *E) { 16661 if (E->getOperatorDelete()) 16662 S.MarkFunctionReferenced(E->getBeginLoc(), E->getOperatorDelete()); 16663 QualType Destroyed = S.Context.getBaseElementType(E->getDestroyedType()); 16664 if (const RecordType *DestroyedRec = Destroyed->getAs<RecordType>()) { 16665 CXXRecordDecl *Record = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(DestroyedRec->getDecl()); 16666 S.MarkFunctionReferenced(E->getBeginLoc(), S.LookupDestructor(Record)); 16667 } 16668 16669 Inherited::VisitCXXDeleteExpr(E); 16670 } 16671 16672 void VisitCXXConstructExpr(CXXConstructExpr *E) { 16673 S.MarkFunctionReferenced(E->getBeginLoc(), E->getConstructor()); 16674 Inherited::VisitCXXConstructExpr(E); 16675 } 16676 16677 void VisitCXXDefaultArgExpr(CXXDefaultArgExpr *E) { 16678 Visit(E->getExpr()); 16679 } 16680 }; 16681 } 16682 16683 /// Mark any declarations that appear within this expression or any 16684 /// potentially-evaluated subexpressions as "referenced". 16685 /// 16686 /// \param SkipLocalVariables If true, don't mark local variables as 16687 /// 'referenced'. 16688 void Sema::MarkDeclarationsReferencedInExpr(Expr *E, 16689 bool SkipLocalVariables) { 16690 EvaluatedExprMarker(*this, SkipLocalVariables).Visit(E); 16691 } 16692 16693 /// Emit a diagnostic that describes an effect on the run-time behavior 16694 /// of the program being compiled. 16695 /// 16696 /// This routine emits the given diagnostic when the code currently being 16697 /// type-checked is "potentially evaluated", meaning that there is a 16698 /// possibility that the code will actually be executable. Code in sizeof() 16699 /// expressions, code used only during overload resolution, etc., are not 16700 /// potentially evaluated. This routine will suppress such diagnostics or, 16701 /// in the absolutely nutty case of potentially potentially evaluated 16702 /// expressions (C++ typeid), queue the diagnostic to potentially emit it 16703 /// later. 16704 /// 16705 /// This routine should be used for all diagnostics that describe the run-time 16706 /// behavior of a program, such as passing a non-POD value through an ellipsis. 16707 /// Failure to do so will likely result in spurious diagnostics or failures 16708 /// during overload resolution or within sizeof/alignof/typeof/typeid. 16709 bool Sema::DiagRuntimeBehavior(SourceLocation Loc, ArrayRef<const Stmt*> Stmts, 16710 const PartialDiagnostic &PD) { 16711 switch (ExprEvalContexts.back().Context) { 16712 case ExpressionEvaluationContext::Unevaluated: 16713 case ExpressionEvaluationContext::UnevaluatedList: 16714 case ExpressionEvaluationContext::UnevaluatedAbstract: 16715 case ExpressionEvaluationContext::DiscardedStatement: 16716 // The argument will never be evaluated, so don't complain. 16717 break; 16718 16719 case ExpressionEvaluationContext::ConstantEvaluated: 16720 // Relevant diagnostics should be produced by constant evaluation. 16721 break; 16722 16723 case ExpressionEvaluationContext::PotentiallyEvaluated: 16724 case ExpressionEvaluationContext::PotentiallyEvaluatedIfUsed: 16725 if (!Stmts.empty() && getCurFunctionOrMethodDecl()) { 16726 FunctionScopes.back()->PossiblyUnreachableDiags. 16727 push_back(sema::PossiblyUnreachableDiag(PD, Loc, Stmts)); 16728 return true; 16729 } 16730 16731 // The initializer of a constexpr variable or of the first declaration of a 16732 // static data member is not syntactically a constant evaluated constant, 16733 // but nonetheless is always required to be a constant expression, so we 16734 // can skip diagnosing. 16735 // FIXME: Using the mangling context here is a hack. 16736 if (auto *VD = dyn_cast_or_null<VarDecl>( 16737 ExprEvalContexts.back().ManglingContextDecl)) { 16738 if (VD->isConstexpr() || 16739 (VD->isStaticDataMember() && VD->isFirstDecl() && !VD->isInline())) 16740 break; 16741 // FIXME: For any other kind of variable, we should build a CFG for its 16742 // initializer and check whether the context in question is reachable. 16743 } 16744 16745 Diag(Loc, PD); 16746 return true; 16747 } 16748 16749 return false; 16750 } 16751 16752 bool Sema::DiagRuntimeBehavior(SourceLocation Loc, const Stmt *Statement, 16753 const PartialDiagnostic &PD) { 16754 return DiagRuntimeBehavior( 16755 Loc, Statement ? llvm::makeArrayRef(Statement) : llvm::None, PD); 16756 } 16757 16758 bool Sema::CheckCallReturnType(QualType ReturnType, SourceLocation Loc, 16759 CallExpr *CE, FunctionDecl *FD) { 16760 if (ReturnType->isVoidType() || !ReturnType->isIncompleteType()) 16761 return false; 16762 16763 // If we're inside a decltype's expression, don't check for a valid return 16764 // type or construct temporaries until we know whether this is the last call. 16765 if (ExprEvalContexts.back().ExprContext == 16766 ExpressionEvaluationContextRecord::EK_Decltype) { 16767 ExprEvalContexts.back().DelayedDecltypeCalls.push_back(CE); 16768 return false; 16769 } 16770 16771 class CallReturnIncompleteDiagnoser : public TypeDiagnoser { 16772 FunctionDecl *FD; 16773 CallExpr *CE; 16774 16775 public: 16776 CallReturnIncompleteDiagnoser(FunctionDecl *FD, CallExpr *CE) 16777 : FD(FD), CE(CE) { } 16778 16779 void diagnose(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, QualType T) override { 16780 if (!FD) { 16781 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_call_incomplete_return) 16782 << T << CE->getSourceRange(); 16783 return; 16784 } 16785 16786 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_call_function_incomplete_return) 16787 << CE->getSourceRange() << FD->getDeclName() << T; 16788 S.Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::note_entity_declared_at) 16789 << FD->getDeclName(); 16790 } 16791 } Diagnoser(FD, CE); 16792 16793 if (RequireCompleteType(Loc, ReturnType, Diagnoser)) 16794 return true; 16795 16796 return false; 16797 } 16798 16799 // Diagnose the s/=/==/ and s/\|=/!=/ typos. Note that adding parentheses 16800 // will prevent this condition from triggering, which is what we want. 16801 void Sema::DiagnoseAssignmentAsCondition(Expr *E) { 16802 SourceLocation Loc; 16803 16804 unsigned diagnostic = diag::warn_condition_is_assignment; 16805 bool IsOrAssign = false; 16806 16807 if (BinaryOperator *Op = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(E)) { 16808 if (Op->getOpcode() != BO_Assign && Op->getOpcode() != BO_OrAssign) 16809 return; 16810 16811 IsOrAssign = Op->getOpcode() == BO_OrAssign; 16812 16813 // Greylist some idioms by putting them into a warning subcategory. 16814 if (ObjCMessageExpr *ME 16815 = dyn_cast<ObjCMessageExpr>(Op->getRHS()->IgnoreParenCasts())) { 16816 Selector Sel = ME->getSelector(); 16817 16818 // self = [<foo> init...] 16819 if (isSelfExpr(Op->getLHS()) && ME->getMethodFamily() == OMF_init) 16820 diagnostic = diag::warn_condition_is_idiomatic_assignment; 16821 16822 // <foo> = [<bar> nextObject] 16823 else if (Sel.isUnarySelector() && Sel.getNameForSlot(0) == "nextObject") 16824 diagnostic = diag::warn_condition_is_idiomatic_assignment; 16825 } 16826 16827 Loc = Op->getOperatorLoc(); 16828 } else if (CXXOperatorCallExpr *Op = dyn_cast<CXXOperatorCallExpr>(E)) { 16829 if (Op->getOperator() != OO_Equal && Op->getOperator() != OO_PipeEqual) 16830 return; 16831 16832 IsOrAssign = Op->getOperator() == OO_PipeEqual; 16833 Loc = Op->getOperatorLoc(); 16834 } else if (PseudoObjectExpr *POE = dyn_cast<PseudoObjectExpr>(E)) 16835 return DiagnoseAssignmentAsCondition(POE->getSyntacticForm()); 16836 else { 16837 // Not an assignment. 16838 return; 16839 } 16840 16841 Diag(Loc, diagnostic) << E->getSourceRange(); 16842 16843 SourceLocation Open = E->getBeginLoc(); 16844 SourceLocation Close = getLocForEndOfToken(E->getSourceRange().getEnd()); 16845 Diag(Loc, diag::note_condition_assign_silence) 16846 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(Open, "(") 16847 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(Close, ")"); 16848 16849 if (IsOrAssign) 16850 Diag(Loc, diag::note_condition_or_assign_to_comparison) 16851 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(Loc, "!="); 16852 else 16853 Diag(Loc, diag::note_condition_assign_to_comparison) 16854 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(Loc, "=="); 16855 } 16856 16857 /// Redundant parentheses over an equality comparison can indicate 16858 /// that the user intended an assignment used as condition. 16859 void Sema::DiagnoseEqualityWithExtraParens(ParenExpr *ParenE) { 16860 // Don't warn if the parens came from a macro. 16861 SourceLocation parenLoc = ParenE->getBeginLoc(); 16862 if (parenLoc.isInvalid() || parenLoc.isMacroID()) 16863 return; 16864 // Don't warn for dependent expressions. 16865 if (ParenE->isTypeDependent()) 16866 return; 16867 16868 Expr *E = ParenE->IgnoreParens(); 16869 16870 if (BinaryOperator *opE = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(E)) 16871 if (opE->getOpcode() == BO_EQ && 16872 opE->getLHS()->IgnoreParenImpCasts()->isModifiableLvalue(Context) 16873 == Expr::MLV_Valid) { 16874 SourceLocation Loc = opE->getOperatorLoc(); 16875 16876 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_equality_with_extra_parens) << E->getSourceRange(); 16877 SourceRange ParenERange = ParenE->getSourceRange(); 16878 Diag(Loc, diag::note_equality_comparison_silence) 16879 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(ParenERange.getBegin()) 16880 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(ParenERange.getEnd()); 16881 Diag(Loc, diag::note_equality_comparison_to_assign) 16882 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(Loc, "="); 16883 } 16884 } 16885 16886 ExprResult Sema::CheckBooleanCondition(SourceLocation Loc, Expr *E, 16887 bool IsConstexpr) { 16888 DiagnoseAssignmentAsCondition(E); 16889 if (ParenExpr *parenE = dyn_cast<ParenExpr>(E)) 16890 DiagnoseEqualityWithExtraParens(parenE); 16891 16892 ExprResult result = CheckPlaceholderExpr(E); 16893 if (result.isInvalid()) return ExprError(); 16894 E = result.get(); 16895 16896 if (!E->isTypeDependent()) { 16897 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) 16898 return CheckCXXBooleanCondition(E, IsConstexpr); // C++ 6.4p4 16899 16900 ExprResult ERes = DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(E); 16901 if (ERes.isInvalid()) 16902 return ExprError(); 16903 E = ERes.get(); 16904 16905 QualType T = E->getType(); 16906 if (!T->isScalarType()) { // C99 6.8.4.1p1 16907 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_statement_requires_scalar) 16908 << T << E->getSourceRange(); 16909 return ExprError(); 16910 } 16911 CheckBoolLikeConversion(E, Loc); 16912 } 16913 16914 return E; 16915 } 16916 16917 Sema::ConditionResult Sema::ActOnCondition(Scope *S, SourceLocation Loc, 16918 Expr *SubExpr, ConditionKind CK) { 16919 // Empty conditions are valid in for-statements. 16920 if (!SubExpr) 16921 return ConditionResult(); 16922 16923 ExprResult Cond; 16924 switch (CK) { 16925 case ConditionKind::Boolean: 16926 Cond = CheckBooleanCondition(Loc, SubExpr); 16927 break; 16928 16929 case ConditionKind::ConstexprIf: 16930 Cond = CheckBooleanCondition(Loc, SubExpr, true); 16931 break; 16932 16933 case ConditionKind::Switch: 16934 Cond = CheckSwitchCondition(Loc, SubExpr); 16935 break; 16936 } 16937 if (Cond.isInvalid()) 16938 return ConditionError(); 16939 16940 // FIXME: FullExprArg doesn't have an invalid bit, so check nullness instead. 16941 FullExprArg FullExpr = MakeFullExpr(Cond.get(), Loc); 16942 if (!FullExpr.get()) 16943 return ConditionError(); 16944 16945 return ConditionResult(*this, nullptr, FullExpr, 16946 CK == ConditionKind::ConstexprIf); 16947 } 16948 16949 namespace { 16950 /// A visitor for rebuilding a call to an __unknown_any expression 16951 /// to have an appropriate type. 16952 struct RebuildUnknownAnyFunction 16953 : StmtVisitor<RebuildUnknownAnyFunction, ExprResult> { 16954 16955 Sema &S; 16956 16957 RebuildUnknownAnyFunction(Sema &S) : S(S) {} 16958 16959 ExprResult VisitStmt(Stmt *S) { 16960 llvm_unreachable("unexpected statement!"); 16961 } 16962 16963 ExprResult VisitExpr(Expr *E) { 16964 S.Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_unsupported_unknown_any_call) 16965 << E->getSourceRange(); 16966 return ExprError(); 16967 } 16968 16969 /// Rebuild an expression which simply semantically wraps another 16970 /// expression which it shares the type and value kind of. 16971 template <class T> ExprResult rebuildSugarExpr(T *E) { 16972 ExprResult SubResult = Visit(E->getSubExpr()); 16973 if (SubResult.isInvalid()) return ExprError(); 16974 16975 Expr *SubExpr = SubResult.get(); 16976 E->setSubExpr(SubExpr); 16977 E->setType(SubExpr->getType()); 16978 E->setValueKind(SubExpr->getValueKind()); 16979 assert(E->getObjectKind() == OK_Ordinary); 16980 return E; 16981 } 16982 16983 ExprResult VisitParenExpr(ParenExpr *E) { 16984 return rebuildSugarExpr(E); 16985 } 16986 16987 ExprResult VisitUnaryExtension(UnaryOperator *E) { 16988 return rebuildSugarExpr(E); 16989 } 16990 16991 ExprResult VisitUnaryAddrOf(UnaryOperator *E) { 16992 ExprResult SubResult = Visit(E->getSubExpr()); 16993 if (SubResult.isInvalid()) return ExprError(); 16994 16995 Expr *SubExpr = SubResult.get(); 16996 E->setSubExpr(SubExpr); 16997 E->setType(S.Context.getPointerType(SubExpr->getType())); 16998 assert(E->getValueKind() == VK_RValue); 16999 assert(E->getObjectKind() == OK_Ordinary); 17000 return E; 17001 } 17002 17003 ExprResult resolveDecl(Expr *E, ValueDecl *VD) { 17004 if (!isa<FunctionDecl>(VD)) return VisitExpr(E); 17005 17006 E->setType(VD->getType()); 17007 17008 assert(E->getValueKind() == VK_RValue); 17009 if (S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && 17010 !(isa<CXXMethodDecl>(VD) && 17011 cast<CXXMethodDecl>(VD)->isInstance())) 17012 E->setValueKind(VK_LValue); 17013 17014 return E; 17015 } 17016 17017 ExprResult VisitMemberExpr(MemberExpr *E) { 17018 return resolveDecl(E, E->getMemberDecl()); 17019 } 17020 17021 ExprResult VisitDeclRefExpr(DeclRefExpr *E) { 17022 return resolveDecl(E, E->getDecl()); 17023 } 17024 }; 17025 } 17026 17027 /// Given a function expression of unknown-any type, try to rebuild it 17028 /// to have a function type. 17029 static ExprResult rebuildUnknownAnyFunction(Sema &S, Expr *FunctionExpr) { 17030 ExprResult Result = RebuildUnknownAnyFunction(S).Visit(FunctionExpr); 17031 if (Result.isInvalid()) return ExprError(); 17032 return S.DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(Result.get()); 17033 } 17034 17035 namespace { 17036 /// A visitor for rebuilding an expression of type __unknown_anytype 17037 /// into one which resolves the type directly on the referring 17038 /// expression. Strict preservation of the original source 17039 /// structure is not a goal. 17040 struct RebuildUnknownAnyExpr 17041 : StmtVisitor<RebuildUnknownAnyExpr, ExprResult> { 17042 17043 Sema &S; 17044 17045 /// The current destination type. 17046 QualType DestType; 17047 17048 RebuildUnknownAnyExpr(Sema &S, QualType CastType) 17049 : S(S), DestType(CastType) {} 17050 17051 ExprResult VisitStmt(Stmt *S) { 17052 llvm_unreachable("unexpected statement!"); 17053 } 17054 17055 ExprResult VisitExpr(Expr *E) { 17056 S.Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_unsupported_unknown_any_expr) 17057 << E->getSourceRange(); 17058 return ExprError(); 17059 } 17060 17061 ExprResult VisitCallExpr(CallExpr *E); 17062 ExprResult VisitObjCMessageExpr(ObjCMessageExpr *E); 17063 17064 /// Rebuild an expression which simply semantically wraps another 17065 /// expression which it shares the type and value kind of. 17066 template <class T> ExprResult rebuildSugarExpr(T *E) { 17067 ExprResult SubResult = Visit(E->getSubExpr()); 17068 if (SubResult.isInvalid()) return ExprError(); 17069 Expr *SubExpr = SubResult.get(); 17070 E->setSubExpr(SubExpr); 17071 E->setType(SubExpr->getType()); 17072 E->setValueKind(SubExpr->getValueKind()); 17073 assert(E->getObjectKind() == OK_Ordinary); 17074 return E; 17075 } 17076 17077 ExprResult VisitParenExpr(ParenExpr *E) { 17078 return rebuildSugarExpr(E); 17079 } 17080 17081 ExprResult VisitUnaryExtension(UnaryOperator *E) { 17082 return rebuildSugarExpr(E); 17083 } 17084 17085 ExprResult VisitUnaryAddrOf(UnaryOperator *E) { 17086 const PointerType *Ptr = DestType->getAs<PointerType>(); 17087 if (!Ptr) { 17088 S.Diag(E->getOperatorLoc(), diag::err_unknown_any_addrof) 17089 << E->getSourceRange(); 17090 return ExprError(); 17091 } 17092 17093 if (isa<CallExpr>(E->getSubExpr())) { 17094 S.Diag(E->getOperatorLoc(), diag::err_unknown_any_addrof_call) 17095 << E->getSourceRange(); 17096 return ExprError(); 17097 } 17098 17099 assert(E->getValueKind() == VK_RValue); 17100 assert(E->getObjectKind() == OK_Ordinary); 17101 E->setType(DestType); 17102 17103 // Build the sub-expression as if it were an object of the pointee type. 17104 DestType = Ptr->getPointeeType(); 17105 ExprResult SubResult = Visit(E->getSubExpr()); 17106 if (SubResult.isInvalid()) return ExprError(); 17107 E->setSubExpr(SubResult.get()); 17108 return E; 17109 } 17110 17111 ExprResult VisitImplicitCastExpr(ImplicitCastExpr *E); 17112 17113 ExprResult resolveDecl(Expr *E, ValueDecl *VD); 17114 17115 ExprResult VisitMemberExpr(MemberExpr *E) { 17116 return resolveDecl(E, E->getMemberDecl()); 17117 } 17118 17119 ExprResult VisitDeclRefExpr(DeclRefExpr *E) { 17120 return resolveDecl(E, E->getDecl()); 17121 } 17122 }; 17123 } 17124 17125 /// Rebuilds a call expression which yielded __unknown_anytype. 17126 ExprResult RebuildUnknownAnyExpr::VisitCallExpr(CallExpr *E) { 17127 Expr *CalleeExpr = E->getCallee(); 17128 17129 enum FnKind { 17130 FK_MemberFunction, 17131 FK_FunctionPointer, 17132 FK_BlockPointer 17133 }; 17134 17135 FnKind Kind; 17136 QualType CalleeType = CalleeExpr->getType(); 17137 if (CalleeType == S.Context.BoundMemberTy) { 17138 assert(isa<CXXMemberCallExpr>(E) || isa<CXXOperatorCallExpr>(E)); 17139 Kind = FK_MemberFunction; 17140 CalleeType = Expr::findBoundMemberType(CalleeExpr); 17141 } else if (const PointerType *Ptr = CalleeType->getAs<PointerType>()) { 17142 CalleeType = Ptr->getPointeeType(); 17143 Kind = FK_FunctionPointer; 17144 } else { 17145 CalleeType = CalleeType->castAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType(); 17146 Kind = FK_BlockPointer; 17147 } 17148 const FunctionType *FnType = CalleeType->castAs<FunctionType>(); 17149 17150 // Verify that this is a legal result type of a function. 17151 if (DestType->isArrayType() || DestType->isFunctionType()) { 17152 unsigned diagID = diag::err_func_returning_array_function; 17153 if (Kind == FK_BlockPointer) 17154 diagID = diag::err_block_returning_array_function; 17155 17156 S.Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diagID) 17157 << DestType->isFunctionType() << DestType; 17158 return ExprError(); 17159 } 17160 17161 // Otherwise, go ahead and set DestType as the call's result. 17162 E->setType(DestType.getNonLValueExprType(S.Context)); 17163 E->setValueKind(Expr::getValueKindForType(DestType)); 17164 assert(E->getObjectKind() == OK_Ordinary); 17165 17166 // Rebuild the function type, replacing the result type with DestType. 17167 const FunctionProtoType *Proto = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(FnType); 17168 if (Proto) { 17169 // __unknown_anytype(...) is a special case used by the debugger when 17170 // it has no idea what a function's signature is. 17171 // 17172 // We want to build this call essentially under the K&R 17173 // unprototyped rules, but making a FunctionNoProtoType in C++ 17174 // would foul up all sorts of assumptions. However, we cannot 17175 // simply pass all arguments as variadic arguments, nor can we 17176 // portably just call the function under a non-variadic type; see 17177 // the comment on IR-gen's TargetInfo::isNoProtoCallVariadic. 17178 // However, it turns out that in practice it is generally safe to 17179 // call a function declared as "A foo(B,C,D);" under the prototype 17180 // "A foo(B,C,D,...);". The only known exception is with the 17181 // Windows ABI, where any variadic function is implicitly cdecl 17182 // regardless of its normal CC. Therefore we change the parameter 17183 // types to match the types of the arguments. 17184 // 17185 // This is a hack, but it is far superior to moving the 17186 // corresponding target-specific code from IR-gen to Sema/AST. 17187 17188 ArrayRef<QualType> ParamTypes = Proto->getParamTypes(); 17189 SmallVector<QualType, 8> ArgTypes; 17190 if (ParamTypes.empty() && Proto->isVariadic()) { // the special case 17191 ArgTypes.reserve(E->getNumArgs()); 17192 for (unsigned i = 0, e = E->getNumArgs(); i != e; ++i) { 17193 Expr *Arg = E->getArg(i); 17194 QualType ArgType = Arg->getType(); 17195 if (E->isLValue()) { 17196 ArgType = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(ArgType); 17197 } else if (E->isXValue()) { 17198 ArgType = S.Context.getRValueReferenceType(ArgType); 17199 } 17200 ArgTypes.push_back(ArgType); 17201 } 17202 ParamTypes = ArgTypes; 17203 } 17204 DestType = S.Context.getFunctionType(DestType, ParamTypes, 17205 Proto->getExtProtoInfo()); 17206 } else { 17207 DestType = S.Context.getFunctionNoProtoType(DestType, 17208 FnType->getExtInfo()); 17209 } 17210 17211 // Rebuild the appropriate pointer-to-function type. 17212 switch (Kind) { 17213 case FK_MemberFunction: 17214 // Nothing to do. 17215 break; 17216 17217 case FK_FunctionPointer: 17218 DestType = S.Context.getPointerType(DestType); 17219 break; 17220 17221 case FK_BlockPointer: 17222 DestType = S.Context.getBlockPointerType(DestType); 17223 break; 17224 } 17225 17226 // Finally, we can recurse. 17227 ExprResult CalleeResult = Visit(CalleeExpr); 17228 if (!CalleeResult.isUsable()) return ExprError(); 17229 E->setCallee(CalleeResult.get()); 17230 17231 // Bind a temporary if necessary. 17232 return S.MaybeBindToTemporary(E); 17233 } 17234 17235 ExprResult RebuildUnknownAnyExpr::VisitObjCMessageExpr(ObjCMessageExpr *E) { 17236 // Verify that this is a legal result type of a call. 17237 if (DestType->isArrayType() || DestType->isFunctionType()) { 17238 S.Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_func_returning_array_function) 17239 << DestType->isFunctionType() << DestType; 17240 return ExprError(); 17241 } 17242 17243 // Rewrite the method result type if available. 17244 if (ObjCMethodDecl *Method = E->getMethodDecl()) { 17245 assert(Method->getReturnType() == S.Context.UnknownAnyTy); 17246 Method->setReturnType(DestType); 17247 } 17248 17249 // Change the type of the message. 17250 E->setType(DestType.getNonReferenceType()); 17251 E->setValueKind(Expr::getValueKindForType(DestType)); 17252 17253 return S.MaybeBindToTemporary(E); 17254 } 17255 17256 ExprResult RebuildUnknownAnyExpr::VisitImplicitCastExpr(ImplicitCastExpr *E) { 17257 // The only case we should ever see here is a function-to-pointer decay. 17258 if (E->getCastKind() == CK_FunctionToPointerDecay) { 17259 assert(E->getValueKind() == VK_RValue); 17260 assert(E->getObjectKind() == OK_Ordinary); 17261 17262 E->setType(DestType); 17263 17264 // Rebuild the sub-expression as the pointee (function) type. 17265 DestType = DestType->castAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType(); 17266 17267 ExprResult Result = Visit(E->getSubExpr()); 17268 if (!Result.isUsable()) return ExprError(); 17269 17270 E->setSubExpr(Result.get()); 17271 return E; 17272 } else if (E->getCastKind() == CK_LValueToRValue) { 17273 assert(E->getValueKind() == VK_RValue); 17274 assert(E->getObjectKind() == OK_Ordinary); 17275 17276 assert(isa<BlockPointerType>(E->getType())); 17277 17278 E->setType(DestType); 17279 17280 // The sub-expression has to be a lvalue reference, so rebuild it as such. 17281 DestType = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(DestType); 17282 17283 ExprResult Result = Visit(E->getSubExpr()); 17284 if (!Result.isUsable()) return ExprError(); 17285 17286 E->setSubExpr(Result.get()); 17287 return E; 17288 } else { 17289 llvm_unreachable("Unhandled cast type!"); 17290 } 17291 } 17292 17293 ExprResult RebuildUnknownAnyExpr::resolveDecl(Expr *E, ValueDecl *VD) { 17294 ExprValueKind ValueKind = VK_LValue; 17295 QualType Type = DestType; 17296 17297 // We know how to make this work for certain kinds of decls: 17298 17299 // - functions 17300 if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(VD)) { 17301 if (const PointerType *Ptr = Type->getAs<PointerType>()) { 17302 DestType = Ptr->getPointeeType(); 17303 ExprResult Result = resolveDecl(E, VD); 17304 if (Result.isInvalid()) return ExprError(); 17305 return S.ImpCastExprToType(Result.get(), Type, 17306 CK_FunctionToPointerDecay, VK_RValue); 17307 } 17308 17309 if (!Type->isFunctionType()) { 17310 S.Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_unknown_any_function) 17311 << VD << E->getSourceRange(); 17312 return ExprError(); 17313 } 17314 if (const FunctionProtoType *FT = Type->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) { 17315 // We must match the FunctionDecl's type to the hack introduced in 17316 // RebuildUnknownAnyExpr::VisitCallExpr to vararg functions of unknown 17317 // type. See the lengthy commentary in that routine. 17318 QualType FDT = FD->getType(); 17319 const FunctionType *FnType = FDT->castAs<FunctionType>(); 17320 const FunctionProtoType *Proto = dyn_cast_or_null<FunctionProtoType>(FnType); 17321 DeclRefExpr *DRE = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(E); 17322 if (DRE && Proto && Proto->getParamTypes().empty() && Proto->isVariadic()) { 17323 SourceLocation Loc = FD->getLocation(); 17324 FunctionDecl *NewFD = FunctionDecl::Create( 17325 S.Context, FD->getDeclContext(), Loc, Loc, 17326 FD->getNameInfo().getName(), DestType, FD->getTypeSourceInfo(), 17327 SC_None, false /*isInlineSpecified*/, FD->hasPrototype(), 17328 /*ConstexprKind*/ CSK_unspecified); 17329 17330 if (FD->getQualifier()) 17331 NewFD->setQualifierInfo(FD->getQualifierLoc()); 17332 17333 SmallVector<ParmVarDecl*, 16> Params; 17334 for (const auto &AI : FT->param_types()) { 17335 ParmVarDecl *Param = 17336 S.BuildParmVarDeclForTypedef(FD, Loc, AI); 17337 Param->setScopeInfo(0, Params.size()); 17338 Params.push_back(Param); 17339 } 17340 NewFD->setParams(Params); 17341 DRE->setDecl(NewFD); 17342 VD = DRE->getDecl(); 17343 } 17344 } 17345 17346 if (CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FD)) 17347 if (MD->isInstance()) { 17348 ValueKind = VK_RValue; 17349 Type = S.Context.BoundMemberTy; 17350 } 17351 17352 // Function references aren't l-values in C. 17353 if (!S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) 17354 ValueKind = VK_RValue; 17355 17356 // - variables 17357 } else if (isa<VarDecl>(VD)) { 17358 if (const ReferenceType *RefTy = Type->getAs<ReferenceType>()) { 17359 Type = RefTy->getPointeeType(); 17360 } else if (Type->isFunctionType()) { 17361 S.Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_unknown_any_var_function_type) 17362 << VD << E->getSourceRange(); 17363 return ExprError(); 17364 } 17365 17366 // - nothing else 17367 } else { 17368 S.Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_unsupported_unknown_any_decl) 17369 << VD << E->getSourceRange(); 17370 return ExprError(); 17371 } 17372 17373 // Modifying the declaration like this is friendly to IR-gen but 17374 // also really dangerous. 17375 VD->setType(DestType); 17376 E->setType(Type); 17377 E->setValueKind(ValueKind); 17378 return E; 17379 } 17380 17381 /// Check a cast of an unknown-any type. We intentionally only 17382 /// trigger this for C-style casts. 17383 ExprResult Sema::checkUnknownAnyCast(SourceRange TypeRange, QualType CastType, 17384 Expr *CastExpr, CastKind &CastKind, 17385 ExprValueKind &VK, CXXCastPath &Path) { 17386 // The type we're casting to must be either void or complete. 17387 if (!CastType->isVoidType() && 17388 RequireCompleteType(TypeRange.getBegin(), CastType, 17389 diag::err_typecheck_cast_to_incomplete)) 17390 return ExprError(); 17391 17392 // Rewrite the casted expression from scratch. 17393 ExprResult result = RebuildUnknownAnyExpr(*this, CastType).Visit(CastExpr); 17394 if (!result.isUsable()) return ExprError(); 17395 17396 CastExpr = result.get(); 17397 VK = CastExpr->getValueKind(); 17398 CastKind = CK_NoOp; 17399 17400 return CastExpr; 17401 } 17402 17403 ExprResult Sema::forceUnknownAnyToType(Expr *E, QualType ToType) { 17404 return RebuildUnknownAnyExpr(*this, ToType).Visit(E); 17405 } 17406 17407 ExprResult Sema::checkUnknownAnyArg(SourceLocation callLoc, 17408 Expr *arg, QualType ¶mType) { 17409 // If the syntactic form of the argument is not an explicit cast of 17410 // any sort, just do default argument promotion. 17411 ExplicitCastExpr *castArg = dyn_cast<ExplicitCastExpr>(arg->IgnoreParens()); 17412 if (!castArg) { 17413 ExprResult result = DefaultArgumentPromotion(arg); 17414 if (result.isInvalid()) return ExprError(); 17415 paramType = result.get()->getType(); 17416 return result; 17417 } 17418 17419 // Otherwise, use the type that was written in the explicit cast. 17420 assert(!arg->hasPlaceholderType()); 17421 paramType = castArg->getTypeAsWritten(); 17422 17423 // Copy-initialize a parameter of that type. 17424 InitializedEntity entity = 17425 InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context, paramType, 17426 /*consumed*/ false); 17427 return PerformCopyInitialization(entity, callLoc, arg); 17428 } 17429 17430 static ExprResult diagnoseUnknownAnyExpr(Sema &S, Expr *E) { 17431 Expr *orig = E; 17432 unsigned diagID = diag::err_uncasted_use_of_unknown_any; 17433 while (true) { 17434 E = E->IgnoreParenImpCasts(); 17435 if (CallExpr *call = dyn_cast<CallExpr>(E)) { 17436 E = call->getCallee(); 17437 diagID = diag::err_uncasted_call_of_unknown_any; 17438 } else { 17439 break; 17440 } 17441 } 17442 17443 SourceLocation loc; 17444 NamedDecl *d; 17445 if (DeclRefExpr *ref = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(E)) { 17446 loc = ref->getLocation(); 17447 d = ref->getDecl(); 17448 } else if (MemberExpr *mem = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(E)) { 17449 loc = mem->getMemberLoc(); 17450 d = mem->getMemberDecl(); 17451 } else if (ObjCMessageExpr *msg = dyn_cast<ObjCMessageExpr>(E)) { 17452 diagID = diag::err_uncasted_call_of_unknown_any; 17453 loc = msg->getSelectorStartLoc(); 17454 d = msg->getMethodDecl(); 17455 if (!d) { 17456 S.Diag(loc, diag::err_uncasted_send_to_unknown_any_method) 17457 << static_cast<unsigned>(msg->isClassMessage()) << msg->getSelector() 17458 << orig->getSourceRange(); 17459 return ExprError(); 17460 } 17461 } else { 17462 S.Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_unsupported_unknown_any_expr) 17463 << E->getSourceRange(); 17464 return ExprError(); 17465 } 17466 17467 S.Diag(loc, diagID) << d << orig->getSourceRange(); 17468 17469 // Never recoverable. 17470 return ExprError(); 17471 } 17472 17473 /// Check for operands with placeholder types and complain if found. 17474 /// Returns ExprError() if there was an error and no recovery was possible. 17475 ExprResult Sema::CheckPlaceholderExpr(Expr *E) { 17476 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 17477 // C cannot handle TypoExpr nodes on either side of a binop because it 17478 // doesn't handle dependent types properly, so make sure any TypoExprs have 17479 // been dealt with before checking the operands. 17480 ExprResult Result = CorrectDelayedTyposInExpr(E); 17481 if (!Result.isUsable()) return ExprError(); 17482 E = Result.get(); 17483 } 17484 17485 const BuiltinType *placeholderType = E->getType()->getAsPlaceholderType(); 17486 if (!placeholderType) return E; 17487 17488 switch (placeholderType->getKind()) { 17489 17490 // Overloaded expressions. 17491 case BuiltinType::Overload: { 17492 // Try to resolve a single function template specialization. 17493 // This is obligatory. 17494 ExprResult Result = E; 17495 if (ResolveAndFixSingleFunctionTemplateSpecialization(Result, false)) 17496 return Result; 17497 17498 // No guarantees that ResolveAndFixSingleFunctionTemplateSpecialization 17499 // leaves Result unchanged on failure. 17500 Result = E; 17501 if (resolveAndFixAddressOfOnlyViableOverloadCandidate(Result)) 17502 return Result; 17503 17504 // If that failed, try to recover with a call. 17505 tryToRecoverWithCall(Result, PDiag(diag::err_ovl_unresolvable), 17506 /*complain*/ true); 17507 return Result; 17508 } 17509 17510 // Bound member functions. 17511 case BuiltinType::BoundMember: { 17512 ExprResult result = E; 17513 const Expr *BME = E->IgnoreParens(); 17514 PartialDiagnostic PD = PDiag(diag::err_bound_member_function); 17515 // Try to give a nicer diagnostic if it is a bound member that we recognize. 17516 if (isa<CXXPseudoDestructorExpr>(BME)) { 17517 PD = PDiag(diag::err_dtor_expr_without_call) << /*pseudo-destructor*/ 1; 17518 } else if (const auto *ME = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(BME)) { 17519 if (ME->getMemberNameInfo().getName().getNameKind() == 17520 DeclarationName::CXXDestructorName) 17521 PD = PDiag(diag::err_dtor_expr_without_call) << /*destructor*/ 0; 17522 } 17523 tryToRecoverWithCall(result, PD, 17524 /*complain*/ true); 17525 return result; 17526 } 17527 17528 // ARC unbridged casts. 17529 case BuiltinType::ARCUnbridgedCast: { 17530 Expr *realCast = stripARCUnbridgedCast(E); 17531 diagnoseARCUnbridgedCast(realCast); 17532 return realCast; 17533 } 17534 17535 // Expressions of unknown type. 17536 case BuiltinType::UnknownAny: 17537 return diagnoseUnknownAnyExpr(*this, E); 17538 17539 // Pseudo-objects. 17540 case BuiltinType::PseudoObject: 17541 return checkPseudoObjectRValue(E); 17542 17543 case BuiltinType::BuiltinFn: { 17544 // Accept __noop without parens by implicitly converting it to a call expr. 17545 auto *DRE = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(E->IgnoreParenImpCasts()); 17546 if (DRE) { 17547 auto *FD = cast<FunctionDecl>(DRE->getDecl()); 17548 if (FD->getBuiltinID() == Builtin::BI__noop) { 17549 E = ImpCastExprToType(E, Context.getPointerType(FD->getType()), 17550 CK_BuiltinFnToFnPtr) 17551 .get(); 17552 return CallExpr::Create(Context, E, /*Args=*/{}, Context.IntTy, 17553 VK_RValue, SourceLocation()); 17554 } 17555 } 17556 17557 Diag(E->getBeginLoc(), diag::err_builtin_fn_use); 17558 return ExprError(); 17559 } 17560 17561 // Expressions of unknown type. 17562 case BuiltinType::OMPArraySection: 17563 Diag(E->getBeginLoc(), diag::err_omp_array_section_use); 17564 return ExprError(); 17565 17566 // Everything else should be impossible. 17567 #define IMAGE_TYPE(ImgType, Id, SingletonId, Access, Suffix) \ 17568 case BuiltinType::Id: 17569 #include "clang/Basic/OpenCLImageTypes.def" 17570 #define EXT_OPAQUE_TYPE(ExtType, Id, Ext) \ 17571 case BuiltinType::Id: 17572 #include "clang/Basic/OpenCLExtensionTypes.def" 17573 #define SVE_TYPE(Name, Id, SingletonId) \ 17574 case BuiltinType::Id: 17575 #include "clang/Basic/AArch64SVEACLETypes.def" 17576 #define BUILTIN_TYPE(Id, SingletonId) case BuiltinType::Id: 17577 #define PLACEHOLDER_TYPE(Id, SingletonId) 17578 #include "clang/AST/BuiltinTypes.def" 17579 break; 17580 } 17581 17582 llvm_unreachable("invalid placeholder type!"); 17583 } 17584 17585 bool Sema::CheckCaseExpression(Expr *E) { 17586 if (E->isTypeDependent()) 17587 return true; 17588 if (E->isValueDependent() || E->isIntegerConstantExpr(Context)) 17589 return E->getType()->isIntegralOrEnumerationType(); 17590 return false; 17591 } 17592 17593 /// ActOnObjCBoolLiteral - Parse {__objc_yes,__objc_no} literals. 17594 ExprResult 17595 Sema::ActOnObjCBoolLiteral(SourceLocation OpLoc, tok::TokenKind Kind) { 17596 assert((Kind == tok::kw___objc_yes || Kind == tok::kw___objc_no) && 17597 "Unknown Objective-C Boolean value!"); 17598 QualType BoolT = Context.ObjCBuiltinBoolTy; 17599 if (!Context.getBOOLDecl()) { 17600 LookupResult Result(*this, &Context.Idents.get("BOOL"), OpLoc, 17601 Sema::LookupOrdinaryName); 17602 if (LookupName(Result, getCurScope()) && Result.isSingleResult()) { 17603 NamedDecl *ND = Result.getFoundDecl(); 17604 if (TypedefDecl *TD = dyn_cast<TypedefDecl>(ND)) 17605 Context.setBOOLDecl(TD); 17606 } 17607 } 17608 if (Context.getBOOLDecl()) 17609 BoolT = Context.getBOOLType(); 17610 return new (Context) 17611 ObjCBoolLiteralExpr(Kind == tok::kw___objc_yes, BoolT, OpLoc); 17612 } 17613 17614 ExprResult Sema::ActOnObjCAvailabilityCheckExpr( 17615 llvm::ArrayRef<AvailabilitySpec> AvailSpecs, SourceLocation AtLoc, 17616 SourceLocation RParen) { 17617 17618 StringRef Platform = getASTContext().getTargetInfo().getPlatformName(); 17619 17620 auto Spec = llvm::find_if(AvailSpecs, [&](const AvailabilitySpec &Spec) { 17621 return Spec.getPlatform() == Platform; 17622 }); 17623 17624 VersionTuple Version; 17625 if (Spec != AvailSpecs.end()) 17626 Version = Spec->getVersion(); 17627 17628 // The use of `@available` in the enclosing function should be analyzed to 17629 // warn when it's used inappropriately (i.e. not if(@available)). 17630 if (getCurFunctionOrMethodDecl()) 17631 getEnclosingFunction()->HasPotentialAvailabilityViolations = true; 17632 else if (getCurBlock() || getCurLambda()) 17633 getCurFunction()->HasPotentialAvailabilityViolations = true; 17634 17635 return new (Context) 17636 ObjCAvailabilityCheckExpr(Version, AtLoc, RParen, Context.BoolTy); 17637 } 17638